Add a 'starti' command.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 @node Sample Session
550 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
551
552 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
553 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
554 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
555
556 @iftex
557 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
558 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
559 @end iftex
560
561 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
562 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
563
564 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
565 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
566 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
567 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
568 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
569 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
570 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
571 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
572 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
573
574 @smallexample
575 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
576 $ @b{./m4}
577 @b{define(foo,0000)}
578
579 @b{foo}
580 0000
581 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
582
583 @b{bar}
584 0000
585 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
586
587 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
588 @b{baz}
589 @b{Ctrl-d}
590 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
595
596 @smallexample
597 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
598 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
599 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
600 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
601 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
602 the conditions.
603 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
604 for details.
605
606 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
607 (@value{GDBP})
608 @end smallexample
609
610 @noindent
611 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
612 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
613 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
614 that examples fit in this manual.
615
616 @smallexample
617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
618 @end smallexample
619
620 @noindent
621 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
622 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
623 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
624 @code{break} command.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
628 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
633 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
634 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
638 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
639 @b{define(foo,0000)}
640
641 @b{foo}
642 0000
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
647 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
648 context where it stops.
649
650 @smallexample
651 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
652
653 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
654 at builtin.c:879
655 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
660 the next line of the current function.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
664 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
665 : nil,
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
670 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
671 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
672 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
683 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
684 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
685 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
686 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
687 stack frame for each active subroutine.
688
689 @smallexample
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
691 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
692 at input.c:530
693 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
694 at builtin.c:882
695 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
696 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
697 at macro.c:71
698 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
699 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
700 @end smallexample
701
702 @noindent
703 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
704 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
705 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
709 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
711 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
712 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
714 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
715 : xstrdup(rq);
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
717 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
722 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
723 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
724 (@code{print}) to see their values.
725
726 @smallexample
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
728 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
730 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
735 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
736 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
737
738 @smallexample
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
740 533 xfree(rquote);
741 534
742 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
743 : xstrdup (lq);
744 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
745 : xstrdup (rq);
746 537
747 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
748 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
749 540 @}
750 541
751 542 void
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
760 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
762 540 @}
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
764 $3 = 9
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
766 $4 = 7
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
771 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
772 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
773 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
774 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
775 assignments.
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
779 $5 = 7
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
781 $6 = 9
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
786 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
787 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
788 example that caused trouble initially:
789
790 @smallexample
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
792 Continuing.
793
794 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
795
796 baz
797 0000
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @noindent
801 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
802 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
803 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
804
805 @smallexample
806 @b{Ctrl-d}
807 Program exited normally.
808 @end smallexample
809
810 @noindent
811 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
812 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
813 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
814
815 @smallexample
816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
817 @end smallexample
818
819 @node Invocation
820 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
821
822 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
823 The essentials are:
824 @itemize @bullet
825 @item
826 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
827 @item
828 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
829 @end itemize
830
831 @menu
832 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
833 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
834 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
835 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
836 @end menu
837
838 @node Invoking GDB
839 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
840
841 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
842 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
843
844 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
845 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
846
847 The command-line options described here are designed
848 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
849 options may effectively be unavailable.
850
851 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
852 specifying an executable program:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
860 specified:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
864 @end smallexample
865
866 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
867 to debug a running process:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
875 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
876
877 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
878 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
879 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
880 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
881 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
882
883 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
884 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
885 option processing.
886 @smallexample
887 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
888 @end smallexample
889 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
890 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
891
892 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
893 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
894 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
895
896 @smallexample
897 @value{GDBP} --silent
898 @end smallexample
899
900 @noindent
901 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
902 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
903
904 @noindent
905 Type
906
907 @smallexample
908 @value{GDBP} -help
909 @end smallexample
910
911 @noindent
912 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
913 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
914
915 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
916 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
917 @samp{-x} option is used.
918
919
920 @menu
921 * File Options:: Choosing files
922 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
923 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
924 @end menu
925
926 @node File Options
927 @subsection Choosing Files
928
929 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
930 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
931 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
932 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
933 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
934 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
935 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
936 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
937 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
938 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
939 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
940 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
941 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
942
943 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
944 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
945 argument and ignore it.
946
947 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
948 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
949 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
950 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
951 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
952
953 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
954 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
955 @c it.
956
957 @table @code
958 @item -symbols @var{file}
959 @itemx -s @var{file}
960 @cindex @code{--symbols}
961 @cindex @code{-s}
962 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
963
964 @item -exec @var{file}
965 @itemx -e @var{file}
966 @cindex @code{--exec}
967 @cindex @code{-e}
968 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
969 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
970
971 @item -se @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--se}
973 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
974 file.
975
976 @item -core @var{file}
977 @itemx -c @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--core}
979 @cindex @code{-c}
980 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
981
982 @item -pid @var{number}
983 @itemx -p @var{number}
984 @cindex @code{--pid}
985 @cindex @code{-p}
986 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
987
988 @item -command @var{file}
989 @itemx -x @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--command}
991 @cindex @code{-x}
992 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
993 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
994 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
995
996 @item -eval-command @var{command}
997 @itemx -ex @var{command}
998 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
999 @cindex @code{-ex}
1000 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1001
1002 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1003 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1004
1005 @smallexample
1006 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1007 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1008 @end smallexample
1009
1010 @item -init-command @var{file}
1011 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1012 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1013 @cindex @code{-ix}
1014 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1015 after loading gdbinit files).
1016 @xref{Startup}.
1017
1018 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1019 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1020 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1021 @cindex @code{-iex}
1022 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1023 after loading gdbinit files).
1024 @xref{Startup}.
1025
1026 @item -directory @var{directory}
1027 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--directory}
1029 @cindex @code{-d}
1030 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1031
1032 @item -r
1033 @itemx -readnow
1034 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1035 @cindex @code{-r}
1036 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1037 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1038 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1039
1040 @end table
1041
1042 @node Mode Options
1043 @subsection Choosing Modes
1044
1045 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1046 batch mode or quiet mode.
1047
1048 @table @code
1049 @anchor{-nx}
1050 @item -nx
1051 @itemx -n
1052 @cindex @code{--nx}
1053 @cindex @code{-n}
1054 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1055 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1056
1057 @table @code
1058 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1059 This is the system-wide init file.
1060 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1061 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1062 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1063 have been processed.
1064 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1065 This is the init file in your home directory.
1066 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1067 command options have been processed.
1068 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1069 This is the init file in the current directory.
1070 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1071 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1072 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1073 @end table
1074
1075 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1076 For documentation on how to write command files,
1077 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1078
1079 @anchor{-nh}
1080 @item -nh
1081 @cindex @code{--nh}
1082 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1083 in your home directory.
1084 @xref{Startup}.
1085
1086 @item -quiet
1087 @itemx -silent
1088 @itemx -q
1089 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1090 @cindex @code{--silent}
1091 @cindex @code{-q}
1092 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1093 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1094
1095 @item -batch
1096 @cindex @code{--batch}
1097 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1098 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1099 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1100 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1101 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1102 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1103 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1104
1105 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1106 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1107 make this more useful, the message
1108
1109 @smallexample
1110 Program exited normally.
1111 @end smallexample
1112
1113 @noindent
1114 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1115 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1116 mode.
1117
1118 @item -batch-silent
1119 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1120 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1121 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1122 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1123 for an interactive session.
1124
1125 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1126 messages, for example.
1127
1128 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1129 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1130
1131 @item -return-child-result
1132 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1133 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1134 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137 @item
1138 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1139 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1140 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1141 @item
1142 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1143 @item
1144 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1145 the exit code will be -1.
1146 @end itemize
1147
1148 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1149 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1150 interface.
1151
1152 @item -nowindows
1153 @itemx -nw
1154 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1155 @cindex @code{-nw}
1156 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1157 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1158 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1159
1160 @item -windows
1161 @itemx -w
1162 @cindex @code{--windows}
1163 @cindex @code{-w}
1164 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1165 used if possible.
1166
1167 @item -cd @var{directory}
1168 @cindex @code{--cd}
1169 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1170 instead of the current directory.
1171
1172 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1173 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1174 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1175 @cindex @code{-D}
1176 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1177 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1178 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1179
1180 @item -fullname
1181 @itemx -f
1182 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1183 @cindex @code{-f}
1184 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1185 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1186 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1187 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1188 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1189 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1190 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1191 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1192 frame.
1193
1194 @item -annotate @var{level}
1195 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1196 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1197 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1198 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1199 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1200 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1201 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1202 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1203 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1204
1205 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1206 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1207
1208 @item --args
1209 @cindex @code{--args}
1210 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1211 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1212 This option stops option processing.
1213
1214 @item -baud @var{bps}
1215 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1216 @cindex @code{--baud}
1217 @cindex @code{-b}
1218 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1219 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -l @var{timeout}
1222 @cindex @code{-l}
1223 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1224 for remote debugging.
1225
1226 @item -tty @var{device}
1227 @itemx -t @var{device}
1228 @cindex @code{--tty}
1229 @cindex @code{-t}
1230 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1231 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1232
1233 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1234 @item -tui
1235 @cindex @code{--tui}
1236 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1237 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1238 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1239 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1240 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1241 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1242
1243 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1244 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1245 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1246 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1247 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1248 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1249
1250 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1251 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1252 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1253 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1254 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1255 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1256
1257 @item -write
1258 @cindex @code{--write}
1259 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1260 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1261 (@pxref{Patching}).
1262
1263 @item -statistics
1264 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1266 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1267
1268 @item -version
1269 @cindex @code{--version}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1271 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1272
1273 @item -configuration
1274 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1275 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1276 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1277 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1278
1279 @end table
1280
1281 @node Startup
1282 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1283 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1284
1285 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1286
1287 @enumerate
1288 @item
1289 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1290 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1291
1292 @item
1293 @cindex init file
1294 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1295 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1296 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1297 that file.
1298
1299 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1300 @item
1301 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1302 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1303 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1304 that file.
1305
1306 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1307 @item
1308 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1309 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1310 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1311 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1312 gets loaded.
1313
1314 @item
1315 Processes command line options and operands.
1316
1317 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1318 @item
1319 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1320 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1321 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1322 This is only done if the current directory is
1323 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1324 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1325 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1326 @value{GDBN}.
1327
1328 @item
1329 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1330 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1331 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1332 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1333
1334 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1335 you must do something like the following:
1336
1337 @smallexample
1338 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1339 @end smallexample
1340
1341 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1342 off too late.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1346 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1347 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1348
1349 @item
1350 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1351 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1352 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1353 @end enumerate
1354
1355 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1356 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1357 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1358 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1359 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1360 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1361
1362 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1363 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1364
1365 @cindex init file name
1366 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1367 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1368 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1369 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1370 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1371 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1372 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1373 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1374
1375
1376 @node Quitting GDB
1377 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1378 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1379 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1380
1381 @table @code
1382 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1383 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1384 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @itemx q
1386 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1387 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1388 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1389 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1390 error code.
1391 @end table
1392
1393 @cindex interrupt
1394 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1395 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1396 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1397 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1398 until a time when it is safe.
1399
1400 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1401 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1402 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1403
1404 @node Shell Commands
1405 @section Shell Commands
1406
1407 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1408 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1409 just use the @code{shell} command.
1410
1411 @table @code
1412 @kindex shell
1413 @kindex !
1414 @cindex shell escape
1415 @item shell @var{command-string}
1416 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1417 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1418 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1419 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1420 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1421 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1422 @end table
1423
1424 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1425 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1426 @value{GDBN}:
1427
1428 @table @code
1429 @kindex make
1430 @cindex calling make
1431 @item make @var{make-args}
1432 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1433 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1434 @end table
1435
1436 @node Logging Output
1437 @section Logging Output
1438 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1439 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1440
1441 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1442 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1443
1444 @table @code
1445 @kindex set logging
1446 @item set logging on
1447 Enable logging.
1448 @item set logging off
1449 Disable logging.
1450 @cindex logging file name
1451 @item set logging file @var{file}
1452 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1453 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1454 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1455 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1456 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1457 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1458 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1459 @kindex show logging
1460 @item show logging
1461 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1462 @end table
1463
1464 @node Commands
1465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1466
1467 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1468 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1469 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1470 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1471 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1472
1473 @menu
1474 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1475 * Completion:: Command completion
1476 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1477 @end menu
1478
1479 @node Command Syntax
1480 @section Command Syntax
1481
1482 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1483 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1484 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1485 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1486 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1487 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1488
1489 @cindex abbreviation
1490 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1491 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1492 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1493 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1494 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1495 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1496 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1497
1498 @cindex repeating commands
1499 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1500 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1501 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1502 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1503 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1504 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1505 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1506
1507 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1508 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1509 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1510
1511 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1512 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1513 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1514 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1515 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1516
1517 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1518 @cindex comment
1519 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1520 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1521 Files,,Command Files}).
1522
1523 @cindex repeating command sequences
1524 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1525 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1526 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1527 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1528 for editing.
1529
1530 @node Completion
1531 @section Command Completion
1532
1533 @cindex completion
1534 @cindex word completion
1535 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1536 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1537 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1538 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1539
1540 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1541 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1542 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1543 enter it). For example, if you type
1544
1545 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1546 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1547 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1548 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1549 @smallexample
1550 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1555 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 @noindent
1562 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1563 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1564 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1565 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1566 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1567 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1568
1569 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1570 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1571 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1572 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1573 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1574 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1575 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1576 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1577 example:
1578
1579 @smallexample
1580 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1581 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1582 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1583 make_abs_section make_function_type
1584 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1585 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1586 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1587 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1592 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1593 command.
1594
1595 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1596 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1597 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1598 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1599 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1600
1601 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1602 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1603 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1604
1605 @smallexample
1606 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1607 main
1608 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1609 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1610 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 @noindent
1614 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1615
1616 @table @code
1617 @kindex set max-completions
1618 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1619 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1620 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1621 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1622 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1623 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1624 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1625 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1626 completion slow.
1627 @kindex show max-completions
1628 @item show max-completions
1629 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1630 during completion.
1631 @end table
1632
1633 @cindex quotes in commands
1634 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1635 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1636 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1637 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1638 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1639 @value{GDBN} commands.
1640
1641 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1642 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1643 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1644 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1645 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1646 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1647 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1648 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1649 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1650 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1651 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1652
1653 @smallexample
1654 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1655 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1657 @end smallexample
1658
1659 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1660 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1661 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1662 place:
1663
1664 @smallexample
1665 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1666 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1668 @end smallexample
1669
1670 @noindent
1671 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1672 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1673 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1674
1675 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1676 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1677 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1678 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1679
1680 @cindex completion of structure field names
1681 @cindex structure field name completion
1682 @cindex completion of union field names
1683 @cindex union field name completion
1684 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1685 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1686 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1687 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1688 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1689 left-hand-side:
1690
1691 @smallexample
1692 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1693 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1694 to_data to_isatty to_write
1695 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1696 to_flush to_read
1697 @end smallexample
1698
1699 @noindent
1700 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1701 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1702 follows:
1703
1704 @smallexample
1705 struct ui_file
1706 @{
1707 int *magic;
1708 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1709 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1710 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1711 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1712 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1713 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1714 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1715 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1716 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1717 void *to_data;
1718 @}
1719 @end smallexample
1720
1721
1722 @node Help
1723 @section Getting Help
1724 @cindex online documentation
1725 @kindex help
1726
1727 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1728 using the command @code{help}.
1729
1730 @table @code
1731 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1732 @item help
1733 @itemx h
1734 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1735 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 (@value{GDBP}) help
1739 List of classes of commands:
1740
1741 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1742 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1743 data -- Examining data
1744 files -- Specifying and examining files
1745 internals -- Maintenance commands
1746 obscure -- Obscure features
1747 running -- Running the program
1748 stack -- Examining the stack
1749 status -- Status inquiries
1750 support -- Support facilities
1751 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1752 stopping the program
1753 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1754
1755 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1756 commands in that class.
1757 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1758 documentation.
1759 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1760 (@value{GDBP})
1761 @end smallexample
1762 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1763
1764 @item help @var{class}
1765 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1766 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1767 help display for the class @code{status}:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1771 Status inquiries.
1772
1773 List of commands:
1774
1775 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1776 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1777 info -- Generic command for showing things
1778 about the program being debugged
1779 show -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the debugger
1781
1782 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1783 documentation.
1784 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1785 (@value{GDBP})
1786 @end smallexample
1787
1788 @item help @var{command}
1789 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1790 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1791
1792 @kindex apropos
1793 @item apropos @var{args}
1794 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1795 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1796 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1797
1798 @smallexample
1799 apropos alias
1800 @end smallexample
1801
1802 @noindent
1803 results in:
1804
1805 @smallexample
1806 @c @group
1807 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1808 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1809 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1810 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1811 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 @c @end group
1813 @end smallexample
1814
1815 @kindex complete
1816 @item complete @var{args}
1817 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1818 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1819 command you want completed. For example:
1820
1821 @smallexample
1822 complete i
1823 @end smallexample
1824
1825 @noindent results in:
1826
1827 @smallexample
1828 @group
1829 if
1830 ignore
1831 info
1832 inspect
1833 @end group
1834 @end smallexample
1835
1836 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1837 @end table
1838
1839 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1840 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1841 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1842 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1843 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1844 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1845 Index}.
1846
1847 @c @group
1848 @table @code
1849 @kindex info
1850 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1851 @item info
1852 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1853 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1854 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1855 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1856 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1857 @w{@code{help info}}.
1858
1859 @kindex set
1860 @item set
1861 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1862 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1863 @code{set prompt $}.
1864
1865 @kindex show
1866 @item show
1867 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1868 @value{GDBN} itself.
1869 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1870 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1871 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1872 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1873
1874 @kindex info set
1875 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1876 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1877 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1878 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1879 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1880 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1881 @end table
1882 @c @end group
1883
1884 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1885 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1886
1887 @table @code
1888 @kindex show version
1889 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1890 @item show version
1891 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1892 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1893 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1894 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1895 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1896 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1897 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1898 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1899 @value{GDBN}.
1900
1901 @kindex show copying
1902 @kindex info copying
1903 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1904 @item show copying
1905 @itemx info copying
1906 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1907
1908 @kindex show warranty
1909 @kindex info warranty
1910 @item show warranty
1911 @itemx info warranty
1912 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1913 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1914
1915 @kindex show configuration
1916 @item show configuration
1917 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1918 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1919 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1920 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1921 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1922 your report.
1923
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @node Running
1927 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1928
1929 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1930 debugging information when you compile it.
1931
1932 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1933 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1934 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1935 kill a child process.
1936
1937 @menu
1938 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1939 * Starting:: Starting your program
1940 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1941 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1942
1943 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1944 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1945 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1946 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1947
1948 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1949 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1950 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1951 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1952 @end menu
1953
1954 @node Compilation
1955 @section Compiling for Debugging
1956
1957 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1958 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1959 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1960 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1961 and addresses in the executable code.
1962
1963 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1964 the compiler.
1965
1966 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1967 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1968 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1969 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1970 executables containing debugging information.
1971
1972 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1973 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1974 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1975 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1976 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1977
1978 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1979 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1980 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1981
1982 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1983 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1984 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1985 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1986 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1987 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1988
1989 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1990 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1991 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1992
1993 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1994 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1995 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1996 format in @value{GDBN}.
1997
1998 @need 2000
1999 @node Starting
2000 @section Starting your Program
2001 @cindex starting
2002 @cindex running
2003
2004 @table @code
2005 @kindex run
2006 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2007 @item run
2008 @itemx r
2009 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2010 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2011 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2012 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2013 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2014
2015 @end table
2016
2017 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2018 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2019 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2020 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2021 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2022 message like this one:
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2026 Try "help target" or "continue".
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2031 first (@pxref{load}).
2032
2033 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2034 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2035 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2036 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2037 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2038 divided into four categories:
2039
2040 @table @asis
2041 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2042 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2043 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2044 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2045 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2046 the arguments.
2047 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2048 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2049 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2050 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2051 below for details).
2052
2053 @item The @emph{environment.}
2054 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2055 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2056 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2057 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2060 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2061 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2062 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2063
2064 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2065 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2066 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2067 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2068 set a different device for your program.
2069 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2070
2071 @cindex pipes
2072 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2073 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2074 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2075 wrong program.
2076 @end table
2077
2078 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2079 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2080 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2081 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2082 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2083
2084 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2085 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2086 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2087 your current breakpoints.
2088
2089 @table @code
2090 @kindex start
2091 @item start
2092 @cindex run to main procedure
2093 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2094 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2095 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2096 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2097 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2098 procedure, depending on the language used.
2099
2100 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2101 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2102 the @samp{run} command.
2103
2104 @cindex elaboration phase
2105 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2106 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2107 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2108 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2109 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2110 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2111 will remain to halt execution.
2112
2113 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2114 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2115 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2116 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2117 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2118
2119 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2120 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2121 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2122 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2123 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2124 use the @code{starti} command.
2125
2126 @kindex starti
2127 @item starti
2128 @cindex run to first instruction
2129 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2130 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2131 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2132 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2133 the start of the elaboration phase.
2134
2135 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2136 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2137 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2138 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2139 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2140 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2141 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2142 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2143 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2144 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2145 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2146 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2147
2148 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2149 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2150 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2151 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2152
2153 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2154 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2155 environment:
2156
2157 @smallexample
2158 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2159 (@value{GDBP}) run
2160 @end smallexample
2161
2162 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2163 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2164
2165 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2166 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2167 @item set startup-with-shell
2168 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2169 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2170 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2171 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2172 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2173 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2174 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2175 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2176 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2177 startup failures such as:
2178
2179 @smallexample
2180 (@value{GDBP}) run
2181 Starting program: ./a.out
2182 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2183 @end smallexample
2184
2185 @noindent
2186 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2187 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2188 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2189 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2190 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2191 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2192
2193 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2194 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2195 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2196 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2197 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2198 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2199
2200 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2201 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2202 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2203 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2204 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2205 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2206
2207 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2208 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2209 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2210
2211 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2212 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2220 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2221
2222 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2223 @code{target native} command. For example,
2224
2225 @smallexample
2226 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2227 (@value{GDBP}) run
2228 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2229 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2230 (@value{GDBP}) run
2231 Starting program: ./a.out
2232 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2233 @end smallexample
2234
2235 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2236 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2237 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2238 disconnect.
2239
2240 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2241 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2242 proc}, @code{info os}.
2243
2244 @kindex set disable-randomization
2245 @item set disable-randomization
2246 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2247 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2248 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2249 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2250 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2251
2252 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2253 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2254
2255 @smallexample
2256 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2257 @end smallexample
2258
2259 @item set disable-randomization off
2260 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2261 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2262 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2263 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2264 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2265 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2266
2267 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2268 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2269 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2270 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2271 a code at its expected addresses.
2272
2273 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2274 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2275 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2276 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2277 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2278 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2279 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2280 a randomly chosen address.
2281
2282 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2283 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2284 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2285 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2286 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2287
2288 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2289 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2290
2291 @item show disable-randomization
2292 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2293 the virtual address space of the started program.
2294
2295 @end table
2296
2297 @node Arguments
2298 @section Your Program's Arguments
2299
2300 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2301 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2302 @code{run} command.
2303 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2304 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2305 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2306 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2307 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2308
2309 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2310 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2311 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2312 the program, not by the shell.
2313
2314 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2315 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2316
2317 @table @code
2318 @kindex set args
2319 @item set args
2320 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2321 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2322 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2323 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2324 it again without arguments.
2325
2326 @kindex show args
2327 @item show args
2328 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2329 @end table
2330
2331 @node Environment
2332 @section Your Program's Environment
2333
2334 @cindex environment (of your program)
2335 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2336 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2337 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2338 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2339 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2340 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2341 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2342
2343 @table @code
2344 @kindex path
2345 @item path @var{directory}
2346 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2347 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2348 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2349 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2350 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2351 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2352 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2353
2354 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2355 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2356 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2357 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2358 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2359 @var{directory} to the search path.
2360 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2361 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2362
2363 @kindex show paths
2364 @item show paths
2365 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2366 environment variable).
2367
2368 @kindex show environment
2369 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2370 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2371 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2372 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2373 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2374
2375 @kindex set environment
2376 @anchor{set environment}
2377 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2378 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2379 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2380 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2381 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2382 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2383 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2384 null value.
2385 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2386 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2387
2388 For example, this command:
2389
2390 @smallexample
2391 set env USER = foo
2392 @end smallexample
2393
2394 @noindent
2395 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2396 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2397 are not actually required.)
2398
2399 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2400 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2401 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2402 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2403 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2404
2405 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2406 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2407 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2408
2409 @kindex unset environment
2410 @anchor{unset environment}
2411 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2412 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2413 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2414 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2415 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2416
2417 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2418 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2419 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2420 @end table
2421
2422 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2423 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2424 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2425 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2426 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2427 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2428 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2429 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2430 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2431 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2432
2433 @node Working Directory
2434 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2435
2436 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2437 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2438 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2439 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2440 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2441 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2442
2443 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2444 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2445 Specify Files}.
2446
2447 @table @code
2448 @kindex cd
2449 @cindex change working directory
2450 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2451 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2452 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2453
2454 @kindex pwd
2455 @item pwd
2456 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2460 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2461 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2462 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2463 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2464 current working directory of the debuggee.
2465
2466 @node Input/Output
2467 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2468
2469 @cindex redirection
2470 @cindex i/o
2471 @cindex terminal
2472 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2473 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2474 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2475 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2476 running your program.
2477
2478 @table @code
2479 @kindex info terminal
2480 @item info terminal
2481 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2482 program is using.
2483 @end table
2484
2485 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2486 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2487
2488 @smallexample
2489 run > outfile
2490 @end smallexample
2491
2492 @noindent
2493 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2494
2495 @kindex tty
2496 @cindex controlling terminal
2497 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2498 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2499 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2500 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2501 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2502
2503 @smallexample
2504 tty /dev/ttyb
2505 @end smallexample
2506
2507 @noindent
2508 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2509 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2510 that as their controlling terminal.
2511
2512 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2513 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2514 terminal.
2515
2516 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2517 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2518 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2519 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2520
2521 @cindex inferior tty
2522 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2523 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2524 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2525 program.
2526
2527 @table @code
2528 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2529 @kindex set inferior-tty
2530 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2531 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2532 @value{GDBN}.
2533
2534 @item show inferior-tty
2535 @kindex show inferior-tty
2536 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2537 @end table
2538
2539 @node Attach
2540 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2541 @kindex attach
2542 @cindex attach
2543
2544 @table @code
2545 @item attach @var{process-id}
2546 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2547 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2548 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2549 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2550 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2551
2552 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2553 executing the command.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2557 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2558 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2559 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2560
2561 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2562 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2563 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2564 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2565 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2566 Specify Files}.
2567
2568 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2569 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2570 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2571 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2572 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2573 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2574 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2575
2576 @table @code
2577 @kindex detach
2578 @item detach
2579 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2580 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2581 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2582 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2583 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2584 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2585 executing the command.
2586 @end table
2587
2588 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2589 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2590 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2591 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2592 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2593 Messages}).
2594
2595 @node Kill Process
2596 @section Killing the Child Process
2597
2598 @table @code
2599 @kindex kill
2600 @item kill
2601 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2605 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2606 is running.
2607
2608 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2609 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2610 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2611 outside the debugger.
2612
2613 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2614 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2615 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2616 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2617 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2618 breakpoint settings).
2619
2620 @node Inferiors and Programs
2621 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2622
2623 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2624 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2625 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2626 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2627 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2628 from multiple executables.
2629
2630 @cindex inferior
2631 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2632 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2633 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2634 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2635 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2636 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2637 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2638 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2639 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2640 threads running in it.
2641
2642 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2643 inferiors}}:
2644
2645 @table @code
2646 @kindex info inferiors
2647 @item info inferiors
2648 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2649
2650 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2651
2652 @enumerate
2653 @item
2654 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2655
2656 @item
2657 the target system's inferior identifier
2658
2659 @item
2660 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2661
2662 @end enumerate
2663
2664 @noindent
2665 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2666 indicates the current inferior.
2667
2668 For example,
2669 @end table
2670 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2671
2672 @smallexample
2673 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2674 Num Description Executable
2675 2 process 2307 hello
2676 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2677 @end smallexample
2678
2679 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2680
2681 @table @code
2682 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2683 @item inferior @var{infno}
2684 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2685 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2686 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2687 @end table
2688
2689 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2690 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2691 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2692 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2693 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2694 information on convenience variables.
2695
2696 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2697 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2698 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2699 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2700 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2701 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2702
2703 @table @code
2704 @kindex add-inferior
2705 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2706 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2707 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2708 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2709 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2710 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2711
2712 @kindex clone-inferior
2713 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2714 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2715 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2716 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2717 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2718
2719 @smallexample
2720 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2721 Num Description Executable
2722 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2723 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2724 Added inferior 2.
2725 1 inferiors added.
2726 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2727 Num Description Executable
2728 2 <null> helloworld
2729 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2730 @end smallexample
2731
2732 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2733
2734 @kindex remove-inferiors
2735 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2736 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2737 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2738 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2739
2740 @end table
2741
2742 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2743 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2744 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2745 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2746
2747 @table @code
2748 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2749 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2750 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2751 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2752 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2753 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2754
2755 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2756 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2757 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2758 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2759 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2760 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2761 @end table
2762
2763 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2764 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2765 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2766 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2767
2768
2769 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2770 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2771
2772 @table @code
2773 @kindex set print inferior-events
2774 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2775 @item set print inferior-events
2776 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2777 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2778 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2779 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2780 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2781 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2782
2783 @kindex show print inferior-events
2784 @item show print inferior-events
2785 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2786 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2787 @end table
2788
2789 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2790 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2791 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2792
2793
2794 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2795 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2796 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2797 info program-spaces}} command.
2798
2799 @table @code
2800 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2801 @item maint info program-spaces
2802 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2803 @value{GDBN}.
2804
2805 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2806
2807 @enumerate
2808 @item
2809 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2810
2811 @item
2812 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2813 the @code{file} command.
2814
2815 @end enumerate
2816
2817 @noindent
2818 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2819 indicates the current program space.
2820
2821 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2822 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2823 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2824
2825 @smallexample
2826 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2827 Id Executable
2828 * 1 hello
2829 2 goodbye
2830 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2831 @end smallexample
2832
2833 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2834 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2835 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2836 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2837 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2838
2839 @smallexample
2840 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2841 Id Executable
2842 * 1 vfork-test
2843 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2844 @end smallexample
2845
2846 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2847 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2848 @end table
2849
2850 @node Threads
2851 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2852
2853 @cindex threads of execution
2854 @cindex multiple threads
2855 @cindex switching threads
2856 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2857 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2858 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2859 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2860 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2861 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2862 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2863
2864 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2865 programs:
2866
2867 @itemize @bullet
2868 @item automatic notification of new threads
2869 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2870 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2871 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2872 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2873 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2874 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2875 messages on thread start and exit.
2876 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2877 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2878 isn't compatible with the program.
2879 @end itemize
2880
2881 @cindex focus of debugging
2882 @cindex current thread
2883 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2884 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2885 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2886 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2887 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2888
2889 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2890 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2891 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2892 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2893 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2894 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2895 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2896 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2897 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2898 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2899
2900 @smallexample
2901 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2902 @end smallexample
2903
2904 @noindent
2905 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2906 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2907 further qualifier.
2908
2909 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2910 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2911 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2912 @c program?
2913 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2914 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2915 @c threads ab initio?
2916
2917 @anchor{thread numbers}
2918 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2919 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2920 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2921 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2922 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2923 between threads of different inferiors.
2924
2925 @cindex qualified thread ID
2926 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2927 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2928 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2929 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2930 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2931 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2932 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2933 inferior.
2934
2935 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2936 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2937 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2938 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2939
2940 @anchor{thread ID lists}
2941 @cindex thread ID lists
2942 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2943 argument. A list element can be:
2944
2945 @enumerate
2946 @item
2947 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2948 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2949 @samp{1}.
2950
2951 @item
2952 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2953 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2954 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2955
2956 @item
2957 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2958 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2959 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
2960 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2961 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2962
2963 @end enumerate
2964
2965 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2966 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2967 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
2968 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
2969 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
2970 7.1}.
2971
2972
2973 @anchor{global thread numbers}
2974 @cindex global thread number
2975 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2976 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2977 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2978 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
2979 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2980 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2981
2982 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2983 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2984 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2985
2986 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2987 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2988 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2989 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2990 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
2991 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2992 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2993 general information on convenience variables.
2994
2995 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2996 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2997 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2998
2999 @smallexample
3000 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3001 @end smallexample
3002
3003 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3004
3005 @smallexample
3006 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3007 @end smallexample
3008
3009 @table @code
3010 @kindex info threads
3011 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3012
3013 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3014 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3015 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3016 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3017
3018 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3019
3020 @enumerate
3021 @item
3022 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3023
3024 @item
3025 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3026 option was specified
3027
3028 @item
3029 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3030
3031 @item
3032 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3033 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3034 program itself.
3035
3036 @item
3037 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3038 @end enumerate
3039
3040 @noindent
3041 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3042 indicates the current thread.
3043
3044 For example,
3045 @end table
3046 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3047
3048 @smallexample
3049 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3050 Id Target Id Frame
3051 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3052 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3053 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3054 at threadtest.c:68
3055 @end smallexample
3056
3057 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3058 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3059 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3060
3061 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3062 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3063
3064 @smallexample
3065 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3066 Id GId Target Id Frame
3067 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3068 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3069 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3070 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3074 Solaris-specific command:
3075
3076 @table @code
3077 @item maint info sol-threads
3078 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3079 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3080 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3081 @end table
3082
3083 @table @code
3084 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3085 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3086 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3087 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3088 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3089 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3090
3091 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3092 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3093
3094 @smallexample
3095 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3096 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3097 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3098 8 printf ("hello\n");
3099 @end smallexample
3100
3101 @noindent
3102 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3103 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3104 threads.
3105
3106 @kindex thread apply
3107 @cindex apply command to several threads
3108 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3109 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3110 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3111 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3112 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3113 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3114 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3115 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3116
3117
3118 @kindex thread name
3119 @cindex name a thread
3120 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3121 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3122 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3123 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3124
3125 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3126 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3127 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3128 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3129 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3130
3131 @kindex thread find
3132 @cindex search for a thread
3133 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3134 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3135 matches the supplied regular expression.
3136
3137 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3138 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3139 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3140 is the LWP id.
3141
3142 @smallexample
3143 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3144 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3145 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3146 Id Target Id Frame
3147 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3148 @end smallexample
3149
3150 @kindex set print thread-events
3151 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3152 @item set print thread-events
3153 @itemx set print thread-events on
3154 @itemx set print thread-events off
3155 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3156 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3157 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3158 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3159 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3160
3161 @kindex show print thread-events
3162 @item show print thread-events
3163 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3164 have started and exited.
3165 @end table
3166
3167 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3168 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3169 programs with multiple threads.
3170
3171 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3172 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3173
3174 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3175 @table @code
3176 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3177 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3178 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3179 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3180 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3181 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3182 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3183 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3184 macro.
3185
3186 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3187 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3188 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3189 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3190 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3191 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3192
3193 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3194 refers to the default system directories that are
3195 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3196 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3197 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3198
3199 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3200 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3201 was loaded in the inferior process.
3202
3203 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3204 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3205 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3206 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3207 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3208 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3209 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3210
3211 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3212 only on some platforms.
3213
3214 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3215 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3216 Display current libthread_db search path.
3217
3218 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3219 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3220 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3221 @item set debug libthread-db
3222 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3223 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3224 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3225 @end table
3226
3227 @node Forks
3228 @section Debugging Forks
3229
3230 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3231 @cindex multiple processes
3232 @cindex processes, multiple
3233 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3234 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3235 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3236 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3237 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3238 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3239 will cause it to terminate.
3240
3241 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3242 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3243 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3244 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3245 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3246 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3247 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3248 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3249 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3250 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3251
3252 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3253 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3254 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3255 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3256
3257 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3258 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3259 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3260
3261 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3262 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3263
3264 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3265 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3266
3267 @table @code
3268 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3269 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3270 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3271 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3272 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3273
3274 @table @code
3275 @item parent
3276 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3277 unimpeded. This is the default.
3278
3279 @item child
3280 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3281 unimpeded.
3282
3283 @end table
3284
3285 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3286 @item show follow-fork-mode
3287 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3288 @end table
3289
3290 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3291 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3292 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3293
3294 @table @code
3295 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3296 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3297 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3298 retain debugger control over them both.
3299
3300 @table @code
3301 @item on
3302 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3303 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3304 independently. This is the default.
3305
3306 @item off
3307 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3308 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3309 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3310 is held suspended.
3311
3312 @end table
3313
3314 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3315 @item show detach-on-fork
3316 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3317 @end table
3318
3319 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3320 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3321 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3322 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3323 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3324 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3325
3326 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3327 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3328 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3329 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3330 and Programs}.
3331
3332 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3333 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3334 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3335 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3336 the child process's @code{main}.
3337
3338 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3339 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3340
3341 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3342 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3343 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3344 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3345 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3346 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3347 command.
3348
3349 @table @code
3350 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3351 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3352
3353 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3354 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3355
3356 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3357
3358 @table @code
3359 @item new
3360 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3361 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3362 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3363 original inferior.
3364
3365 For example:
3366
3367 @smallexample
3368 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3369 (gdb) info inferior
3370 Id Description Executable
3371 * 1 <null> prog1
3372 (@value{GDBP}) run
3373 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3374 Program exited normally.
3375 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3376 Id Description Executable
3377 1 <null> prog1
3378 * 2 <null> prog2
3379 @end smallexample
3380
3381 @item same
3382 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3383 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3384 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3385 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3386 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3387
3388 For example:
3389
3390 @smallexample
3391 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3392 Id Description Executable
3393 * 1 <null> prog1
3394 (@value{GDBP}) run
3395 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3396 Program exited normally.
3397 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3398 Id Description Executable
3399 * 1 <null> prog2
3400 @end smallexample
3401
3402 @end table
3403 @end table
3404
3405 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3406 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3407
3408 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3409 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3410 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3411
3412 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3413 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3414
3415 @cindex checkpoint
3416 @cindex restart
3417 @cindex bookmark
3418 @cindex snapshot of a process
3419 @cindex rewind program state
3420
3421 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3422 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3423 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3424 later.
3425
3426 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3427 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3428 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3429 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3430 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3431
3432 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3433 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3434 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3435 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3436 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3437 start again from there.
3438
3439 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3440 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3441
3442 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3443
3444 @table @code
3445 @kindex checkpoint
3446 @item checkpoint
3447 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3448 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3449 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3450
3451 @kindex info checkpoints
3452 @item info checkpoints
3453 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3454 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3455 listed:
3456
3457 @table @code
3458 @item Checkpoint ID
3459 @item Process ID
3460 @item Code Address
3461 @item Source line, or label
3462 @end table
3463
3464 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3465 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3466 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3467 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3468 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3469 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3470 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3471
3472 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3473 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3474 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3475 the debugger.
3476
3477 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3478 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3479 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3480
3481 @end table
3482
3483 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3484 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3485 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3486 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3487 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3488 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3489 previously read data can be read again.
3490
3491 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3492 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3493 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3494 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3495 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3496 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3497
3498 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3499 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3500 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3501 different execution path this time.
3502
3503 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3504 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3505 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3506 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3507 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3508 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3509 potentially pose a problem.
3510
3511 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3512
3513 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3514 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3515 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3516 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3517 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3518 next.
3519
3520 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3521 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3522 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3523 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3524 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3525
3526 @node Stopping
3527 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3528
3529 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3530 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3531 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3532
3533 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3534 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3535 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3536 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3537 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3538 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3539 explicitly request this information at any time.
3540
3541 @table @code
3542 @kindex info program
3543 @item info program
3544 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3545 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3546 @end table
3547
3548 @menu
3549 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3550 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3551 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3552 Skipping over functions and files
3553 * Signals:: Signals
3554 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3555 @end menu
3556
3557 @node Breakpoints
3558 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3559
3560 @cindex breakpoints
3561 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3562 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3563 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3564 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3565 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3566 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3567 program.
3568
3569 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3570 the executable is run.
3571
3572 @cindex watchpoints
3573 @cindex data breakpoints
3574 @cindex memory tracing
3575 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3576 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3577 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3578 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3579 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3580 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3581 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3582 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3583 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3584 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3585 same commands.
3586
3587 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3588 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3589 Automatic Display}.
3590
3591 @cindex catchpoints
3592 @cindex breakpoint on events
3593 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3594 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3595 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3596 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3597 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3598 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3599 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3600
3601 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3602 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3603 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3604 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3605 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3606 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3607 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3608 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3609 enable it again.
3610
3611 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3612 @cindex breakpoint lists
3613 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3614 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3615 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3616 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3617 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3618 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3619 are operated on.
3620
3621 @menu
3622 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3623 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3624 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3625 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3626 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3627 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3628 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3629 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3630 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3631 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3632 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3633 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3634 @end menu
3635
3636 @node Set Breaks
3637 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3638
3639 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3640 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3641 @c
3642 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3643
3644 @kindex break
3645 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3646 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3647 @cindex latest breakpoint
3648 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3649 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3650 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3651 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3652 convenience variables.
3653
3654 @table @code
3655 @item break @var{location}
3656 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3657 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3658 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3659 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3660 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3661
3662 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3663 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3664 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3665 that situation.
3666
3667 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3668 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3669 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3670
3671 @item break
3672 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3673 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3674 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3675 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3676 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3677 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3678 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3679 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3680 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3681 inside loops.
3682
3683 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3684 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3685 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3686 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3687 existed when your program stopped.
3688
3689 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3690 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3691 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3692 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3693 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3694 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3695 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3696
3697 @kindex tbreak
3698 @item tbreak @var{args}
3699 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3700 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3701 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3702 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3703
3704 @kindex hbreak
3705 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3706 @item hbreak @var{args}
3707 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3708 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3709 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3710 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3711 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3712 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3713 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3714 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3715 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3716 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3717 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3718 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3719 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3720 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3721 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3722 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3723 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3724 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3725
3726 @kindex thbreak
3727 @item thbreak @var{args}
3728 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3729 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3730 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3731 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3732 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3733 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3734 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3735 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3736
3737 @kindex rbreak
3738 @cindex regular expression
3739 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3740 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3741 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3742 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3743 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3744 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3745 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3746 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3747 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3748
3749 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3750 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3751 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3752 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3753 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3754 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3755
3756 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3757 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3758 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3759 classes.
3760
3761 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3762 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3763 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3764
3765 @smallexample
3766 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3770 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3771 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3772 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3773 every function in a given file:
3774
3775 @smallexample
3776 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3777 @end smallexample
3778
3779 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3780 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3781
3782 @kindex info breakpoints
3783 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3784 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3785 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3786 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3787 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3788 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3789 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3790
3791 @table @emph
3792 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3793 @item Type
3794 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3795 @item Disposition
3796 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3797 @item Enabled or Disabled
3798 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3799 that are not enabled.
3800 @item Address
3801 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3802 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3803 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3804 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3805 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3806 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3807 @item What
3808 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3809 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3810 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3811 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3812 @end table
3813
3814 @noindent
3815 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3816 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3817 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3818 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3819 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3820 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3821
3822 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3823 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3824 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3825 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3826
3827 @noindent
3828 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3829 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3830 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3831 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3832 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3833
3834 @noindent
3835 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3836 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3837 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3838 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3839 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3840 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3841
3842 @noindent
3843 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3844 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3845
3846 @end table
3847
3848 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3849 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3850 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3851 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3852
3853 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3854 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3855 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3856 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3857
3858 @itemize @bullet
3859 @item
3860 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3861
3862 @item
3863 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3864 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3865
3866 @item
3867 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3868 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3869
3870 @item
3871 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3872 several places where that function is inlined.
3873 @end itemize
3874
3875 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3876 the relevant locations.
3877
3878 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3879 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3880 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3881 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3882 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3883 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3884 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3885
3886 For example:
3887
3888 @smallexample
3889 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3890 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3891 stop only if i==1
3892 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3893 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3894 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3895 @end smallexample
3896
3897 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3898 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3899 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3900 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3901 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3902 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3903 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3904 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3905 that belong to that breakpoint.
3906
3907 @cindex pending breakpoints
3908 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3909 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3910 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3911 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3912 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3913 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3914 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3915 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3916 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3917 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3918 is not yet resolved.
3919
3920 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3921 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3922 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3923 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3924 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3925 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3926
3927 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3928 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3929 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3930 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3931
3932 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3933 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3934 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3935
3936 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3937 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3938 address specification to an address:
3939
3940 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3941 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3942 @table @code
3943 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3944 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3945 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3946
3947 @item set breakpoint pending on
3948 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3949 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3950
3951 @item set breakpoint pending off
3952 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3953 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3954 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3955
3956 @item show breakpoint pending
3957 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3958 @end table
3959
3960 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3961 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3962 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3963
3964 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3965 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3966 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3967 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3968 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3969 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3970 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3971 breakpoints.
3972
3973 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
3974
3975 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3976 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3977 @table @code
3978 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3979 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3980 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3981 breakpoint must be used.
3982
3983 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3984 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3985 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3986 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3987 @end table
3988
3989 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3990 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3991 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3992 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3993 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3994 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3995 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3996 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3997 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3998
3999 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4000 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4001 @table @code
4002 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4003 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4004 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4005 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4006
4007 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4008 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4009 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4010 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4011 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4012 @end table
4013
4014 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4015 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4016 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4017
4018 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4019 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4020
4021 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4022
4023 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4024 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4025 @table @code
4026 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4027 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4028 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4029 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4030 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4031
4032 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4033 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4034 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4035 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4036 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4037 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4038 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4039 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4040 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4041 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4042 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4043 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4044 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4045
4046 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4047 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4048 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4049 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4050 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4051 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4052 @end table
4053
4054
4055 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4056 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4057 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4058 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4059 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4060 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4061 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4062 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4063
4064
4065 @node Set Watchpoints
4066 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4067
4068 @cindex setting watchpoints
4069 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4070 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4071 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4072 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4073 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4074
4075 @itemize @bullet
4076 @item
4077 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4078
4079 @item
4080 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4081 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4082 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4083
4084 @item
4085 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4086 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4087 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4088 @end itemize
4089
4090 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4091 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4092 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4093 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4094 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4095 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4096 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4097 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4098 the expression changes.
4099
4100 @cindex software watchpoints
4101 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4102 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4103 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4104 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4105 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4106 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4107 culprit.)
4108
4109 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4110 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4111 slow down the running of your program.
4112
4113 @table @code
4114 @kindex watch
4115 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4116 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4117 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4118 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4119 to watch the value of a single variable:
4120
4121 @smallexample
4122 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4123 @end smallexample
4124
4125 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4126 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4127 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4128 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4129 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4130 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4131
4132 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4133 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4134 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4135 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4136 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4137 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4138 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4139 error.
4140
4141 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4142 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4143 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4144 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4145 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4146 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4147 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4148 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4149 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4150 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4151 Examples:
4152
4153 @smallexample
4154 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4155 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4156 @end smallexample
4157
4158 @kindex rwatch
4159 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4160 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4161 by the program.
4162
4163 @kindex awatch
4164 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4165 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4166 or written into by the program.
4167
4168 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4169 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4170 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4171 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4172 @end table
4173
4174 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4175 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4176 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4177 a never-changing value:
4178
4179 @smallexample
4180 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4181 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4182 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4183 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4184 @end smallexample
4185
4186 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4187 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4188 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4189 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4190 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4191 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4192
4193 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4194 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4195 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4196 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4197 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4198 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4199 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4200 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4201
4202 @table @code
4203 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4204 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4205 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4206
4207 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4208 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4209 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4210 @end table
4211
4212 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4213 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4214 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4215
4216 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4217
4218 @smallexample
4219 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4220 @end smallexample
4221
4222 @noindent
4223 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4224
4225 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4226 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4227 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4228 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4229 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4230 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4231 will print a message like this:
4232
4233 @smallexample
4234 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4235 @end smallexample
4236
4237 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4238 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4239 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4240 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4241 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4242 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4243 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4244 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4245
4246 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4247 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4248 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4249 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4250 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4251 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4252
4253 @smallexample
4254 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4255 @end smallexample
4256
4257 @noindent
4258 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4259
4260 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4261 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4262 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4263 expression with separately allocated resources.
4264
4265 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4266 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4267 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4268
4269 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4270 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4271 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4272 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4273 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4274 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4275 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4276 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4277 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4278
4279 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4280 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4281 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4282 watched expression from every thread.
4283
4284 @quotation
4285 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4286 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4287 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4288 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4289 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4290 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4291 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4292 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4293 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4294 @end quotation
4295
4296 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4297
4298 @node Set Catchpoints
4299 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4300 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4301 @cindex exception handlers
4302 @cindex event handling
4303
4304 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4305 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4306 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4307
4308 @table @code
4309 @kindex catch
4310 @item catch @var{event}
4311 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4312
4313 @table @code
4314 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4315 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4316 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4317 @kindex catch throw
4318 @kindex catch rethrow
4319 @kindex catch catch
4320 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4321 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4322
4323 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4324 regular expression will be caught.
4325
4326 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4327 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4328 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4329 exception being thrown.
4330
4331 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4332 @value{GDBN}:
4333
4334 @itemize @bullet
4335 @item
4336 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4337 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4338 supported.
4339
4340 @item
4341 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4342 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4343 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4344 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4345 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4346 built.
4347
4348 @item
4349 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4350 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4351
4352 @item
4353 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4354 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4355 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4356 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4357
4358 @item
4359 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4360 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4361 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4362 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4363 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4364 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4365 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4366 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4367 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4368
4369 @item
4370 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4371
4372 @item
4373 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4374 @end itemize
4375
4376 @item exception
4377 @kindex catch exception
4378 @cindex Ada exception catching
4379 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4380 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4381 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4382 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4383 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4384
4385 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4386 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4387 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4388 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4389 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4390 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4391 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4392 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4393
4394 @item exception unhandled
4395 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4396 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4397
4398 @item assert
4399 @kindex catch assert
4400 A failed Ada assertion.
4401
4402 @item exec
4403 @kindex catch exec
4404 @cindex break on fork/exec
4405 A call to @code{exec}.
4406
4407 @item syscall
4408 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4409 @kindex catch syscall
4410 @cindex break on a system call.
4411 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4412 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4413 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4414 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4415 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4416 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4417 will be caught.
4418
4419 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4420 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4421 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4422 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4423
4424 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4425 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4426 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4427 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4428
4429 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4430 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4431 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4432 available choices.
4433
4434 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4435 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4436 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4437 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4438 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4439 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4440 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4441 behind the OS upgrades).
4442
4443 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4444 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4445 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4446 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4447 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4448 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4449 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4450 syscall groups available on your environment.
4451
4452 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4453 arguments to it:
4454
4455 @smallexample
4456 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4457 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4458 (@value{GDBP}) r
4459 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4460
4461 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4462 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4463 (@value{GDBP}) c
4464 Continuing.
4465
4466 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4467 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4468 (@value{GDBP})
4469 @end smallexample
4470
4471 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4472
4473 @smallexample
4474 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4475 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4476 (@value{GDBP}) r
4477 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4478
4479 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4480 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4481 (@value{GDBP}) c
4482 Continuing.
4483
4484 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4485 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4486 (@value{GDBP})
4487 @end smallexample
4488
4489 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4490 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4491 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4492
4493 @smallexample
4494 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4495 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4496 (@value{GDBP}) r
4497 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4498
4499 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4500 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4501 (@value{GDBP}) c
4502 Continuing.
4503
4504 Program exited normally.
4505 (@value{GDBP})
4506 @end smallexample
4507
4508 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4509
4510 @smallexample
4511 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4512 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4513 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4514 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4515 (@value{GDBP}) r
4516 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4517
4518 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4519 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4520
4521 (@value{GDBP}) c
4522 Continuing.
4523 @end smallexample
4524
4525 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4526 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4527 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4528 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4529
4530 @smallexample
4531 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4532 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4533 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4534 (@value{GDBP})
4535 @end smallexample
4536
4537 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4538 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4539 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4540 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4541 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4542 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4543
4544 @smallexample
4545 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4546 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4547 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4548 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4549 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4550 (@value{GDBP})
4551 @end smallexample
4552
4553 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4554
4555 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4556 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4557
4558 @smallexample
4559 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4560 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4561 @end smallexample
4562
4563 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4564
4565 @item fork
4566 @kindex catch fork
4567 A call to @code{fork}.
4568
4569 @item vfork
4570 @kindex catch vfork
4571 A call to @code{vfork}.
4572
4573 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4574 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4575 @kindex catch load
4576 @kindex catch unload
4577 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4578 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4579 matches one of the affected libraries.
4580
4581 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4582 @kindex catch signal
4583 The delivery of a signal.
4584
4585 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4586 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4587 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4588
4589 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4590 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4591 signal names.
4592
4593 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4594 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4595 will be caught.
4596
4597 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4598 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4599 catchpoint.
4600
4601 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4602 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4603 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4604 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4605 commands.
4606
4607 @end table
4608
4609 @item tcatch @var{event}
4610 @kindex tcatch
4611 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4612 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4613
4614 @end table
4615
4616 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4617
4618
4619 @node Delete Breaks
4620 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4621
4622 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4623 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4624 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4625 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4626 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4627 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4628
4629 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4630 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4631 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4632 their breakpoint numbers.
4633
4634 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4635 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4636 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4637
4638 @table @code
4639 @kindex clear
4640 @item clear
4641 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4642 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4643 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4644 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4645
4646 @item clear @var{location}
4647 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4648 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4649 most useful ones are listed below:
4650
4651 @table @code
4652 @item clear @var{function}
4653 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4654 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4655
4656 @item clear @var{linenum}
4657 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4658 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4659 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4660 @end table
4661
4662 @cindex delete breakpoints
4663 @kindex delete
4664 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4665 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4666 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4667 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4668 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4669 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4670 @end table
4671
4672 @node Disabling
4673 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4674
4675 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4676 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4677 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4678 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4679 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4680
4681 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4682 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4683 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4684 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4685 do not know which numbers to use.
4686
4687 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4688 affects all of its locations.
4689
4690 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4691 different states of enablement:
4692
4693 @itemize @bullet
4694 @item
4695 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4696 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4697 @item
4698 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4699 @item
4700 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4701 disabled.
4702 @item
4703 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4704 N times, then becomes disabled.
4705 @item
4706 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4707 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4708 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4709 @end itemize
4710
4711 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4712 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4713
4714 @table @code
4715 @kindex disable
4716 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4717 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4718 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4719 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4720 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4721 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4722 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4723
4724 @kindex enable
4725 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4726 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4727 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4728
4729 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4730 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4731 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4732
4733 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4734 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4735 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4736 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4737 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4738 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4739 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4740
4741 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4742 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4743 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4744 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4745 @end table
4746
4747 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4748 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4749 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4750 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4751 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4752 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4753 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4754 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4755 Stepping}.)
4756
4757 @node Conditions
4758 @subsection Break Conditions
4759 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4760 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4761
4762 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4763 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4764 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4765 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4766 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4767 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4768 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4769 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4770
4771 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4772 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4773 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4774 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4775 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4776
4777 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4778 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4779 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4780 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4781 one.
4782
4783 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4784 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4785 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4786 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4787 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4788 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4789 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4790 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4791 conditions for the
4792 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4793 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4794
4795 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4796 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4797 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4798 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4799 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4800 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4801
4802 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4803 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4804 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4805 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4806 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4807
4808 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4809 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4810 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4811 with the @code{condition} command.
4812
4813 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4814 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4815 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4816 catchpoint.
4817
4818 @table @code
4819 @kindex condition
4820 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4821 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4822 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4823 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4824 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4825 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4826 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4827 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4828 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4829 prints an error message:
4830
4831 @smallexample
4832 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4833 @end smallexample
4834
4835 @noindent
4836 @value{GDBN} does
4837 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4838 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4839 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4840
4841 @item condition @var{bnum}
4842 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4843 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4844 @end table
4845
4846 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4847 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4848 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4849 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4850 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4851 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4852 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4853 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4854 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4855 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4856 your program reaches it.
4857
4858 @table @code
4859 @kindex ignore
4860 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4861 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4862 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4863 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4864 takes no action.
4865
4866 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4867 a count of zero.
4868
4869 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4870 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4871 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4872 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4873
4874 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4875 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4876 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4877
4878 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4879 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4880 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4881 Variables}.
4882 @end table
4883
4884 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4885
4886
4887 @node Break Commands
4888 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4889
4890 @cindex breakpoint commands
4891 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4892 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4893 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4894 enable other breakpoints.
4895
4896 @table @code
4897 @kindex commands
4898 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4899 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4900 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4901 @itemx end
4902 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4903 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4904 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4905
4906 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4907 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4908
4909 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4910 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4911 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4912 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4913 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4914 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4915 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4916 Expressions}).
4917 @end table
4918
4919 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4920 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4921
4922 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4923 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4924 that resumes execution.
4925
4926 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4927 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4928 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4929 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4930 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4931
4932 @kindex silent
4933 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4934 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4935 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4936 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4937 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4938 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4939
4940 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4941 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4942 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4943
4944 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4945 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4946
4947 @smallexample
4948 break foo if x>0
4949 commands
4950 silent
4951 printf "x is %d\n",x
4952 cont
4953 end
4954 @end smallexample
4955
4956 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4957 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4958 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4959 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4960 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4961 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4962 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4963
4964 @smallexample
4965 break 403
4966 commands
4967 silent
4968 set x = y + 4
4969 cont
4970 end
4971 @end smallexample
4972
4973 @node Dynamic Printf
4974 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4975
4976 @cindex dynamic printf
4977 @cindex dprintf
4978 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4979 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4980 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4981 having to recompile it.
4982
4983 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4984 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4985 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4986 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4987 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4988 redirects to files and so forth.
4989
4990 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4991 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4992 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4993 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4994 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4995 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4996 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4997
4998 @table @code
4999 @kindex dprintf
5000 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5001 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5002 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5003 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5004
5005 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5006 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5007 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5008 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5009 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5010 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5011
5012 @table @code
5013 @item gdb
5014 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5015 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5016
5017 @item call
5018 @kindex dprintf-style call
5019 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5020 @code{printf}).
5021
5022 @item agent
5023 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5024 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5025 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5026 support running commands on the target.
5027 @end table
5028
5029 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5030 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5031 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5032 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5033 command.
5034
5035 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5036 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5037 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5038 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5039 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5040 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5041
5042 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5043 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5044 you could do the following:
5045
5046 @example
5047 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5048 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5049 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5050 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5051 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5052 (gdb) info break
5053 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5054 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5055 continue
5056 (gdb)
5057 @end example
5058
5059 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5060 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5061 the variable settings.
5062
5063 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5064 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5065 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5066 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5067 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5068 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5069
5070 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5071 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5072 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5073
5074 @end table
5075
5076 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5077 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5078 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5079 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5080 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5081 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5082
5083 @node Save Breakpoints
5084 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5085
5086 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5087 breakpoints}} command.
5088
5089 @table @code
5090 @kindex save breakpoints
5091 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5092 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5093 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5094 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5095 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5096 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5097 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5098 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5099 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5100 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5101 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5102 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5103 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5104 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5105 that can no longer be recreated.
5106 @end table
5107
5108 @node Static Probe Points
5109 @subsection Static Probe Points
5110
5111 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5112 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5113 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5114 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5115 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5116
5117 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5118 ELF-compatible systems:
5119
5120 @itemize @bullet
5121
5122 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5123 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5124 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5125 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5126 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5127 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5128 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5129 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5130
5131 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5132 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5133 C@t{++} languages.
5134 @end itemize
5135
5136 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5137 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5138 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5139 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5140 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5141 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5142 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5143 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5144 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5145
5146 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5147 probes}, with optional arguments:
5148
5149 @table @code
5150 @kindex info probes
5151 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5152 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5153 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5154 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5155
5156 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5157 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5158 probes from all providers are listed.
5159
5160 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5161 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5162 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5163
5164 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5165 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5166 given, all object files are considered.
5167
5168 @item info probes all
5169 List the available static probes, from all types.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5173 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5174 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5175 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5176 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5177
5178 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5179 commands, with optional arguments:
5180
5181 @table @code
5182 @kindex enable probes
5183 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5184 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5185 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5186 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5187
5188 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5189 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5190 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5191
5192 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5193 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5194 given, all object files are considered.
5195
5196 @kindex disable probes
5197 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5198 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5199 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5200 @end table
5201
5202 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5203 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5204 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5205 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5206 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5207 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5208 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5209 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5210 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5211 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5212 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5213 at the current probe point.
5214
5215 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5216 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5217 an error message.
5218
5219
5220 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5221 @node Error in Breakpoints
5222 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5223
5224 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5225 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5226
5227 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5228 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5229 @smallexample
5230 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5231 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5232 @end smallexample
5233
5234 @noindent
5235 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5236 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5237 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5238
5239 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5240 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5241
5242 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5243 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5244 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5245
5246 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5247 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5248 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5249 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5250
5251 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5252 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5253 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5254 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5255 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5256 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5257 first in the bundle.
5258
5259 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5260 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5261 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5262 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5263 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5264 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5265 is hit.
5266
5267 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5268 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5269
5270 @smallexample
5271 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5272 @end smallexample
5273
5274 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5275 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5276 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5277 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5278 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5279 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5280 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5281 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5282
5283 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5284 adjusted breakpoints:
5285
5286 @smallexample
5287 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5288 to 0x00010410.
5289 @end smallexample
5290
5291 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5292 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5293 frequently than expected.
5294
5295 @node Continuing and Stepping
5296 @section Continuing and Stepping
5297
5298 @cindex stepping
5299 @cindex continuing
5300 @cindex resuming execution
5301 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5302 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5303 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5304 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5305 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5306 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5307 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5308 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5309 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5310 handlers}).)
5311
5312 @table @code
5313 @kindex continue
5314 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5315 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5316 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5317 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5318 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5319 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5320 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5321 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5322 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5323 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5324
5325 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5326 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5327 @code{continue} is ignored.
5328
5329 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5330 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5331 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5332 @code{continue}.
5333 @end table
5334
5335 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5336 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5337 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5338 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5339
5340 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5341 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5342 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5343 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5344 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5345 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5346
5347 @table @code
5348 @kindex step
5349 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5350 @item step
5351 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5352 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5353 abbreviated @code{s}.
5354
5355 @quotation
5356 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5357 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5358 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5359 @c distinction here.
5360 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5361 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5362 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5363 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5364 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5365 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5366 below.
5367 @end quotation
5368
5369 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5370 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5371 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5372 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5373 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5374 called within the line.
5375
5376 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5377 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5378 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5379 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5380 was any debugging information about the routine.
5381
5382 @item step @var{count}
5383 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5384 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5385 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5386
5387 @kindex next
5388 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5389 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5390 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5391 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5392 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5393 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5394 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5395 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5396
5397 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5398
5399
5400 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5401 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5402 @c
5403 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5404 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5405 @c function are executed without stopping.
5406
5407 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5408 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5409 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5410
5411 @kindex set step-mode
5412 @item set step-mode
5413 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5414 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5415 @itemx set step-mode on
5416 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5417 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5418 information rather than stepping over it.
5419
5420 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5421 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5422 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5423
5424 @item set step-mode off
5425 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5426 debug information. This is the default.
5427
5428 @item show step-mode
5429 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5430 source line debug information.
5431
5432 @kindex finish
5433 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5434 @item finish
5435 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5436 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5437 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5438
5439 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5440 ,Returning from a Function}).
5441
5442 @kindex until
5443 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5444 @cindex run until specified location
5445 @item until
5446 @itemx u
5447 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5448 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5449 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5450 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5451 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5452 than the address of the jump.
5453
5454 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5455 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5456 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5457 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5458 through the next iteration.
5459
5460 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5461 stack frame.
5462
5463 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5464 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5465 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5466 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5467 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5468
5469 @smallexample
5470 (@value{GDBP}) f
5471 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5472 206 expand_input();
5473 (@value{GDBP}) until
5474 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5475 @end smallexample
5476
5477 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5478 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5479 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5480 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5481 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5482 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5483 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5484
5485 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5486 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5487 argument.
5488
5489 @item until @var{location}
5490 @itemx u @var{location}
5491 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5492 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5493 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5494 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5495 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5496 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5497 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5498 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5499 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5500 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5501 invocations have returned.
5502
5503 @smallexample
5504 94 int factorial (int value)
5505 95 @{
5506 96 if (value > 1) @{
5507 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5508 98 @}
5509 99 return (value);
5510 100 @}
5511 @end smallexample
5512
5513
5514 @kindex advance @var{location}
5515 @item advance @var{location}
5516 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5517 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5518 @ref{Specify Location}.
5519 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5520 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5521 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5522 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5523
5524
5525 @kindex stepi
5526 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5527 @item stepi
5528 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5529 @itemx si
5530 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5531
5532 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5533 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5534 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5535 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5536
5537 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5538
5539 @need 750
5540 @kindex nexti
5541 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5542 @item nexti
5543 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5544 @itemx ni
5545 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5546 proceed until the function returns.
5547
5548 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5549
5550 @end table
5551
5552 @anchor{range stepping}
5553 @cindex range stepping
5554 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5555 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5556 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5557 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5558 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5559 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5560 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5561 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5562 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5563 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5564 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5565 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5566 if necessary:
5567
5568 @table @code
5569 @kindex set range-stepping
5570 @kindex show range-stepping
5571 @item set range-stepping
5572 @itemx show range-stepping
5573 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5574
5575 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5576 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5577 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5578 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5579 default is @code{on}.
5580
5581 @end table
5582
5583 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5584 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5585 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5586
5587 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5588 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5589 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5590 a particular file when stepping.
5591
5592 For example, consider the following C function:
5593
5594 @smallexample
5595 101 int func()
5596 102 @{
5597 103 foo(boring());
5598 104 bar(boring());
5599 105 @}
5600 @end smallexample
5601
5602 @noindent
5603 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5604 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5605 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5606 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5607
5608 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5609 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5610 is called from many places.
5611
5612 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5613 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5614 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5615 @code{foo}.
5616
5617 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5618 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5619 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5620
5621 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5622 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5623 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5624 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5625 the underlying system.
5626 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5627 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5628
5629 @table @code
5630 @kindex skip
5631 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5632 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5633 that specify what to skip.
5634 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5635
5636 @table @code
5637 @item -file @var{file}
5638 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5639 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5640
5641 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5642 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5643 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5644 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5645 over when stepping.
5646
5647 @smallexample
5648 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5649 @end smallexample
5650
5651 @item -function @var{linespec}
5652 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5653 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5654 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5655 @xref{Specify Location}.
5656
5657 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5658 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5659 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5660 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5661
5662 This form is useful for complex function names.
5663 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5664 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5665 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5666 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5667 regular expression makes this easier.
5668
5669 @smallexample
5670 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5671 @end smallexample
5672
5673 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5674 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5675
5676 @smallexample
5677 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5678 @end smallexample
5679 @end table
5680
5681 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5682 will be skipped.
5683
5684 @kindex skip function
5685 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5686 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5687 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5688 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5689
5690 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5691 will be skipped.
5692
5693 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5694 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5695
5696 @kindex skip file
5697 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5698 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5699 will be skipped over when stepping.
5700
5701 @smallexample
5702 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5703 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5704 @end smallexample
5705
5706 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5707 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5708 @end table
5709
5710 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5711 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5712
5713 @table @code
5714 @kindex info skip
5715 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5716 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5717 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5718 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5719
5720 @table @emph
5721 @item Identifier
5722 A number identifying this skip.
5723 @item Enabled or Disabled
5724 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5725 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5726 @item Glob
5727 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5728 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5729 @item File
5730 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5731 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5732 @item RE
5733 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5734 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5735 @item Function
5736 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5737 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5738 @end table
5739
5740 @kindex skip delete
5741 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5742 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5743 skips.
5744
5745 @kindex skip enable
5746 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5747 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5748 skips.
5749
5750 @kindex skip disable
5751 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5752 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5753 skips.
5754
5755 @end table
5756
5757 @node Signals
5758 @section Signals
5759 @cindex signals
5760
5761 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5762 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5763 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5764 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5765 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5766 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5767 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5768 requested an alarm).
5769
5770 @cindex fatal signals
5771 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5772 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5773 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5774 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5775 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5776 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5777
5778 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5779 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5780 signal.
5781
5782 @cindex handling signals
5783 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5784 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5785 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5786 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5787 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5788
5789 @table @code
5790 @kindex info signals
5791 @kindex info handle
5792 @item info signals
5793 @itemx info handle
5794 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5795 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5796 the defined types of signals.
5797
5798 @item info signals @var{sig}
5799 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5800
5801 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5802
5803 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5804 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5805 for details about this command.
5806
5807 @kindex handle
5808 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5809 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5810 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5811 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5812 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5813 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5814 say what change to make.
5815 @end table
5816
5817 @c @group
5818 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5819 Their full names are:
5820
5821 @table @code
5822 @item nostop
5823 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5824 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5825
5826 @item stop
5827 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5828 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5829
5830 @item print
5831 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5832
5833 @item noprint
5834 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5835 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5836
5837 @item pass
5838 @itemx noignore
5839 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5840 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5841 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5842
5843 @item nopass
5844 @itemx ignore
5845 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5846 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5847 @end table
5848 @c @end group
5849
5850 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5851 program until you
5852 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5853 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5854 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5855 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5856 program sees that signal when you continue.
5857
5858 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5859 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5860 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5861 erroneous signals.
5862
5863 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5864 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5865 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5866 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5867 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5868 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5869 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5870 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5871 Program a Signal}.
5872
5873 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5874 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5875
5876 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5877 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5878 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5879 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5880 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5881 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5882 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5883 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5884 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5885 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5886 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5887 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5888 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5889
5890 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5891
5892 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5893 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5894 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5895 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5896
5897 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5898 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5899 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5900 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5901
5902 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5903 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5904
5905 @smallexample
5906 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5907 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5908 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5909 (@value{GDBP}) c
5910 Continuing.
5911
5912 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5913 main () sigusr1.c:28
5914 28 p = 0;
5915 (@value{GDBP}) si
5916 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5917 9 @{
5918 @end smallexample
5919
5920 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5921 program to receive the signal first:
5922
5923 @smallexample
5924 (@value{GDBP}) n
5925 28 p = 0;
5926 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5927 (@value{GDBP}) si
5928 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5929 9 @{
5930 (@value{GDBP})
5931 @end smallexample
5932
5933 @cindex extra signal information
5934 @anchor{extra signal information}
5935
5936 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5937 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5938 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5939 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5940 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5941 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5942 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5943 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5944 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5945 system header.
5946
5947 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5948 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5949
5950 @smallexample
5951 @group
5952 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5953 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5954 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5955 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5956 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5957 type = struct @{
5958 int si_signo;
5959 int si_errno;
5960 int si_code;
5961 union @{
5962 int _pad[28];
5963 struct @{...@} _kill;
5964 struct @{...@} _timer;
5965 struct @{...@} _rt;
5966 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5967 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5968 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5969 @} _sifields;
5970 @}
5971 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5972 type = struct @{
5973 void *si_addr;
5974 @}
5975 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5976 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5977 @end group
5978 @end smallexample
5979
5980 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5981
5982 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5983 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5984 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5985 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5986 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5987 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5988 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5989 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5990 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5991 information is displayed.
5992
5993 The usual output of a segfault is:
5994 @smallexample
5995 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5996 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
5997 68 value = *(p + len);
5998 @end smallexample
5999
6000 While a bound violation is presented as:
6001 @smallexample
6002 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6003 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6004 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6005 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6006 68 value = *(p + len);
6007 @end smallexample
6008
6009 @node Thread Stops
6010 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6011
6012 @cindex stopped threads
6013 @cindex threads, stopped
6014
6015 @cindex continuing threads
6016 @cindex threads, continuing
6017
6018 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6019 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6020 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6021 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6022 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6023 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6024 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6025 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6026 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6027
6028 @menu
6029 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6030 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6031 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6032 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6033 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6034 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6035 @end menu
6036
6037 @node All-Stop Mode
6038 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6039
6040 @cindex all-stop mode
6041
6042 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6043 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6044 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6045 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6046 underfoot.
6047
6048 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6049 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6050 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6051
6052 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6053 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6054 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6055 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6056 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6057 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6058 stops.
6059
6060 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6061 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6062 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6063 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6064
6065 @cindex automatic thread selection
6066 @cindex switching threads automatically
6067 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6068 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6069 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6070 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6071 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6072 thread.
6073
6074 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6075 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6076
6077 @table @code
6078 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6079 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6080 @cindex lock scheduler
6081 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6082 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6083 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6084 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6085 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6086 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6087 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6088 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6089 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6090 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6091 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6092 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6093 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6094 @code{on} in replay mode.
6095
6096 @item show scheduler-locking
6097 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6098 @end table
6099
6100 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6101 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6102 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6103 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6104 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6105 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6106 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6107 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6108 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6109 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6110 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6111 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6112 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6113 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6114
6115 @table @code
6116 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6117 @item set schedule-multiple
6118 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6119 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6120 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6121 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6122 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6123 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6124
6125 @item show schedule-multiple
6126 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6127 multiple processes.
6128 @end table
6129
6130 @node Non-Stop Mode
6131 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6132
6133 @cindex non-stop mode
6134
6135 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6136 @c with more details.
6137
6138 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6139 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6140 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6141 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6142 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6143 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6144
6145 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6146 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6147 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6148 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6149 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6150 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6151 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6152 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6153 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6154 independently and simultaneously.
6155
6156 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6157 or attach to your program:
6158
6159 @smallexample
6160 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6161 set pagination off
6162
6163 # Finally, turn it on!
6164 set non-stop on
6165 @end smallexample
6166
6167 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6168
6169 @table @code
6170 @kindex set non-stop
6171 @item set non-stop on
6172 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6173 @item set non-stop off
6174 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6175 @kindex show non-stop
6176 @item show non-stop
6177 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6178 @end table
6179
6180 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6181 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6182 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6183 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6184 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6185 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6186 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6187 default.
6188
6189 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6190 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6191 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6192
6193 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6194 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6195 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6196 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6197 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6198
6199 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6200 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6201 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6202 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6203 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6204
6205 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6206
6207 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6208 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6209 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6210 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6211 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6212 previously current thread.
6213
6214 @node Background Execution
6215 @subsection Background Execution
6216
6217 @cindex foreground execution
6218 @cindex background execution
6219 @cindex asynchronous execution
6220 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6221
6222 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6223 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6224 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6225 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6226 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6227 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6228
6229 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6230 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6231
6232 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6233 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6234 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6235 are:
6236
6237 @table @code
6238 @kindex run&
6239 @item run
6240 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6241
6242 @item attach
6243 @kindex attach&
6244 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6245
6246 @item step
6247 @kindex step&
6248 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6249
6250 @item stepi
6251 @kindex stepi&
6252 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6253
6254 @item next
6255 @kindex next&
6256 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6257
6258 @item nexti
6259 @kindex nexti&
6260 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6261
6262 @item continue
6263 @kindex continue&
6264 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6265
6266 @item finish
6267 @kindex finish&
6268 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6269
6270 @item until
6271 @kindex until&
6272 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6273
6274 @end table
6275
6276 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6277 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6278 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6279 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6280 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6281 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6282
6283 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6284 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6285
6286 @table @code
6287 @kindex interrupt
6288 @item interrupt
6289 @itemx interrupt -a
6290
6291 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6292 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6293 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6294 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6295 @end table
6296
6297 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6298 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6299
6300 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6301 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6302 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6303
6304 @table @code
6305 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6306 @cindex thread breakpoints
6307 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6308 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6309 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6310 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6311 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6312 specify some source line.
6313
6314 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6315 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6316 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6317 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6318 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6319
6320 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6321 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6322 program.
6323
6324 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6325 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6326 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6327
6328 @smallexample
6329 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 @end table
6333
6334 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6335 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6336 thread list. For example:
6337
6338 @smallexample
6339 (@value{GDBP}) c
6340 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6341 @end smallexample
6342
6343 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6344 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6345 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6346 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6347 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6348 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6349 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6350 command.
6351
6352 @node Interrupted System Calls
6353 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6354
6355 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6356 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6357 @cindex premature return from system calls
6358 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6359 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6360 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6361 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6362 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6363 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6364 stop execution.
6365
6366 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6367 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6368 style anyways.
6369
6370 For example, do not write code like this:
6371
6372 @smallexample
6373 sleep (10);
6374 @end smallexample
6375
6376 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6377 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6378
6379 Instead, write this:
6380
6381 @smallexample
6382 int unslept = 10;
6383 while (unslept > 0)
6384 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6385 @end smallexample
6386
6387 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6388 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6389 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6390 @value{GDBN}.
6391
6392 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6393 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6394 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6395 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6396
6397 @node Observer Mode
6398 @subsection Observer Mode
6399
6400 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6401 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6402 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6403 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6404 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6405
6406 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6407 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6408 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6409 mode.
6410
6411 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6412 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6413 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6414 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6415 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6416
6417 @table @code
6418
6419 @kindex observer
6420 @item set observer on
6421 @itemx set observer off
6422 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6423 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6424 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6425 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6426
6427 @item show observer
6428 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6429
6430 @kindex may-write-registers
6431 @item set may-write-registers on
6432 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6433 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6434 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6435 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6436
6437 @item show may-write-registers
6438 Show the current permission to write registers.
6439
6440 @kindex may-write-memory
6441 @item set may-write-memory on
6442 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6443 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6444 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6445 defaults to @code{on}.
6446
6447 @item show may-write-memory
6448 Show the current permission to write memory.
6449
6450 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6451 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6452 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6453 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6454 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6455 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6456
6457 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6458 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6459
6460 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6461 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6462 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6463 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6464 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6465 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6466 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6467
6468 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6469 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6470
6471 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6472 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6473 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6474 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6475 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6476 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6477 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6478
6479 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6480 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6481
6482 @kindex may-interrupt
6483 @item set may-interrupt on
6484 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6485 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6486 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6487 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6488 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6489
6490 @item show may-interrupt
6491 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6492
6493 @end table
6494
6495 @node Reverse Execution
6496 @chapter Running programs backward
6497 @cindex reverse execution
6498 @cindex running programs backward
6499
6500 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6501 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6502 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6503 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6504
6505 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6506 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6507 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6508 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6509 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6510 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6511
6512 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6513 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6514 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6515 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6516 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6517 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6518 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6519 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6520 prior values@footnote{
6521 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6522 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6523 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6524
6525 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6526 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6527 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6528 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6529 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6530 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6531 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6532 }.
6533
6534 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6535 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6536
6537 @table @code
6538 @kindex reverse-continue
6539 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6540 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6541 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6542 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6543 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6544 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6545 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6546
6547 @kindex reverse-step
6548 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6549 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6550 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6551 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6552
6553 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6554 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6555 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6556 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6557 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6558 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6559
6560 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6561 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6562
6563 @kindex reverse-stepi
6564 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6565 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6566 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6567 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6568 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6569 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6570 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6571
6572 @kindex reverse-next
6573 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6574 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6575 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6576 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6577 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6578 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6579 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6580 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6581 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6582 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6583
6584 @kindex reverse-nexti
6585 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6586 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6587 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6588 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6589 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6590 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6591 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6592 frame) is reached.
6593
6594 @kindex reverse-finish
6595 @item reverse-finish
6596 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6597 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6598 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6599 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6600
6601 @kindex set exec-direction
6602 @item set exec-direction
6603 Set the direction of target execution.
6604 @item set exec-direction reverse
6605 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6606 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6607 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6608 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6609 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6610 @item set exec-direction forward
6611 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6612 This is the default.
6613 @end table
6614
6615
6616 @node Process Record and Replay
6617 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6618 @cindex process record and replay
6619 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6620
6621 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6622 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6623 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6624
6625 @cindex replay mode
6626 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6627 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6628 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6629 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6630 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6631 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6632 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6633 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6634 execution log.
6635
6636 @cindex record mode
6637 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6638 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6639 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6640 for future replay.
6641
6642 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6643 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6644 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6645 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6646 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6647 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6648
6649 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6650 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6651 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6652 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6653
6654 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6655 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6656
6657 @table @code
6658 @kindex target record
6659 @kindex target record-full
6660 @kindex target record-btrace
6661 @kindex record
6662 @kindex record full
6663 @kindex record btrace
6664 @kindex record btrace bts
6665 @kindex record btrace pt
6666 @kindex record bts
6667 @kindex record pt
6668 @kindex rec
6669 @kindex rec full
6670 @kindex rec btrace
6671 @kindex rec btrace bts
6672 @kindex rec btrace pt
6673 @kindex rec bts
6674 @kindex rec pt
6675 @item record @var{method}
6676 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6677 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6678 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6679 recording methods are available:
6680
6681 @table @code
6682 @item full
6683 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6684 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6685 execution.
6686
6687 @item btrace @var{format}
6688 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6689 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6690 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6691 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6692 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6693 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6694 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6695
6696 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6697 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6698 formats are available:
6699
6700 @table @code
6701 @item bts
6702 @cindex branch trace store
6703 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6704 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6705 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6706
6707 @item pt
6708 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6709 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6710 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6711 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6712
6713 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6714 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6715 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6716
6717 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6718 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6719 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6720 buffer-size with care.
6721 @end table
6722
6723 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6724 @end table
6725
6726 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6727 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6728 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6729 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6730
6731 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6732 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6733 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6734 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6735 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6736
6737 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6738 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6739 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6740 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6741 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6742 does not support these two modes.
6743
6744 @kindex record stop
6745 @kindex rec s
6746 @item record stop
6747 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6748 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6749 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6750
6751 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6752 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6753 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6754 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6755 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6756
6757 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6758 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6759 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6760 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6761 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6762
6763 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6764 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6765
6766 @kindex record goto
6767 @item record goto
6768 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6769 ways to specify the location to go to:
6770
6771 @table @code
6772 @item record goto begin
6773 @itemx record goto start
6774 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6775
6776 @item record goto end
6777 Go to the end of the execution log.
6778
6779 @item record goto @var{n}
6780 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6781 @end table
6782
6783 @kindex record save
6784 @item record save @var{filename}
6785 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6786 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6787 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6788
6789 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6790
6791 @kindex record restore
6792 @item record restore @var{filename}
6793 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6794 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6795
6796 @kindex set record full
6797 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6798 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6799 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6800 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6801
6802 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6803 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6804 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6805 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6806 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6807 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6808 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6809 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6810
6811 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6812 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6813 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6814
6815 @kindex show record full
6816 @item show record full insn-number-max
6817 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6818 recording method.
6819
6820 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6821 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6822 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6823 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6824 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6825 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6826 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6827 oldest one to be deleted.
6828
6829 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6830 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6831
6832 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6833 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6834
6835 @item set record full memory-query
6836 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6837 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6838 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6839 case.
6840
6841 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6842 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6843 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6844 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6845 results.
6846
6847 @item show record full memory-query
6848 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6849
6850 @kindex set record btrace
6851 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6852 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6853 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6854 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6855 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6856 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6857 You can use the following command for that:
6858
6859 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6860 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6861 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6862 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6863 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6864 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6865 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6866 position.
6867
6868 @kindex show record btrace
6869 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6870 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6871
6872 @kindex set record btrace bts
6873 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6874 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6875 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6876 format. Default is 64KB.
6877
6878 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6879 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6880 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6881 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6882 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6883 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6884 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6885
6886 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6887 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6888
6889 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6890 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6891
6892 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6893 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6894 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6895
6896 @kindex set record btrace pt
6897 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6898 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6899 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6900 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6901
6902 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6903 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6904 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6905 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6906 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6907 actual buffer size for each thread.
6908
6909 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6910 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6911
6912 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6913 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6914
6915 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6916 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6917 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6918
6919 @kindex info record
6920 @item info record
6921 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6922 method:
6923
6924 @table @code
6925 @item full
6926 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6927 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6928
6929 @itemize @bullet
6930 @item
6931 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6932 @item
6933 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6934 @item
6935 Highest recorded instruction number.
6936 @item
6937 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6938 @item
6939 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6940 @item
6941 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6942 @end itemize
6943
6944 @item btrace
6945 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6946
6947 @itemize @bullet
6948 @item
6949 Recording format.
6950 @item
6951 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6952 @item
6953 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6954 instructions.
6955 @item
6956 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6957 @end itemize
6958
6959 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6960 @itemize @bullet
6961 @item
6962 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6963 @end itemize
6964
6965 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6966 @itemize @bullet
6967 @item
6968 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6969 @end itemize
6970 @end table
6971
6972 @kindex record delete
6973 @kindex rec del
6974 @item record delete
6975 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6976 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6977 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6978 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6979
6980 @kindex record instruction-history
6981 @kindex rec instruction-history
6982 @item record instruction-history
6983 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6984 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6985 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6986 are printed in execution order.
6987
6988 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6989 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6990 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6991
6992 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6993 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6994 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6995 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6996 @code{/p} modifier.
6997
6998 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6999 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7000 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7001
7002 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7003 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7004
7005 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7006 disassemble:
7007
7008 @table @code
7009 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7010 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7011 @var{insn}.
7012
7013 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7014 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7015 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7016 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7017 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7018 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7019
7020 @item record instruction-history
7021 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7022
7023 @item record instruction-history -
7024 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7025
7026 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7027 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7028 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7029 number @var{end} is included.
7030 @end table
7031
7032 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7033
7034 @kindex set record
7035 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7036 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7037 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7038 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7039 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7040
7041 @kindex show record
7042 @item show record instruction-history-size
7043 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7044 instruction-history} command.
7045
7046 @kindex record function-call-history
7047 @kindex rec function-call-history
7048 @item record function-call-history
7049 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7050 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7051 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7052 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7053 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7054 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7055 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7056 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7057 given together.
7058
7059 @smallexample
7060 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7061 1 void foo (void)
7062 2 @{
7063 3 @}
7064 4
7065 5 void bar (void)
7066 6 @{
7067 7 ...
7068 8 foo ();
7069 9 ...
7070 10 @}
7071 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7072 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7073 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7074 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7075 @end smallexample
7076
7077 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7078 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7079 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7080 to print:
7081
7082 @table @code
7083 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7084 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7085
7086 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7087 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7088 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7089 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7090 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7091
7092 @item record function-call-history
7093 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7094
7095 @item record function-call-history -
7096 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7097
7098 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7099 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7100 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7101 @end table
7102
7103 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7104
7105 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7106 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7107 Define how many lines to print in the
7108 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7109 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7110
7111 @item show record function-call-history-size
7112 Show how many lines to print in the
7113 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7114 @end table
7115
7116
7117 @node Stack
7118 @chapter Examining the Stack
7119
7120 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7121 stopped and how it got there.
7122
7123 @cindex call stack
7124 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7125 is generated.
7126 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7127 the arguments of the call,
7128 and the local variables of the function being called.
7129 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7130 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7131 stack}.
7132
7133 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7134 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7135
7136 @cindex selected frame
7137 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7138 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7139 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7140 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7141 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7142 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7143
7144 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7145 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7146 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7147
7148 @menu
7149 * Frames:: Stack frames
7150 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7151 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7152 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7153 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7154
7155 @end menu
7156
7157 @node Frames
7158 @section Stack Frames
7159
7160 @cindex frame, definition
7161 @cindex stack frame
7162 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7163 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7164 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7165 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7166 which the function is executing.
7167
7168 @cindex initial frame
7169 @cindex outermost frame
7170 @cindex innermost frame
7171 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7172 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7173 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7174 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7175 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7176 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7177 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7178 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7179
7180 @cindex frame pointer
7181 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7182 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7183 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7184 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7185 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7186 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7187
7188 @cindex frame number
7189 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7190 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7191 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7192 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7193 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7194
7195 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7196 @c underflow problems.
7197 @cindex frameless execution
7198 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7199 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7200 @smallexample
7201 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7202 @end smallexample
7203 generates functions without a frame.)
7204 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7205 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7206 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7207 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7208 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7209 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7210 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7211
7212 @node Backtrace
7213 @section Backtraces
7214
7215 @cindex traceback
7216 @cindex call stack traces
7217 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7218 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7219 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7220 stack.
7221
7222 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7223 @table @code
7224 @kindex backtrace
7225 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7226 @item backtrace
7227 @itemx bt
7228 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7229 frames in the stack.
7230
7231 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7232 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7233
7234 @item backtrace @var{n}
7235 @itemx bt @var{n}
7236 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7237
7238 @item backtrace -@var{n}
7239 @itemx bt -@var{n}
7240 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7241
7242 @item backtrace full
7243 @itemx bt full
7244 @itemx bt full @var{n}
7245 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
7246 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
7247 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7248
7249 @item backtrace no-filters
7250 @itemx bt no-filters
7251 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7252 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7253 @itemx bt no-filters full
7254 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7255 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7256 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7257 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7258 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7259 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7260 support.
7261 @end table
7262
7263 @kindex where
7264 @kindex info stack
7265 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7266 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7267
7268 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7269 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7270 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7271 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7272 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7273 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7274 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7275 multi-threaded program.
7276
7277 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7278 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7279 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7280 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7281 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7282 line number.
7283
7284 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7285 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7286
7287 @smallexample
7288 @group
7289 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7290 at builtin.c:993
7291 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7292 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7293 at macro.c:71
7294 (More stack frames follow...)
7295 @end group
7296 @end smallexample
7297
7298 @noindent
7299 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7300 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7301 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7302
7303 @noindent
7304 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7305 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7306 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7307 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7308 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7309
7310 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7311 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7312 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7313 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7314 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7315 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7316 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7317 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7318 such a backtrace might look like:
7319
7320 @smallexample
7321 @group
7322 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7323 at builtin.c:993
7324 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7325 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7326 at macro.c:71
7327 (More stack frames follow...)
7328 @end group
7329 @end smallexample
7330
7331 @noindent
7332 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7333 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7334
7335 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7336 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7337 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7338
7339 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7340 @cindex program entry point
7341 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7342 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7343 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7344 @code{main}@footnote{
7345 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7346 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7347 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7348 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7349 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7350 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7351
7352 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7353 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7354
7355 @table @code
7356 @item set backtrace past-main
7357 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7358 @kindex set backtrace
7359 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7360
7361 @item set backtrace past-main off
7362 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7363 default.
7364
7365 @item show backtrace past-main
7366 @kindex show backtrace
7367 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7368
7369 @item set backtrace past-entry
7370 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7371 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7372 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7373 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7374
7375 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7376 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7377 application. This is the default.
7378
7379 @item show backtrace past-entry
7380 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7381
7382 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7383 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7384 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7385 @cindex backtrace limit
7386 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7387 or zero means unlimited levels.
7388
7389 @item show backtrace limit
7390 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7391 @end table
7392
7393 You can control how file names are displayed.
7394
7395 @table @code
7396 @item set filename-display
7397 @itemx set filename-display relative
7398 @cindex filename-display
7399 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7400
7401 @item set filename-display basename
7402 Display only basename of a filename.
7403
7404 @item set filename-display absolute
7405 Display an absolute filename.
7406
7407 @item show filename-display
7408 Show the current way to display filenames.
7409 @end table
7410
7411 @node Selection
7412 @section Selecting a Frame
7413
7414 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7415 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7416 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7417 of the stack frame just selected.
7418
7419 @table @code
7420 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7421 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7422 @item frame @var{n}
7423 @itemx f @var{n}
7424 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7425 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7426 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7427 @code{main}.
7428
7429 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7430 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7431 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7432 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7433 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7434 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7435 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7436 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7437
7438 @kindex up
7439 @item up @var{n}
7440 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7441 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7442 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7443
7444 @kindex down
7445 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7446 @item down @var{n}
7447 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7448 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7449 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7450 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7451 @end table
7452
7453 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7454 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7455 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7456 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7457
7458 @need 1000
7459 For example:
7460
7461 @smallexample
7462 @group
7463 (@value{GDBP}) up
7464 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7465 at env.c:10
7466 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7467 @end group
7468 @end smallexample
7469
7470 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7471 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7472 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7473 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7474 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7475 for details.
7476
7477 @table @code
7478 @kindex select-frame
7479 @item select-frame
7480 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7481 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7482 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7483 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7484
7485 @kindex down-silently
7486 @kindex up-silently
7487 @item up-silently @var{n}
7488 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7489 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7490 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7491 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7492 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7493 distracting.
7494 @end table
7495
7496 @node Frame Info
7497 @section Information About a Frame
7498
7499 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7500 stack frame.
7501
7502 @table @code
7503 @item frame
7504 @itemx f
7505 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7506 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7507 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7508 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7509 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7510
7511 @kindex info frame
7512 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7513 @item info frame
7514 @itemx info f
7515 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7516 including:
7517
7518 @itemize @bullet
7519 @item
7520 the address of the frame
7521 @item
7522 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7523 @item
7524 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7525 @item
7526 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7527 @item
7528 the address of the frame's arguments
7529 @item
7530 the address of the frame's local variables
7531 @item
7532 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7533 @item
7534 which registers were saved in the frame
7535 @end itemize
7536
7537 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7538 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7539 the usual conventions.
7540
7541 @item info frame @var{addr}
7542 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7543 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7544 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7545 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7546 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7547 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7548
7549 @kindex info args
7550 @item info args
7551 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7552
7553 @item info locals
7554 @kindex info locals
7555 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7556 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7557 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7558
7559 @end table
7560
7561 @node Frame Filter Management
7562 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7563 @cindex managing frame filters
7564
7565 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7566 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7567
7568 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7569 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7570
7571 @table @code
7572 @kindex info frame-filter
7573 @item info frame-filter
7574 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7575 their name, priority and enabled status.
7576
7577 @kindex disable frame-filter
7578 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7579 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7580 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7581 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7582 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7583 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7584 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7585 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7586 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7587 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7588 may be enabled again later.
7589
7590 @kindex enable frame-filter
7591 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7592 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7593 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7594 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7595 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7596 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7597 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7598 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7599 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7600
7601 Example:
7602
7603 @smallexample
7604 (gdb) info frame-filter
7605
7606 global frame-filters:
7607 Priority Enabled Name
7608 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7609 100 Yes Reverse
7610
7611 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7612 Priority Enabled Name
7613 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7614
7615 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7616 Priority Enabled Name
7617 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7618
7619 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7620 (gdb) info frame-filter
7621
7622 global frame-filters:
7623 Priority Enabled Name
7624 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7625 100 Yes Reverse
7626
7627 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7628 Priority Enabled Name
7629 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7630
7631 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7632 Priority Enabled Name
7633 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7634
7635 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7636 (gdb) info frame-filter
7637
7638 global frame-filters:
7639 Priority Enabled Name
7640 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7641 100 Yes Reverse
7642
7643 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7644 Priority Enabled Name
7645 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7646
7647 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7648 Priority Enabled Name
7649 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7650 @end smallexample
7651
7652 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7653 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7654 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7655 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7656 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7657 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7658 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7659
7660 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7661 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7662 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7663 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7664 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7665 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7666 dictionary resides.
7667
7668 Example:
7669
7670 @smallexample
7671 (gdb) info frame-filter
7672
7673 global frame-filters:
7674 Priority Enabled Name
7675 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7676 100 Yes Reverse
7677
7678 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7679 Priority Enabled Name
7680 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7681
7682 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7683 Priority Enabled Name
7684 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7685
7686 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7687 (gdb) info frame-filter
7688
7689 global frame-filters:
7690 Priority Enabled Name
7691 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7692 50 Yes Reverse
7693
7694 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7695 Priority Enabled Name
7696 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7697
7698 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7699 Priority Enabled Name
7700 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7701 @end smallexample
7702 @end table
7703
7704 @node Source
7705 @chapter Examining Source Files
7706
7707 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7708 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7709 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7710 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7711 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7712 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7713 source files by explicit command.
7714
7715 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7716 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7717 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7718
7719 @menu
7720 * List:: Printing source lines
7721 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7722 * Edit:: Editing source files
7723 * Search:: Searching source files
7724 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7725 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7726 @end menu
7727
7728 @node List
7729 @section Printing Source Lines
7730
7731 @kindex list
7732 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7733 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7734 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7735 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7736 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7737
7738 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7739
7740 @table @code
7741 @item list @var{linenum}
7742 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7743 current source file.
7744
7745 @item list @var{function}
7746 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7747 @var{function}.
7748
7749 @item list
7750 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7751 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7752 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7753 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7754 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7755
7756 @item list -
7757 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7758 @end table
7759
7760 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7761 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7762 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7763
7764 @table @code
7765 @kindex set listsize
7766 @item set listsize @var{count}
7767 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7768 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7769 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7770 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7771
7772 @kindex show listsize
7773 @item show listsize
7774 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7775 @end table
7776
7777 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7778 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7779 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7780 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7781 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7782
7783 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7784 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7785 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7786 to specify some source line.
7787
7788 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7789
7790 @table @code
7791 @item list @var{location}
7792 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7793
7794 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7795 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7796 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7797 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7798 the same source file as the first location.
7799
7800 @item list ,@var{last}
7801 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7802
7803 @item list @var{first},
7804 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7805
7806 @item list +
7807 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7808
7809 @item list -
7810 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7811
7812 @item list
7813 As described in the preceding table.
7814 @end table
7815
7816 @node Specify Location
7817 @section Specifying a Location
7818 @cindex specifying location
7819 @cindex location
7820 @cindex source location
7821
7822 @menu
7823 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7824 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7825 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7826 @end menu
7827
7828 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7829 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7830 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7831 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7832 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7833
7834 @node Linespec Locations
7835 @subsection Linespec Locations
7836 @cindex linespec locations
7837
7838 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7839 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7840 specifying a linespec:
7841
7842 @table @code
7843 @item @var{linenum}
7844 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7845
7846 @item -@var{offset}
7847 @itemx +@var{offset}
7848 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7849 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7850 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7851 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7852 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7853 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7854 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7855 linespec.
7856
7857 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7858 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7859 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7860 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7861 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7862 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7863 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7864
7865 @item @var{function}
7866 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7867 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7868
7869 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7870 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7871
7872 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7873 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7874 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7875 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7876 functions in different source files.
7877
7878 @item @var{label}
7879 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7880 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7881 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7882 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7883
7884 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7885 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7886 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7887 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7888 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7889 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7890
7891 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7892 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7893 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7894 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7895 each one of those probes.
7896 @end table
7897
7898 @node Explicit Locations
7899 @subsection Explicit Locations
7900 @cindex explicit locations
7901
7902 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7903 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7904
7905 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7906 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7907 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7908 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7909 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7910
7911 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7912 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7913 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7914 the symbol table to know.
7915
7916 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7917 following table:
7918
7919 @table @code
7920 @item -source @var{filename}
7921 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7922 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7923 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7924 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7925 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7926
7927 @item -function @var{function}
7928 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7929 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7930 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7931 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7932
7933 @item -label @var{label}
7934 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7935 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7936 selected stack frame.
7937
7938 @item -line @var{number}
7939 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7940 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7941 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7942 relative to the current line.
7943 @end table
7944
7945 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7946 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7947
7948 @node Address Locations
7949 @subsection Address Locations
7950 @cindex address locations
7951
7952 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7953 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7954
7955 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7956 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7957 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7958 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7959 source files.
7960
7961 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7962 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7963 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7964 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7965 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7966 of @var{address}:
7967
7968 @table @code
7969 @item @var{expression}
7970 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7971
7972 @item @var{funcaddr}
7973 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7974 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7975 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7976 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7977 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7978 (although the Pascal form also works).
7979
7980 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7981 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7982
7983 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7984 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7985 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7986 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7987 functions with identical names in different source files.
7988 @end table
7989
7990 @node Edit
7991 @section Editing Source Files
7992 @cindex editing source files
7993
7994 @kindex edit
7995 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7996 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7997 The editing program of your choice
7998 is invoked with the current line set to
7999 the active line in the program.
8000 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8001 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8002
8003 @table @code
8004 @item edit @var{location}
8005 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8006 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8007 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8008 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8009 command most commonly used:
8010
8011 @table @code
8012 @item edit @var{number}
8013 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8014
8015 @item edit @var{function}
8016 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8017 @end table
8018
8019 @end table
8020
8021 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8022 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8023 @footnote{
8024 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8025 following command-line syntax:
8026 @smallexample
8027 ex +@var{number} file
8028 @end smallexample
8029 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8030 the file where to start editing.}.
8031 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8032 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8033 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8034 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8035 @smallexample
8036 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8037 export EDITOR
8038 gdb @dots{}
8039 @end smallexample
8040 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8041 @smallexample
8042 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8043 gdb @dots{}
8044 @end smallexample
8045
8046 @node Search
8047 @section Searching Source Files
8048 @cindex searching source files
8049
8050 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8051 regular expression.
8052
8053 @table @code
8054 @kindex search
8055 @kindex forward-search
8056 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8057 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8058 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8059 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8060 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8061 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8062 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8063 @code{fo}.
8064
8065 @kindex reverse-search
8066 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8067 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8068 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8069 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8070 this command as @code{rev}.
8071 @end table
8072
8073 @node Source Path
8074 @section Specifying Source Directories
8075
8076 @cindex source path
8077 @cindex directories for source files
8078 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8079 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8080 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8081 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8082 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8083 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8084 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8085
8086 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8087 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8088 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8089 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8090 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8091 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8092 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8093 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8094 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8095 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8096 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8097
8098 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8099 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8100 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8101 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8102 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8103 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8104
8105 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8106 source files.
8107
8108 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8109 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8110 each line is in the file.
8111
8112 @kindex directory
8113 @kindex dir
8114 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8115 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8116 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8117
8118 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8119 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8120
8121 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8122 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8123 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8124 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8125 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8126 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8127 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8128 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8129 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8130 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8131 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8132 name to look up the sources.
8133
8134 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8135 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8136 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8137 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8138 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8139 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8140 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8141 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8142
8143 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8144 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8145 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8146 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8147 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8148 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8149 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8150
8151 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8152 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8153 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8154 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8155 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8156 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8157 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8158 command.
8159
8160 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8161 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8162 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8163 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8164 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8165 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8166 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8167
8168 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8169 @cindex default source path substitution
8170 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8171 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8172 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8173 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8174 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8175 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8176 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8177 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8178 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8179 together.
8180
8181 @table @code
8182 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8183 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8184 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8185 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8186 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8187 part of absolute file names) or
8188 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8189 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8190
8191 @kindex cdir
8192 @kindex cwd
8193 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8194 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8195 @cindex compilation directory
8196 @cindex current directory
8197 @cindex working directory
8198 @cindex directory, current
8199 @cindex directory, compilation
8200 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8201 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8202 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8203 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8204 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8205 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8206
8207 @item directory
8208 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8209
8210 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8211 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8212
8213 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8214 @kindex set directories
8215 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8216 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8217
8218 @item show directories
8219 @kindex show directories
8220 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8221
8222 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8223 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8224 @kindex set substitute-path
8225 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8226 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8227 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8228
8229 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8230 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8231
8232 @smallexample
8233 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8234 @end smallexample
8235
8236 @noindent
8237 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8238 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8239 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8240
8241 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8242 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8243 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8244 the substitution.
8245
8246 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8247
8248 @smallexample
8249 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8250 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8251 @end smallexample
8252
8253 @noindent
8254 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8255 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8256 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8257 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8258
8259
8260 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8261 @kindex unset substitute-path
8262 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8263 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8264 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8265
8266 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8267
8268 @item show substitute-path [path]
8269 @kindex show substitute-path
8270 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8271 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8272
8273 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8274 rules.
8275
8276 @end table
8277
8278 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8279 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8280 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8281
8282 @enumerate
8283 @item
8284 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8285
8286 @item
8287 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8288 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8289 directories in one command.
8290 @end enumerate
8291
8292 @node Machine Code
8293 @section Source and Machine Code
8294 @cindex source line and its code address
8295
8296 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8297 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8298 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8299 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8300 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8301 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8302 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8303 well as hex.
8304
8305 @table @code
8306 @kindex info line
8307 @item info line @var{location}
8308 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8309 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8310 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8311 @end table
8312
8313 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8314 the object code for the first line of function
8315 @code{m4_changequote}:
8316
8317 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8318 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8319 @smallexample
8320 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8321 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8322 @end smallexample
8323
8324 @noindent
8325 @cindex code address and its source line
8326 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8327 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8328 @smallexample
8329 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8330 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8331 @end smallexample
8332
8333 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8334 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8335 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8336 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8337 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8338 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8339 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8340 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8341 Variables}).
8342
8343 @table @code
8344 @kindex disassemble
8345 @cindex assembly instructions
8346 @cindex instructions, assembly
8347 @cindex machine instructions
8348 @cindex listing machine instructions
8349 @item disassemble
8350 @itemx disassemble /m
8351 @itemx disassemble /s
8352 @itemx disassemble /r
8353 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8354 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8355 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8356 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8357 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8358 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8359 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8360 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8361 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8362 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8363
8364 @table @code
8365 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8366 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8367 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8368 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8369 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8370 @end table
8371
8372 @noindent
8373 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8374 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8375
8376 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8377 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8378
8379 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8380 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8381 @end table
8382
8383 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8384 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8385
8386 @smallexample
8387 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8388 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8389 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8390 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8391 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8392 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8393 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8394 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8395 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8396 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8397 End of assembler dump.
8398 @end smallexample
8399
8400 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8401 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8402 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8403
8404 @smallexample
8405 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8406 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8407 5 @{
8408 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8409 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8410 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8411 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8412 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8413
8414 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8415 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8416 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8417
8418 7 return 0;
8419 8 @}
8420 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8421 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8422 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8423
8424 End of assembler dump.
8425 @end smallexample
8426
8427 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8428 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8429 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8430 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8431 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8432 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8433 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8434 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8435 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8436
8437 @file{foo.h}:
8438
8439 @smallexample
8440 int
8441 foo (int a)
8442 @{
8443 if (a < 0)
8444 return a * 2;
8445 if (a == 0)
8446 return 1;
8447 return a + 10;
8448 @}
8449 @end smallexample
8450
8451 @file{foo.c}:
8452
8453 @smallexample
8454 #include "foo.h"
8455 volatile int x, y;
8456 int
8457 main ()
8458 @{
8459 x = foo (y);
8460 return 0;
8461 @}
8462 @end smallexample
8463
8464 @smallexample
8465 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8466 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8467 5 @{
8468
8469 6 x = foo (y);
8470 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8471 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8472
8473 7 return 0;
8474 8 @}
8475 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8476 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8477 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8478 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8479
8480 End of assembler dump.
8481 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8482 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8483 foo.c:
8484 5 @{
8485 6 x = foo (y);
8486 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8487
8488 foo.h:
8489 4 if (a < 0)
8490 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8491 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8492
8493 6 if (a == 0)
8494 7 return 1;
8495 8 return a + 10;
8496 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8497 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8498 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8499 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8500
8501 foo.c:
8502 6 x = foo (y);
8503 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8504
8505 7 return 0;
8506 8 @}
8507 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8508 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8509
8510 foo.h:
8511 5 return a * 2;
8512 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8513 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8514 End of assembler dump.
8515 @end smallexample
8516
8517 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8518
8519 @smallexample
8520 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8521 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8522 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8523 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8524 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8525 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8526 End of assembler dump.
8527 @end smallexample
8528
8529 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8530 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8531 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8532 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8533
8534 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8535 mnemonics or other syntax.
8536
8537 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8538 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8539 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8540 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8541 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8542
8543 @table @code
8544 @kindex set disassembler-options
8545 @cindex disassembler options
8546 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8547 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8548 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8549 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8550 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8551 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8552 The default value is the empty string.
8553
8554 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8555 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8556 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8557 and S/390.
8558
8559 @kindex show disassembler-options
8560 @item show disassembler-options
8561 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8562 @end table
8563
8564 @table @code
8565 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8566 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8567 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8568 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8569 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8570 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8571
8572 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8573 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8574 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8575 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8576
8577 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8578 @item show disassembly-flavor
8579 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8580 @end table
8581
8582 @table @code
8583 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8584 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8585 @item set disassemble-next-line
8586 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8587 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8588 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8589 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8590 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8591 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8592 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8593 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8594 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8595 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8596 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8597 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8598 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8599 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8600 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8601 instruction.
8602 @end table
8603
8604
8605 @node Data
8606 @chapter Examining Data
8607
8608 @cindex printing data
8609 @cindex examining data
8610 @kindex print
8611 @kindex inspect
8612 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8613 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8614 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8615 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8616 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8617 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8618
8619 @table @code
8620 @item print @var{expr}
8621 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8622 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8623 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8624 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8625 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8626 Formats}.
8627
8628 @item print
8629 @itemx print /@var{f}
8630 @cindex reprint the last value
8631 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8632 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8633 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8634 @end table
8635
8636 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8637 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8638 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8639
8640 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8641 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8642 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8643 Table}.
8644
8645 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8646 @kindex explore
8647 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8648 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8649 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8650 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8651 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8652 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8653 embedded in the higher level data types.
8654
8655 @table @code
8656 @item explore @var{arg}
8657 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8658 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8659 @end table
8660
8661 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8662 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8663 C program as
8664
8665 @smallexample
8666 struct SimpleStruct
8667 @{
8668 int i;
8669 double d;
8670 @};
8671
8672 struct ComplexStruct
8673 @{
8674 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8675 int arr[10];
8676 @};
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 @noindent
8680 followed by variable declarations as
8681
8682 @smallexample
8683 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8684 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8685 @end smallexample
8686
8687 @noindent
8688 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8689 @code{explore} command as follows.
8690
8691 @smallexample
8692 (gdb) explore cs
8693 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8694 the following fields:
8695
8696 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8697 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8698
8699 Enter the field number of choice:
8700 @end smallexample
8701
8702 @noindent
8703 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8704 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8705 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8706 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8707 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8708 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8709 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8710 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8711
8712 @smallexample
8713 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8714 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8715 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8716 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8717
8718 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8719 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8720
8721 Press enter to return to parent value:
8722 @end smallexample
8723
8724 @noindent
8725 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8726 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8727 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8728 to explore.
8729
8730 @smallexample
8731 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8732 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8733
8734 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8735
8736 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8737
8738 Press enter to return to parent value:
8739 @end smallexample
8740
8741 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8742 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8743 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8744 level data structure).
8745
8746 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8747 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8748 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8749 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8750 same example as above, your can explore the type
8751 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8752 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8756 @end smallexample
8757
8758 @noindent
8759 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8760 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8761 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8762 example.
8763
8764 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8765 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8766 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8767 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8768 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8769
8770 @table @code
8771 @item explore value @var{expr}
8772 @cindex explore value
8773 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8774 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8775 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8776 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8777 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8778
8779 @item explore type @var{arg}
8780 @cindex explore type
8781 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8782 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8783 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8784 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8785 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8786 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8787 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8788 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8789 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8790 @end table
8791
8792 @menu
8793 * Expressions:: Expressions
8794 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8795 * Variables:: Program variables
8796 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8797 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8798 * Memory:: Examining memory
8799 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8800 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8801 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8802 * Value History:: Value history
8803 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8804 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8805 * Registers:: Registers
8806 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8807 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8808 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8809 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8810 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8811 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8812 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8813 character set than GDB does
8814 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8815 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8816 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8817 @end menu
8818
8819 @node Expressions
8820 @section Expressions
8821
8822 @cindex expressions
8823 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8824 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8825 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8826 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8827 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8828 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8829 @ref{Compilation}.
8830
8831 @cindex arrays in expressions
8832 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8833 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8834 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8835 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8836 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8837 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8838
8839 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8840 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8841 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8842 languages.
8843
8844 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8845 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8846
8847 @cindex casts, in expressions
8848 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8849 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8850 at that address in memory.
8851 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8852
8853 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8854 to programming languages:
8855
8856 @table @code
8857 @item @@
8858 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8859 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8860
8861 @item ::
8862 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8863 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8864
8865 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8866 @cindex type casting memory
8867 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8868 @cindex casts, to view memory
8869 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8870 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8871 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8872 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8873 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8874 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8875 @end table
8876
8877 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8878 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8879 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8880
8881 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8882 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8883 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8884 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8885 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8886 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8887 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8888
8889 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8890 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8891 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8892 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8893 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8894 as well.
8895
8896 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8897 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8898 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8899 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8900 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8901 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8902 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8903 choices.
8904
8905 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8906 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8907 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8908
8909 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8910 @smallexample
8911 @group
8912 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8913 [0] cancel
8914 [1] all
8915 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8916 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8917 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8918 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8919 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8920 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8921 > 2 4 6
8922 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8923 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8924 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8925 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8926 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8927 breakpoints.
8928 (@value{GDBP})
8929 @end group
8930 @end smallexample
8931
8932 @table @code
8933 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8934 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8935 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8936
8937 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8938 is ambiguous.
8939
8940 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8941 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8942 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8943 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8944 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8945 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8946 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8947 in the use of the menu.
8948
8949 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8950 when an ambiguity is detected.
8951
8952 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8953 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8954
8955 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8956 @item show multiple-symbols
8957 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8958 @end table
8959
8960 @node Variables
8961 @section Program Variables
8962
8963 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8964 in your program.
8965
8966 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8967 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8968
8969 @itemize @bullet
8970 @item
8971 global (or file-static)
8972 @end itemize
8973
8974 @noindent or
8975
8976 @itemize @bullet
8977 @item
8978 visible according to the scope rules of the
8979 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8980 @end itemize
8981
8982 @noindent This means that in the function
8983
8984 @smallexample
8985 foo (a)
8986 int a;
8987 @{
8988 bar (a);
8989 @{
8990 int b = test ();
8991 bar (b);
8992 @}
8993 @}
8994 @end smallexample
8995
8996 @noindent
8997 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8998 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8999 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9000 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9001
9002 @cindex variable name conflict
9003 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9004 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9005 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9006 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9007 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9008 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9009 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9010
9011 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9012 @ifnotinfo
9013 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9014 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9015 @end ifnotinfo
9016 @smallexample
9017 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9018 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9019 @end smallexample
9020
9021 @noindent
9022 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9023 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9024 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9025 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9026
9027 @smallexample
9028 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9029 @end smallexample
9030
9031 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9032 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9033 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9034 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9035 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9036
9037 @smallexample
9038 void
9039 foo (int a)
9040 @{
9041 if (a < 10)
9042 bar (a);
9043 else
9044 process (a); /* Stop here */
9045 @}
9046
9047 int
9048 bar (int a)
9049 @{
9050 foo (a + 5);
9051 @}
9052 @end smallexample
9053
9054 @noindent
9055 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9056 here is what you might see
9057 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9058
9059 @smallexample
9060 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9061 $1 = 10
9062 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9063 $2 = 5
9064 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9065 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9066 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9067 $3 = 5
9068 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9069 $4 = 0
9070 @end smallexample
9071
9072 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9073 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9074 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9075 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9076 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9077
9078 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9079 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9080 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9081 @code{some_global}.
9082
9083 @smallexample
9084 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9085 $1 = 23
9086 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9087 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9088 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9089 $2 = 27
9090 @end smallexample
9091
9092 @cindex wrong values
9093 @cindex variable values, wrong
9094 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9095 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9096 @quotation
9097 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9098 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9099 scope, and just before exit.
9100 @end quotation
9101 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9102 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9103 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9104 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9105 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9106 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9107 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9108 variable definitions may be gone.
9109
9110 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9111 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9112 when compiling.
9113
9114 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9115 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9116 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9117 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9118 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9119 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9120 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9121
9122 @smallexample
9123 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9124 @end smallexample
9125
9126 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9127 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9128 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9129 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9130 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9131
9132 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9133 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9134 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9135 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9136
9137 @cindex no debug info variables
9138 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9139 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9140 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9141 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9142 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9143 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9144 example, in a C program:
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9148 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9149 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9150 $1 = 3.14
9151 @end smallexample
9152
9153 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9154 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9155 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9156 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9157 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9158
9159 @smallexample
9160 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9161 29 i++;
9162 (gdb) next
9163 30 e (i);
9164 (gdb) print i
9165 $1 = 31
9166 (gdb) print i@@entry
9167 $2 = 30
9168 @end smallexample
9169
9170 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9171 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9172 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9173 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9174 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9175 For program code
9176
9177 @smallexample
9178 char var0[] = "A";
9179 signed char var1[] = "A";
9180 @end smallexample
9181
9182 You get during debugging
9183 @smallexample
9184 (gdb) print var0
9185 $1 = "A"
9186 (gdb) print var1
9187 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9188 @end smallexample
9189
9190 @node Arrays
9191 @section Artificial Arrays
9192
9193 @cindex artificial array
9194 @cindex arrays
9195 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9196 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9197 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9198 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9199 program.
9200
9201 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9202 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9203 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9204 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9205 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9206 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9207 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9208 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9209 example. If a program says
9210
9211 @smallexample
9212 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9213 @end smallexample
9214
9215 @noindent
9216 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9217
9218 @smallexample
9219 p *array@@len
9220 @end smallexample
9221
9222 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9223 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9224 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9225 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9226 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9227
9228 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9229 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9230 The value need not be in memory:
9231 @smallexample
9232 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9233 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9234 @end smallexample
9235
9236 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9237 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9238 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9239 @smallexample
9240 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9241 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9242 @end smallexample
9243
9244 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9245 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9246 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9247 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9248 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9249 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9250 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9251 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9252 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9253 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9254
9255 @smallexample
9256 set $i = 0
9257 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9258 @key{RET}
9259 @key{RET}
9260 @dots{}
9261 @end smallexample
9262
9263 @node Output Formats
9264 @section Output Formats
9265
9266 @cindex formatted output
9267 @cindex output formats
9268 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9269 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9270 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9271 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9272 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9273
9274 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9275 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9276 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9277 letters supported are:
9278
9279 @table @code
9280 @item x
9281 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9282 hexadecimal.
9283
9284 @item d
9285 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9286
9287 @item u
9288 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9289
9290 @item o
9291 Print as integer in octal.
9292
9293 @item t
9294 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9295 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9296 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9297 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9298
9299 @item a
9300 @cindex unknown address, locating
9301 @cindex locate address
9302 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9303 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9304 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9305
9306 @smallexample
9307 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9308 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9309 @end smallexample
9310
9311 @noindent
9312 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9313 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9314
9315 @item c
9316 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9317 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9318 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9319 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9320
9321 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9322 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9323 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9324 data.
9325
9326 @item f
9327 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9328 using typical floating point syntax.
9329
9330 @item s
9331 @cindex printing strings
9332 @cindex printing byte arrays
9333 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9334 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9335 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9336 natural types.
9337
9338 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9339 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9340 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9341 array.
9342
9343 @item z
9344 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9345 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9346 to the size of the integer type.
9347
9348 @item r
9349 @cindex raw printing
9350 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9351 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9352 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9353 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9354 pretty-printer which might exist.
9355 @end table
9356
9357 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9358
9359 @smallexample
9360 p/x $pc
9361 @end smallexample
9362
9363 @noindent
9364 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9365 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9366
9367 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9368 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9369 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9370
9371 @node Memory
9372 @section Examining Memory
9373
9374 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9375 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9376
9377 @cindex examining memory
9378 @table @code
9379 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9380 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9381 @itemx x @var{addr}
9382 @itemx x
9383 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9384 @end table
9385
9386 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9387 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9388 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9389 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9390 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9391
9392 @table @r
9393 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9394 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9395 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9396 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9397 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9398 @c 4.1.2.
9399
9400 @item @var{f}, the display format
9401 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9402 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9403 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9404 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9405 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9406
9407 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9408 The unit size is any of
9409
9410 @table @code
9411 @item b
9412 Bytes.
9413 @item h
9414 Halfwords (two bytes).
9415 @item w
9416 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9417 @item g
9418 Giant words (eight bytes).
9419 @end table
9420
9421 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9422 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9423 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9424 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9425 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9426 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9427 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9428 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9429 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9430 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9431 be altered.
9432
9433 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9434 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9435 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9436 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9437 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9438 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9439 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9440 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9441 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9442 a value from memory).
9443 @end table
9444
9445 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9446 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9447 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9448 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9449 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9450
9451 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9452 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9453 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9454
9455 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9456 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9457 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9458 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9459 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9460
9461 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9462 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9463 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9464 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9465 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9466 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9467 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9468 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9469 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9470
9471 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9472 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9473 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9474 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9475 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9476 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9477
9478 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9479 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9480 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9481 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9482 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9483 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9484 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9485
9486 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9487 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9488
9489 @smallexample
9490 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9491 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9492 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9493 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9494 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9495 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9496 @end smallexample
9497
9498 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9499 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9500 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9501 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9502 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9503 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9504 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9505 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9506 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9507
9508 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9509 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9510 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9511
9512 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9513 @cindex addressable memory unit
9514 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9515 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9516 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9517 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9518 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9519 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9520 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9521 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9522 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9523
9524 @cindex remote memory comparison
9525 @cindex target memory comparison
9526 @cindex verify remote memory image
9527 @cindex verify target memory image
9528 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9529 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9530 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9531 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9532 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9533 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9534
9535 @table @code
9536 @kindex compare-sections
9537 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9538 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9539 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9540 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9541 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9542 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9543
9544 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9545 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9546 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9547 @end table
9548
9549 @node Auto Display
9550 @section Automatic Display
9551 @cindex automatic display
9552 @cindex display of expressions
9553
9554 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9555 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9556 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9557 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9558 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9559 The automatic display looks like this:
9560
9561 @smallexample
9562 2: foo = 38
9563 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9564 @end smallexample
9565
9566 @noindent
9567 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9568 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9569 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9570 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9571 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9572 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9573
9574 @table @code
9575 @kindex display
9576 @item display @var{expr}
9577 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9578 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9579
9580 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9581
9582 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9583 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9584 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9585 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9586 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9587
9588 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9589 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9590 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9591 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9592 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9593 @end table
9594
9595 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9596 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9597 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9598
9599 @table @code
9600 @kindex delete display
9601 @kindex undisplay
9602 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9603 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9604 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9605 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9606 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9607 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9608 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9609
9610 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9611 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9612
9613 @kindex disable display
9614 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9615 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9616 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9617 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9618 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9619 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9620 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9621 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9622
9623 @kindex enable display
9624 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9625 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9626 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9627 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9628 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9629 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9630 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9631
9632 @item display
9633 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9634 done when your program stops.
9635
9636 @kindex info display
9637 @item info display
9638 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9639 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9640 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9641 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9642 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9643 @end table
9644
9645 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9646 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9647 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9648 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9649 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9650 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9651 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9652 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9653 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9654 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9655 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9656
9657 @node Print Settings
9658 @section Print Settings
9659
9660 @cindex format options
9661 @cindex print settings
9662 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9663 and symbols are printed.
9664
9665 @noindent
9666 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9667
9668 @table @code
9669 @kindex set print
9670 @item set print address
9671 @itemx set print address on
9672 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9673 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9674 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9675 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9676 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9677 @code{set print address on}:
9678
9679 @smallexample
9680 @group
9681 (@value{GDBP}) f
9682 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9683 at input.c:530
9684 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9685 @end group
9686 @end smallexample
9687
9688 @item set print address off
9689 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9690 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9691
9692 @smallexample
9693 @group
9694 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9695 (@value{GDBP}) f
9696 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9697 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9698 @end group
9699 @end smallexample
9700
9701 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9702 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9703 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9704 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9705
9706 @kindex show print
9707 @item show print address
9708 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9709 @end table
9710
9711 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9712 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9713 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9714 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9715 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9716 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9717 it prints a symbolic address:
9718
9719 @table @code
9720 @item set print symbol-filename on
9721 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9722 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9723 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9724 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9725
9726 @item set print symbol-filename off
9727 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9728 default.
9729
9730 @item show print symbol-filename
9731 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9732 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9733 @end table
9734
9735 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9736 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9737 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9738
9739 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9740 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9741
9742 @table @code
9743 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9744 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9745 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9746 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9747 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9748 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9749 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9750 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9751
9752 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9753 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9754 symbolic address.
9755 @end table
9756
9757 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9758 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9759 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9760 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9761 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9762 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9763 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9764 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9765
9766 @smallexample
9767 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9768 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9769 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9770 @end smallexample
9771
9772 @quotation
9773 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9774 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9775 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9776 @end quotation
9777
9778 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9779 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9780
9781 @table @code
9782 @item set print symbol on
9783 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9784 one exists.
9785
9786 @item set print symbol off
9787 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9788 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9789 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9790
9791 @item show print symbol
9792 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9793 address.
9794 @end table
9795
9796 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9797
9798 @table @code
9799 @item set print array
9800 @itemx set print array on
9801 @cindex pretty print arrays
9802 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9803 but uses more space. The default is off.
9804
9805 @item set print array off
9806 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9807
9808 @item show print array
9809 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9810 arrays.
9811
9812 @cindex print array indexes
9813 @item set print array-indexes
9814 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9815 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9816 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9817 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9818
9819 @item set print array-indexes off
9820 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9821
9822 @item show print array-indexes
9823 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9824 arrays.
9825
9826 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9827 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9828 @cindex number of array elements to print
9829 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9830 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9831 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9832 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9833 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9834 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9835 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9836 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9837
9838 @item show print elements
9839 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9840 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9841
9842 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9843 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9844 @cindex printing frame argument values
9845 @cindex print all frame argument values
9846 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9847 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9848 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9849 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9850 values are:
9851
9852 @table @code
9853 @item all
9854 The values of all arguments are printed.
9855
9856 @item scalars
9857 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9858 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9859 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9860 only scalar arguments are shown:
9861
9862 @smallexample
9863 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9864 at frame-args.c:23
9865 @end smallexample
9866
9867 @item none
9868 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9869 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9870
9871 @smallexample
9872 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9873 at frame-args.c:23
9874 @end smallexample
9875 @end table
9876
9877 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9878 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9879 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9880 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9881 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9882 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9883 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9884 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9885 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9886 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9887
9888 @item show print frame-arguments
9889 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9890
9891 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9892 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9893
9894 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9895 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9896 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9897 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9898 This is the default.
9899
9900 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9901 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9902
9903 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9904 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9905 @kindex set print entry-values
9906 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9907 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9908 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9909 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9910 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9911
9912 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9913 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9914 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9915 @code{no} setting.
9916
9917 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9918 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
9919 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9920 this information.
9921
9922 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9923
9924 @table @code
9925 @item no
9926 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9927 point.
9928 @smallexample
9929 #0 equal (val=5)
9930 #0 different (val=6)
9931 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9932 #0 born (val=10)
9933 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9934 @end smallexample
9935
9936 @item only
9937 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9938 values are never printed.
9939 @smallexample
9940 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9941 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9942 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9943 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9944 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9945 @end smallexample
9946
9947 @item preferred
9948 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9949 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9950 value for such parameter.
9951 @smallexample
9952 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9953 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9954 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9955 #0 born (val=10)
9956 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9957 @end smallexample
9958
9959 @item if-needed
9960 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9961 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9962 parameter.
9963 @smallexample
9964 #0 equal (val=5)
9965 #0 different (val=6)
9966 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9967 #0 born (val=10)
9968 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9969 @end smallexample
9970
9971 @item both
9972 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9973 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9974 optimizations.
9975 @smallexample
9976 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9977 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9978 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9979 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9980 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9981 @end smallexample
9982
9983 @item compact
9984 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9985 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9986 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9987 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9988 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9989 @smallexample
9990 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9991 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9992 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9993 #0 born (val=10)
9994 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9995 @end smallexample
9996
9997 @item default
9998 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9999 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10000 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10001 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10002 @smallexample
10003 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10004 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10005 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10006 #0 born (val=10)
10007 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10008 @end smallexample
10009 @end table
10010
10011 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10012 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10013
10014 @item show print entry-values
10015 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10016 entry.
10017
10018 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10019 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10020 @cindex repeated array elements
10021 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10022 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10023 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10024 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10025 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10026 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10027 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10028 is 10.
10029
10030 @item show print repeats
10031 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10032 elements.
10033
10034 @item set print null-stop
10035 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10036 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10037 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10038 contain only short strings.
10039 The default is off.
10040
10041 @item show print null-stop
10042 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10043 @sc{null} character.
10044
10045 @item set print pretty on
10046 @cindex print structures in indented form
10047 @cindex indentation in structure display
10048 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10049 per line, like this:
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 @group
10053 $1 = @{
10054 next = 0x0,
10055 flags = @{
10056 sweet = 1,
10057 sour = 1
10058 @},
10059 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10060 @}
10061 @end group
10062 @end smallexample
10063
10064 @item set print pretty off
10065 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10066
10067 @smallexample
10068 @group
10069 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10070 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10071 @end group
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @noindent
10075 This is the default format.
10076
10077 @item show print pretty
10078 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10079
10080 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10081 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10082 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10083 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10084 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10085 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10086 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10087 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10088
10089 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10090 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10091 international character sets, and is the default.
10092
10093 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10094 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10095
10096 @item set print union on
10097 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10098 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10099 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10100
10101 @item set print union off
10102 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10103 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10104 instead.
10105
10106 @item show print union
10107 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10108 structures and other unions.
10109
10110 For example, given the declarations
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10114 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10115 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10116 Bug_forms;
10117
10118 struct thing @{
10119 Species it;
10120 union @{
10121 Tree_forms tree;
10122 Bug_forms bug;
10123 @} form;
10124 @};
10125
10126 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10127 @end smallexample
10128
10129 @noindent
10130 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10131
10132 @smallexample
10133 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10134 @end smallexample
10135
10136 @noindent
10137 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10138
10139 @smallexample
10140 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10141 @end smallexample
10142
10143 @noindent
10144 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10145 and in Pascal.
10146 @end table
10147
10148 @need 1000
10149 @noindent
10150 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10151
10152 @table @code
10153 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10154 @item set print demangle
10155 @itemx set print demangle on
10156 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10157 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10158 linkage. The default is on.
10159
10160 @item show print demangle
10161 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10162
10163 @item set print asm-demangle
10164 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10165 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10166 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10167 The default is off.
10168
10169 @item show print asm-demangle
10170 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10171 or demangled form.
10172
10173 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10174 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10175 @kindex set demangle-style
10176 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10177 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10178 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10179
10180 @table @code
10181 @item auto
10182 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10183 This is the default.
10184
10185 @item gnu
10186 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10187
10188 @item hp
10189 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10190
10191 @item lucid
10192 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10193
10194 @item arm
10195 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10196 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10197 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10198 require further enhancement to permit that.
10199
10200 @end table
10201 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10202
10203 @item show demangle-style
10204 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10205
10206 @item set print object
10207 @itemx set print object on
10208 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10209 @cindex display derived types
10210 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10211 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10212 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10213 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10214 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10215 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10216 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10217
10218 @item set print object off
10219 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10220 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10221
10222 @item show print object
10223 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10224
10225 @item set print static-members
10226 @itemx set print static-members on
10227 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10228 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10229
10230 @item set print static-members off
10231 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10232
10233 @item show print static-members
10234 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10235
10236 @item set print pascal_static-members
10237 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10238 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10239 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10240 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10241
10242 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10243 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10244
10245 @item show print pascal_static-members
10246 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10247
10248 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10249 @item set print vtbl
10250 @itemx set print vtbl on
10251 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10252 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10253 @cindex VTBL display
10254 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10255 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10256 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10257
10258 @item set print vtbl off
10259 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10260
10261 @item show print vtbl
10262 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10263 @end table
10264
10265 @node Pretty Printing
10266 @section Pretty Printing
10267
10268 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10269 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10270 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10271
10272 @menu
10273 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10274 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10275 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10276 @end menu
10277
10278 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10279 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10280
10281 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10282 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10283 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10284
10285 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10286 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10287 pretty-printers with their names.
10288 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10289 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10290 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10291 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10292
10293 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10294 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10295 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10296 do anything special.
10297
10298 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10299
10300 @itemize @bullet
10301 @item
10302 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10303 all inferiors.
10304
10305 @item
10306 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10307 when debugging that program.
10308 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10309
10310 @item
10311 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10312 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10313 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10314 @end itemize
10315
10316 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10317 pretty-printers are selected,
10318
10319 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10320 for new types.
10321
10322 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10323 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10324
10325 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10326
10327 @smallexample
10328 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10329 $1 = @{
10330 static npos = 4294967295,
10331 _M_dataplus = @{
10332 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10333 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10334 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10335 @},
10336 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10337 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10338 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10339 @}
10340 @}
10341 @end smallexample
10342
10343 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10344
10345 @smallexample
10346 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10347 $2 = "abcd"
10348 @end smallexample
10349
10350 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10351 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10352 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10353
10354 @table @code
10355 @kindex info pretty-printer
10356 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10357 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10358 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10359
10360 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10361 whose pretty-printers to list.
10362 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10363 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10364 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10365 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10366 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10367
10368 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10369 to list.
10370
10371 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10372 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10373 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10374 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10375
10376 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10377 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10378 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10379 @end table
10380
10381 Example:
10382
10383 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10384 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10385 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10386 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10387
10388 @smallexample
10389 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10390 library1.so:
10391 foo
10392 library2.so:
10393 bar
10394 bar1
10395 bar2
10396 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10397 library2.so:
10398 bar
10399 bar1
10400 bar2
10401 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10402 1 printer disabled
10403 2 of 3 printers enabled
10404 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10405 library1.so:
10406 foo [disabled]
10407 library2.so:
10408 bar
10409 bar1
10410 bar2
10411 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10412 1 printer disabled
10413 1 of 3 printers enabled
10414 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10415 library1.so:
10416 foo [disabled]
10417 library2.so:
10418 bar
10419 bar1 [disabled]
10420 bar2
10421 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10422 1 printer disabled
10423 0 of 3 printers enabled
10424 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10425 library1.so:
10426 foo [disabled]
10427 library2.so:
10428 bar [disabled]
10429 bar1 [disabled]
10430 bar2
10431 @end smallexample
10432
10433 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10434 as can each individual subprinter.
10435
10436 @node Value History
10437 @section Value History
10438
10439 @cindex value history
10440 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10441 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10442 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10443 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10444 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10445 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10446 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10447 symbol table.
10448
10449 @cindex @code{$}
10450 @cindex @code{$$}
10451 @cindex history number
10452 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10453 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10454 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10455 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10456 history number.
10457
10458 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10459 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10460 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10461 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10462 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10463 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10464 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10465
10466 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10467 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10468
10469 @smallexample
10470 p *$
10471 @end smallexample
10472
10473 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10474 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10475
10476 @smallexample
10477 p *$.next
10478 @end smallexample
10479
10480 @noindent
10481 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10482 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10483
10484 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10485 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10486
10487 @smallexample
10488 print x
10489 set x=5
10490 @end smallexample
10491
10492 @noindent
10493 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10494 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10495
10496 @table @code
10497 @kindex show values
10498 @item show values
10499 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10500 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10501 values} does not change the history.
10502
10503 @item show values @var{n}
10504 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10505
10506 @item show values +
10507 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10508 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10509 @end table
10510
10511 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10512 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10513
10514 @node Convenience Vars
10515 @section Convenience Variables
10516
10517 @cindex convenience variables
10518 @cindex user-defined variables
10519 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10520 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10521 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10522 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10523 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10524
10525 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10526 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10527 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10528 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10529 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10530
10531 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10532 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10533 For example:
10534
10535 @smallexample
10536 set $foo = *object_ptr
10537 @end smallexample
10538
10539 @noindent
10540 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10541 @code{object_ptr}.
10542
10543 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10544 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10545 value with another assignment at any time.
10546
10547 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10548 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10549 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10550 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10551
10552 @table @code
10553 @kindex show convenience
10554 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10555 @item show convenience
10556 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10557 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10558 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10559
10560 @kindex init-if-undefined
10561 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10562 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10563 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10564 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10565 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10566 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10567 override default values used in a command script.
10568
10569 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10570 any side-effects do not occur.
10571 @end table
10572
10573 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10574 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10575 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10576
10577 @smallexample
10578 set $i = 0
10579 print bar[$i++]->contents
10580 @end smallexample
10581
10582 @noindent
10583 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10584
10585 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10586 values likely to be useful.
10587
10588 @table @code
10589 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10590 @item $_
10591 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10592 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10593 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10594 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10595 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10596 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10597 to the type of @code{$__}.
10598
10599 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10600 @item $__
10601 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10602 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10603 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10604
10605 @item $_exitcode
10606 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10607 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10608 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10609 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10610
10611 @item $_exitsignal
10612 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10613 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10614 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10615 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10616
10617 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10618 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10619 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10620 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10621 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10622
10623 @smallexample
10624 #include <signal.h>
10625
10626 int
10627 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10628 @{
10629 raise (SIGALRM);
10630 return 0;
10631 @}
10632 @end smallexample
10633
10634 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10635 or signalled would be:
10636
10637 @smallexample
10638 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10639 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10640 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10641 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10642 >echo The program has exited\n
10643 >else
10644 >echo The program has signalled\n
10645 >end
10646 >end
10647 (@value{GDBP}) run
10648 Starting program:
10649
10650 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10651 The program no longer exists.
10652 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10653 The program has signalled
10654 @end smallexample
10655
10656 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10657 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10658 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10659 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10660
10661 @smallexample
10662 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10663 The program has exited
10664 @end smallexample
10665
10666 @item $_exception
10667 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10668 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10669
10670 @item $_probe_argc
10671 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10672 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10673
10674 @item $_sdata
10675 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10676 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10677 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10678 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10679 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10680
10681 @item $_siginfo
10682 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10683 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10684 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10685 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10686 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10687
10688 @item $_tlb
10689 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10690 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10691 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10692 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10693 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10694 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10695
10696 @item $_inferior
10697 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10698 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10699
10700 @item $_thread
10701 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10702
10703 @item $_gthread
10704 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10705
10706 @end table
10707
10708 @node Convenience Funs
10709 @section Convenience Functions
10710
10711 @cindex convenience functions
10712 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10713 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10714 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10715 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10716 @value{GDBN}.
10717
10718 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10719 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10720
10721 @table @code
10722
10723 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10724 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10725 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10726 returns zero.
10727
10728 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10729 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10730 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10731 it is @code{void}:
10732
10733 @smallexample
10734 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10735 $1 = void
10736 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10737 $2 = 1
10738 (@value{GDBP}) run
10739 Starting program: ./a.out
10740 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10741 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10742 $3 = 0
10743 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10744 $4 = 0
10745 @end smallexample
10746
10747 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10748 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10749 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10750 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10751 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10752 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10753 anymore.
10754
10755 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10756 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10757
10758 @smallexample
10759 void
10760 foo (void)
10761 @{
10762 @}
10763 @end smallexample
10764
10765 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10766
10767 @smallexample
10768 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10769 $1 = void
10770 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10771 $2 = 1
10772 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10773 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10774 $3 = void
10775 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10776 $4 = 1
10777 @end smallexample
10778
10779 @end table
10780
10781 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10782 @code{Python} support.
10783
10784 @table @code
10785
10786 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10787 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10788 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10789 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10790 Otherwise it returns zero.
10791
10792 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10793 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10794 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10795 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10796 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10797 regular expression support.
10798
10799 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10800 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10801 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10802 Otherwise it returns zero.
10803
10804 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10805 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10806 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10807
10808 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10809 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10810 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10811 Otherwise it returns zero.
10812
10813 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10814 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10815 The default is 1.
10816
10817 Example:
10818
10819 @smallexample
10820 (gdb) backtrace
10821 #0 bottom_func ()
10822 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10823 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10824 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10825 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10826 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10827 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10828 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10829 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10830 $1 = 1
10831 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10832 $1 = 1
10833 @end smallexample
10834
10835 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10836 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10837 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10838 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10839
10840 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10841 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10842 The default is 1.
10843
10844 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10845 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10846 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10847 Otherwise it returns zero.
10848
10849 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10850 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10851 The default is 1.
10852
10853 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10854 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10855 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10856 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10857
10858 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10859 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10860 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10861 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10862
10863 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10864 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10865 The default is 1.
10866
10867 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10868 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10869 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10870 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10871
10872 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
10873 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10874 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10875
10876 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10877 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10878 an enumerated type:
10879
10880 @smallexample
10881 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10882 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10883 @end smallexample
10884
10885 @end table
10886
10887 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10888 convenience functions.
10889
10890 @table @code
10891 @item help function
10892 @kindex help function
10893 @cindex show all convenience functions
10894 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10895 @end table
10896
10897 @node Registers
10898 @section Registers
10899
10900 @cindex registers
10901 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10902 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10903 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10904 your machine.
10905
10906 @table @code
10907 @kindex info registers
10908 @item info registers
10909 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10910 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10911
10912 @kindex info all-registers
10913 @cindex floating point registers
10914 @item info all-registers
10915 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10916 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10917
10918 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10919 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10920 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10921 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10922 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10923 @end table
10924
10925 @anchor{standard registers}
10926 @cindex stack pointer register
10927 @cindex program counter register
10928 @cindex process status register
10929 @cindex frame pointer register
10930 @cindex standard registers
10931 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10932 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10933 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10934 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10935 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10936 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10937 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10938 you could print the program counter in hex with
10939
10940 @smallexample
10941 p/x $pc
10942 @end smallexample
10943
10944 @noindent
10945 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10946
10947 @smallexample
10948 x/i $pc
10949 @end smallexample
10950
10951 @noindent
10952 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10953 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10954 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10955 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10956 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10957 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10958 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10959
10960 @smallexample
10961 set $sp += 4
10962 @end smallexample
10963
10964 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10965 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10966 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10967 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10968 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10969 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10970 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10971
10972 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10973 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10974 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10975 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10976 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10977 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10978 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10979
10980 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10981 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10982 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10983 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10984 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10985 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10986 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10987 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10988 prints the data in both formats.
10989
10990 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10991 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10992 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10993 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10994 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10995 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10996 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10997
10998 @smallexample
10999 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11000 $1 = @{
11001 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11002 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11003 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11004 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11005 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11006 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11007 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11008 @}
11009 @end smallexample
11010
11011 @noindent
11012 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11013 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11014 value to a @code{struct} member:
11015
11016 @smallexample
11017 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11018 @end smallexample
11019
11020 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11021 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11022 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11023 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11024 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11025 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11026
11027 @cindex caller-saved registers
11028 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11029 @cindex volatile registers
11030 @cindex <not saved> values
11031 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11032 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11033 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11034 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11035 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11036 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11037 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11038 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11039 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11040 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11041 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11042 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11043 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11044 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11045 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11046 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11047 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11048 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11049 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11050 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11051 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11052 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11053 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11054
11055 @node Floating Point Hardware
11056 @section Floating Point Hardware
11057 @cindex floating point
11058
11059 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11060 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11061
11062 @table @code
11063 @kindex info float
11064 @item info float
11065 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11066 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11067 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11068 the ARM and x86 machines.
11069 @end table
11070
11071 @node Vector Unit
11072 @section Vector Unit
11073 @cindex vector unit
11074
11075 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11076 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11077
11078 @table @code
11079 @kindex info vector
11080 @item info vector
11081 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11082 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11083 @end table
11084
11085 @node OS Information
11086 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11087 @cindex OS information
11088
11089 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11090 you debug your program.
11091
11092 @cindex auxiliary vector
11093 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11094 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11095 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11096 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11097 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11098 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11099 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11100 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11101 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11102 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11103 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11104 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11105
11106 @table @code
11107 @kindex info auxv
11108 @item info auxv
11109 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11110 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11111 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11112 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11113 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11114 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11115 an unrecognized tag.
11116 @end table
11117
11118 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11119 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11120 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11121 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11122 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11123 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11124 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11125
11126 @table @code
11127 @kindex info os
11128 @item info os @var{infotype}
11129
11130 Display OS information of the requested type.
11131
11132 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11133
11134 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11135 @table @code
11136 @kindex info os cpus
11137 @item cpus
11138 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11139 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11140 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11141 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11142 kernel initialization.
11143
11144 @kindex info os files
11145 @item files
11146 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11147 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11148 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11149 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11150
11151 @kindex info os modules
11152 @item modules
11153 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11154 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11155 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11156 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11157 in memory.
11158
11159 @kindex info os msg
11160 @item msg
11161 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11162 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11163 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11164 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11165 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11166 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11167 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11168 the message queue was last changed.
11169
11170 @kindex info os processes
11171 @item processes
11172 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11173 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11174 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11175 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11176 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11177 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11178
11179 @kindex info os procgroups
11180 @item procgroups
11181 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11182 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11183 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11184 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11185 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11186 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11187 and the process group leader is listed first.
11188
11189 @kindex info os semaphores
11190 @item semaphores
11191 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11192 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11193 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11194 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11195 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11196
11197 @kindex info os shm
11198 @item shm
11199 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11200 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11201 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11202 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11203 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11204 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11205 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11206
11207 @kindex info os sockets
11208 @item sockets
11209 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11210 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11211 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11212 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11213 connection.
11214
11215 @kindex info os threads
11216 @item threads
11217 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11218 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11219 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11220 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11221 process is not listed.
11222 @end table
11223
11224 @item info os
11225 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11226 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11227 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11228 types, this command will report an error.
11229 @end table
11230
11231 @node Memory Region Attributes
11232 @section Memory Region Attributes
11233 @cindex memory region attributes
11234
11235 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11236 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11237 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11238 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11239 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11240 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11241 user can override the fetched regions.
11242
11243 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11244 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11245 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11246 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11247 all memory.
11248
11249 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11250 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11251
11252 @table @code
11253 @kindex mem
11254 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11255 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11256 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11257 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11258 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11259 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11260
11261 @item mem auto
11262 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11263 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11264
11265 @kindex delete mem
11266 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11267 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11268 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11269
11270 @kindex disable mem
11271 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11272 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11273 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11274 It may be enabled again later.
11275
11276 @kindex enable mem
11277 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11278 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11279
11280 @kindex info mem
11281 @item info mem
11282 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11283 for each region:
11284
11285 @table @emph
11286 @item Memory Region Number
11287 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11288 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11289 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11290
11291 @item Lo Address
11292 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11293
11294 @item Hi Address
11295 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11296
11297 @item Attributes
11298 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11299 @end table
11300 @end table
11301
11302
11303 @subsection Attributes
11304
11305 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11306 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11307 write accesses to a memory region.
11308
11309 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11310 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11311 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11312
11313 @table @code
11314 @item ro
11315 Memory is read only.
11316 @item wo
11317 Memory is write only.
11318 @item rw
11319 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11320 @end table
11321
11322 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11323 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11324 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11325 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11326 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11327
11328 @table @code
11329 @item 8
11330 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11331 @item 16
11332 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11333 @item 32
11334 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11335 @item 64
11336 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11337 @end table
11338
11339 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11340 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11341 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11342 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11343 @c
11344 @c @table @code
11345 @c @item hwbreak
11346 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11347 @c @item swbreak (default)
11348 @c @end table
11349
11350 @subsubsection Data Cache
11351 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11352 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11353 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11354 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11355 registers.
11356
11357 @table @code
11358 @item cache
11359 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11360 @item nocache
11361 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11362 @end table
11363
11364 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11365 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11366 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11367 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11368 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11369
11370 @table @code
11371 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11372 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11373 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11374 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11375 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11376 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11377 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11378 The default value is @code{on}.
11379 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11380 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11381 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11382 @end table
11383
11384
11385 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11386 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11387 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11388 @c
11389 @c @table @code
11390 @c @item verify
11391 @c @item noverify (default)
11392 @c @end table
11393
11394 @node Dump/Restore Files
11395 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11396 @cindex dump/restore files
11397 @cindex append data to a file
11398 @cindex dump data to a file
11399 @cindex restore data from a file
11400
11401 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11402 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11403 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11404 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11405 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11406 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11407 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11408
11409 @table @code
11410
11411 @kindex dump
11412 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11413 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11414 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11415 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11416
11417 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11418 @table @code
11419 @item binary
11420 Raw binary form.
11421 @item ihex
11422 Intel hex format.
11423 @item srec
11424 Motorola S-record format.
11425 @item tekhex
11426 Tektronix Hex format.
11427 @item verilog
11428 Verilog Hex format.
11429 @end table
11430
11431 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11432 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11433 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11434 form.
11435
11436 @kindex append
11437 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11438 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11439 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11440 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11441 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11442
11443 @kindex restore
11444 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11445 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11446 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11447 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11448 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11449
11450 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11451 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11452 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11453 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11454 from that location.
11455
11456 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11457 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11458 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11459 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11460
11461 @end table
11462
11463 @node Core File Generation
11464 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11465 @cindex dump core from inferior
11466
11467 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11468 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11469 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11470 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11471 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11472 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11473 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11474
11475 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11476 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11477 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11478
11479 @table @code
11480 @kindex gcore
11481 @kindex generate-core-file
11482 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11483 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11484 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11485 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11486 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11487 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11488
11489 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11490 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11491
11492 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11493 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11494 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11495
11496 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11497 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11498 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11499 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11500 Enable or disable the use of the file
11501 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11502 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11503 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11504 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11505
11506 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11507 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11508 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11509 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11510 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11511 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11512 about the bits that can be set in the
11513 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11514 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11515
11516 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11517 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11518 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11519 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11520 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11521 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11522 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11523 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11524 @end table
11525
11526 @node Character Sets
11527 @section Character Sets
11528 @cindex character sets
11529 @cindex charset
11530 @cindex translating between character sets
11531 @cindex host character set
11532 @cindex target character set
11533
11534 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11535 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11536 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11537 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11538 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11539 @dfn{target character set}.
11540
11541 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11542 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11543 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11544 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11545 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11546 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11547 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11548 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11549 character and string literals in expressions.
11550
11551 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11552 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11553 target-charset} command, described below.
11554
11555 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11556 support:
11557
11558 @table @code
11559 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11560 @kindex set target-charset
11561 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11562 list of supported target character sets, type
11563 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11564
11565 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11566 @kindex set host-charset
11567 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11568
11569 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11570 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11571 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11572 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11573 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11574
11575 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11576 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11577 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11578
11579 @item set charset @var{charset}
11580 @kindex set charset
11581 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11582 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11583 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11584 for both host and target.
11585
11586 @item show charset
11587 @kindex show charset
11588 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11589
11590 @item show host-charset
11591 @kindex show host-charset
11592 Show the name of the current host character set.
11593
11594 @item show target-charset
11595 @kindex show target-charset
11596 Show the name of the current target character set.
11597
11598 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11599 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11600 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11601 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11602 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11603 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11604
11605 @item show target-wide-charset
11606 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11607 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11608 @end table
11609
11610 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11611 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11612 @file{charset-test.c}:
11613
11614 @smallexample
11615 #include <stdio.h>
11616
11617 char ascii_hello[]
11618 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11619 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11620 char ibm1047_hello[]
11621 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11622 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11623
11624 main ()
11625 @{
11626 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11627 @}
11628 @end smallexample
11629
11630 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11631 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11632 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11633
11634 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11635
11636 @smallexample
11637 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11638 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11639 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11640 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11641 @dots{}
11642 (@value{GDBP})
11643 @end smallexample
11644
11645 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11646 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11647 strings:
11648
11649 @smallexample
11650 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11651 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11652 (@value{GDBP})
11653 @end smallexample
11654
11655 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11656 initial character set:
11657 @smallexample
11658 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11659 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11660 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11661 (@value{GDBP})
11662 @end smallexample
11663
11664 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11665 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11666 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11667 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11668 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11669
11670 @smallexample
11671 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11672 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11673 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11674 $2 = 72 'H'
11675 (@value{GDBP})
11676 @end smallexample
11677
11678 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11679 literals you use in expressions:
11680
11681 @smallexample
11682 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11683 $3 = 43 '+'
11684 (@value{GDBP})
11685 @end smallexample
11686
11687 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11688 character.
11689
11690 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11691 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11692 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11693
11694 @smallexample
11695 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11696 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11697 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11698 $5 = 200 '\310'
11699 (@value{GDBP})
11700 @end smallexample
11701
11702 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11703 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11704
11705 @smallexample
11706 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11707 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11708 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11709 @end smallexample
11710
11711 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11712 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11713 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11714 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11715 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11716
11717 @smallexample
11718 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11719 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11720 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11721 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11722 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11723 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11724 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11725 $7 = 72 '\110'
11726 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11727 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11728 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11729 $9 = 200 'H'
11730 (@value{GDBP})
11731 @end smallexample
11732
11733 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11734 string literals you use in expressions:
11735
11736 @smallexample
11737 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11738 $10 = 78 '+'
11739 (@value{GDBP})
11740 @end smallexample
11741
11742 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11743 character.
11744
11745 @node Caching Target Data
11746 @section Caching Data of Targets
11747 @cindex caching data of targets
11748
11749 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11750 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11751 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11752 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11753 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11754 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11755 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11756 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11757 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11758 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11759 is executing.
11760 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11761 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11762 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11763 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11764 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11765 in the code segment.
11766 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11767 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11768
11769 @table @code
11770 @kindex set remotecache
11771 @item set remotecache on
11772 @itemx set remotecache off
11773 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11774 with old scripts.
11775
11776 @kindex show remotecache
11777 @item show remotecache
11778 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11779
11780 @kindex set stack-cache
11781 @item set stack-cache on
11782 @itemx set stack-cache off
11783 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11784 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11785
11786 @kindex show stack-cache
11787 @item show stack-cache
11788 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11789
11790 @kindex set code-cache
11791 @item set code-cache on
11792 @itemx set code-cache off
11793 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11794 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11795 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11796
11797 @kindex show code-cache
11798 @item show code-cache
11799 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11800 accesses.
11801
11802 @kindex info dcache
11803 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11804 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11805 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11806 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11807 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11808 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11809
11810 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11811 printed in hex.
11812
11813 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11814 @cindex dcache size
11815 @kindex set dcache size
11816 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11817
11818 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11819 @cindex dcache line-size
11820 @kindex set dcache line-size
11821 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11822 Must be a power of 2.
11823
11824 @item show dcache size
11825 @kindex show dcache size
11826 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11827
11828 @item show dcache line-size
11829 @kindex show dcache line-size
11830 Show default size of dcache lines.
11831
11832 @end table
11833
11834 @node Searching Memory
11835 @section Search Memory
11836 @cindex searching memory
11837
11838 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11839 @code{find} command.
11840
11841 @table @code
11842 @kindex find
11843 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11844 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11845 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11846 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11847 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11848 @end table
11849
11850 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11851 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11852
11853 @table @r
11854 @item @var{s}, search query size
11855 The size of each search query value.
11856
11857 @table @code
11858 @item b
11859 bytes
11860 @item h
11861 halfwords (two bytes)
11862 @item w
11863 words (four bytes)
11864 @item g
11865 giant words (eight bytes)
11866 @end table
11867
11868 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11869 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11870 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11871
11872 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11873 value's type in the current language.
11874 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11875 pattern as a mixture of types.
11876 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11877 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11878 which is typically four bytes.
11879
11880 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11881 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11882 @end table
11883
11884 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11885 (@code{"}).
11886 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11887 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11888
11889 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11890 number of matches found.
11891
11892 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11893 @samp{$_}.
11894 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11895
11896 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11897
11898 @smallexample
11899 void
11900 hello ()
11901 @{
11902 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11903 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11904 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11905 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11906 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11907 @}
11908 @end smallexample
11909
11910 @noindent
11911 you get during debugging:
11912
11913 @smallexample
11914 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11915 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11916 1 pattern found
11917 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11918 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11919 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11920 2 patterns found
11921 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11922 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11923 1 pattern found
11924 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11925 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11926 1 pattern found
11927 (gdb) print $numfound
11928 $1 = 1
11929 (gdb) print $_
11930 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11931 @end smallexample
11932
11933 @node Value Sizes
11934 @section Value Sizes
11935
11936 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11937 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
11938 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11939 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11940 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11941
11942 @table @code
11943 @kindex set max-value-size
11944 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11945 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11946 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11947 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11948 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11949
11950 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11951 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11952
11953 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11954 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11955 currently 16 bytes.
11956
11957 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11958 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
11959 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11960 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
11961 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11962 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11963 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11964 size is less than @var{bytes}.
11965
11966 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11967
11968 @kindex show max-value-size
11969 @item show max-value-size
11970 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11971 allocate for the contents of a value.
11972 @end table
11973
11974 @node Optimized Code
11975 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11976 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11977 @cindex debugging optimized code
11978
11979 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11980 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11981 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11982 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11983 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11984 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11985 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11986
11987 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11988 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11989 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11990 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11991
11992 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11993 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11994 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11995 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11996 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11997 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11998
11999 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12000 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12001 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12002 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12003 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12004
12005 @menu
12006 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12007 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12008 @end menu
12009
12010 @node Inline Functions
12011 @section Inline Functions
12012 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12013
12014 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12015 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12016 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12017 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12018 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12019 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12020 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12021 @code{info frame} command.
12022
12023 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12024 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12025 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12026 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12027 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12028 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12029 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12030 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12031 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12032 local variables in the caller.
12033
12034 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12035 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12036 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12037 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12038 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12039 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12040 instructions are executed.
12041
12042 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12043 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12044 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12045 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12046
12047 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12048 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12049
12050 @itemize @bullet
12051 @item
12052 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12053 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12054 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12055 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12056 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12057 or inside the inlined function instead.
12058
12059 @item
12060 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12061 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12062 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12063 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12064
12065 @end itemize
12066
12067 @node Tail Call Frames
12068 @section Tail Call Frames
12069 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12070
12071 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12072 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12073 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12074 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12075 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12076
12077 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12078 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12079 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12080 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12081 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12082 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12083 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12084
12085 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12086 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12087 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12088 this information.
12089
12090 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12091 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12092
12093 @smallexample
12094 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12095 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12096 (gdb) info frame
12097 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12098 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12099 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12100 source language c++.
12101 Arglist at unknown address.
12102 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12103 @end smallexample
12104
12105 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12106 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12107 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12108 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12109 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12110 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12111
12112 @table @code
12113 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12114 @item set debug entry-values
12115 @kindex set debug entry-values
12116 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12117 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12118 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12119 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12120 result.
12121
12122 @item show debug entry-values
12123 @kindex show debug entry-values
12124 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12125 values at function entry and tail calls.
12126 @end table
12127
12128 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12129 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12130 reference by variable @code{x}):
12131
12132 @smallexample
12133 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12134 void (*x) (void) = c;
12135 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12136 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12137 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12138
12139 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12140 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12141 a () at t.c:3
12142 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12143 (gdb) bt
12144 #0 a () at t.c:3
12145 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12146 @end smallexample
12147
12148 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12149
12150 @smallexample
12151 int i;
12152 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12153 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12154 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12155 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12156 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12157 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12158 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12159 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12160
12161 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12162 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12163 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12164 (gdb) bt
12165 #0 f () at t.c:2
12166 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12167 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12168 @end smallexample
12169
12170 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12171 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12172
12173 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12174 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12175 @set ARROW @click{}
12176 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12177 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12178 @end ifset
12179 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12180 @set ARROW ->
12181 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12182 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12183 @end ifclear
12184
12185 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12186 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12187 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12188
12189 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12190 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12191 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12192 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12193 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12194 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12195
12196 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12197 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12198 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12199 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12200 omitted.
12201
12202 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12203 entry may fail:
12204
12205 @smallexample
12206 int v;
12207 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12208 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12209 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12210 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12211 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12212 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12213
12214 (gdb) bt
12215 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12216 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12217 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12218 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12219 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12220 @end smallexample
12221
12222 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12223 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12224 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12225 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12226 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12227
12228 @node Macros
12229 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12230
12231 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12232 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12233 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12234 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12235 where it was defined.
12236
12237 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12238 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12239 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12240 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12241
12242 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12243 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12244 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12245 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12246 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12247 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12248 see @ref{List}.
12249
12250 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12251 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12252 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12253
12254 @table @code
12255
12256 @kindex macro expand
12257 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12258 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12259 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12260 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12261 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12262 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12263 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12264 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12265 it can be any string of tokens.
12266
12267 @kindex macro exp1
12268 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12269 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12270 @cindex expand macro once
12271 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12272 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12273 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12274 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12275 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12276 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12277 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12278 can be any string of tokens.
12279
12280 @kindex info macro
12281 @cindex macro definition, showing
12282 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12283 @cindex macros, from debug info
12284 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12285 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12286 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12287 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12288 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12289 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12290
12291 @kindex info macros
12292 @item info macros @var{location}
12293 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12294 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12295 command-line where those definitions were established.
12296
12297 @kindex macro define
12298 @cindex user-defined macros
12299 @cindex defining macros interactively
12300 @cindex macros, user-defined
12301 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12302 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12303 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12304 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12305 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12306 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12307 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12308 @var{arglist}.
12309
12310 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12311 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12312 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12313 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12314 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12315
12316 @kindex macro undef
12317 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12318 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12319 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12320 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12321 in the program being debugged.
12322
12323 @kindex macro list
12324 @item macro list
12325 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12326 @end table
12327
12328 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12329 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12330 show our source files:
12331
12332 @smallexample
12333 $ cat sample.c
12334 #include <stdio.h>
12335 #include "sample.h"
12336
12337 #define M 42
12338 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12339
12340 main ()
12341 @{
12342 #define N 28
12343 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12344 #undef N
12345 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12346 #define N 1729
12347 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12348 @}
12349 $ cat sample.h
12350 #define Q <
12351 $
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12355 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12356 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12357 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12358 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12359 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12360 information.
12361
12362 @smallexample
12363 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12364 $
12365 @end smallexample
12366
12367 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12368
12369 @smallexample
12370 $ gdb -nw sample
12371 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12372 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12373 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12374 (@value{GDBP})
12375 @end smallexample
12376
12377 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12378 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12379 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12380
12381 @smallexample
12382 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12383 3
12384 4 #define M 42
12385 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12386 6
12387 7 main ()
12388 8 @{
12389 9 #define N 28
12390 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12391 11 #undef N
12392 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12393 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12394 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12395 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12396 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12397 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12398 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12399 #define Q <
12400 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12401 expands to: (42 + 1)
12402 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12403 expands to: once (M + 1)
12404 (@value{GDBP})
12405 @end smallexample
12406
12407 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12408 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12409 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12410 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12411
12412 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12413 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12414
12415 @smallexample
12416 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12417 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12418 (@value{GDBP}) run
12419 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12420
12421 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12422 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12423 (@value{GDBP})
12424 @end smallexample
12425
12426 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12427
12428 @smallexample
12429 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12430 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12431 #define N 28
12432 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12433 expands to: 28 < 42
12434 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12435 $1 = 1
12436 (@value{GDBP})
12437 @end smallexample
12438
12439 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12440 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12441 thereof) in force at each point:
12442
12443 @smallexample
12444 (@value{GDBP}) next
12445 Hello, world!
12446 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12447 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12448 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12449 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12450 (@value{GDBP}) next
12451 We're so creative.
12452 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12453 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12454 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12455 #define N 1729
12456 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12457 expands to: 1729 < 42
12458 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12459 $2 = 0
12460 (@value{GDBP})
12461 @end smallexample
12462
12463 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12464 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12465 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12466 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12467
12468 @smallexample
12469 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12470 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12471 -D__STDC__=1
12472 (@value{GDBP})
12473 @end smallexample
12474
12475
12476 @node Tracepoints
12477 @chapter Tracepoints
12478 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12479 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12480
12481 @cindex tracepoints
12482 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12483 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12484 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12485 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12486 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12487 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12488 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12489
12490 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12491 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12492 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12493 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12494 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12495 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12496 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12497 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12498 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12499 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12500 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12501
12502 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12503 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12504 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12505 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12506 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12507 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12508 Packets}.
12509
12510 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12511 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12512 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12513
12514 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12515
12516 @menu
12517 * Set Tracepoints::
12518 * Analyze Collected Data::
12519 * Tracepoint Variables::
12520 * Trace Files::
12521 @end menu
12522
12523 @node Set Tracepoints
12524 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12525
12526 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12527 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12528 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12529 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12530 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12531 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12532 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12533
12534 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12535 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12536 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12537 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12538 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12539 tracepoint was hit.
12540
12541 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12542 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12543 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12544 either.
12545
12546 @cindex fast tracepoints
12547 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12548 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12549 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12550
12551 @cindex static tracepoints
12552 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12553 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12554 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12555 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12556 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12557 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12558 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12559 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12560 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12561 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12562 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12563 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12564 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12565 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12566 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12567 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12568 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12569 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12570 static tracepoint marker.
12571
12572 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12573 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12574
12575 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12576 conditions and actions.
12577
12578 @menu
12579 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12580 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12581 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12582 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12583 * Trace State Variables::
12584 * Tracepoint Actions::
12585 * Listing Tracepoints::
12586 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12587 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12588 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12589 @end menu
12590
12591 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12592 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12593
12594 @table @code
12595 @cindex set tracepoint
12596 @kindex trace
12597 @item trace @var{location}
12598 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12599 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12600 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12601 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12602 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12603 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12604 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12605 in tracing}).
12606 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12607 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12608 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12609 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12610 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12611 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12612 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12613 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12614 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12615 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12616 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12617 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12618
12619 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12620
12621 @smallexample
12622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12623
12624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12625
12626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12627
12628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12629
12630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12631 @end smallexample
12632
12633 @noindent
12634 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12635
12636 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12637 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12638 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12639 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12640 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12641 information on tracepoint conditions.
12642
12643 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12644 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12645 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12646 @kindex ftrace
12647 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12648 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12649 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12650 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12651 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12652 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12653 message.
12654
12655 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12656 @code{trace}.
12657
12658 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12659 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12660 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12661 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12662 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12663 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12664 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12665 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12666
12667 @example
12668 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12669 @end example
12670
12671 @noindent
12672 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12673 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12674
12675 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12676 @cindex set static tracepoint
12677 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12678 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12679 @kindex strace
12680 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12681 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12682 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12683 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12684 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12685
12686 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12687 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12688 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12689 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12690 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12691 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12692 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12693 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12694 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12695 tracing engine:
12696
12697 @smallexample
12698 main ()
12699 @{
12700 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12701 @}
12702 @end smallexample
12703
12704 @noindent
12705 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12706 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12707
12708 @smallexample
12709 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12710 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12711 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12712 Data: "str %s"
12713 [etc...]
12714 @end smallexample
12715
12716 @noindent
12717 so you may probe the marker above with:
12718
12719 @smallexample
12720 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12721 @end smallexample
12722
12723 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12724 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12725 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12726 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12727 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12728 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12729 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12730 the @samp{Data:} field.
12731
12732 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12733 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12734 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12735
12736 @vindex $tpnum
12737 @cindex last tracepoint number
12738 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12739 @cindex tracepoint number
12740 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12741 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12742
12743 @kindex delete tracepoint
12744 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12745 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12746 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12747 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12748 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12749
12750 Examples:
12751
12752 @smallexample
12753 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12754
12755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12756 @end smallexample
12757
12758 @noindent
12759 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12760 @end table
12761
12762 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12763 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12764
12765 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12766
12767 @table @code
12768 @kindex disable tracepoint
12769 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12770 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12771 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12772 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12773 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12774 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12775 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12776 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12777 next trace experiment.
12778
12779 @kindex enable tracepoint
12780 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12781 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12782 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12783 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12784 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12785 next time a trace experiment is run.
12786 @end table
12787
12788 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12789 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12790
12791 @table @code
12792 @kindex passcount
12793 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12794 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12795 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12796 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12797 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12798 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12799 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12800 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12801 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12802 user.
12803
12804 Examples:
12805
12806 @smallexample
12807 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12808 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12809
12810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12811 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12813 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12814 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12815 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12816 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12818 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12819 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12820 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12821 @end smallexample
12822 @end table
12823
12824 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12825 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12826 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12827 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12828
12829 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12830 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12831 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12832 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12833 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12834 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12835 is true.
12836
12837 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12838 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12839 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12840 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12841 just as with breakpoints.
12842
12843 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12844 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12845 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12846 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12847 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12848 accesses, and so forth.
12849
12850 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12851 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12852 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12853 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12854 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12855 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12856 search through.
12857
12858 @smallexample
12859 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12860 @end smallexample
12861
12862 @node Trace State Variables
12863 @subsection Trace State Variables
12864 @cindex trace state variables
12865
12866 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12867 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12868 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12869 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12870 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12871 integers.
12872
12873 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12874 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12875 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12876 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12877
12878 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12879 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12880 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12881 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12882 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12883 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12884 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12885 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12886 variable with the same name.
12887
12888 @table @code
12889
12890 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12891 @kindex tvariable
12892 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12893 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12894 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12895 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12896 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12897 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12898 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12899 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12900 value. The default initial value is 0.
12901
12902 @item info tvariables
12903 @kindex info tvariables
12904 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12905 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12906 currently running.
12907
12908 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12909 @kindex delete tvariable
12910 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12911 are specified.
12912
12913 @end table
12914
12915 @node Tracepoint Actions
12916 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12917
12918 @table @code
12919 @kindex actions
12920 @cindex tracepoint actions
12921 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12922 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12923 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12924 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12925 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12926 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12927 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12928 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12929 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12930 @code{while-stepping}.
12931
12932 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12933 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12934 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12935
12936 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12937 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12938 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12939
12940 @smallexample
12941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12942
12943 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12944
12945 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12946 @end smallexample
12947
12948 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12949 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12950 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12951 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12952 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12953 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12954 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12955 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12956
12957 @smallexample
12958 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12960 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12961 > collect bar,baz
12962 > collect $regs
12963 > while-stepping 12
12964 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12965 > end
12966 end
12967 @end smallexample
12968
12969 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12970 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12971 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12972 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12973 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12974 special arguments are supported:
12975
12976 @table @code
12977 @item $regs
12978 Collect all registers.
12979
12980 @item $args
12981 Collect all function arguments.
12982
12983 @item $locals
12984 Collect all local variables.
12985
12986 @item $_ret
12987 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12988 of a backtrace.
12989
12990 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12991 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12992 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
12993 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12994 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12995 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12996
12997 @item $_probe_argc
12998 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12999 tracepoint is located.
13000 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13001
13002 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13003 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13004 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13005 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13006
13007 @item $_sdata
13008 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13009 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13010 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13011 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13012 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13013 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13014 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13015 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13016 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13017
13018 @smallexample
13019 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13020 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13021 @end smallexample
13022
13023 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13024 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13025 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13026 @value{GDBN}.
13027 @end table
13028
13029 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13030 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13031 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13032
13033 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13034 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13035 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13036 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13037 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13038 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13039 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13040 @samp{mystr}.
13041
13042 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13043 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13044
13045 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13046 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13047 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13048 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13049 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13050 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13051 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13052 action were used.
13053
13054 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13055 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13056 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13057 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13058 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13059 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13060
13061 @smallexample
13062 > while-stepping 12
13063 > collect $regs, myglobal
13064 > end
13065 >
13066 @end smallexample
13067
13068 @noindent
13069 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13070 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13071 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13072 @code{stepping}.
13073
13074 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13075 @kindex set default-collect
13076 @cindex default collection action
13077 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13078 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13079 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13080 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13081 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13082 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13083
13084 @item show default-collect
13085 @kindex show default-collect
13086 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13087 tracepoint hit.
13088
13089 @end table
13090
13091 @node Listing Tracepoints
13092 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13093
13094 @table @code
13095 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13096 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13097 @cindex information about tracepoints
13098 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13099 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13100 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13101 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13102 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13103 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13104
13105 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13106 tracing:
13107
13108 @itemize @bullet
13109 @item
13110 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13111
13112 @item
13113 the state about installed on target of each location
13114 @end itemize
13115
13116 @smallexample
13117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13118 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13119 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13120 while-stepping 20
13121 collect globfoo, $regs
13122 end
13123 collect globfoo2
13124 end
13125 pass count 1200
13126 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13127 collect $eip
13128 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13129 installed on target
13130 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13131 installed on target
13132 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13133 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13134 not installed on target
13135 (@value{GDBP})
13136 @end smallexample
13137
13138 @noindent
13139 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13140 @end table
13141
13142 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13143 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13144
13145 @table @code
13146 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13147 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13148 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13149 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13150 program.
13151
13152 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13153
13154 @table @emph
13155 @item Count
13156 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13157 stable identifier.
13158 @item ID
13159 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13160 @item Enabled or Disabled
13161 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13162 that are not enabled.
13163 @item Address
13164 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13165 @item What
13166 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13167 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13168 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13169 will be left blank.
13170 @end table
13171
13172 @noindent
13173 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13174
13175 @table @emph
13176 @item Data
13177 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13178 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13179 marker call.
13180 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13181 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13182 @end table
13183
13184 @smallexample
13185 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13186 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13187 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13188 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13189 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13190 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13191 Data: str %s
13192 (@value{GDBP})
13193 @end smallexample
13194 @end table
13195
13196 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13197 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13198
13199 @table @code
13200 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13201 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13202 @cindex collected data discarded
13203 @item tstart
13204 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13205 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13206 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13207 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13208 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13209 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13210 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13211 information, and so forth.
13212
13213 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13214 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13215 @item tstop
13216 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13217 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13218 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13219 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13220 needs to be stopped quickly.
13221
13222 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13223 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13224 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13225
13226 @kindex tstatus
13227 @cindex status of trace data collection
13228 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13229 @item tstatus
13230 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13231 collection.
13232 @end table
13233
13234 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13235
13236 @smallexample
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13239 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13240 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13241 > while-stepping 11
13242 > collect $regs
13243 > end
13244 > end
13245 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13246 [time passes @dots{}]
13247 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13248 @end smallexample
13249
13250 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13251 @cindex disconnected tracing
13252 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13253 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13254 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13255 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13256 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13257 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13258 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13259 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13260
13261 @table @code
13262 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13263 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13264 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13265 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13266 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13267 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13268 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13269 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13270
13271 @item show disconnected-tracing
13272 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13273 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13274
13275 @end table
13276
13277 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13278 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13279 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13280 it will continue after reconnection.
13281
13282 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13283 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13284 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13285 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13286 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13287 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13288 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13289 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13290 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13291 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13292
13293 @cindex circular trace buffer
13294 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13295 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13296 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13297 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13298 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13299 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13300 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13301 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13302 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13303 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13304 the next run.
13305
13306 @table @code
13307 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13308 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13309 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13310 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13311 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13312 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13313 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13314
13315 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13316 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13317 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13318 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13319 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13320 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13321
13322 @end table
13323
13324 @table @code
13325 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13326 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13327 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13328 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13329 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13330 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13331 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13332 likes. This is also the default.
13333
13334 @item show trace-buffer-size
13335 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13336 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13337 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13338 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13339 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13340 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13341 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13342 @end table
13343
13344 @table @code
13345 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13346 @kindex set trace-user
13347
13348 @item show trace-user
13349 @kindex show trace-user
13350
13351 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13352 @kindex set trace-notes
13353 Set the trace run's notes.
13354
13355 @item show trace-notes
13356 @kindex show trace-notes
13357 Show the trace run's notes.
13358
13359 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13360 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13361 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13362 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13363 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13364
13365 @item show trace-stop-notes
13366 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13367 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13368
13369 @end table
13370
13371 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13372 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13373
13374 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13375 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13376 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13377 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13378 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13379 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13380 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13381 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13382 mentioned here.
13383
13384 @itemize @bullet
13385
13386 @item
13387 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13388 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13389 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13390 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13391 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13392 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13393 cannot be collected either.
13394
13395 @item
13396 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13397 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13398 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13399 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13400 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13401 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13402 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13403 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13404 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13405 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13406
13407 @item
13408 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13409 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13410 in a misleading way.
13411
13412 @item
13413 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13414 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13415 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13416 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13417 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13418 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13419 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13420 by @code{ptr}.
13421
13422 @item
13423 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13424 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13425 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13426 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13427 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13428 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13429 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13430 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13431 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13432 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13433 invalid address.
13434
13435 @item
13436 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13437 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13438 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13439 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13440 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13441 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13442 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13443 it to zero.
13444
13445 @end itemize
13446
13447 @node Analyze Collected Data
13448 @section Using the Collected Data
13449
13450 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13451 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13452 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13453 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13454 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13455 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13456 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13457 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13458 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13459 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13460 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13461 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13462 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13463 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13464 the buffer will fail.
13465
13466 @menu
13467 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13468 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13469 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13470 @end menu
13471
13472 @node tfind
13473 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13474
13475 @kindex tfind
13476 @cindex select trace snapshot
13477 @cindex find trace snapshot
13478 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13479 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13480 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13481 snapshot is selected.
13482
13483 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13484
13485 @table @code
13486 @item tfind start
13487 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13488 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13489
13490 @item tfind none
13491 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13492
13493 @item tfind end
13494 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13495
13496 @item tfind
13497 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13498 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13499
13500 @item tfind -
13501 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13502 retracing earlier steps.
13503
13504 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13505 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13506 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13507 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13508 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13509
13510 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13511 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13512 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13513 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13514 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13515
13516 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13517 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13518 addresses (exclusive).
13519
13520 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13521 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13522 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13523
13524 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13525 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13526 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13527 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13528 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13529 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13530 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13531 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13532 @end table
13533
13534 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13535 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13536 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13537 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13538 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13539 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13540 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13541 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13542 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13543 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13544 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13545 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13546 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13547 tracepoint as the current one.
13548
13549 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13550 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13551 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13552 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13553 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13554
13555 @smallexample
13556 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13557 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13558 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13559 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13560 > tfind
13561 > end
13562
13563 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13564 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13565 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13566 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13567 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13568 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13569 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13570 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13571 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13572 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13573 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13574 @end smallexample
13575
13576 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13577 the buffer:
13578
13579 @smallexample
13580 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13582 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13583 > tfind line
13584 > end
13585
13586 Frame 0, X = 1
13587 Frame 7, X = 2
13588 Frame 13, X = 255
13589 @end smallexample
13590
13591 @node tdump
13592 @subsection @code{tdump}
13593 @kindex tdump
13594 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13595 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13596
13597 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13598 the current trace snapshot.
13599
13600 @smallexample
13601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13603 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13604 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13605 > end
13606
13607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13608
13609 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13610 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13611 at gdb_test.c:444
13612 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13613
13614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13615 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13616 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13617 d1 0x18 24
13618 d2 0x80 128
13619 d3 0x33 51
13620 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13621 d5 0x22 34
13622 d6 0xe0 224
13623 d7 0x380035 3670069
13624 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13625 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13626 a2 0x100 256
13627 a3 0x322000 3284992
13628 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13629 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13630 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13631 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13632 ps 0x0 0
13633 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13634 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13635 fpstatus 0x0 0
13636 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13637 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13638 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13639 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13640 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13641 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13642 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13643 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13644 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13645
13646 (@value{GDBP})
13647 @end smallexample
13648
13649 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13650 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13651 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13652 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13653
13654 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13655 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13656 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13657 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13658 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13659 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13660 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13661 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13662 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13663 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13664
13665 @node save tracepoints
13666 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13667 @kindex save tracepoints
13668 @kindex save-tracepoints
13669 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13670
13671 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13672 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13673 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13674 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13675 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13676 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13677
13678 @node Tracepoint Variables
13679 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13680 @cindex tracepoint variables
13681 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13682
13683 @table @code
13684 @vindex $trace_frame
13685 @item (int) $trace_frame
13686 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13687 snapshot is selected.
13688
13689 @vindex $tracepoint
13690 @item (int) $tracepoint
13691 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13692
13693 @vindex $trace_line
13694 @item (int) $trace_line
13695 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13696
13697 @vindex $trace_file
13698 @item (char []) $trace_file
13699 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13700
13701 @vindex $trace_func
13702 @item (char []) $trace_func
13703 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13704 @end table
13705
13706 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13707 use @code{output} instead.
13708
13709 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13710 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13711 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13712 which are managed by the target.
13713
13714 @smallexample
13715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13716
13717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13718 > output $trace_file
13719 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13720 > tfind
13721 > end
13722 @end smallexample
13723
13724 @node Trace Files
13725 @section Using Trace Files
13726 @cindex trace files
13727
13728 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13729 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13730 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13731 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13732 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13733
13734 @table @code
13735
13736 @kindex tsave
13737 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13738 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13739 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13740 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13741 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13742 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13743 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13744 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13745 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13746 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13747 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13748 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13749 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13750 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13751 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13752
13753 @kindex target tfile
13754 @kindex tfile
13755 @kindex target ctf
13756 @kindex ctf
13757 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13758 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13759 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13760 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13761 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13762 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13763 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13764 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13765 the host.
13766
13767 @smallexample
13768 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13769 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13770 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13771 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13772 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13773 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13774 i = 0
13775 a = 0
13776 b = 1 '\001'
13777 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13778 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13779 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13780 $1 = 1
13781 @end smallexample
13782
13783 @end table
13784
13785 @node Overlays
13786 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13787 @cindex overlays
13788
13789 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13790 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13791 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13792 use overlays.
13793
13794 @menu
13795 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13796 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13797 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13798 mapped by asking the inferior.
13799 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13800 @end menu
13801
13802 @node How Overlays Work
13803 @section How Overlays Work
13804 @cindex mapped overlays
13805 @cindex unmapped overlays
13806 @cindex load address, overlay's
13807 @cindex mapped address
13808 @cindex overlay area
13809
13810 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13811 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13812 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13813 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13814 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13815
13816 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13817 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13818 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13819 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13820 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13821 largest overlay as well.
13822
13823 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13824 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13825 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13826 there.
13827
13828 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13829 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13830 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13831
13832 @smallexample
13833 @group
13834 Data Instruction Larger
13835 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13836 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13837 | | | | | |
13838 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13839 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13840 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13841 | and heap | | | | | |
13842 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13843 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13844 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13845 | | | | | |
13846 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13847 address | | | | | |
13848 | overlay | <-' | | |
13849 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13850 | | <---. | | load address
13851 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13852 | | | |
13853 +-----------+ | |
13854 +-----------+
13855 | |
13856 +-----------+
13857
13858 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13859 @end group
13860 @end smallexample
13861
13862 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13863 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13864 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13865 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13866 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13867 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13868 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13869 program and the overlay area.
13870
13871 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13872 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13873 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13874 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13875 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13876 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13877 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13878
13879 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13880 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13881 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13882
13883 @itemize @bullet
13884
13885 @item
13886 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13887 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13888 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13889 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13890
13891 @item
13892 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13893 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13894 your program's performance.
13895
13896 @item
13897 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13898 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13899 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13900 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13901 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13902 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13903 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13904
13905 @item
13906 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13907 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13908 instruction and data spaces.
13909
13910 @end itemize
13911
13912 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13913 improved in many ways:
13914
13915 @itemize @bullet
13916
13917 @item
13918 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13919 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13920 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13921 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13922 area in the usual way.
13923
13924 @item
13925 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13926 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13927
13928 @item
13929 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13930 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13931 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13932 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13933 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13934 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13935 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13936
13937 @end itemize
13938
13939
13940 @node Overlay Commands
13941 @section Overlay Commands
13942
13943 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13944 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13945 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13946 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13947 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13948 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13949
13950 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13951 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13952
13953 @table @code
13954 @item overlay off
13955 @kindex overlay
13956 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13957 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13958 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13959 overlay support is disabled.
13960
13961 @item overlay manual
13962 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13963 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13964 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13965 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13966 commands described below.
13967
13968 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13969 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13970 @cindex map an overlay
13971 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13972 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13973 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13974 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13975 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13976 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13977
13978 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13979 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13980 @cindex unmap an overlay
13981 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13982 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13983 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13984 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13985
13986 @item overlay auto
13987 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13988 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13989 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13990 Overlay Debugging}.
13991
13992 @item overlay load-target
13993 @itemx overlay load
13994 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13995 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13996 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13997 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13998 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13999 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14000
14001 @item overlay list-overlays
14002 @itemx overlay list
14003 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14004 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14005 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14006
14007 @end table
14008
14009 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14010 of the function the address falls in:
14011
14012 @smallexample
14013 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14014 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14015 @end smallexample
14016 @noindent
14017 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14018 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14019 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14020 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14021
14022 @smallexample
14023 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14024 No sections are mapped.
14025 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14026 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14027 @end smallexample
14028 @noindent
14029 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14030 name normally:
14031
14032 @smallexample
14033 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14034 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14035 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14036 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14037 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14038 @end smallexample
14039
14040 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14041 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14042 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14043 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14044 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14045
14046 @itemize @bullet
14047 @item
14048 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14049 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14050 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14051 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14052 @item
14053 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14054 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14055 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14056 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14057 breakpoints properly.
14058 @end itemize
14059
14060
14061 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14062 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14063 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14064
14065 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14066 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14067 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14068 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14069 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14070 current state of the overlays.
14071
14072 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14073 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14074
14075 @table @asis
14076
14077 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14078 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14079
14080 @smallexample
14081 struct
14082 @{
14083 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14084 unsigned long vma;
14085
14086 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14087 unsigned long size;
14088
14089 /* The overlay's load address. */
14090 unsigned long lma;
14091
14092 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14093 zero otherwise. */
14094 unsigned long mapped;
14095 @}
14096 @end smallexample
14097
14098 @item @code{_novlys}:
14099 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14100 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14101
14102 @end table
14103
14104 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14105 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14106 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14107 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14108 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14109 currently mapped.
14110
14111 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14112 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14113 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14114 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14115 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14116 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14117 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14118 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14119 are not being executed.
14120
14121 @node Overlay Sample Program
14122 @section Overlay Sample Program
14123 @cindex overlay example program
14124
14125 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14126 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14127 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14128 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14129 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14130 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14131 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14132
14133 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14134 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14135 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14136 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14137
14138 @table @file
14139 @item overlays.c
14140 The main program file.
14141 @item ovlymgr.c
14142 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14143 @item foo.c
14144 @itemx bar.c
14145 @itemx baz.c
14146 @itemx grbx.c
14147 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14148 @item d10v.ld
14149 @itemx m32r.ld
14150 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14151 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14152 @end table
14153
14154 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14155 cross-compiler like this:
14156
14157 @smallexample
14158 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14159 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14160 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14161 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14162 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14163 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14164 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14165 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14166 @end smallexample
14167
14168 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14169 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14170 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14171
14172
14173 @node Languages
14174 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14175 @cindex languages
14176
14177 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14178 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14179 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14180 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14181 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14182 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14183
14184 @cindex working language
14185 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14186 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14187 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14188 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14189 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14190 language}.
14191
14192 @menu
14193 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14194 * Show:: Displaying the language
14195 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14196 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14197 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14198 @end menu
14199
14200 @node Setting
14201 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14202
14203 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14204 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14205 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14206 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14207 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14208 are printed, etc.
14209
14210 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14211 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14212 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14213 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14214 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14215 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14216 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14217 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14218 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14219 Displaying the Language}.
14220
14221 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14222 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14223 another language. In that case, make the
14224 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14225 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14226 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14227
14228 @menu
14229 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14230 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14231 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14232 @end menu
14233
14234 @node Filenames
14235 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14236
14237 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14238 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14239
14240 @table @file
14241 @item .ada
14242 @itemx .ads
14243 @itemx .adb
14244 @itemx .a
14245 Ada source file.
14246
14247 @item .c
14248 C source file
14249
14250 @item .C
14251 @itemx .cc
14252 @itemx .cp
14253 @itemx .cpp
14254 @itemx .cxx
14255 @itemx .c++
14256 C@t{++} source file
14257
14258 @item .d
14259 D source file
14260
14261 @item .m
14262 Objective-C source file
14263
14264 @item .f
14265 @itemx .F
14266 Fortran source file
14267
14268 @item .mod
14269 Modula-2 source file
14270
14271 @item .s
14272 @itemx .S
14273 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14274 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14275 @end table
14276
14277 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14278 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14279
14280 @node Manually
14281 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14282
14283 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14284 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14285 your program.
14286
14287 @kindex set language
14288 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14289 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14290 a language, such as
14291 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14292 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14293
14294 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14295 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14296 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14297 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14298 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14299 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14300 command such as:
14301
14302 @smallexample
14303 print a = b + c
14304 @end smallexample
14305
14306 @noindent
14307 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14308 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14309 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14310 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14311
14312 @node Automatically
14313 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14314
14315 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14316 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14317 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14318 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14319 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14320 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14321 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14322 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14323 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14324
14325 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14326 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14327 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14328 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14329 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14330
14331 @node Show
14332 @section Displaying the Language
14333
14334 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14335 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14336
14337 @table @code
14338 @item show language
14339 @anchor{show language}
14340 @kindex show language
14341 Display the current working language. This is the
14342 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14343 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14344
14345 @item info frame
14346 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14347 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14348 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14349 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14350 information listed here.
14351
14352 @item info source
14353 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14354 Display the source language of this source file.
14355 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14356 information listed here.
14357 @end table
14358
14359 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14360 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14361 with a language explicitly:
14362
14363 @table @code
14364 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14365 @kindex set extension-language
14366 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14367 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14368
14369 @item info extensions
14370 @kindex info extensions
14371 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14372 @end table
14373
14374 @node Checks
14375 @section Type and Range Checking
14376
14377 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14378 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14379 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14380 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14381 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14382 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14383 errors when your program is running.
14384
14385 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14386 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14387 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14388 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14389
14390 @menu
14391 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14392 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14393 @end menu
14394
14395 @cindex type checking
14396 @cindex checks, type
14397 @node Type Checking
14398 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14399
14400 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14401 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14402 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14403 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14404
14405 @smallexample
14406 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14407
14408 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14409 $1 = 2
14410 @exdent but
14411 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14412 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14413 @end smallexample
14414
14415 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14416 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14417
14418 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14419 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14420 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14421 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14422 expressions like the second example above.
14423
14424 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14425 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14426 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14427 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14428 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14429 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14430
14431 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14432
14433 @kindex set check type
14434 @kindex show check type
14435 @table @code
14436 @item set check type on
14437 @itemx set check type off
14438 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14439 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14440 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14441
14442 @item show check type
14443 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14444 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14445 @end table
14446
14447 @cindex range checking
14448 @cindex checks, range
14449 @node Range Checking
14450 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14451
14452 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14453 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14454 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14455 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14456 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14457
14458 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14459 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14460 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14461 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14462
14463 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14464 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14465 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14466 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14467 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14468 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14469
14470 @smallexample
14471 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14472 @end smallexample
14473
14474 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14475 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14476 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14477
14478 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14479
14480 @kindex set check range
14481 @kindex show check range
14482 @table @code
14483 @item set check range auto
14484 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14485 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14486 each language.
14487
14488 @item set check range on
14489 @itemx set check range off
14490 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14491 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14492 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14493 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14494
14495 @item set check range warn
14496 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14497 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14498 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14499 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14500 systems).
14501
14502 @item show range
14503 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14504 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14505 @end table
14506
14507 @node Supported Languages
14508 @section Supported Languages
14509
14510 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14511 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14512 @c This is false ...
14513 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14514 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14515 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14516 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14517 language.
14518
14519 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14520 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14521 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14522 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14523 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14524 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14525 language reference or tutorial.
14526
14527 @menu
14528 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14529 * D:: D
14530 * Go:: Go
14531 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14532 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14533 * Fortran:: Fortran
14534 * Pascal:: Pascal
14535 * Rust:: Rust
14536 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14537 * Ada:: Ada
14538 @end menu
14539
14540 @node C
14541 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14542
14543 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14544 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14545
14546 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14547 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14548 together.
14549
14550 @cindex C@t{++}
14551 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14552 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14553 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14554 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14555 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14556 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14557 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14558
14559 @menu
14560 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14561 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14562 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14563 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14564 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14565 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14566 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14567 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14568 @end menu
14569
14570 @node C Operators
14571 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14572
14573 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14574
14575 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14576 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14577 often defined on groups of types.
14578
14579 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14580
14581 @itemize @bullet
14582
14583 @item
14584 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14585 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14586
14587 @item
14588 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14589 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14590
14591 @item
14592 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14593
14594 @item
14595 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14596
14597 @end itemize
14598
14599 @noindent
14600 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14601 in order of increasing precedence:
14602
14603 @table @code
14604 @item ,
14605 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14606 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14607 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14608
14609 @item =
14610 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14611 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14612
14613 @item @var{op}=
14614 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14615 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14616 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14617 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14618 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14619
14620 @item ?:
14621 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14622 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14623 should be of an integral type.
14624
14625 @item ||
14626 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14627
14628 @item &&
14629 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14630
14631 @item |
14632 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14633
14634 @item ^
14635 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14636
14637 @item &
14638 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14639
14640 @item ==@r{, }!=
14641 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14642 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14643
14644 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14645 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14646 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14647 and non-zero for true.
14648
14649 @item <<@r{, }>>
14650 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14651
14652 @item @@
14653 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14654
14655 @item +@r{, }-
14656 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14657 pointer types.
14658
14659 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14660 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14661 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14662 integral types.
14663
14664 @item ++@r{, }--
14665 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14666 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14667 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14668 operation takes place.
14669
14670 @item *
14671 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14672 @code{++}.
14673
14674 @item &
14675 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14676
14677 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14678 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14679 to examine the address
14680 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14681 stored.
14682
14683 @item -
14684 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14685 precedence as @code{++}.
14686
14687 @item !
14688 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14689 @code{++}.
14690
14691 @item ~
14692 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14693 @code{++}.
14694
14695
14696 @item .@r{, }->
14697 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14698 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14699 pointer based on the stored type information.
14700 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14701
14702 @item .*@r{, }->*
14703 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14704
14705 @item []
14706 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14707 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14708
14709 @item ()
14710 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14711
14712 @item ::
14713 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14714 and @code{class} types.
14715
14716 @item ::
14717 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14718 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14719 above.
14720 @end table
14721
14722 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14723 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14724 predefined meaning.
14725
14726 @node C Constants
14727 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14728
14729 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14730
14731 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14732 following ways:
14733
14734 @itemize @bullet
14735 @item
14736 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14737 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14738 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14739 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14740 @code{long} value.
14741
14742 @item
14743 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14744 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14745 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14746 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14747 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14748 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14749 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14750 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14751 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14752 constant.
14753
14754 @item
14755 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14756 integral equivalents.
14757
14758 @item
14759 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14760 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14761 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14762 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14763 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14764 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14765 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14766 @samp{\n} for newline.
14767
14768 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14769 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14770 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14771 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14772
14773 @item
14774 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14775 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14776 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14777 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14778 characters.
14779
14780 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14781 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14782 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14783
14784 @item
14785 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14786 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14787
14788 @item
14789 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14790 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14791 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14792 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14793 @end itemize
14794
14795 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14796 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14797
14798 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14799 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14800
14801 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14802 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14803 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14804 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14805 @quotation
14806 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14807 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14808 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14809 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14810 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14811 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14812 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14813 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14814 @end quotation
14815
14816 @enumerate
14817
14818 @cindex member functions
14819 @item
14820 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14821
14822 @smallexample
14823 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14824 @end smallexample
14825
14826 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14827 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14828 @item
14829 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14830 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14831 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14832 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14833 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14834
14835 @cindex call overloaded functions
14836 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14837 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14838 @item
14839 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14840 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14841 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14842 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14843 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14844 default arguments.
14845
14846 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14847 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14848 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14849 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14850 number of function arguments.
14851
14852 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14853 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14854 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14855
14856 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14857 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14858 @smallexample
14859 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14860 @end smallexample
14861
14862 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14863 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14864
14865 @cindex reference declarations
14866 @item
14867 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
14868 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
14869 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
14870
14871 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14872 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14873 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14874 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14875 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14876
14877 @item
14878 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14879 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14880 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14881 necessary, for example in an expression like
14882 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14883 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14884 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14885
14886 @item
14887 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14888 specification.
14889 @end enumerate
14890
14891 @node C Defaults
14892 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14893
14894 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14895
14896 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14897 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14898 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14899 selects the working language.
14900
14901 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14902 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14903 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14904 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14905 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14906 for further details.
14907
14908 @node C Checks
14909 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14910
14911 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14912
14913 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14914 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14915 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14916 constants to pointers.
14917
14918 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14919 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14920 that is not itself an array.
14921
14922 @node Debugging C
14923 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14924
14925 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14926 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14927 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14928 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14929
14930 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14931 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14932 ,Expressions}.
14933
14934 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14935 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14936
14937 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14938
14939 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14940 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14941
14942 @table @code
14943 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14944 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14945 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14946 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14947 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14948 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14949
14950 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14951 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14952 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14953 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14954 classes.
14955 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14956
14957 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14958 @item catch throw
14959 @itemx catch rethrow
14960 @itemx catch catch
14961 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14962 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14963
14964 @cindex inheritance
14965 @item ptype @var{typename}
14966 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14967 @var{typename}.
14968 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14969
14970 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14971 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14972 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14973 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14974 multiple inheritance is in use.
14975
14976 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14977 @item demangle @var{name}
14978 Demangle @var{name}.
14979 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14980
14981 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14982 @item set print demangle
14983 @itemx show print demangle
14984 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14985 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14986 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14987 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14988 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14989
14990 @item set print object
14991 @itemx show print object
14992 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14993 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14994
14995 @item set print vtbl
14996 @itemx show print vtbl
14997 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14998 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14999 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15000 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15001
15002 @kindex set overload-resolution
15003 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15004 @item set overload-resolution on
15005 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15006 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15007 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15008 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15009 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15010 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15011
15012 @item set overload-resolution off
15013 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15014 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15015 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15016 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15017 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15018 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15019 argument types.
15020
15021 @kindex show overload-resolution
15022 @item show overload-resolution
15023 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15024
15025 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15026 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15027 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15028 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15029 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15030 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15031 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15032 @end table
15033
15034 @node Decimal Floating Point
15035 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15036 @cindex decimal floating point format
15037
15038 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15039 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15040 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15041 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15042
15043 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15044 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15045 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15046 configured target.
15047
15048 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15049 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15050 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15051
15052 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15053 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15054 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15055
15056 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15057 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15058 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15059
15060 @node D
15061 @subsection D
15062
15063 @cindex D
15064 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15065 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15066 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15067
15068 @node Go
15069 @subsection Go
15070
15071 @cindex Go (programming language)
15072 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15073 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15074
15075 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15076
15077 @table @code
15078 @cindex current Go package
15079 @item The current Go package
15080 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15081 specifying global variables and functions.
15082
15083 For example, given the program:
15084
15085 @example
15086 package main
15087 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15088 func main () @{
15089 // ...
15090 @}
15091 @end example
15092
15093 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15094
15095 @example
15096 (gdb) p myglob
15097 (gdb) p main.myglob
15098 @end example
15099
15100 @cindex builtin Go types
15101 @item Builtin Go types
15102 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15103 as a string.
15104
15105 @cindex builtin Go functions
15106 @item Builtin Go functions
15107 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15108 function and handles it internally.
15109
15110 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15111 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15112 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15113 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15114 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15115 @end table
15116
15117 @node Objective-C
15118 @subsection Objective-C
15119
15120 @cindex Objective-C
15121 This section provides information about some commands and command
15122 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15123 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15124 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15125
15126 @menu
15127 * Method Names in Commands::
15128 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15129 @end menu
15130
15131 @node Method Names in Commands
15132 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15133
15134 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15135 names as line specifications:
15136
15137 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15138 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15139 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15140 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15141 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15142 @itemize
15143 @item @code{clear}
15144 @item @code{break}
15145 @item @code{info line}
15146 @item @code{jump}
15147 @item @code{list}
15148 @end itemize
15149
15150 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15151
15152 @smallexample
15153 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15154 @end smallexample
15155
15156 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15157 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15158 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15159 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15160 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15161 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15162 debugged, enter:
15163
15164 @smallexample
15165 break -[Fruit create]
15166 @end smallexample
15167
15168 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15169 enter:
15170
15171 @smallexample
15172 list +[NSText initialize]
15173 @end smallexample
15174
15175 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15176 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15177 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15178 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15179
15180 @smallexample
15181 break create
15182 @end smallexample
15183
15184 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15185 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15186 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15187 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15188 none apply.
15189
15190 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15191 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15192
15193 @smallexample
15194 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15195 @end smallexample
15196
15197 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15198 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15199 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15200 @kindex print-object
15201 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15202
15203 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15204
15205 @smallexample
15206 print -[@var{object} hash]
15207 @end smallexample
15208
15209 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15210 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15211 @noindent
15212 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15213 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15214 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15215 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15216 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15217 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15218
15219 @node OpenCL C
15220 @subsection OpenCL C
15221
15222 @cindex OpenCL C
15223 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15224
15225 @menu
15226 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15227 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15228 * OpenCL C Operators::
15229 @end menu
15230
15231 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15232 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15233
15234 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15235 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15236 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15237 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15238 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15239
15240 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15241 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15242
15243 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15244 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15245 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15246 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15247
15248 @node OpenCL C Operators
15249 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15250
15251 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15252 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15253 vector data types.
15254
15255 @node Fortran
15256 @subsection Fortran
15257 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15258
15259 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15260 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15261
15262 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15263 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15264 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15265 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15266 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15267 underscore.
15268
15269 @menu
15270 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15271 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15272 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15273 @end menu
15274
15275 @node Fortran Operators
15276 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15277
15278 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15279
15280 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15281 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15282 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15283
15284 @table @code
15285 @item **
15286 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15287 of the second one.
15288
15289 @item :
15290 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15291 represent a section of array.
15292
15293 @item %
15294 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15295 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15296 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15297 union type.
15298 @end table
15299
15300 @node Fortran Defaults
15301 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15302
15303 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15304
15305 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15306 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15307 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15308 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15309
15310 @node Special Fortran Commands
15311 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15312
15313 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15314
15315 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15316 such as displaying common blocks.
15317
15318 @table @code
15319 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15320 @kindex info common
15321 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15322 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15323 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15324 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15325 printed.
15326 @end table
15327
15328 @node Pascal
15329 @subsection Pascal
15330
15331 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15332 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15333 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15334 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15335 syntax.
15336
15337 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15338 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15339 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15340
15341 @node Rust
15342 @subsection Rust
15343
15344 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15345 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15346 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15347 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15348
15349 @itemize @bullet
15350 @item
15351 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15352 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15353 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15354
15355 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15356 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15357 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15358 @samp{B}.
15359
15360 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15361 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15362
15363 @item
15364 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15365 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15366 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15367 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15368 @samp{K::x::y}.
15369
15370 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15371 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15372 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15373 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15374 scope.
15375
15376 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15377 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15378
15379 @item
15380 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15381 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15382
15383 @item
15384 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15385
15386 @item
15387 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15388 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15389 never be destroyed.
15390
15391 @item
15392 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15393 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15394 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15395
15396 @item
15397 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15398 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15399 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15400 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15401 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15402 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15403 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15404 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15405
15406 @item
15407 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15408 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15409 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15410 @itemize @bullet
15411
15412 @item
15413 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15414
15415 @item
15416 Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15417
15418 @item
15419 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15420
15421 @item
15422 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15423 type names.
15424
15425 @item
15426 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15427
15428 @item
15429 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15430 available in the crate.
15431 @end itemize
15432 @end itemize
15433
15434 @node Modula-2
15435 @subsection Modula-2
15436
15437 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15438
15439 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15440 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15441 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15442 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15443 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15444 table.
15445
15446 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15447 @menu
15448 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15449 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15450 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15451 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15452 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15453 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15454 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15455 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15456 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15457 @end menu
15458
15459 @node M2 Operators
15460 @subsubsection Operators
15461 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15462
15463 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15464 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15465 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15466 following definitions hold:
15467
15468 @itemize @bullet
15469
15470 @item
15471 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15472 their subranges.
15473
15474 @item
15475 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15476
15477 @item
15478 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15479
15480 @item
15481 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15482 @var{type}}.
15483
15484 @item
15485 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15486
15487 @item
15488 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15489
15490 @item
15491 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15492 @end itemize
15493
15494 @noindent
15495 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15496 increasing precedence:
15497
15498 @table @code
15499 @item ,
15500 Function argument or array index separator.
15501
15502 @item :=
15503 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15504 @var{value}.
15505
15506 @item <@r{, }>
15507 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15508 types.
15509
15510 @item <=@r{, }>=
15511 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15512 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15513 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15514
15515 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15516 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15517 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15518 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15519 comment character.
15520
15521 @item IN
15522 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15523 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15524
15525 @item OR
15526 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15527
15528 @item AND@r{, }&
15529 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15530
15531 @item @@
15532 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15533
15534 @item +@r{, }-
15535 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15536 and difference on set types.
15537
15538 @item *
15539 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15540 on set types.
15541
15542 @item /
15543 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15544 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15545
15546 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15547 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15548 precedence as @code{*}.
15549
15550 @item -
15551 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15552
15553 @item ^
15554 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15555
15556 @item NOT
15557 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15558 @code{^}.
15559
15560 @item .
15561 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15562 precedence as @code{^}.
15563
15564 @item []
15565 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15566
15567 @item ()
15568 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15569 as @code{^}.
15570
15571 @item ::@r{, }.
15572 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15573 @end table
15574
15575 @quotation
15576 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15577 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15578 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15579 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15580 @end quotation
15581
15582
15583 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15584 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15585 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15586
15587 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15588 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15589
15590 @table @var
15591
15592 @item a
15593 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15594
15595 @item c
15596 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15597
15598 @item i
15599 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15600
15601 @item m
15602 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15603 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15604 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15605
15606 @item n
15607 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15608
15609 @item r
15610 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15611
15612 @item t
15613 represents a type.
15614
15615 @item v
15616 represents a variable.
15617
15618 @item x
15619 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15620 explanation of the function for details.
15621 @end table
15622
15623 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15624
15625 @table @code
15626 @item ABS(@var{n})
15627 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15628
15629 @item CAP(@var{c})
15630 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15631 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15632
15633 @item CHR(@var{i})
15634 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15635
15636 @item DEC(@var{v})
15637 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15638
15639 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15640 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15641 new value.
15642
15643 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15644 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15645 set.
15646
15647 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15648 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15649
15650 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15651 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15652
15653 @item INC(@var{v})
15654 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15655
15656 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15657 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15658 new value.
15659
15660 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15661 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15662 there. Returns the new set.
15663
15664 @item MAX(@var{t})
15665 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15666
15667 @item MIN(@var{t})
15668 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15669
15670 @item ODD(@var{i})
15671 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15672
15673 @item ORD(@var{x})
15674 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15675 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15676 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15677 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15678
15679 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15680 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15681 variable or a type.
15682
15683 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15684 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15685
15686 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15687 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15688 variable or a type.
15689
15690 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15691 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15692 @end table
15693
15694 @quotation
15695 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15696 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15697 an error.
15698 @end quotation
15699
15700 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15701 @node M2 Constants
15702 @subsubsection Constants
15703
15704 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15705 ways:
15706
15707 @itemize @bullet
15708
15709 @item
15710 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15711 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15712 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15713 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15714
15715 @item
15716 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15717 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15718 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15719 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15720 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15721 digits.
15722
15723 @item
15724 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15725 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15726 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15727 followed by a @samp{C}.
15728
15729 @item
15730 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15731 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15732 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15733 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15734 sequences.
15735
15736 @item
15737 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15738
15739 @item
15740 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15741 @code{FALSE}.
15742
15743 @item
15744 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15745
15746 @item
15747 Set constants are not yet supported.
15748 @end itemize
15749
15750 @node M2 Types
15751 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15752 @cindex Modula-2 types
15753
15754 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15755 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15756 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15757 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15758 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15759 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15760
15761 The first example contains the following section of code:
15762
15763 @smallexample
15764 VAR
15765 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15766 r: [20..40] ;
15767 @end smallexample
15768
15769 @noindent
15770 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15771 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15772
15773 @smallexample
15774 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15775 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15776 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15777 SET OF CHAR
15778 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15779 21
15780 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15781 [20..40]
15782 @end smallexample
15783
15784 @noindent
15785 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15786
15787 @smallexample
15788 VAR
15789 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15790 @end smallexample
15791
15792 @noindent
15793 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15794
15795 @smallexample
15796 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15797 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15798 @end smallexample
15799
15800 @noindent
15801 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15802 expressions using the debugger.
15803
15804 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15805 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15806
15807 @smallexample
15808 VAR
15809 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15810 @end smallexample
15811
15812 @smallexample
15813 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15814 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15815 @end smallexample
15816
15817 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15818 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15819 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15820 above.
15821
15822 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15823
15824 @smallexample
15825 TYPE
15826 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15827 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15828 VAR
15829 s: t ;
15830 BEGIN
15831 s := blue ;
15832 @end smallexample
15833
15834 @noindent
15835 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15836 and value of a variable.
15837
15838 @smallexample
15839 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15840 $1 = blue
15841 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15842 type = [blue..yellow]
15843 @end smallexample
15844
15845 @noindent
15846 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15847 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15848 their @code{C} counterparts.
15849
15850 @smallexample
15851 VAR
15852 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15853 BEGIN
15854 s[1] := 1 ;
15855 @end smallexample
15856
15857 @smallexample
15858 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15859 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15860 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15861 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15862 @end smallexample
15863
15864 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15865 pointer types as shown in this example:
15866
15867 @smallexample
15868 VAR
15869 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15870 BEGIN
15871 NEW(s) ;
15872 s^[1] := 1 ;
15873 @end smallexample
15874
15875 @noindent
15876 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15877
15878 @smallexample
15879 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15880 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15881 @end smallexample
15882
15883 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15884 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15885 types:
15886
15887 @smallexample
15888 TYPE
15889 foo = RECORD
15890 f1: CARDINAL ;
15891 f2: CHAR ;
15892 f3: myarray ;
15893 END ;
15894
15895 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15896 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15897 VAR
15898 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15899 @end smallexample
15900
15901 @noindent
15902 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15903 below.
15904
15905 @smallexample
15906 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15907 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15908 f1 : CARDINAL;
15909 f2 : CHAR;
15910 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15911 END
15912 @end smallexample
15913
15914 @node M2 Defaults
15915 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15916 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15917
15918 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15919 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15920 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15921 selected the working language.
15922
15923 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15924 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15925 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15926 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15927
15928 @node Deviations
15929 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15930 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15931
15932 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15933 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15934
15935 @itemize @bullet
15936 @item
15937 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15938 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15939 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15940 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15941 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15942 returned a pointer.)
15943
15944 @item
15945 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15946 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15947 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15948 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15949
15950 @item
15951 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15952 argument.
15953
15954 @item
15955 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15956 @end itemize
15957
15958 @node M2 Checks
15959 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15960 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15961
15962 @quotation
15963 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15964 range checking.
15965 @end quotation
15966 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15967
15968 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15969
15970 @itemize @bullet
15971 @item
15972 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15973 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15974
15975 @item
15976 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15977 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15978 @end itemize
15979
15980 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15981 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15982
15983 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15984 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15985
15986 @node M2 Scope
15987 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15988 @cindex scope
15989 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15990 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15991 @ifinfo
15992 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15993 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15994 @end ifinfo
15995 @ifnotinfo
15996 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15997 @end ifnotinfo
15998
15999 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16000 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16001 similar syntax:
16002
16003 @smallexample
16004
16005 @var{module} . @var{id}
16006 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16007 @end smallexample
16008
16009 @noindent
16010 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16011 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16012 identifier within your program, except another module.
16013
16014 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16015 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16016 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16017 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16018
16019 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16020 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16021 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16022 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16023 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16024 @var{module}.
16025
16026 @node GDB/M2
16027 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16028
16029 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16030 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16031 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16032 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16033 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16034 analogue in Modula-2.
16035
16036 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16037 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16038 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16039 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16040 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16041 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16042
16043 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16044 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16045 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16046
16047 @node Ada
16048 @subsection Ada
16049 @cindex Ada
16050
16051 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16052 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16053 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16054 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16055 to be difficult.
16056
16057
16058 @cindex expressions in Ada
16059 @menu
16060 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16061 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16062 in @value{GDBN}.
16063 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16064 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16065 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16066 subprograms.
16067 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16068 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16069 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16070 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16071 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16072 Profile
16073 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16074 @end menu
16075
16076 @node Ada Mode Intro
16077 @subsubsection Introduction
16078 @cindex Ada mode, general
16079
16080 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16081 syntax, with some extensions.
16082 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16083
16084 @itemize @bullet
16085 @item
16086 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16087 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16088 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16089 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16090
16091 @item
16092 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16093 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16094
16095 @item
16096 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16097 @end itemize
16098
16099 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16100 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16101 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16102 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16103 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16104
16105 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16106 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16107 was translated from an Ada source file.
16108
16109 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16110 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16111 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16112 middle (to allow based literals).
16113
16114 @node Omissions from Ada
16115 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16116 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16117
16118 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16119
16120 @itemize @bullet
16121 @item
16122 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16123
16124 @itemize @minus
16125 @item
16126 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16127 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16128
16129 @item
16130 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16131
16132 @item
16133 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16134
16135 @item
16136 @t{'Tag}.
16137
16138 @item
16139 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16140 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16141
16142 @item
16143 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16144 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16145
16146 @item
16147 @t{'Address}.
16148 @end itemize
16149
16150 @item
16151 The names in
16152 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16153 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16154 not currently available.
16155
16156 @item
16157 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16158 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16159 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16160 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16161 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16162 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16163 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16164 indeterminate values.
16165
16166 @item
16167 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16168 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16169 are not implemented.
16170
16171 @item
16172 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16173 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16174 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16175 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16176 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16177
16178 @smallexample
16179 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16180 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16181 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16182 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16183 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16184 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16185 @end smallexample
16186
16187 Changing a
16188 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16189 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16190 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16191 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16192 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16193 declared to have a type such as:
16194
16195 @smallexample
16196 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16197 Id : Integer;
16198 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16199 end record;
16200 @end smallexample
16201
16202 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16203 assignments:
16204
16205 @smallexample
16206 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16207 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16208 @end smallexample
16209
16210 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16211 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16212 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16213 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16214 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16215 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16216 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16217 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16218
16219 @item
16220 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16221
16222 @item
16223 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16224 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16225 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16226 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16227 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16228 the proper resolution.
16229
16230 @item
16231 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16232
16233 @item
16234 Entry calls are not implemented.
16235
16236 @item
16237 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16238 formats are not supported.
16239
16240 @item
16241 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16242
16243 @item
16244 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16245 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16246 context.
16247 Should your program
16248 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16249 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16250 @end itemize
16251
16252 @node Additions to Ada
16253 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16254 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16255
16256 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16257 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16258
16259 @itemize @bullet
16260 @item
16261 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16262 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16263 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16264 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16265 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16266 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16267 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16268 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16269
16270 @item
16271 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16272 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16273 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16274
16275 @item
16276 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16277 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16278
16279 @item
16280 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16281 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16282 @end itemize
16283
16284 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16285 additions specific to Ada:
16286
16287 @itemize @bullet
16288 @item
16289 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16290 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16291
16292 @smallexample
16293 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16294 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16295 @end smallexample
16296
16297 @item
16298 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16299 the value of its right-hand operand.
16300 This allows, for example,
16301 complex conditional breaks:
16302
16303 @smallexample
16304 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16305 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16306 @end smallexample
16307
16308 @item
16309 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16310 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16311 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16312 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16313 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16314 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16315 in strings. For example,
16316 @smallexample
16317 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16318 @end smallexample
16319 @noindent
16320 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16321 after each period.
16322
16323 @item
16324 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16325 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16326 to write
16327
16328 @smallexample
16329 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16330 @end smallexample
16331
16332 @item
16333 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16334 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16335 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16336 of 3 might print as
16337
16338 @smallexample
16339 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16340 @end smallexample
16341
16342 @noindent
16343 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16344 clause.
16345
16346 @item
16347 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16348 multi-character subsequence of
16349 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16350 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16351 in place of @t{a'length}.
16352
16353 @item
16354 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16355 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16356 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16357 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16358 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16359 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16360 For example,
16361 @smallexample
16362 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16363 @end smallexample
16364
16365 @item
16366 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16367 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16368 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16369 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16370 object.
16371
16372 @end itemize
16373
16374 @node Overloading support for Ada
16375 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16376 @cindex overloading, Ada
16377
16378 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16379 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16380 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16381 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16382 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16383 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16384
16385 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16386 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16387 use, for instance:
16388
16389 @smallexample
16390 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16391 Multiple matches for f
16392 [0] cancel
16393 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16394 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16395 >
16396 @end smallexample
16397
16398 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16399 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16400 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16401
16402 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16403 case:
16404
16405 @table @code
16406
16407 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16408 @item set ada print-signatures
16409 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16410 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16411 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16412
16413 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16414 @item show ada print-signatures
16415 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16416 overloads selection menu.
16417 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16418
16419 @end table
16420
16421 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16422 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16423
16424 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16425 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16426 before reaching the main procedure.
16427 As defined in the Ada Reference
16428 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16429 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16430 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16431 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16432
16433 @node Ada Exceptions
16434 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16435
16436 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16437
16438 @table @code
16439 @kindex info exceptions
16440 @item info exceptions
16441 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16442 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16443 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16444 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16445 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16446 @end table
16447
16448 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16449 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16450 argument.
16451
16452 @smallexample
16453 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16454 All defined Ada exceptions:
16455 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16456 program_error: 0x613d20
16457 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16458 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16459 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16460 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16461 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16462 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16463 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16464 @end smallexample
16465
16466 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16467 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16468
16469 @node Ada Tasks
16470 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16471 @cindex Ada, tasking
16472
16473 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16474 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16475
16476 @table @code
16477 @kindex info tasks
16478 @item info tasks
16479 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16480
16481
16482 @smallexample
16483 @iftex
16484 @leftskip=0.5cm
16485 @end iftex
16486 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16487 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16488 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16489 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16490 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16491 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16492
16493 @end smallexample
16494
16495 @noindent
16496 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16497 task currently being inspected.
16498
16499 @table @asis
16500 @item ID
16501 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16502
16503 @item TID
16504 The Ada task ID.
16505
16506 @item P-ID
16507 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16508
16509 @item Pri
16510 The base priority of the task.
16511
16512 @item State
16513 Current state of the task.
16514
16515 @table @code
16516 @item Unactivated
16517 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16518 executing.
16519
16520 @item Runnable
16521 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16522 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16523
16524 @item Terminated
16525 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16526 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16527 terminated themselves.
16528
16529 @item Child Activation Wait
16530 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16531
16532 @item Accept Statement
16533 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16534
16535 @item Waiting on entry call
16536 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16537
16538 @item Async Select Wait
16539 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16540 select statement.
16541
16542 @item Delay Sleep
16543 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16544 alternative open.
16545
16546 @item Child Termination Wait
16547 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16548 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16549 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16550
16551 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16552 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16553 finish terminating.
16554
16555 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16556 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16557 @end table
16558
16559 @item Name
16560 Name of the task in the program.
16561
16562 @end table
16563
16564 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16565 @item info task @var{taskno}
16566 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16567 the following example:
16568 @smallexample
16569 @iftex
16570 @leftskip=0.5cm
16571 @end iftex
16572 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16573 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16574 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16575 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16576 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16577 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16578 Name: task_1
16579 Thread: 0x807f378
16580 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16581 Base Priority: 15
16582 State: Runnable
16583 @end smallexample
16584
16585 @item task
16586 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16587 @cindex current Ada task ID
16588 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16589
16590 @smallexample
16591 @iftex
16592 @leftskip=0.5cm
16593 @end iftex
16594 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16595 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16596 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16597 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16598 (@value{GDBP}) task
16599 [Current task is 2]
16600 @end smallexample
16601
16602 @item task @var{taskno}
16603 @cindex Ada task switching
16604 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16605 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16606 from the current task to the given task.
16607
16608 @smallexample
16609 @iftex
16610 @leftskip=0.5cm
16611 @end iftex
16612 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16613 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16614 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16615 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16616 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16617 [Switching to task 1]
16618 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16619 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16620 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16621 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16622 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16623 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16624 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16625 @end smallexample
16626
16627 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16628 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16629 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16630 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16631 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16632 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16633 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16634 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16635 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16636
16637 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16638 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16639 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16640 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16641 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16642
16643 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16644 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16645 program.
16646
16647 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16648 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16649 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16650
16651 For example,
16652
16653 @smallexample
16654 @iftex
16655 @leftskip=0.5cm
16656 @end iftex
16657 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16658 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16659 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16660 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16661 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16662 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16663 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16664 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16665 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16666 Continuing.
16667 task # 1 running
16668 task # 2 running
16669
16670 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16671 15 flush;
16672 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16673 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16674 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16675 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16676 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16677 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16678 @end smallexample
16679 @end table
16680
16681 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16682 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16683 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16684
16685 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16686 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16687 the platform being used.
16688 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16689 switching is not supported.
16690
16691 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16692 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16693 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16694 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16695 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16696 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16697
16698 @node Ravenscar Profile
16699 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16700 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16701
16702 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16703 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16704 requirements.
16705
16706 @table @code
16707 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16708 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16709 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16710 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16711 Profile. This is the default.
16712
16713 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16714 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16715 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16716 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16717 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16718 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16719 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16720
16721 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16722 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16723 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16724 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16725
16726 @end table
16727
16728 @node Ada Glitches
16729 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16730 @cindex Ada, problems
16731
16732 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16733 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16734 @value{GDBN},
16735 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16736 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16737
16738 @itemize @bullet
16739 @item
16740 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16741 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16742
16743 @item
16744 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16745 argument lists are treated as positional).
16746
16747 @item
16748 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16749
16750 @item
16751 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16752 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16753 the host machine.
16754
16755 @item
16756 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16757 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16758 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16759 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16760 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16761 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16762 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16763 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16764 you can usually resolve the confusion
16765 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16766 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16767 @end itemize
16768
16769 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16770 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16771 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16772 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16773 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16774 enabled.
16775
16776 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16777 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16778 @table @code
16779
16780 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16781 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16782 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16783 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16784 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16785 This is the default.
16786
16787 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16788 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16789 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16790 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16791 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16792 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16793 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16794
16795 @end table
16796
16797 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16798 @cindex GNAT encoding
16799 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16800 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16801 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16802 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16803 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16804 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16805
16806 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16807 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16808 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16809 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16810 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16811 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16812 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16813 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16814
16815 @table @code
16816
16817 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16818 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16819 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16820 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16821
16822 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16823 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16824 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16825
16826 @end table
16827
16828 @node Unsupported Languages
16829 @section Unsupported Languages
16830
16831 @cindex unsupported languages
16832 @cindex minimal language
16833 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16834 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16835 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16836 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16837 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16838 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16839
16840 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16841 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16842 language.
16843
16844 @node Symbols
16845 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16846
16847 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16848 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16849 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16850 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16851 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16852 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16853 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16854
16855 @cindex symbol names
16856 @cindex names of symbols
16857 @cindex quoting names
16858 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16859 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16860 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16861 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16862 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16863 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16864 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16865 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16866
16867 @smallexample
16868 p 'foo.c'::x
16869 @end smallexample
16870
16871 @noindent
16872 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16873
16874 @table @code
16875 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16876 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16877 @kindex set case-sensitive
16878 @item set case-sensitive on
16879 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16880 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16881 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16882 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16883 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16884 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16885 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16886 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16887 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16888 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16889 case-insensitive matches.
16890
16891 @kindex show case-sensitive
16892 @item show case-sensitive
16893 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16894 lookups.
16895
16896 @kindex set print type methods
16897 @item set print type methods
16898 @itemx set print type methods on
16899 @itemx set print type methods off
16900 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16901 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16902 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16903 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16904 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16905 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16906
16907 @kindex show print type methods
16908 @item show print type methods
16909 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16910 classes.
16911
16912 @kindex set print type typedefs
16913 @item set print type typedefs
16914 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16915 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16916
16917 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16918 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16919 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16920 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16921 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16922 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16923 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16924 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16925 types.
16926
16927 @kindex show print type typedefs
16928 @item show print type typedefs
16929 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16930 printing classes.
16931
16932 @kindex info address
16933 @cindex address of a symbol
16934 @item info address @var{symbol}
16935 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16936 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16937 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16938 is always stored.
16939
16940 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16941 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16942 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16943
16944 @kindex info symbol
16945 @cindex symbol from address
16946 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16947 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16948 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16949 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16950 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16951
16952 @smallexample
16953 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16954 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16955 @end smallexample
16956
16957 @noindent
16958 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16959 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16960
16961 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16962 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16963
16964 @smallexample
16965 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16966 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16967 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16968 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16969 @end smallexample
16970
16971 @kindex demangle
16972 @cindex demangle
16973 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16974 Demangle @var{name}.
16975 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16976 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16977
16978 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16979 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16980
16981 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16982 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16983
16984 @kindex whatis
16985 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16986 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16987 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16988 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16989
16990 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16991 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16992 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16993
16994 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16995 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16996 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16997 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16998 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16999 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17000 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17001 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17002 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17003
17004 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17005 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17006 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17007 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17008 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17009 unroll it.
17010
17011 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17012 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17013 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17014
17015 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17016 Available flags are:
17017
17018 @table @code
17019 @item r
17020 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17021 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17022 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17023
17024 @item m
17025 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17026
17027 @item M
17028 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17029 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17030
17031 @item t
17032 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17033 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17034 names are substituted when printing other types.
17035
17036 @item T
17037 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17038 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17039 @end table
17040
17041 @kindex ptype
17042 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17043 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17044 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17045 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17046
17047 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17048 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17049 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17050 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17051 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17052 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17053 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17054 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17055
17056 For example, for this variable declaration:
17057
17058 @smallexample
17059 typedef double real_t;
17060 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17061 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17062 complex_t var;
17063 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17064 @end smallexample
17065
17066 @noindent
17067 the two commands give this output:
17068
17069 @smallexample
17070 @group
17071 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17072 type = complex_t
17073 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17074 type = struct complex @{
17075 real_t real;
17076 double imag;
17077 @}
17078 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17079 type = struct complex
17080 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17081 type = struct complex
17082 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17083 type = struct complex @{
17084 real_t real;
17085 double imag;
17086 @}
17087 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17088 type = real_t *
17089 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17090 type = double *
17091 @end group
17092 @end smallexample
17093
17094 @noindent
17095 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17096 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17097
17098 @cindex incomplete type
17099 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17100 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17101 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17102 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17103 given these declarations:
17104
17105 @smallexample
17106 struct foo;
17107 struct foo *fooptr;
17108 @end smallexample
17109
17110 @noindent
17111 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17112
17113 @smallexample
17114 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17115 $1 = <incomplete type>
17116 @end smallexample
17117
17118 @noindent
17119 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17120 completely specified.
17121
17122 @cindex unknown type
17123 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17124 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17125 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17126 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17127 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17128 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17129 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17130 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17131
17132 @smallexample
17133 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17134 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17135 @end smallexample
17136
17137 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17138 of such variables.
17139
17140 @kindex info types
17141 @item info types @var{regexp}
17142 @itemx info types
17143 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17144 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17145 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17146 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17147 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17148 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17149 name is @code{value}.
17150
17151 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17152 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17153 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17154
17155 @kindex info type-printers
17156 @item info type-printers
17157 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17158 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17159 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17160 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17161 type printers.
17162
17163 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17164
17165 @kindex enable type-printer
17166 @kindex disable type-printer
17167 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17168 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17169 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17170
17171 @kindex info scope
17172 @cindex local variables
17173 @item info scope @var{location}
17174 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17175 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17176 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17177 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17178 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17179
17180 @smallexample
17181 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17182 Scope for command_line_handler:
17183 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17184 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17185 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17186 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17187 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17188 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17189 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17190 @end smallexample
17191
17192 @noindent
17193 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17194 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17195 collect}.
17196
17197 @kindex info source
17198 @item info source
17199 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17200 the function containing the current point of execution:
17201 @itemize @bullet
17202 @item
17203 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17204 @item
17205 the directory it was compiled in,
17206 @item
17207 its length, in lines,
17208 @item
17209 which programming language it is written in,
17210 @item
17211 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17212 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17213 @item
17214 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17215 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17216 @item
17217 whether the debugging information includes information about
17218 preprocessor macros.
17219 @end itemize
17220
17221
17222 @kindex info sources
17223 @item info sources
17224 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17225 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17226 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17227
17228 @kindex info functions
17229 @item info functions
17230 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17231
17232 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17233 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17234 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17235 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17236 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17237 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17238 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17239 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17240
17241 @kindex info variables
17242 @item info variables
17243 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17244 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17245
17246 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17247 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17248 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17249 @var{regexp}.
17250
17251 @kindex info classes
17252 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17253 @item info classes
17254 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17255 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17256 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17257 expression.
17258
17259 @kindex info selectors
17260 @item info selectors
17261 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17262 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17263 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17264 expression.
17265
17266 @ignore
17267 This was never implemented.
17268 @kindex info methods
17269 @item info methods
17270 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17271 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17272 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17273 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17274 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17275 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17276 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17277 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17278 @end ignore
17279
17280 @cindex opaque data types
17281 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17282 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17283 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17284 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17285 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17286 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17287 another source file. The default is on.
17288
17289 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17290 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17291
17292 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17293 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17294 is printed as follows:
17295 @smallexample
17296 @{<no data fields>@}
17297 @end smallexample
17298
17299 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17300 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17301 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17302
17303 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17304 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17305 @item set print symbol-loading
17306 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17307 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17308 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17309 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17310 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17311 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17312 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17313 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17314 can be annoying.
17315 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17316 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17317 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17318 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17319
17320 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17321 @item show print symbol-loading
17322 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17323 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17324
17325 @kindex maint print symbols
17326 @cindex symbol dump
17327 @kindex maint print psymbols
17328 @cindex partial symbol dump
17329 @kindex maint print msymbols
17330 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17331 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17332 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17333 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17334 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17335 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17336 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17337 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17338 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17339 that objfile.
17340 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17341 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17342 @code{main}.
17343 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17344 source file.
17345
17346 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17347 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17348 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17349 tables.
17350 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17351 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17352 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17353 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17354 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17355 ``ELF symbols''.
17356
17357 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17358 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17359
17360 @kindex maint info symtabs
17361 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17362 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17363 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17364 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17365 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17366 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17367 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17368
17369 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17370 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17371 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17372 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17373 structure in more detail. For example:
17374
17375 @smallexample
17376 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17377 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17378 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17379 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17380 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17381 readin no
17382 fullname (null)
17383 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17384 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17385 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17386 dependencies (none)
17387 @}
17388 @}
17389 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17390 (@value{GDBP})
17391 @end smallexample
17392 @noindent
17393 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17394 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17395 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17396 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17397 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17398
17399 @smallexample
17400 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17401 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17402 line 1574.
17403 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17404 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17405 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17406 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17407 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17408 dirname (null)
17409 fullname (null)
17410 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17411 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17412 debugformat DWARF 2
17413 @}
17414 @}
17415 (@value{GDBP})
17416 @end smallexample
17417
17418 @kindex maint info line-table
17419 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17420 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17421 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17422
17423 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17424 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17425 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17426
17427 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17428 @cindex symbol cache size
17429 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17430 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17431 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17432 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17433 with different sizes.
17434
17435 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17436 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17437 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17438
17439 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17440 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17441 @item maint print symbol-cache
17442 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17443 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17444
17445 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17446 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17447 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17448 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17449 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17450
17451 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17452 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17453 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17454 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17455 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17456 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17457
17458 @end table
17459
17460 @node Altering
17461 @chapter Altering Execution
17462
17463 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17464 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17465 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17466 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17467 program.
17468
17469 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17470 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17471 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17472
17473 @menu
17474 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17475 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17476 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17477 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17478 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17479 * Patching:: Patching your program
17480 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17481 @end menu
17482
17483 @node Assignment
17484 @section Assignment to Variables
17485
17486 @cindex assignment
17487 @cindex setting variables
17488 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17489 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17490
17491 @smallexample
17492 print x=4
17493 @end smallexample
17494
17495 @noindent
17496 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17497 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17498 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17499 information on operators in supported languages.
17500
17501 @kindex set variable
17502 @cindex variables, setting
17503 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17504 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17505 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17506 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17507 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17508
17509 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17510 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17511 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17512 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17513 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17514 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17515 command @code{set width}:
17516
17517 @smallexample
17518 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17519 type = double
17520 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17521 $4 = 13
17522 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17523 Invalid syntax in expression.
17524 @end smallexample
17525
17526 @noindent
17527 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17528 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17529
17530 @smallexample
17531 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17532 @end smallexample
17533
17534 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17535 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17536 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17537 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17538 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17539 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17540
17541 @smallexample
17542 @group
17543 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17544 type = double
17545 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17546 $1 = 1
17547 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17548 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17549 $2 = 1
17550 (@value{GDBP}) r
17551 The program being debugged has been started already.
17552 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17553 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17554 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17555 Invalid bfd target.
17556 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17557 The current BFD target is "=4".
17558 @end group
17559 @end smallexample
17560
17561 @noindent
17562 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17563 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17564 @code{g}, use
17565
17566 @smallexample
17567 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17568 @end smallexample
17569
17570 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17571 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17572 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17573 same length or shorter.
17574 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17575 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17576
17577 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17578 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17579 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17580 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17581 and representation in memory), and
17582
17583 @smallexample
17584 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17585 @end smallexample
17586
17587 @noindent
17588 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17589
17590 @node Jumping
17591 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17592
17593 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17594 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17595 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17596
17597 @table @code
17598 @kindex jump
17599 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17600 @item jump @var{location}
17601 @itemx j @var{location}
17602 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17603 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17604 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17605 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17606 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17607
17608 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17609 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17610 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17611 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17612 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17613 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17614 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17615 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17616 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17617 @end table
17618
17619 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17620 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17621 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17622 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17623 example,
17624
17625 @smallexample
17626 set $pc = 0x485
17627 @end smallexample
17628
17629 @noindent
17630 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17631 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17632 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17633
17634 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17635 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17636 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17637 detail.
17638
17639 @c @group
17640 @node Signaling
17641 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17642 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17643
17644 @table @code
17645 @kindex signal
17646 @item signal @var{signal}
17647 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17648 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17649 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17650 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17651
17652 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17653 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17654 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17655 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17656 signal.
17657
17658 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17659 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17660 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17661 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17662 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17663 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17664 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17665 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17666
17667 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17668 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17669 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17670 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17671 passes the signal directly to your program.
17672
17673 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17674 after executing the command.
17675
17676 @kindex queue-signal
17677 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17678 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17679 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17680 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17681 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17682 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17683 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17684 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17685 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17686
17687 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17688 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17689 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17690 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17691 @code{continue} command.
17692
17693 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17694 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17695 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17696 (@pxref{Signals}).
17697 @end table
17698 @c @end group
17699
17700 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17701 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17702
17703 @node Returning
17704 @section Returning from a Function
17705
17706 @table @code
17707 @cindex returning from a function
17708 @kindex return
17709 @item return
17710 @itemx return @var{expression}
17711 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17712 command. If you give an
17713 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17714 value.
17715 @end table
17716
17717 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17718 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17719 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17720 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17721
17722 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17723 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17724 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17725 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17726 of functions.
17727
17728 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17729 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17730 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17731 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17732 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17733
17734 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17735 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17736 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17737 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17738 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17739 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17740 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17741 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17742 assignment into the right register(s).
17743
17744 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17745 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17746 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17747 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17748 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17749 into a @code{long long int}:
17750
17751 @smallexample
17752 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17753 29 return 31;
17754 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17755 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17756 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17757 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17758 (@value{GDBP})
17759 @end smallexample
17760
17761 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17762 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17763 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17764 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17765 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17766 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17767 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17768 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17769
17770 @smallexample
17771 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17772 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17773 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17774 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17775 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17776 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17777 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17778 (@value{GDBP})
17779 @end smallexample
17780
17781 @node Calling
17782 @section Calling Program Functions
17783
17784 @table @code
17785 @cindex calling functions
17786 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17787 @item print @var{expr}
17788 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17789 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17790 debugged.
17791
17792 @kindex call
17793 @item call @var{expr}
17794 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17795 returned values.
17796
17797 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17798 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17799 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17800 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17801 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17802 value history.
17803 @end table
17804
17805 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17806 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17807 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17808 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17809
17810 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17811 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17812 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17813 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17814 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17815 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17816 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17817 in that case is controlled by the
17818 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17819
17820 @table @code
17821 @item set unwindonsignal
17822 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17823 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17824 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17825 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17826 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17827 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17828 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17829 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17830 received.
17831
17832 @item show unwindonsignal
17833 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17834 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17835 @value{GDBN}.
17836
17837 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17838 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17839 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17840 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17841 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17842 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17843 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17844 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17845 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17846 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17847
17848 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17849 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17850 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17851 @value{GDBN}.
17852
17853 @end table
17854
17855 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
17856
17857 @cindex no debug info functions
17858 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
17859 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
17860 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
17861 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
17862 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
17863 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
17864
17865 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
17866 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
17867 declared return type. For example:
17868
17869 @smallexample
17870 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
17871 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
17872 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
17873 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
17874 @end smallexample
17875
17876 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
17877 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
17878 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
17879 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
17880
17881 @smallexample
17882 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
17883 @end smallexample
17884
17885 @noindent
17886 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
17887
17888 @smallexample
17889 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
17890 @end smallexample
17891
17892 @noindent
17893 these calls are equivalent:
17894
17895 @smallexample
17896 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
17897 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17898 @end smallexample
17899
17900 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
17901 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
17902 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
17903 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
17904 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
17905 float parameters, and no debug info:
17906
17907 @smallexample
17908 float
17909 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
17910 float v1, v2;
17911 @{
17912 return v1 * v2;
17913 @}
17914 @end smallexample
17915
17916 @noindent
17917 you call it like this:
17918
17919 @smallexample
17920 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
17921 @end smallexample
17922
17923 @node Patching
17924 @section Patching Programs
17925
17926 @cindex patching binaries
17927 @cindex writing into executables
17928 @cindex writing into corefiles
17929
17930 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17931 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17932 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17933 patching your program's binary.
17934
17935 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17936 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17937 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17938 repairs.
17939
17940 @table @code
17941 @kindex set write
17942 @item set write on
17943 @itemx set write off
17944 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17945 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17946 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17947
17948 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17949 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17950 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17951
17952 @item show write
17953 @kindex show write
17954 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17955 as well as reading.
17956 @end table
17957
17958 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17959 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17960 @cindex injecting code
17961 @cindex writing into executables
17962 @cindex compiling code
17963
17964 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17965 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17966 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17967 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17968
17969 @table @code
17970 @kindex compile code
17971 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17972 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17973 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17974 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17975 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17976 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17977 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17978 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17979 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17980 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17981 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17982 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17983
17984 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17985 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17986 E.g.:
17987
17988 @smallexample
17989 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17990 @end smallexample
17991
17992 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17993 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17994 from actual source code. E.g.:
17995
17996 @smallexample
17997 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17998 @end smallexample
17999
18000 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18001 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18002 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18003 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18004 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18005 editor.
18006
18007 @smallexample
18008 compile code
18009 >printf ("hello\n");
18010 >printf ("world\n");
18011 >end
18012 @end smallexample
18013
18014 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18015 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18016 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18017 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18018 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18019 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18020 inferior symbols otherwise.
18021
18022 @kindex compile file
18023 @item compile file @var{filename}
18024 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18025 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18026
18027 @smallexample
18028 compile file /home/user/example.c
18029 @end smallexample
18030 @end table
18031
18032 @table @code
18033 @item compile print @var{expr}
18034 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18035 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18036 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18037 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18038 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18039 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18040 Formats}.
18041
18042 @item compile print
18043 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18044 @cindex reprint the last value
18045 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18046 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18047 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18048 multiple-line editor.
18049 @end table
18050
18051 @noindent
18052 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18053
18054 @table @code
18055 @anchor{set debug compile}
18056 @item set debug compile
18057 @cindex compile command debugging info
18058 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18059 injecting the code. The default is off.
18060
18061 @item show debug compile
18062 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18063 compiling and injecting the code.
18064 @end table
18065
18066 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18067
18068 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18069 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18070 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18071 injecting process.
18072
18073 @noindent
18074 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18075
18076 @table @asis
18077 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18078 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18079 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18080 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18081
18082 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18083 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18084 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18085 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18086 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18087 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18088 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18089 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18090
18091 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18092 @end table
18093
18094 @noindent
18095 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18096
18097 @table @code
18098 @item set compile-args
18099 @cindex compile command options override
18100 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18101 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18102 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18103 compilation.
18104
18105 @item show compile-args
18106 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18107 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18108 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18109 @end table
18110
18111 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18112
18113 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18114 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18115 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18116
18117 @table @asis
18118 @item C code examples and caveats
18119 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18120 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18121 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18122 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18123 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18124
18125 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18126 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18127 much like any other normal debugging session.
18128
18129 @smallexample
18130 void function1 (void)
18131 @{
18132 int i = 42;
18133 printf ("function 1\n");
18134 @}
18135
18136 void function2 (void)
18137 @{
18138 int j = 12;
18139 function1 ();
18140 @}
18141
18142 int main(void)
18143 @{
18144 int k = 6;
18145 int *p;
18146 function2 ();
18147 return 0;
18148 @}
18149 @end smallexample
18150
18151 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18152 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18153 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18154
18155 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18156 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18157 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18158 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18159 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18160
18161 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18162 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18163 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18164 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18165 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18166 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18167 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18168 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18169 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18170 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18171
18172 @smallexample
18173 compile code k = 3;
18174 @end smallexample
18175
18176 @noindent
18177 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18178 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18179 @code{compile} command changes it.
18180
18181 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18182 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18183 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18184 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18185 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18186
18187 @smallexample
18188 compile code j = 3;
18189 @end smallexample
18190
18191 @noindent
18192 will result in a compilation error message.
18193
18194 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18195 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18196 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18197
18198 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18199 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18200 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18201 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18202
18203 @smallexample
18204 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18205 @end smallexample
18206
18207 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18208 command has completed:
18209
18210 @smallexample
18211 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18212 @end smallexample
18213
18214 @noindent
18215 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18216 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18217 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18218 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18219 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18220
18221 @smallexample
18222 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18226 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18227 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18228 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18229 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18230 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18231 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18232 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18233
18234 @smallexample
18235 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18236 @end smallexample
18237
18238 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18239 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18240 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18241 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18242 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18243 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18244 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18245
18246 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18247 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18248 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18249 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18250 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18251 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18252
18253 @smallexample
18254 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18255 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18256 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18257 Compilation failed.
18258 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18259 42
18260 @end smallexample
18261
18262 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18263 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18264 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18265 will print to the console.
18266 @end table
18267
18268 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18269
18270 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18271 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18272 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18273 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18274 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18275 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18276 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18277 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18278
18279
18280 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18281 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18282 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18283 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18284 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18285 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18286 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18287
18288 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18289 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18290 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18291 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18292 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18293 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18294 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18295
18296 @table @code
18297 @item set compile-gcc
18298 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18299 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18300 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18301 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18302 default.
18303
18304 @item show compile-gcc
18305 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18306 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18307 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18308 @end table
18309
18310 @node GDB Files
18311 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18312
18313 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18314 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18315 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18316 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18317
18318 @menu
18319 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18320 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18321 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18322 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18323 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18324 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18325 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18326 @end menu
18327
18328 @node Files
18329 @section Commands to Specify Files
18330
18331 @cindex symbol table
18332 @cindex core dump file
18333
18334 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18335 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18336 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18337 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18338
18339 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18340 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18341 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18342 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18343 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18344 new files are useful.
18345
18346 @table @code
18347 @cindex executable file
18348 @kindex file
18349 @item file @var{filename}
18350 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18351 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18352 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18353 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18354 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18355 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18356 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18357 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18358
18359 @cindex unlinked object files
18360 @cindex patching object files
18361 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18362 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18363 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18364 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18365 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18366 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18367 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18368 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18369
18370 @item file
18371 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18372 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18373
18374 @kindex exec-file
18375 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18376 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18377 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18378 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18379 discard information on the executable file.
18380
18381 @kindex symbol-file
18382 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18383 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18384 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18385 table and program to run from the same file.
18386
18387 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18388 program's symbol table.
18389
18390 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18391 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18392 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18393 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18394 @value{GDBN}.
18395
18396 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18397 executing it once.
18398
18399 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18400 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18401 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18402 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18403 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18404 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18405 optimized code.
18406
18407 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18408 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18409 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18410 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18411 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18412
18413 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18414 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18415 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18416 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18417 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18418 Warnings and Messages}.)
18419
18420 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18421 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18422 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18423 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18424 in stabs format.
18425
18426 @kindex readnow
18427 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18428 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18429 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18430 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18431 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18432 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18433 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18434 entire symbol table available.
18435
18436 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18437 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18438 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18439 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18440 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18441 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18442 @c files.
18443
18444 @kindex core-file
18445 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18446 @itemx core
18447 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18448 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18449 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18450 executable file itself for other parts.
18451
18452 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18453 to be used.
18454
18455 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18456 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18457 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18458 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18459 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18460
18461 @kindex add-symbol-file
18462 @cindex dynamic linking
18463 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18464 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18465 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18466 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18467 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18468 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18469 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18470 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18471 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18472 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18473 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18474 @var{address} as an expression.
18475
18476 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18477 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18478 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18479 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18480
18481 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18482
18483 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18484 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18485 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18486 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18487 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18488 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18489 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18490 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18491 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18492
18493 @itemize @bullet
18494 @item
18495 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18496 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18497 @item
18498 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18499 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18500 @item
18501 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18502 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18503 @end itemize
18504
18505 @noindent
18506 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18507 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18508 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18509 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18510 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18511 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18512 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18513 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18514 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18515 way.
18516
18517 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18518
18519 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18520 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18521 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18522 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18523 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18524 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18525
18526 @smallexample
18527 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18528 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18529 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18530 (y or n) y
18531 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18532 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18533 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18534 (gdb)
18535 @end smallexample
18536
18537
18538 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18539
18540 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18541 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18542 @cindex load symbols from memory
18543 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18544 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18545 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18546 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18547 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18548 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18549 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18550 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18551 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18552
18553 @kindex section
18554 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18555 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18556 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18557 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18558 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18559 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18560 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18561 their addresses.
18562
18563 @kindex info files
18564 @kindex info target
18565 @item info files
18566 @itemx info target
18567 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18568 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18569 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18570 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18571 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18572 current ones.
18573
18574 @kindex maint info sections
18575 @item maint info sections
18576 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18577 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18578 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18579 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18580 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18581 may be arbitrarily combined):
18582
18583 @table @code
18584 @item ALLOBJ
18585 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18586 @item @var{sections}
18587 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18588 @item @var{section-flags}
18589 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18590 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18591 @table @code
18592 @item ALLOC
18593 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18594 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18595 @item LOAD
18596 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18597 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18598 @item RELOC
18599 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18600 @item READONLY
18601 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18602 @item CODE
18603 Section contains executable code only.
18604 @item DATA
18605 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18606 @item ROM
18607 Section will reside in ROM.
18608 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18609 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18610 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18611 Section is not empty.
18612 @item NEVER_LOAD
18613 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18614 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18615 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18616 COFF shared library information.
18617 @item IS_COMMON
18618 Section contains common symbols.
18619 @end table
18620 @end table
18621 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18622 @cindex read-only sections
18623 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18624 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18625 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18626 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18627 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18628 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18629 enhancement to debugging performance.
18630
18631 The default is off.
18632
18633 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18634 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18635 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18636 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18637
18638 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18639 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18640 @end table
18641
18642 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18643 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18644 name and remembers it that way.
18645
18646 @cindex shared libraries
18647 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18648 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18649 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18650 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18651
18652 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18653 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18654
18655 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18656 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18657 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18658 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18659 debugging a core file).
18660
18661 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18662 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18663 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18664
18665 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18666 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18667 particularly large or there are many of them.
18668
18669 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18670 commands:
18671
18672 @table @code
18673 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18674 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18675 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18676 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18677 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18678 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18679 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18680 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18681
18682 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18683 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18684 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18685 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18686 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18687 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18688 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18689 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18690 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18691
18692 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18693 @item show auto-solib-add
18694 Display the current autoloading mode.
18695 @end table
18696
18697 @cindex load shared library
18698 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18699 command:
18700
18701 @table @code
18702 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18703 @kindex info share
18704 @item info share @var{regex}
18705 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18706 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18707 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18708 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18709
18710 @kindex info dll
18711 @item info dll @var{regex}
18712 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18713
18714 @kindex sharedlibrary
18715 @kindex share
18716 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18717 @itemx share @var{regex}
18718 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18719 Unix regular expression.
18720 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18721 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18722 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18723 loaded.
18724
18725 @item nosharedlibrary
18726 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18727 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18728 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18729 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18730 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18731 discarded.
18732 @end table
18733
18734 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18735 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18736 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18737 Catchpoints}).
18738
18739 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18740 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18741 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18742 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18743
18744 @table @code
18745 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18746 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18747 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18748 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18749 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18750 shared library.
18751
18752 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18753 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18754 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18755 library events happen.
18756 @end table
18757
18758 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18759 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18760 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18761 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18762 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18763 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18764 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18765 not.
18766
18767 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18768 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18769 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18770 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18771 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18772
18773 @table @code
18774 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18775 @cindex system root, alternate
18776 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18777 @kindex set sysroot
18778 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18779 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18780 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18781 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18782 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18783 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18784 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18785 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18786 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18787 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18788 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18789 @var{path}.
18790
18791 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18792 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18793 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18794 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18795 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18796 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18797 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18798 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18799 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18800 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18801 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18802 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18803 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18804 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18805
18806 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18807 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18808 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18809 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18810 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18811
18812 @smallexample
18813 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18814 @end smallexample
18815
18816 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18817 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18818 system:
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18825 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18826 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18827 colons:
18828
18829 @smallexample
18830 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18831 @end smallexample
18832
18833 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18834 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18835 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18836 @samp{z}):
18837
18838 @smallexample
18839 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18840 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18841 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18842 @end smallexample
18843
18844 @noindent
18845 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18846 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18847 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18848
18849 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18850 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18851
18852 @smallexample
18853 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18854 @end smallexample
18855
18856 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18857 if you don't want or need to.
18858
18859 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18860 sysroot}.
18861
18862 @cindex default system root
18863 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18864 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18865 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18866 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18867 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18868 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18869 location.
18870
18871 @kindex show sysroot
18872 @item show sysroot
18873 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18874
18875 @kindex set solib-search-path
18876 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18877 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18878 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18879 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18880 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18881 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18882 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18883 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18884 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18885 of shared library symbols.
18886
18887 @kindex show solib-search-path
18888 @item show solib-search-path
18889 Display the current shared library search path.
18890
18891 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18892 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18893 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18894 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18895 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18896
18897 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18898 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18899 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18900 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18901 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18902 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18903 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18904 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18905 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18906 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18907 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18908 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18909 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18910 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18911 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18912 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18913 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18914 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18915 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18916 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18917 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18918 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18919
18920 @table @code
18921 @item unix
18922 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18923 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18924 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18925 the forward slash.
18926
18927 @item dos-based
18928 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18929 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18930 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18931 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18932 considered directory separators.
18933
18934 @item auto
18935 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18936 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18937 This is the default.
18938 @end table
18939 @end table
18940
18941 @cindex file name canonicalization
18942 @cindex base name differences
18943 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18944 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18945 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18946 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18947 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18948 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18949 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18950 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18951 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18952 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18953 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18954 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18955 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18956 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18957 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18958
18959 @table @code
18960 @item set basenames-may-differ
18961 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18962 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18963
18964 @item show basenames-may-differ
18965 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18966 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18967 @end table
18968
18969 @node File Caching
18970 @section File Caching
18971 @cindex caching of opened files
18972 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18973
18974 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18975 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18976 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18977 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18978
18979 @table @code
18980 @kindex maint info bfds
18981 @item maint info bfds
18982 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18983 @value{GDBN}.
18984
18985 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18986 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18987 @kindex bfd caching
18988 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18989 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18990 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18991 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18992 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18993 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18994 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18995 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18996 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18997
18998 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18999 @kindex bfd caching
19000 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19001 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19002
19003 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19004 @kindex bfd caching
19005 @item show debug bfd-cache
19006 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19007 @end table
19008
19009 @node Separate Debug Files
19010 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19011 @cindex separate debugging information files
19012 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19013 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19014 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19015 @cindex global debugging information directories
19016 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19017 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19018
19019 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19020 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19021 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19022 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19023 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19024 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19025 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19026
19027 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19028 file:
19029
19030 @itemize @bullet
19031 @item
19032 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19033 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19034 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19035 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19036 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19037 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19038 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19039 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19040
19041 @item
19042 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19043 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19044 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19045 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19046 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19047 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19048 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19049 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19050 below.
19051 @end itemize
19052
19053 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19054 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19055
19056 @itemize @bullet
19057 @item
19058 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19059 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19060 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19061 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19062 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19063
19064 @item
19065 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19066 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19067 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19068 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19069 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19070 hex characters, not 10.)
19071 @end itemize
19072
19073 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19074 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19075 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19076 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19077 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19078 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19079
19080 @itemize @minus
19081 @item
19082 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19083 @item
19084 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19085 @item
19086 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19087 @item
19088 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19089 @end itemize
19090
19091 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19092 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19093 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19094 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19095 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19096
19097 @table @code
19098
19099 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19100 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19101 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19102 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19103 concatenating them by a path separator.
19104
19105 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19106 @item show debug-file-directory
19107 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19108 information files.
19109
19110 @end table
19111
19112 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19113 @cindex debug link sections
19114 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19115 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19116
19117 @itemize
19118 @item
19119 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19120 a zero byte,
19121 @item
19122 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19123 boundary within the section, and
19124 @item
19125 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19126 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19127 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19128 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19129 @end itemize
19130
19131 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19132 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19133 described above.
19134
19135 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19136 @cindex build ID sections
19137 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19138 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19139 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19140 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19141 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19142 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19143 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19144 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19145 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19146
19147 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19148 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19149 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19150 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19151 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19152 in an ordinary executable.
19153
19154 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19155 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19156 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19157 following commands:
19158
19159 @smallexample
19160 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19161 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19162 @end smallexample
19163
19164 @noindent
19165 These commands remove the debugging
19166 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19167 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19168 two files:
19169
19170 @itemize @bullet
19171 @item
19172 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19173 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19174
19175 @smallexample
19176 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19177 @end smallexample
19178
19179 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19180 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19181 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19182 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19183
19184 @item
19185 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19186 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19187 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19188 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19189 @end itemize
19190
19191 @noindent
19192
19193 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19194 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19195 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19196
19197 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19198 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19199 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19200 @c different ways!
19201 @ifhtml
19202 @display
19203 @html
19204 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19205 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19206 @end html
19207 @end display
19208 @end ifhtml
19209 @ifnothtml
19210 @display
19211 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19212 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19213 @end display
19214 @end ifnothtml
19215
19216 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19217 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19218 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19219 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19220 CRC.
19221
19222 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19223 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19224 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19225 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19226 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19227
19228 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19229 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19230 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19231 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19232 @code{0xffffffff}.
19233
19234 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19235 @smallexample
19236 unsigned long
19237 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19238 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19239 @{
19240 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19241 @{
19242 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19243 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19244 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19245 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19246 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19247 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19248 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19249 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19250 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19251 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19252 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19253 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19254 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19255 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19256 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19257 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19258 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19259 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19260 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19261 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19262 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19263 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19264 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19265 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19266 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19267 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19268 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19269 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19270 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19271 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19272 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19273 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19274 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19275 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19276 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19277 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19278 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19279 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19280 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19281 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19282 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19283 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19284 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19285 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19286 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19287 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19288 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19289 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19290 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19291 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19292 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19293 0x2d02ef8d
19294 @};
19295 unsigned char *end;
19296
19297 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19298 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19299 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19300 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19301 @}
19302 @end smallexample
19303
19304 @noindent
19305 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19306
19307 @node MiniDebugInfo
19308 @section Debugging information in a special section
19309 @cindex separate debug sections
19310 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19311
19312 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19313 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19314 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19315 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19316
19317 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19318 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19319 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19320 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19321 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19322 debugging information might be included in the section.
19323
19324 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19325 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19326 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19327
19328 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19329 standard utilities:
19330
19331 @smallexample
19332 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19333 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19334 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19335 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19336
19337 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19338 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19339 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19340 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19341 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19342 | sort > funcsyms
19343
19344 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19345 # table.
19346 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19347
19348 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19349 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19350
19351 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19352 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19353 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19354 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19355
19356 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19357 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19358
19359 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19360 # original binary.
19361 xz mini_debuginfo
19362 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19363 @end smallexample
19364
19365 @node Index Files
19366 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19367 @cindex index files
19368 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19369
19370 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19371 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19372 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19373 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19374 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19375 startup.
19376
19377 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19378 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19379 using @command{objcopy}.
19380
19381 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19382
19383 @table @code
19384 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19385 @kindex save gdb-index
19386 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19387 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19388 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19389 @var{directory}.
19390 @end table
19391
19392 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19393 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19394
19395 @smallexample
19396 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19397 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19398 @end smallexample
19399
19400 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19401 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19402 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19403 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19404 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19405 The default is @code{off}.
19406 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19407 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19408
19409 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19410 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19411
19412 @smallexample
19413 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19414 @end smallexample
19415
19416 Instead you must do, for example,
19417
19418 @smallexample
19419 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19420 @end smallexample
19421
19422 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19423 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19424 currently work for programs using Ada.
19425
19426 @node Symbol Errors
19427 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19428
19429 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19430 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19431 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19432 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19433 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19434 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19435 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19436 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19437 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19438 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19439 Messages}).
19440
19441 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19442
19443 @table @code
19444 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19445
19446 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19447 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19448 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19449 in its outer scope blocks.
19450
19451 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19452 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19453 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19454 function.
19455
19456 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19457
19458 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19459 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19460 do so.
19461
19462 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19463 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19464 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19465 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19466 Messages}.)
19467
19468 @item bad block start address patched
19469
19470 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19471 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19472 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19473
19474 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19475 starting on the previous source line.
19476
19477 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19478
19479 @cindex foo
19480 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19481 larger than the size of the string table.
19482
19483 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19484 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19485 with this name.
19486
19487 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19488
19489 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19490 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19491 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19492
19493 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19494 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19495 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19496 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19497 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19498 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19499
19500 @item stub type has NULL name
19501
19502 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19503
19504 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19505 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19506 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19507 it.
19508
19509 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19510
19511 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19512
19513 @end table
19514
19515 @node Data Files
19516 @section GDB Data Files
19517
19518 @cindex prefix for data files
19519 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19520 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19521
19522 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19523 is currently using.
19524
19525 @table @code
19526 @kindex set data-directory
19527 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19528 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19529 to @var{directory}.
19530
19531 @kindex show data-directory
19532 @item show data-directory
19533 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19534 @end table
19535
19536 @cindex default data directory
19537 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19538 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19539 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19540 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19541 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19542 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19543 location.
19544
19545 The data directory may also be specified with the
19546 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19547 @xref{Mode Options}.
19548
19549 @node Targets
19550 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19551
19552 @cindex debugging target
19553 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19554
19555 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19556 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19557 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19558 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19559 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19560 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19561 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19562 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19563
19564 @cindex target architecture
19565 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19566 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19567 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19568 command.
19569
19570 @table @code
19571 @kindex set architecture
19572 @kindex show architecture
19573 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19574 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19575 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19576 supported architectures.
19577
19578 @item show architecture
19579 Show the current target architecture.
19580
19581 @item set processor
19582 @itemx processor
19583 @kindex set processor
19584 @kindex show processor
19585 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19586 and @code{show architecture}.
19587 @end table
19588
19589 @menu
19590 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19591 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19592 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19593 @end menu
19594
19595 @node Active Targets
19596 @section Active Targets
19597
19598 @cindex stacking targets
19599 @cindex active targets
19600 @cindex multiple targets
19601
19602 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19603 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19604 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19605 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19606 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19607 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19608 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19609 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19610 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19611
19612 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19613 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19614 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19615 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19616
19617 @node Target Commands
19618 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19619
19620 @table @code
19621 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19622 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19623 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19624 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19625 protocol of the target machine.
19626
19627 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19628 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19629 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19630
19631 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19632 after executing the command.
19633
19634 @kindex help target
19635 @item help target
19636 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19637 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19638 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19639
19640 @item help target @var{name}
19641 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19642 select it.
19643
19644 @kindex set gnutarget
19645 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19646 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19647 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19648 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19649 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19650 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19651
19652 @quotation
19653 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19654 you must know the actual BFD name.
19655 @end quotation
19656
19657 @noindent
19658 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19659
19660 @kindex show gnutarget
19661 @item show gnutarget
19662 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19663 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19664 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19665 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19666 @end table
19667
19668 @cindex common targets
19669 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19670 configuration):
19671
19672 @table @code
19673 @kindex target
19674 @item target exec @var{program}
19675 @cindex executable file target
19676 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19677 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19678
19679 @item target core @var{filename}
19680 @cindex core dump file target
19681 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19682 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19683
19684 @item target remote @var{medium}
19685 @cindex remote target
19686 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19687 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19688 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19689
19690 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19691 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19692
19693 @smallexample
19694 target remote /dev/ttya
19695 @end smallexample
19696
19697 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19698 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19699 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19700 clobbered by the download.
19701
19702 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19703 @cindex built-in simulator target
19704 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19705 In general,
19706 @smallexample
19707 target sim
19708 load
19709 run
19710 @end smallexample
19711 @noindent
19712 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19713 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19714 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19715 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19716 Processors}.
19717
19718 @item target native
19719 @cindex native target
19720 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19721 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19722 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19723 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19724
19725 @end table
19726
19727 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19728 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19729
19730 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19731 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19732 various aspects of this process.
19733
19734 @table @code
19735
19736 @item set hash
19737 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19738 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19739 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19740 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19741 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19742 monitor.
19743
19744 @item show hash
19745 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19746 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19747
19748 @item set debug monitor
19749 @kindex set debug monitor
19750 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19751 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19752 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19753
19754 @item show debug monitor
19755 @kindex show debug monitor
19756 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19757 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19758 @end table
19759
19760 @table @code
19761
19762 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19763 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
19764 @anchor{load}
19765 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19766 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19767 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19768 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19769 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19770 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19771
19772 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19773 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19774 target is @dots{}}''
19775
19776 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19777 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19778 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19779 specifies a fixed address.
19780 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19781
19782 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
19783 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
19784 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
19785
19786 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19787 load programs into flash memory.
19788
19789 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19790 @end table
19791
19792 @table @code
19793
19794 @kindex flash-erase
19795 @item flash-erase
19796 @anchor{flash-erase}
19797
19798 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
19799
19800 @end table
19801
19802 @node Byte Order
19803 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19804
19805 @cindex choosing target byte order
19806 @cindex target byte order
19807
19808 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19809 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19810 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19811 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19812 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19813 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19814
19815 @table @code
19816 @kindex set endian
19817 @item set endian big
19818 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19819
19820 @item set endian little
19821 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19822
19823 @item set endian auto
19824 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19825 executable.
19826
19827 @item show endian
19828 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19829
19830 @end table
19831
19832 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19833 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19834 target system.
19835
19836
19837 @node Remote Debugging
19838 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19839 @cindex remote debugging
19840
19841 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19842 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19843 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19844 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19845 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19846
19847 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19848 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19849 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19850 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19851 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19852 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19853
19854 Other remote targets may be available in your
19855 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19856
19857 @menu
19858 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19859 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19860 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19861 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19862 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19863 @end menu
19864
19865 @node Connecting
19866 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19867 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19868 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19869 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19870 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19871 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19872 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19873
19874 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19875 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19876 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19877 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19878
19879 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19880
19881 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19882 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19883 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19884 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19885
19886 @table @asis
19887
19888 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19889 @item Result of detach or program exit
19890 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19891 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19892 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19893
19894 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19895 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19896 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19897 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19898
19899 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19900 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19901 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19902 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19903
19904 @item Specifying the program to debug
19905 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19906 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19907 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19908 target.
19909
19910 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19911 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19912 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19913
19914 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19915 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19916 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19917 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19918
19919 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19920 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19921 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19922 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19923 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19924 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19925 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19926 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19927 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19928
19929 @item The @code{run} command
19930 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19931 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19932 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19933 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19934 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19935
19936 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19937 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19938 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19939 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19940 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19941
19942 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19943 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19944 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19945 @code{target remote} mode.
19946
19947 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19948 @item Attaching
19949 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19950 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19951 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19952
19953 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19954 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19955 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19956 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19957 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19958
19959 @end table
19960
19961 @anchor{Host and target files}
19962 @subsection Host and Target Files
19963 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19964 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19965
19966 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19967 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19968 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19969 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19970 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19971
19972 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19973 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19974 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19975 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19976 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19977
19978 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19979 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19980 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19981 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19982 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19983 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19984 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19985 target libraries.
19986
19987 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19988 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19989 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19990 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19991 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19992 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19993 programs.
19994
19995 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19996 @cindex remote connection commands
19997 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19998 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19999 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20000 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20001 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20002 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20003 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20004
20005 @table @code
20006
20007 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20008 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20009 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20010 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20011 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20012
20013 @smallexample
20014 target remote /dev/ttyb
20015 @end smallexample
20016
20017 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20018 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20019 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20020 @code{target} command.
20021
20022 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20023 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20024 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20025 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20026 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20027 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20028 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20029 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20030 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20031 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20032 target.
20033
20034 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20035 @code{manyfarms}:
20036
20037 @smallexample
20038 target remote manyfarms:2828
20039 @end smallexample
20040
20041 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20042 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20043 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20044 port 1234 on your local machine:
20045
20046 @smallexample
20047 target remote :1234
20048 @end smallexample
20049 @noindent
20050
20051 Note that the colon is still required here.
20052
20053 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20054 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20055 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20056 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20057 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20058
20059 @smallexample
20060 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20061 @end smallexample
20062
20063 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20064 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20065 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20066 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20067
20068 @item target remote | @var{command}
20069 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20070 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20071 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20072 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20073 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20074 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20075 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20076 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20077 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20078
20079 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20080 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20081 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20082
20083 @end table
20084
20085 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20086 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20087 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20088 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20089 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20090 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20091 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20092
20093 @smallexample
20094 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20095 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20096 @end smallexample
20097
20098 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20099 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20100 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20101 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20102
20103 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20104 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20105
20106 @table @code
20107 @kindex detach (remote)
20108 @item detach
20109 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20110 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20111 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20112 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20113 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20114 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20115 still connected to the target.
20116
20117 @kindex disconnect
20118 @item disconnect
20119 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20120 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20121 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20122 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20123 another target.
20124
20125 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20126 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20127 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20128 @kindex monitor
20129 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20130 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20131 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20132 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20133 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20134 and implement.
20135 @end table
20136
20137 @node File Transfer
20138 @section Sending files to a remote system
20139 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20140 @cindex file transfer
20141 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20142
20143 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20144 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20145 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20146 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20147 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20148 the only way to upload or download files.
20149
20150 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20151
20152 @table @code
20153 @kindex remote put
20154 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20155 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20156 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20157
20158 @kindex remote get
20159 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20160 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20161 on the host system.
20162
20163 @kindex remote delete
20164 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20165 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20166
20167 @end table
20168
20169 @node Server
20170 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20171
20172 @kindex gdbserver
20173 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20174 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20175 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20176 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20177 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20178
20179 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20180 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20181 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20182 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20183 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20184 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20185 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20186 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20187 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20188 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20189 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20190 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20191 choice for debugging.
20192
20193 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20194 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20195 protocol.
20196
20197 @quotation
20198 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20199 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20200 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20201 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20202 @code{gdbserver}.
20203 @end quotation
20204
20205 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20206 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20207 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20208 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20209
20210 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20211 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20212 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20213 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20214 system does all the symbol handling.
20215
20216 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20217 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20218 syntax is:
20219
20220 @smallexample
20221 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20222 @end smallexample
20223
20224 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20225 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20226 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20227 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20228 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20229 @file{/dev/com1}:
20230
20231 @smallexample
20232 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20233 @end smallexample
20234
20235 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20236 with it.
20237
20238 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20239
20240 @smallexample
20241 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20242 @end smallexample
20243
20244 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20245 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20246 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20247 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20248 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20249 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20250 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20251 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20252 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20253 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20254 @code{target remote} command.
20255
20256 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20257 with ssh:
20258
20259 @smallexample
20260 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20261 @end smallexample
20262
20263 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20264 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20265 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20266 You could elide it if you want to.
20267
20268 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20269 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20270 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20271 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20272
20273 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20274 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20275 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20276 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20277
20278 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20279 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20280
20281 @smallexample
20282 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20283 @end smallexample
20284
20285 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20286 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20287
20288 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20289 @value{GDBN} attach command
20290 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20291
20292 @pindex pidof
20293 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20294 @code{pidof} utility:
20295
20296 @smallexample
20297 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20298 @end smallexample
20299
20300 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20301 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20302 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20303
20304 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20305
20306 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20307 port.
20308
20309 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20310 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20311 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20312 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20313 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20314 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20315 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20316 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20317
20318 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20319 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20320 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20321
20322 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20323 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20324 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20325 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20326 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20327 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20328 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20329 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20330 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20331 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20332 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20333 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20334
20335 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20336 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20337
20338 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20339 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20340 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20341 program. For more information,
20342 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20343
20344 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20345 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20346 status information about the debugging process.
20347 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20348 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20349 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20350 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20351
20352 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20353 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20354 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20355 Possible options are:
20356
20357 @table @code
20358 @item none
20359 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20360 @item all
20361 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20362 @item timestamps
20363 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20364 @end table
20365
20366 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20367 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20368
20369 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20370 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20371 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20372 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20373 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20374
20375 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20376 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20377 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20378 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20379
20380 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20381 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20382 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20383 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20384
20385 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20386 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20387 environment:
20388
20389 @smallexample
20390 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20391 @end smallexample
20392
20393 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20394 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20395
20396 @smallexample
20397 $ gdbserver --selftest
20398 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20399 @end smallexample
20400
20401 These tests are disabled in release.
20402 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20403
20404 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20405 @itemize
20406
20407 @item
20408 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20409
20410 @item
20411 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20412 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20413 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20414 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20415 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20416 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20417
20418 @item
20419 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20420 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20421 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20422 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20423 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20424 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20425 program is already on the target.
20426
20427 @end itemize
20428
20429 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20430 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20431 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20432
20433 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20434 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20435 Here are the available commands.
20436
20437 @table @code
20438 @item monitor help
20439 List the available monitor commands.
20440
20441 @item monitor set debug 0
20442 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20443 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20444
20445 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20446 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20447 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20448 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20449
20450 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20451 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20452 Possible options are:
20453
20454 @table @code
20455 @item none
20456 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20457 @item all
20458 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20459 @item timestamps
20460 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20461 @end table
20462
20463 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20464 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20465
20466 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20467 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20468 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20469 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20470 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20471 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20472
20473 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20474 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20475
20476 @item monitor exit
20477 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20478 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20479 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20480 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20481 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20482
20483 @end table
20484
20485 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20486 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20487
20488 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20489 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20490
20491 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20492 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20493 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20494 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20495 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20496 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20497 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20498 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20499 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20500 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20501 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20502 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20503
20504 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20505
20506 @table @code
20507 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20508
20509 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20510 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20511 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20512
20513 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20514
20515 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20516 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20517 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20518 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20519 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20520 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20521
20522 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20523
20524 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20525 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20526 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20527 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20528 command for that. For example:
20529
20530 @smallexample
20531 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20532 @end smallexample
20533
20534 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20535 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20536 @end table
20537
20538 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20539 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20540 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20541 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20542 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20543 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20544 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20545 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20546 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20547 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20548
20549 @smallexample
20550 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20551 @end smallexample
20552
20553 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20554
20555 @smallexample
20556 $ gdb myprogram
20557 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20558 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20559 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20560 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20561 @end smallexample
20562
20563 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20564 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20565 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20566 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20567 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20568 tracing.
20569
20570 @node Remote Configuration
20571 @section Remote Configuration
20572
20573 @kindex set remote
20574 @kindex show remote
20575 This section documents the configuration options available when
20576 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20577 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20578 system-call-allowed}.
20579
20580 @table @code
20581 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20582 @cindex address size for remote targets
20583 @cindex bits in remote address
20584 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20585 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20586 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20587 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20588
20589 @item show remoteaddresssize
20590 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20591
20592 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20593 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20594 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20595 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20596 remote targets.
20597
20598 @item show serial baud
20599 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20600
20601 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20602 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20603 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20604
20605 @item show serial parity
20606 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20607
20608 @item set remotebreak
20609 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20610 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20611 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20612 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20613 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20614 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20615 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20616 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20617
20618 @item show remotebreak
20619 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20620 interrupt the remote program.
20621
20622 @item set remoteflow on
20623 @itemx set remoteflow off
20624 @kindex set remoteflow
20625 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20626 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20627
20628 @item show remoteflow
20629 @kindex show remoteflow
20630 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20631
20632 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20633 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20634 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20635 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20636 @code{ascii}.
20637
20638 @item show remotelogbase
20639 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20640 protocol.
20641
20642 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20643 @cindex record serial communications on file
20644 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20645 default is not to record at all.
20646
20647 @item show remotelogfile.
20648 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20649 serial communications.
20650
20651 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20652 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20653 @cindex remote timeout
20654 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20655 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20656
20657 @item show remotetimeout
20658 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20659 responses.
20660
20661 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20662 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20663 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20664 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20665 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20666 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20667 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20668 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20669
20670 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20671 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20672 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20673 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20674 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20675 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20676 as unlimited.
20677
20678 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20679 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20680 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20681
20682 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20683 @itemx show remote exec-file
20684 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20685 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20686 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20687 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20688 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20689 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20690
20691 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20692 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20693 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20694 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20695 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20696 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20697 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20698 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20699 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20700 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20701
20702 @item show interrupt-sequence
20703 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20704 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20705 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20706 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20707
20708 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20709 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20710 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20711 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20712 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20713 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20714
20715 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20716 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20717 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20718
20719 @kindex set tcp
20720 @kindex show tcp
20721 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20722 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20723 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20724 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20725 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20726 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20727 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20728 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20729 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20730
20731 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20732 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20733
20734 @item show tcp auto-retry
20735 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20736
20737 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20738 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20739 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20740 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20741 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20742 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20743 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20744 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20745 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20746 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20747 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20748
20749 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20750 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20751 @end table
20752
20753 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20754 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20755 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20756 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20757 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20758 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20759 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20760 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20761 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20762
20763 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20764 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20765 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20766 @value{GDBN} developers.
20767
20768 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20769 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20770 are:
20771
20772 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20773 @item Command Name
20774 @tab Remote Packet
20775 @tab Related Features
20776
20777 @item @code{fetch-register}
20778 @tab @code{p}
20779 @tab @code{info registers}
20780
20781 @item @code{set-register}
20782 @tab @code{P}
20783 @tab @code{set}
20784
20785 @item @code{binary-download}
20786 @tab @code{X}
20787 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20788
20789 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20790 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20791 @tab @code{info auxv}
20792
20793 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20794 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20795 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20796
20797 @item @code{attach}
20798 @tab @code{vAttach}
20799 @tab @code{attach}
20800
20801 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20802 @tab @code{vCont}
20803 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20804
20805 @item @code{run}
20806 @tab @code{vRun}
20807 @tab @code{run}
20808
20809 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20810 @tab @code{Z0}
20811 @tab @code{break}
20812
20813 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20814 @tab @code{Z1}
20815 @tab @code{hbreak}
20816
20817 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20818 @tab @code{Z2}
20819 @tab @code{watch}
20820
20821 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20822 @tab @code{Z3}
20823 @tab @code{rwatch}
20824
20825 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20826 @tab @code{Z4}
20827 @tab @code{awatch}
20828
20829 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20830 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20831 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20832
20833 @item @code{target-features}
20834 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20835 @tab @code{set architecture}
20836
20837 @item @code{library-info}
20838 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20839 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20840
20841 @item @code{memory-map}
20842 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20843 @tab @code{info mem}
20844
20845 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20846 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20847 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20848
20849 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20850 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20851 @tab @code{info spu}
20852
20853 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20854 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20855 @tab @code{info spu}
20856
20857 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20858 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20859 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20860
20861 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20862 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20863 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20864
20865 @item @code{threads}
20866 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20867 @tab @code{info threads}
20868
20869 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20870 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20871 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20872
20873 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20874 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20875 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20876
20877 @item @code{search-memory}
20878 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20879 @tab @code{find}
20880
20881 @item @code{supported-packets}
20882 @tab @code{qSupported}
20883 @tab Remote communications parameters
20884
20885 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20886 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20887 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20888
20889 @item @code{pass-signals}
20890 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20891 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20892
20893 @item @code{program-signals}
20894 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20895 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20896
20897 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20898 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20899 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20900
20901 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20902 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20903 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20904
20905 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20906 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20907 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20908
20909 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20910 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20911 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20912
20913 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20914 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20915 @tab @code{remote delete}
20916
20917 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20918 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20919 @tab Host I/O
20920
20921 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20922 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20923 @tab Host I/O
20924
20925 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20926 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20927 @tab Host I/O
20928
20929 @item @code{noack-packet}
20930 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20931 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20932
20933 @item @code{osdata}
20934 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20935 @tab @code{info os}
20936
20937 @item @code{query-attached}
20938 @tab @code{qAttached}
20939 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20940
20941 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20942 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20943 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20944
20945 @item @code{trace-status}
20946 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20947 @tab @code{tstatus}
20948
20949 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20950 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20951 @tab Traceframe info
20952
20953 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20954 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20955 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20956
20957 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20958 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20959 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20960
20961 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
20962 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
20963 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
20964
20965 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
20966 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
20967 @tab @code{set environment}
20968
20969 @item @code{environment-unset}
20970 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
20971 @tab @code{unset environment}
20972
20973 @item @code{environment-reset}
20974 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
20975 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
20976
20977 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20978 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20979 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20980
20981 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20982 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20983 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20984
20985 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20986 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20987 @tab @code{break}
20988
20989 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20990 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20991 @tab @code{hbreak}
20992
20993 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20994 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20995 @tab @code{fork}
20996
20997 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20998 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20999 @tab @code{vfork}
21000
21001 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21002 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21003 @tab @code{exec}
21004
21005 @item @code{thread-events}
21006 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21007 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21008
21009 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21010 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21011 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21012
21013 @end multitable
21014
21015 @node Remote Stub
21016 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21017
21018 @cindex debugging stub, example
21019 @cindex remote stub, example
21020 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21021 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21022 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21023 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21024 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21025 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21026 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21027 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21028
21029 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21030 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21031 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21032 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21033 program, you need:
21034
21035 @enumerate
21036 @item
21037 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21038 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21039 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21040
21041 @item
21042 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21043 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21044
21045 @item
21046 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21047 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21048 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21049 documentation.
21050 @end enumerate
21051
21052 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21053 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21054 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21055
21056 @table @emph
21057 @item On the host,
21058 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21059 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21060 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21061
21062 @item On the target,
21063 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21064 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21065 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21066
21067 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21068 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21069 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21070 @end table
21071
21072 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21073 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21074 @sc{sparc} boards.
21075
21076 @cindex remote serial stub list
21077 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21078
21079 @table @code
21080
21081 @item i386-stub.c
21082 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21083 @cindex Intel
21084 @cindex i386
21085 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21086
21087 @item m68k-stub.c
21088 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21089 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21090 @cindex m680x0
21091 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21092
21093 @item sh-stub.c
21094 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21095 @cindex Renesas
21096 @cindex SH
21097 For Renesas SH architectures.
21098
21099 @item sparc-stub.c
21100 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21101 @cindex Sparc
21102 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21103
21104 @item sparcl-stub.c
21105 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21106 @cindex Fujitsu
21107 @cindex SparcLite
21108 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21109
21110 @end table
21111
21112 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21113 recently added stubs.
21114
21115 @menu
21116 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21117 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21118 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21119 @end menu
21120
21121 @node Stub Contents
21122 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21123
21124 @cindex remote serial stub
21125 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21126 subroutines:
21127
21128 @table @code
21129 @item set_debug_traps
21130 @findex set_debug_traps
21131 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21132 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21133 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21134 program's startup code.
21135
21136 @item handle_exception
21137 @findex handle_exception
21138 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21139 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21140 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21141 run when a trap is triggered.
21142
21143 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21144 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21145 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21146 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21147 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21148 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21149 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21150 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21151 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21152 machine.
21153
21154 @item breakpoint
21155 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21156 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21157 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21158 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21159 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21160 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21161 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21162 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21163 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21164 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21165 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21166
21167 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21168 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21169 start of your debugging session.
21170 @end table
21171
21172 @node Bootstrapping
21173 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21174
21175 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21176 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21177 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21178 debugging target machine.
21179
21180 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21181 serial port.
21182
21183 @table @code
21184 @item int getDebugChar()
21185 @findex getDebugChar
21186 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21187 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21188 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21189
21190 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21191 @findex putDebugChar
21192 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21193 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21194 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21195 @end table
21196
21197 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21198 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21199 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21200 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21201 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21202 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21203 remote system to stop.
21204
21205 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21206 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21207 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21208 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21209
21210 Other routines you need to supply are:
21211
21212 @table @code
21213 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21214 @findex exceptionHandler
21215 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21216 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21217 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21218 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21219 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21220 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21221 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21222 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21223 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21224 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21225 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21226 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21227 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21228
21229 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21230 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21231 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21232 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21233 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21234
21235 @item void flush_i_cache()
21236 @findex flush_i_cache
21237 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21238 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21239 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21240
21241 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21242 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21243 @end table
21244
21245 @noindent
21246 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21247
21248 @table @code
21249 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21250 @findex memset
21251 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21252 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21253 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21254 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21255 @end table
21256
21257 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21258 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21259 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21260 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21261
21262
21263 @node Debug Session
21264 @subsection Putting it All Together
21265
21266 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21267 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21268 steps.
21269
21270 @enumerate
21271 @item
21272 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21273 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21274 @display
21275 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21276 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21277 @end display
21278
21279 @item
21280 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21281 procedure is called:
21282
21283 @smallexample
21284 set_debug_traps();
21285 breakpoint();
21286 @end smallexample
21287
21288 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21289 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21290 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21291 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21292 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21293 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21294 progress.
21295
21296 @item
21297 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21298 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21299
21300 @smallexample
21301 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21302 @end smallexample
21303
21304 @noindent
21305 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21306 function in your program, that function is called when
21307 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21308 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21309 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21310
21311 @item
21312 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21313 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21314
21315 @item
21316 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21317 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21318
21319 @item
21320 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21321 @c document that. FIXME.
21322 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21323 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21324
21325 @item
21326 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21327 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21328
21329 @end enumerate
21330
21331 @node Configurations
21332 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21333
21334 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21335 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21336 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21337
21338 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21339 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21340 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21341 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21342 are quite different from each other.
21343
21344 @menu
21345 * Native::
21346 * Embedded OS::
21347 * Embedded Processors::
21348 * Architectures::
21349 @end menu
21350
21351 @node Native
21352 @section Native
21353
21354 This section describes details specific to particular native
21355 configurations.
21356
21357 @menu
21358 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21359 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
21360 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21361 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21362 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21363 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21364 @end menu
21365
21366 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21367 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21368
21369 @cindex libkvm
21370 @cindex kernel memory image
21371 @cindex kernel crash dump
21372
21373 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21374 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21375 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21376 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21377 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21378 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21379 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21380 @code{kvm} target:
21381
21382 @smallexample
21383 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21384 @end smallexample
21385
21386 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21387 argument:
21388
21389 @smallexample
21390 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21391 @end smallexample
21392
21393 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21394 available:
21395
21396 @table @code
21397 @kindex kvm
21398 @item kvm pcb
21399 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21400
21401 @item kvm proc
21402 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21403 modern FreeBSD systems.
21404 @end table
21405
21406 @node SVR4 Process Information
21407 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
21408 @cindex /proc
21409 @cindex examine process image
21410 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21411
21412 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21413 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21414 process using file-system subroutines.
21415
21416 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21417 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21418 information about the process running your program, or about any
21419 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
21420 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21421
21422 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21423 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21424
21425 @table @code
21426 @kindex info proc
21427 @cindex process ID
21428 @item info proc
21429 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21430 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21431 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21432 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21433 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21434 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21435 executable file's absolute file name.
21436
21437 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21438 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21439 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21440 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21441 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21442 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21443
21444 @item info proc cmdline
21445 @cindex info proc cmdline
21446 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21447 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21448
21449 @item info proc cwd
21450 @cindex info proc cwd
21451 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21452 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21453
21454 @item info proc exe
21455 @cindex info proc exe
21456 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
21457 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21458
21459 @item info proc mappings
21460 @cindex memory address space mappings
21461 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21462 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21463 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21464 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21465 memory access rights to that range.
21466
21467 @item info proc stat
21468 @itemx info proc status
21469 @cindex process detailed status information
21470 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
21471 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21472 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21473 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21474 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21475 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21476 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21477
21478 @item info proc all
21479 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21480 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21481
21482 @ignore
21483 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21484 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21485 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21486 @kindex info proc times
21487 @item info proc times
21488 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21489 its children.
21490
21491 @kindex info proc id
21492 @item info proc id
21493 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21494 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21495 @end ignore
21496
21497 @item set procfs-trace
21498 @kindex set procfs-trace
21499 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21500 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21501
21502 @item show procfs-trace
21503 @kindex show procfs-trace
21504 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21505
21506 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21507 @kindex set procfs-file
21508 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21509 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21510 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21511 standard output.
21512
21513 @item show procfs-file
21514 @kindex show procfs-file
21515 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21516
21517 @item proc-trace-entry
21518 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21519 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21520 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21521 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21522 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21523 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21524 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21525 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21526 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21527
21528 @item info pidlist
21529 @kindex info pidlist
21530 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21531 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21532 processes and all the threads within each process.
21533
21534 @item info meminfo
21535 @kindex info meminfo
21536 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21537 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21538 @end table
21539
21540 @node DJGPP Native
21541 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21542 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21543 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21544 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21545
21546 @cindex DPMI
21547 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21548 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21549 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21550 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21551
21552 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21553 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21554 subsection describes those commands.
21555
21556 @table @code
21557 @kindex info dos
21558 @item info dos
21559 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21560 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21561
21562 @kindex sysinfo
21563 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21564 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21565 @item info dos sysinfo
21566 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21567 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21568 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21569
21570 @cindex GDT
21571 @cindex LDT
21572 @cindex IDT
21573 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21574 @cindex descriptor tables display
21575 @item info dos gdt
21576 @itemx info dos ldt
21577 @itemx info dos idt
21578 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21579 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21580 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21581 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21582 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21583 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21584 rights.
21585
21586 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21587 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21588 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21589 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21590 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21591
21592 @cindex garbled pointers
21593 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21594 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21595 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21596 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21597 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21598 debugged program's data segment:
21599
21600 @smallexample
21601 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21602 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21603 @end smallexample
21604
21605 @noindent
21606 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21607 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21608
21609 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21610 @item info dos pde
21611 @itemx info dos pte
21612 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21613 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
21614 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21615 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
21616 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21617 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
21618 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21619 that is currently in use.
21620
21621 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21622 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21623 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21624 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21625 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21626 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21627 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21628
21629 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21630 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21631 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21632 controller.
21633
21634 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21635
21636 @cindex physical address from linear address
21637 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21638 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21639 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21640 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21641 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21642 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21643 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21644
21645 @smallexample
21646 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21647 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21648 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21649 @end smallexample
21650
21651 @noindent
21652 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21653 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21654 attributes of that page.
21655
21656 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21657 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21658 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21659 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21660 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21661 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21662
21663 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21664 transfer buffer:
21665
21666 @smallexample
21667 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21668 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21669 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21670 @end smallexample
21671
21672 @noindent
21673 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21674 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21675 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21676 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21677 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21678
21679 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21680 @end table
21681
21682 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21683 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21684 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21685 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21686
21687 @table @code
21688 @kindex set com1base
21689 @kindex set com1irq
21690 @kindex set com2base
21691 @kindex set com2irq
21692 @kindex set com3base
21693 @kindex set com3irq
21694 @kindex set com4base
21695 @kindex set com4irq
21696 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21697 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21698 port.
21699
21700 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21701 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21702 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21703
21704 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21705 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21706 other 3 COM ports.
21707
21708 @kindex show com1base
21709 @kindex show com1irq
21710 @kindex show com2base
21711 @kindex show com2irq
21712 @kindex show com3base
21713 @kindex show com3irq
21714 @kindex show com4base
21715 @kindex show com4irq
21716 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21717 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21718 lines used by the COM ports.
21719
21720 @item info serial
21721 @kindex info serial
21722 @cindex DOS serial port status
21723 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21724 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21725 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21726 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21727 @end table
21728
21729
21730 @node Cygwin Native
21731 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21732 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21733 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21734 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21735
21736 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21737 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21738
21739 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21740 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21741 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21742 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21743 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21744 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21745 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21746 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21747
21748 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21749 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21750 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21751
21752 @table @code
21753 @kindex info w32
21754 @item info w32
21755 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21756 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21757
21758 @item info w32 selector
21759 This command displays information returned by
21760 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21761 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21762 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21763 Without argument, this command displays information
21764 about the six segment registers.
21765
21766 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21767 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21768 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21769 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21770
21771 @kindex signal-event
21772 @item signal-event @var{id}
21773 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
21774 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21775
21776 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21777 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21778 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21779 (for x86_64 versions):
21780
21781 @itemize @minus
21782 @item
21783 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21784 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21785 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21786
21787 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21788 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21789 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21790 to attach.
21791
21792 @item
21793 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
21794 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21795 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21796 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21797 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21798 @end itemize
21799
21800 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21801 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21802 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21803 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21804 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21805 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21806 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21807 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21808 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21809 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21810 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21811
21812 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21813 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21814 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21815 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21816
21817 @kindex set new-console
21818 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21819 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21820 be started in a new console on next start.
21821 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21822 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21823
21824 @kindex show new-console
21825 @item show new-console
21826 Displays whether a new console is used
21827 when the debuggee is started.
21828
21829 @kindex set new-group
21830 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21831 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21832 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21833 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21834 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21835
21836 @kindex show new-group
21837 @item show new-group
21838 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21839
21840 @kindex set debugevents
21841 @item set debugevents
21842 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21843 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21844 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21845 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21846 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21847
21848 @kindex set debugexec
21849 @item set debugexec
21850 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21851 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21852
21853 @kindex set debugexceptions
21854 @item set debugexceptions
21855 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21856 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21857
21858 @kindex set debugmemory
21859 @item set debugmemory
21860 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21861 and writes by the debugger.
21862
21863 @kindex set shell
21864 @item set shell
21865 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21866 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21867
21868 @kindex show shell
21869 @item show shell
21870 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21871
21872 @end table
21873
21874 @menu
21875 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21876 @end menu
21877
21878 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21879 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21880 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21881 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21882
21883 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21884 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21885 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21886 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21887 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21888 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21889 ``minimal symbols''.
21890
21891 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21892 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21893 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21894 program run once to completion.
21895
21896 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21897
21898 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21899 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21900 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21901 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21902 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21903 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21904 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21905 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21906 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21907
21908 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21909 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21910 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21911 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21912 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21913 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21914
21915 @smallexample
21916 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21917 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21918
21919 Non-debugging symbols:
21920 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21921 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21922 @end smallexample
21923
21924 @smallexample
21925 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21926 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21927
21928 Non-debugging symbols:
21929 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21930 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21931 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21932 [etc...]
21933 @end smallexample
21934
21935 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21936
21937 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21938 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21939 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21940 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21941 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21942 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21943 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21944
21945 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21946 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21947 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21948 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21949 problem:
21950
21951 @smallexample
21952 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21953 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21954 @end smallexample
21955
21956 @smallexample
21957 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21958 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
21959 @end smallexample
21960
21961 And two possible solutions:
21962
21963 @smallexample
21964 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21965 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21966 @end smallexample
21967
21968 @smallexample
21969 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21970 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21971 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21972 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21973 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21974 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21975 @end smallexample
21976
21977 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21978 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21979 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21980 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21981 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21982
21983 @smallexample
21984 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21985 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21986 @end smallexample
21987
21988 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21989 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21990 safe.
21991
21992 @node Hurd Native
21993 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21994 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21995
21996 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21997 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21998
21999 @table @code
22000 @item set signals
22001 @itemx set sigs
22002 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22003 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22004 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22005 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22006 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22007 @code{signals}.
22008
22009 @item show signals
22010 @itemx show sigs
22011 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22012 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22013 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22014
22015 @item set signal-thread
22016 @itemx set sigthread
22017 @kindex set signal-thread
22018 @kindex set sigthread
22019 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22020 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22021 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22022 signal-thread}.
22023
22024 @item show signal-thread
22025 @itemx show sigthread
22026 @kindex show signal-thread
22027 @kindex show sigthread
22028 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22029 delivered a signal.
22030
22031 @item set stopped
22032 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22033 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22034 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22035 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22036
22037 @item show stopped
22038 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22039 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22040 stopped.
22041
22042 @item set exceptions
22043 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22044 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22045 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22046 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22047 trapping on.
22048
22049 @item show exceptions
22050 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22051 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22052
22053 @item set task pause
22054 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22055 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22056 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22057 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22058 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22059 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22060 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22061 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22062 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22063
22064 @item show task pause
22065 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22066 Show the current state of task suspension.
22067
22068 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22069 @cindex task suspend count
22070 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22071 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22072 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22073
22074 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22075 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22076
22077 @item set task exception-port
22078 @itemx set task excp
22079 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22080 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22081 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22082 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22083
22084 @item set noninvasive
22085 @cindex noninvasive task options
22086 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22087 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22088 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22089 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22090
22091 @item info send-rights
22092 @itemx info receive-rights
22093 @itemx info port-rights
22094 @itemx info port-sets
22095 @itemx info dead-names
22096 @itemx info ports
22097 @itemx info psets
22098 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22099 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22100 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22101 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22102 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22103 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22104 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22105 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22106 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22107
22108 @item set thread pause
22109 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22110 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22111 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22112 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22113 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22114 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22115 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22116 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22117 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22118 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22119 only the current thread.
22120
22121 @item show thread pause
22122 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22123 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22124
22125 @item set thread run
22126 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22127
22128 @item show thread run
22129 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22130
22131 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22132 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22133 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22134 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22135 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22136 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22137 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22138
22139 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22140 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22141 detaching.
22142
22143 @item set thread exception-port
22144 @itemx set thread excp
22145 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22146 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22147 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22148
22149 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22150 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22151 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22152 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22153
22154 @item set thread default
22155 @itemx show thread default
22156 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22157 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22158 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22159 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22160 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22161 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22162 the non-default commands.
22163 @end table
22164
22165 @node Darwin
22166 @subsection Darwin
22167 @cindex Darwin
22168
22169 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22170
22171 @table @code
22172 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22173 @kindex set debug darwin
22174 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22175 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22176
22177 @item show debug darwin
22178 @kindex show debug darwin
22179 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22180
22181 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22182 @kindex set debug mach-o
22183 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22184 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22185 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22186 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22187 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22188 usage.
22189
22190 @item show debug mach-o
22191 @kindex show debug mach-o
22192 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22193
22194 @item set mach-exceptions on
22195 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22196 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22197 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22198 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22199 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22200 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22201
22202 @item show mach-exceptions
22203 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22204 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22205 @end table
22206
22207
22208 @node Embedded OS
22209 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22210
22211 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22212 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22213 architectures.
22214
22215 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22216 various real-time operating systems.
22217
22218 @node Embedded Processors
22219 @section Embedded Processors
22220
22221 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22222 configurations.
22223
22224 @cindex send command to simulator
22225 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22226 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22227
22228 @table @code
22229 @item sim @var{command}
22230 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22231 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22232 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22233 acceptable commands.
22234 @end table
22235
22236
22237 @menu
22238 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22239 * ARM:: ARM
22240 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22241 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22242 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22243 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22244 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22245 * CRIS:: CRIS
22246 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22247 @end menu
22248
22249 @node ARC
22250 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22251 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22252 @cindex ARC specific commands
22253 @cindex ARC600
22254 @cindex ARC700
22255 @cindex ARC EM
22256 @cindex ARC HS
22257
22258 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22259
22260 @table @code
22261 @item set debug arc
22262 @kindex set debug arc
22263 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22264 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22265
22266 @item show debug arc
22267 @kindex show debug arc
22268 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22269
22270 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22271 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22272 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22273
22274 @end table
22275
22276 @node ARM
22277 @subsection ARM
22278
22279 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22280
22281 @table @code
22282 @item set arm disassembler
22283 @kindex set arm
22284 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22285 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22286
22287 @item show arm disassembler
22288 @kindex show arm
22289 Show the current disassembly style.
22290
22291 @item set arm apcs32
22292 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22293 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22294
22295 @item show arm apcs32
22296 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22297
22298 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22299 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22300 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22301
22302 @table @code
22303 @item auto
22304 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22305 @item softfpa
22306 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22307 processors.
22308 @item fpa
22309 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22310 @item softvfp
22311 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22312 @item vfp
22313 VFP co-processor.
22314 @end table
22315
22316 @item show arm fpu
22317 Show the current type of the FPU.
22318
22319 @item set arm abi
22320 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22321
22322 @item show arm abi
22323 Show the currently used ABI.
22324
22325 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22326 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22327 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22328 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22329 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22330 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22331 register).
22332
22333 @item show arm fallback-mode
22334 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22335
22336 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22337 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22338 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22339 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22340 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22341
22342 @item show arm force-mode
22343 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22344
22345 @item set debug arm
22346 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22347 target support subsystem.
22348
22349 @item show debug arm
22350 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22351 @end table
22352
22353 @table @code
22354 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22355 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22356
22357 @table @code
22358 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22359 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22360 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22361 The default value is @code{all}.
22362
22363 @table @code
22364 @item none
22365 @item demon
22366 @item angel
22367 @item redboot
22368 @item all
22369 @end table
22370 @end table
22371 @end table
22372
22373 @node M68K
22374 @subsection M68k
22375
22376 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22377
22378 @node MicroBlaze
22379 @subsection MicroBlaze
22380 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22381 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22382
22383 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22384 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22385 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22386 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22387 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22388 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22389 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22390 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22391 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22392 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22393 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22394
22395 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22396
22397 @table @code
22398 @item target remote :1234
22399 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22400 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22401
22402 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22403 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22404 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22405
22406 @item load
22407 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22408
22409 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22410 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22411
22412 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22413 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22414 @end table
22415
22416 @node MIPS Embedded
22417 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22418
22419 @noindent
22420 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22421
22422 @table @code
22423 @item set mipsfpu double
22424 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22425 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22426 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22427 @itemx show mipsfpu
22428 @kindex set mipsfpu
22429 @kindex show mipsfpu
22430 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22431 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22432 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22433 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22434 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22435 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22436 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22437 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22438 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22439 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22440 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22441 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22442 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22443
22444 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22445 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22446 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22447
22448 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22449 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22450 @end table
22451
22452 @node PowerPC Embedded
22453 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22454
22455 @cindex DVC register
22456 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22457 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22458
22459 @smallexample
22460 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22461 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22462 @end smallexample
22463
22464 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22465 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22466 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22467 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22468 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22469 or newer.
22470
22471 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22472 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22473 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22474 watching variables of scalar types.
22475
22476 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22477 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22478
22479 @smallexample
22480 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22481 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22482 @end smallexample
22483
22484 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22485 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22486
22487 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22488 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22489 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22490 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22491 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22492 use the @code{break-range} command.
22493
22494 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22495
22496 @table @code
22497 @kindex break-range
22498 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22499 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22500 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22501 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22502 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22503 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22504 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22505 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22506 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22507
22508 @kindex set powerpc
22509 @item set powerpc soft-float
22510 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22511 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22512 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22513 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22514
22515 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22516 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22517 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22518 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22519 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22520 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22521 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22522 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22523
22524 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22525 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22526 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22527 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22528 address of its first byte.
22529
22530 @end table
22531
22532 @node AVR
22533 @subsection Atmel AVR
22534 @cindex AVR
22535
22536 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22537 following AVR-specific commands:
22538
22539 @table @code
22540 @item info io_registers
22541 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22542 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22543 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22544 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22545 @end table
22546
22547 @node CRIS
22548 @subsection CRIS
22549 @cindex CRIS
22550
22551 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22552 following CRIS-specific commands:
22553
22554 @table @code
22555 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22556 @cindex CRIS version
22557 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22558 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22559 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22560
22561 @item show cris-version
22562 Show the current CRIS version.
22563
22564 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22565 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22566 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22567 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22568 @code{R59}.
22569
22570 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22571 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22572
22573 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22574 @cindex CRIS mode
22575 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22576 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22577 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22578
22579 @item show cris-mode
22580 Show the current CRIS mode.
22581 @end table
22582
22583 @node Super-H
22584 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22585 @cindex Super-H
22586
22587 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22588 commands:
22589
22590 @table @code
22591 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22592 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22593 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22594 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22595 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22596 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22597 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22598 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22599 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22600 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22601 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22602 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22603
22604 @item show sh calling-convention
22605 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22606 Show the current calling convention setting.
22607
22608 @end table
22609
22610
22611 @node Architectures
22612 @section Architectures
22613
22614 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22615 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22616
22617 @menu
22618 * AArch64::
22619 * i386::
22620 * Alpha::
22621 * MIPS::
22622 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22623 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22624 * PowerPC::
22625 * Nios II::
22626 * Sparc64::
22627 @end menu
22628
22629 @node AArch64
22630 @subsection AArch64
22631 @cindex AArch64 support
22632
22633 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22634 following special commands:
22635
22636 @table @code
22637 @item set debug aarch64
22638 @kindex set debug aarch64
22639 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22640 messages are to be displayed.
22641
22642 @item show debug aarch64
22643 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22644
22645 @end table
22646
22647 @node i386
22648 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22649
22650 @table @code
22651 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22652 @kindex set struct-convention
22653 @cindex struct return convention
22654 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22655 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22656 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22657 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22658 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22659 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22660 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22661 be returned in a register.
22662
22663 @item show struct-convention
22664 @kindex show struct-convention
22665 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22666 from functions.
22667 @end table
22668
22669
22670 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22671 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22672
22673 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22674 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22675 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22676 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22677 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22678 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22679 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22680
22681 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22682 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22683 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22684 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22685 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22686 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22687
22688 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22689 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22690 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22691
22692 @smallexample
22693 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22694 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22695 @end smallexample
22696
22697 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22698 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22699 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22700 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22701 the pointer.
22702
22703 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22704 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22705 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22706 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22707 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22708
22709 @table @code
22710 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22711 @kindex show mpx bound
22712 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22713
22714 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22715 @kindex set mpx bound
22716 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22717 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22718 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22719 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22720 @end table
22721
22722 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
22723 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
22724 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
22725 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
22726
22727 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
22728 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
22729 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
22730 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
22731 function.
22732
22733 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
22734 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
22735 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
22736 continuing the execution. For example:
22737
22738 @smallexample
22739 $ break *upper
22740 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
22741 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
22742 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
22743 $ print $bnd0
22744 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
22745 @end smallexample
22746
22747 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
22748 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
22749 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
22750
22751 @node Alpha
22752 @subsection Alpha
22753
22754 See the following section.
22755
22756 @node MIPS
22757 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22758
22759 @cindex stack on Alpha
22760 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22761 @cindex Alpha stack
22762 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22763 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22764 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22765 find the beginning of a function.
22766
22767 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22768 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22769 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22770 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22771 commands:
22772
22773 @table @code
22774 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22775 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22776 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22777 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22778 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22779 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22780 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22781 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22782
22783 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22784 Display the current limit.
22785 @end table
22786
22787 @noindent
22788 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22789 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22790
22791 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22792 programs:
22793
22794 @table @code
22795 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22796 @kindex set mips abi
22797 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22798 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22799 values of @var{arg} are:
22800
22801 @table @samp
22802 @item auto
22803 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22804 default).
22805 @item o32
22806 @item o64
22807 @item n32
22808 @item n64
22809 @item eabi32
22810 @item eabi64
22811 @end table
22812
22813 @item show mips abi
22814 @kindex show mips abi
22815 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22816
22817 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22818 @kindex set mips compression
22819 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22820 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22821 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22822 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22823 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22824 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22825 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22826 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22827 provided by the executable.
22828
22829 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22830 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22831 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22832 identified as such.
22833
22834 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22835 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22836 implicitly from an executable.
22837
22838 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22839 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22840 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22841 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22842 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22843
22844 @item show mips compression
22845 @kindex show mips compression
22846 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22847 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22848
22849 @item set mipsfpu
22850 @itemx show mipsfpu
22851 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22852
22853 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22854 @kindex set mips mask-address
22855 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22856 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22857 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22858 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22859 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22860
22861 @item show mips mask-address
22862 @kindex show mips mask-address
22863 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22864 not.
22865
22866 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22867 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22868 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22869 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22870 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22871 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22872
22873 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22874 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22875 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22876
22877 @item set debug mips
22878 @kindex set debug mips
22879 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22880 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22881
22882 @item show debug mips
22883 @kindex show debug mips
22884 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22885 @end table
22886
22887
22888 @node HPPA
22889 @subsection HPPA
22890 @cindex HPPA support
22891
22892 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22893 following special commands:
22894
22895 @table @code
22896 @item set debug hppa
22897 @kindex set debug hppa
22898 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22899 messages are to be displayed.
22900
22901 @item show debug hppa
22902 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22903
22904 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22905 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22906 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22907 given @var{address}.
22908
22909 @end table
22910
22911
22912 @node SPU
22913 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22914 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22915 @cindex SPU
22916
22917 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22918 it provides the following special commands:
22919
22920 @table @code
22921 @item info spu event
22922 @kindex info spu
22923 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22924 and pending event status.
22925
22926 @item info spu signal
22927 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22928 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22929 notification channels.
22930
22931 @item info spu mailbox
22932 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22933 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22934 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22935
22936 @item info spu dma
22937 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22938 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22939 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22940
22941 @item info spu proxydma
22942 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22943 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22944 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22945
22946 @end table
22947
22948 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22949 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22950 special commands:
22951
22952 @table @code
22953 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22954 @kindex set spu
22955 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22956 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22957 function. The default is @code{off}.
22958
22959 @item show spu stop-on-load
22960 @kindex show spu
22961 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22962
22963 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22964 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22965 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22966 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22967 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22968 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22969
22970 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22971 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22972
22973 @end table
22974
22975 @node PowerPC
22976 @subsection PowerPC
22977 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22978
22979 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22980 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22981 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22982 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22983 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22984
22985 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22986 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22987 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22988
22989 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22990 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22991
22992 @node Nios II
22993 @subsection Nios II
22994 @cindex Nios II architecture
22995
22996 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22997 it provides the following special commands:
22998
22999 @table @code
23000
23001 @item set debug nios2
23002 @kindex set debug nios2
23003 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23004 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23005
23006 @item show debug nios2
23007 @kindex show debug nios2
23008 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23009 @end table
23010
23011 @node Sparc64
23012 @subsection Sparc64
23013 @cindex Sparc64 support
23014 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23015 @subsubsection ADI Support
23016
23017 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23018 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23019 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23020 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23021 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23022 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23023 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23024 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23025 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23026 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23027 signal.
23028
23029 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23030 ADI-enabled.
23031
23032 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23033 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23034
23035
23036 @table @code
23037 @kindex adi examine
23038 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23039
23040 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23041 cacheline.
23042
23043 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23044 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23045 block size, to display.
23046
23047 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23048 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23049
23050 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23051
23052 @smallexample
23053 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23054 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23055 @end smallexample
23056
23057 @kindex adi assign
23058 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23059
23060 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23061 to an address.
23062
23063 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23064 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23065 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23066
23067 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23068 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23069
23070 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23071
23072 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23073 variable "shmaddr":
23074
23075 @smallexample
23076 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23077 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23078 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23079 @end smallexample
23080
23081 @end table
23082
23083 @node Controlling GDB
23084 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23085
23086 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23087 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23088 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23089 described here.
23090
23091 @menu
23092 * Prompt:: Prompt
23093 * Editing:: Command editing
23094 * Command History:: Command history
23095 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23096 * Numbers:: Numbers
23097 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23098 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23099 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23100 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23101 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23102 @end menu
23103
23104 @node Prompt
23105 @section Prompt
23106
23107 @cindex prompt
23108
23109 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23110 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23111 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23112 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23113 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23114 which one you are talking to.
23115
23116 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23117 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23118 or a prompt that does not.
23119
23120 @table @code
23121 @kindex set prompt
23122 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23123 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23124
23125 @kindex show prompt
23126 @item show prompt
23127 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23128 @end table
23129
23130 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23131 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23132 are:
23133
23134 @table @code
23135 @kindex set extended-prompt
23136 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23137 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23138 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23139 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23140 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23141 is displayed.
23142
23143 For example:
23144
23145 @smallexample
23146 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23147 @end smallexample
23148
23149 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23150 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23151
23152 @kindex show extended-prompt
23153 @item show extended-prompt
23154 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23155 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23156 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23157 @end table
23158
23159 @node Editing
23160 @section Command Editing
23161 @cindex readline
23162 @cindex command line editing
23163
23164 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23165 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23166 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23167 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23168 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23169 debugging sessions.
23170
23171 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23172 command @code{set}.
23173
23174 @table @code
23175 @kindex set editing
23176 @cindex editing
23177 @item set editing
23178 @itemx set editing on
23179 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23180
23181 @item set editing off
23182 Disable command line editing.
23183
23184 @kindex show editing
23185 @item show editing
23186 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23187 @end table
23188
23189 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23190 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23191 @end ifset
23192 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23193 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23194 @end ifclear
23195 for more details about the Readline
23196 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23197 encouraged to read that chapter.
23198
23199 @node Command History
23200 @section Command History
23201 @cindex command history
23202
23203 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23204 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23205 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23206 history facility.
23207
23208 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23209 package, to provide the history facility.
23210 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23211 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23212 @end ifset
23213 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23214 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23215 @end ifclear
23216 for the detailed description of the History library.
23217
23218 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23219 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23220 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23221 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23222 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23223 pressed on a line by itself.
23224
23225 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23226 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23227 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23228 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23229
23230 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23231 history.
23232
23233 @table @code
23234 @cindex history substitution
23235 @cindex history file
23236 @kindex set history filename
23237 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23238 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23239 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23240 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23241 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23242 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23243 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23244 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23245 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23246 is not set.
23247
23248 @cindex save command history
23249 @kindex set history save
23250 @item set history save
23251 @itemx set history save on
23252 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23253 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23254
23255 @item set history save off
23256 Stop recording command history in a file.
23257
23258 @cindex history size
23259 @kindex set history size
23260 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23261 @item set history size @var{size}
23262 @itemx set history size unlimited
23263 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23264 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23265 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23266 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23267 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23268 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23269
23270 @cindex remove duplicate history
23271 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23272 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23273 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23274 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23275 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23276 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23277 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23278 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23279 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23280
23281 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23282 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23283
23284 @end table
23285
23286 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23287 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23288 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23289 @end ifset
23290 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23291 @xref{Event Designators},
23292 @end ifclear
23293 for more details.
23294
23295 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23296 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23297 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23298 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23299 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23300 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23301 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23302 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23303
23304 The commands to control history expansion are:
23305
23306 @table @code
23307 @item set history expansion on
23308 @itemx set history expansion
23309 @kindex set history expansion
23310 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23311
23312 @item set history expansion off
23313 Disable history expansion.
23314
23315 @c @group
23316 @kindex show history
23317 @item show history
23318 @itemx show history filename
23319 @itemx show history save
23320 @itemx show history size
23321 @itemx show history expansion
23322 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23323 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23324 @c @end group
23325 @end table
23326
23327 @table @code
23328 @kindex show commands
23329 @cindex show last commands
23330 @cindex display command history
23331 @item show commands
23332 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23333
23334 @item show commands @var{n}
23335 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23336
23337 @item show commands +
23338 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23339 @end table
23340
23341 @node Screen Size
23342 @section Screen Size
23343 @cindex size of screen
23344 @cindex screen size
23345 @cindex pagination
23346 @cindex page size
23347 @cindex pauses in output
23348
23349 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23350 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23351 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23352 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23353 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23354 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23355 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23356 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23357
23358 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23359 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23360 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23361 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23362 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23363 width} commands:
23364
23365 @table @code
23366 @kindex set height
23367 @kindex set width
23368 @kindex show width
23369 @kindex show height
23370 @item set height @var{lpp}
23371 @itemx set height unlimited
23372 @itemx show height
23373 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23374 @itemx set width unlimited
23375 @itemx show width
23376 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23377 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23378 commands display the current settings.
23379
23380 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23381 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23382 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23383 buffer.
23384
23385 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23386 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23387
23388 @item set pagination on
23389 @itemx set pagination off
23390 @kindex set pagination
23391 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23392 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23393 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23394 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23395
23396 @item show pagination
23397 @kindex show pagination
23398 Show the current pagination mode.
23399 @end table
23400
23401 @node Numbers
23402 @section Numbers
23403 @cindex number representation
23404 @cindex entering numbers
23405
23406 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23407 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23408 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23409 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23410 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23411 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23412 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23413 both input and output with the commands described below.
23414
23415 @table @code
23416 @kindex set input-radix
23417 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23418 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23419 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23420 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23421 example, any of
23422
23423 @smallexample
23424 set input-radix 012
23425 set input-radix 10.
23426 set input-radix 0xa
23427 @end smallexample
23428
23429 @noindent
23430 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23431 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23432 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23433 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23434 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23435 change the radix.
23436
23437 @kindex set output-radix
23438 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23439 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23440 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23441 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23442
23443 @kindex show input-radix
23444 @item show input-radix
23445 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23446
23447 @kindex show output-radix
23448 @item show output-radix
23449 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23450
23451 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23452 @itemx show radix
23453 @kindex set radix
23454 @kindex show radix
23455 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23456 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23457 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23458 default value of 10.
23459
23460 @end table
23461
23462 @node ABI
23463 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23464
23465 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23466 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23467 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23468 current ABI.
23469
23470 @cindex OS ABI
23471 @kindex set osabi
23472 @kindex show osabi
23473 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23474
23475 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23476 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23477 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23478 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23479 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23480 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23481 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23482 platform provides.
23483
23484 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23485 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23486 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23487 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23488
23489 @table @code
23490 @item show osabi
23491 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23492
23493 @item set osabi
23494 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23495
23496 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23497 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23498 @end table
23499
23500 @cindex float promotion
23501
23502 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23503 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23504 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23505 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23506 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23507 @code{double} and then passed.
23508
23509 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23510 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23511 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23512
23513 @table @code
23514 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23515 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23516 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23517 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23518 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23519
23520 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23521 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23522 functions.
23523
23524 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23525 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23526 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23527 @end table
23528
23529 @kindex set cp-abi
23530 @kindex show cp-abi
23531 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23532 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23533 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23534 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23535 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23536 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23537 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23538 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23539 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23540 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23541 ``auto''.
23542
23543 @table @code
23544 @item show cp-abi
23545 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23546
23547 @item set cp-abi
23548 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23549
23550 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23551 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23552 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23553 @end table
23554
23555 @node Auto-loading
23556 @section Automatically loading associated files
23557 @cindex auto-loading
23558
23559 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23560 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23561 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23562 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23563 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23564 sources).
23565
23566 @menu
23567 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23568 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23569
23570 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23571 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23572 @end menu
23573
23574 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23575 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23576 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23577
23578 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23579 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23580 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23581
23582 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23583 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23584
23585 @table @code
23586 @anchor{set auto-load off}
23587 @kindex set auto-load off
23588 @item set auto-load off
23589 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23590 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23591 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23592 @smallexample
23593 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23594 @end smallexample
23595
23596 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23597 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23598 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23599 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23600 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23601 @code{set auto-load no}.
23602
23603 @anchor{show auto-load}
23604 @kindex show auto-load
23605 @item show auto-load
23606 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23607 or disabled.
23608
23609 @smallexample
23610 (gdb) show auto-load
23611 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23612 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23613 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23614 is on.
23615 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23616 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23617 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23618 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23619 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23620 @end smallexample
23621
23622 @anchor{info auto-load}
23623 @kindex info auto-load
23624 @item info auto-load
23625 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23626 not.
23627
23628 @smallexample
23629 (gdb) info auto-load
23630 gdb-scripts:
23631 Loaded Script
23632 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23633 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23634 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23635 loaded.
23636 python-scripts:
23637 Loaded Script
23638 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23639 @end smallexample
23640 @end table
23641
23642 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23643
23644 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23645 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23646 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23647 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23648 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23649 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23650 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23651 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23652 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23653 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23654 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23655 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23656 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23657 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23658 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23659 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23660 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23661 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23662 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23663 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23664 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23665 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23666 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23667 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23668 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23669 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23670 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23671 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23672 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23673 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23674 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23675 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23676 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23677 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23678 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23679 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23680 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23681 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23682 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23683 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23684 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23685 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23686 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23687 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23688 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23689 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23690 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23691 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23692 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23693 @end multitable
23694
23695 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23696 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23697 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23698
23699 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23700 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23701 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23702
23703 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23704 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23705
23706 @table @code
23707 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23708 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23709 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23710 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23711 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23712
23713 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23714 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23715 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23716 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23717 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23718
23719 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23720 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23721 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23722 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23723 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23724 @end table
23725
23726 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23727 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23728 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23729
23730 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23731
23732 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23733 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23734
23735 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23736 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23737 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23738 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23739 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23740 library.
23741
23742 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23743 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23744
23745 @table @code
23746 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23747 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23748 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23749 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23750
23751 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23752 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23753 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23754 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23755 enabled or disabled.
23756
23757 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23758 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23759 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23760 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23761 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23762 @end table
23763
23764 @node Auto-loading safe path
23765 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23766 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23767
23768 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23769 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23770 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23771 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23772 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23773
23774 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23775 get loaded:
23776
23777 @smallexample
23778 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23779 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23780 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23781 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23782 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23783 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23784 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23785 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23786 @end smallexample
23787
23788 @noindent
23789 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23790 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23791
23792 @smallexample
23793 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23794 @end smallexample
23795
23796 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23797
23798 @table @code
23799 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23800 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23801 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23802 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23803 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23804 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23805 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23806 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23807 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23808 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23809
23810 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23811 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23812 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23813
23814 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23815 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23816 @item show auto-load safe-path
23817 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23818 scripts.
23819
23820 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23821 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23822 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23823 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23824 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23825 by the host platform path separator in use.
23826 @end table
23827
23828 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23829 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23830 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23831 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23832 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23833
23834 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23835 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23836 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23837 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23838 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23839 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23840 init file in the current directory
23841 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23842
23843 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23844 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23845
23846 @table @asis
23847 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23848 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23849 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23850 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23851
23852 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23853 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23854 @value{GDBN} session.
23855
23856 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23857 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23858 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23859 from trusted sources.
23860
23861 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23862 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23863 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23864 trusted sources.
23865 @end table
23866
23867 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23868 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23869
23870 @table @asis
23871 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23872 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23873
23874 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23875 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23876 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23877 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23878 @end table
23879
23880 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23881 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23882 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23883 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23884 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23885 recommended to be entered.
23886
23887 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23888 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23889 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23890
23891 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23892 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23893 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23894 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23895 be printed.
23896
23897 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23898 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23899 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23900
23901 @smallexample
23902 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23903 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23904 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23905 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23906 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23907 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23908 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23909 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23910 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23911 @end smallexample
23912
23913 @table @code
23914 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23915 @kindex set debug auto-load
23916 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23917 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23918
23919 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23920 @kindex show debug auto-load
23921 @item show debug auto-load
23922 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23923 on or off.
23924 @end table
23925
23926 @node Messages/Warnings
23927 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23928
23929 @cindex verbose operation
23930 @cindex optional warnings
23931 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23932 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23933 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23934 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23935
23936 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23937 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23938 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23939
23940 @table @code
23941 @kindex set verbose
23942 @item set verbose on
23943 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23944
23945 @item set verbose off
23946 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23947
23948 @kindex show verbose
23949 @item show verbose
23950 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23951 @end table
23952
23953 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23954 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23955 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23956 Symbol Files}).
23957
23958 @table @code
23959
23960 @kindex set complaints
23961 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23962 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23963 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23964 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23965 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23966
23967 @kindex show complaints
23968 @item show complaints
23969 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23970
23971 @end table
23972
23973 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23974 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23975 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23976 you try to run a program which is already running:
23977
23978 @smallexample
23979 (@value{GDBP}) run
23980 The program being debugged has been started already.
23981 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23982 @end smallexample
23983
23984 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23985 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23986
23987 @table @code
23988
23989 @kindex set confirm
23990 @cindex flinching
23991 @cindex confirmation
23992 @cindex stupid questions
23993 @item set confirm off
23994 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23995 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23996 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23997
23998 @item set confirm on
23999 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24000
24001 @kindex show confirm
24002 @item show confirm
24003 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24004
24005 @end table
24006
24007 @cindex command tracing
24008 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24009 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24010 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24011 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24012
24013 @table @code
24014 @kindex set trace-commands
24015 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24016 @item set trace-commands on
24017 Enable command tracing.
24018 @item set trace-commands off
24019 Disable command tracing.
24020 @item show trace-commands
24021 Display the current state of command tracing.
24022 @end table
24023
24024 @node Debugging Output
24025 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24026 @cindex optional debugging messages
24027
24028 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24029 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24030 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24031 section documents those commands.
24032
24033 @table @code
24034 @kindex set exec-done-display
24035 @item set exec-done-display
24036 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24037 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24038 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24039 @kindex show exec-done-display
24040 @item show exec-done-display
24041 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24042 notification.
24043 @kindex set debug
24044 @cindex ARM AArch64
24045 @item set debug aarch64
24046 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24047 The default is off.
24048 @kindex show debug
24049 @item show debug aarch64
24050 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24051 ARM AArch64.
24052 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24053 @cindex architecture debugging info
24054 @item set debug arch
24055 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24056 @item show debug arch
24057 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24058 @item set debug aix-solib
24059 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24060 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24061 support module. The default is off.
24062 @item show debug aix-thread
24063 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24064 @item set debug aix-thread
24065 @cindex AIX threads
24066 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24067 module.
24068 @item show debug aix-thread
24069 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24070 @item set debug check-physname
24071 @cindex physname
24072 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24073 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24074 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24075 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24076 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24077 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24078 @item show debug check-physname
24079 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24080 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24081 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24082 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24083 exported symbols. The default is off.
24084 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24085 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24086 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24087 @item set debug dwarf-die
24088 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24089 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24090 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24091 A value of zero turns off the display.
24092 @item show debug dwarf-die
24093 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24094 @item set debug dwarf-line
24095 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24096 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24097 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24098 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24099 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24100 @item show debug dwarf-line
24101 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24102 @item set debug dwarf-read
24103 @cindex DWARF Reading
24104 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24105 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24106 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24107 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24108 @item show debug dwarf-read
24109 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24110 @item set debug displaced
24111 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24112 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24113 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24114 @item show debug displaced
24115 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24116 related to displaced stepping.
24117 @item set debug event
24118 @cindex event debugging info
24119 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24120 default is off.
24121 @item show debug event
24122 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24123 info.
24124 @item set debug expression
24125 @cindex expression debugging info
24126 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24127 expression parsing. The default is off.
24128 @item show debug expression
24129 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24130 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24131 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24132 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24133 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24134 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24135 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24136 @item set debug frame
24137 @cindex frame debugging info
24138 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24139 default is off.
24140 @item show debug frame
24141 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24142 info.
24143 @item set debug gnu-nat
24144 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24145 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24146 @item show debug gnu-nat
24147 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24148 @item set debug infrun
24149 @cindex inferior debugging info
24150 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24151 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24152 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24153 @item show debug infrun
24154 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24155 @item set debug jit
24156 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24157 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24158 @item show debug jit
24159 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24160 @item set debug lin-lwp
24161 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24162 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24163 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24164 @item show debug lin-lwp
24165 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24166 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24167 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24168 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24169 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24170 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24171 @item set debug mach-o
24172 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24173 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24174 processing. The default is off.
24175 @item show debug mach-o
24176 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24177 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24178 @item set debug notification
24179 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24180 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24181 The default is off.
24182 @item show debug notification
24183 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24184 @item set debug observer
24185 @cindex observer debugging info
24186 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24187 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24188 @item show debug observer
24189 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24190 @item set debug overload
24191 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24192 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24193 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24194 is off.
24195 @item show debug overload
24196 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24197 debugging info.
24198 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24199 @cindex debug expression parser
24200 @item set debug parser
24201 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24202 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24203 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24204 details. The default is off.
24205 @item show debug parser
24206 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24207 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24208 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24209 @cindex debug remote protocol
24210 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24211 @cindex display remote packets
24212 @item set debug remote
24213 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24214 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24215 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24216 @item show debug remote
24217 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24218
24219 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24220 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24221 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24222 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24223
24224 @item set debug serial
24225 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24226 default is off.
24227 @item show debug serial
24228 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24229 info.
24230 @item set debug solib-frv
24231 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24232 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24233 @item show debug solib-frv
24234 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24235 messages.
24236 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24237 @cindex symbol lookup
24238 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24239 The default is 0 (off).
24240 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24241 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24242 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24243 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24244 @item set debug symfile
24245 @cindex symbol file functions
24246 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24247 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24248 @item show debug symfile
24249 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24250 @item set debug symtab-create
24251 @cindex symbol table creation
24252 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24253 The default is 0 (off).
24254 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24255 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24256 @item show debug symtab-create
24257 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24258 @item set debug target
24259 @cindex target debugging info
24260 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24261 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24262 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24263 value of large memory transfers.
24264 @item show debug target
24265 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24266 info.
24267 @item set debug timestamp
24268 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24269 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24270 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24271 message.
24272 @item show debug timestamp
24273 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24274 debugging info.
24275 @item set debug varobj
24276 @cindex variable object debugging info
24277 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24278 info. The default is off.
24279 @item show debug varobj
24280 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24281 debugging info.
24282 @item set debug xml
24283 @cindex XML parser debugging
24284 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24285 @item show debug xml
24286 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24287 @end table
24288
24289 @node Other Misc Settings
24290 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24291 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24292
24293 @table @code
24294 @kindex set interactive-mode
24295 @item set interactive-mode
24296 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24297 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24298 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24299 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24300 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24301 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24302 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24303 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24304
24305 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24306 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24307 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24308 inside a cygwin window.
24309
24310 @kindex show interactive-mode
24311 @item show interactive-mode
24312 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24313 @end table
24314
24315 @node Extending GDB
24316 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24317 @cindex extending GDB
24318
24319 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24320 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24321 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24322 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24323 being debugged.
24324
24325 @menu
24326 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24327 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24328 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24329 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24330 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24331 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24332 @end menu
24333
24334 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24335 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24336 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24337 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24338 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24339 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24340
24341 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24342 setting:
24343
24344 @table @code
24345 @kindex set script-extension
24346 @kindex show script-extension
24347 @item set script-extension off
24348 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24349
24350 @item set script-extension soft
24351 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24352 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24353 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24354 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24355
24356 @item set script-extension strict
24357 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24358 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24359 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24360
24361 @item show script-extension
24362 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24363
24364 @end table
24365
24366 @node Sequences
24367 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24368
24369 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24370 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24371 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24372 files.
24373
24374 @menu
24375 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24376 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24377 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24378 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24379 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24380 @end menu
24381
24382 @node Define
24383 @subsection User-defined Commands
24384
24385 @cindex user-defined command
24386 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24387 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24388 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24389 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24390 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24391 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24392
24393 @smallexample
24394 define adder
24395 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24396 end
24397 @end smallexample
24398
24399 @noindent
24400 To execute the command use:
24401
24402 @smallexample
24403 adder 1 2 3
24404 @end smallexample
24405
24406 @noindent
24407 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24408 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24409 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24410 functions calls.
24411
24412 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24413 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24414 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24415 been passed.
24416
24417 @smallexample
24418 define adder
24419 if $argc == 2
24420 print $arg0 + $arg1
24421 end
24422 if $argc == 3
24423 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24424 end
24425 end
24426 @end smallexample
24427
24428 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24429 to process a variable number of arguments:
24430
24431 @smallexample
24432 define adder
24433 set $i = 0
24434 set $sum = 0
24435 while $i < $argc
24436 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24437 set $i = $i + 1
24438 end
24439 print $sum
24440 end
24441 @end smallexample
24442
24443 @table @code
24444
24445 @kindex define
24446 @item define @var{commandname}
24447 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24448 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24449 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24450 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24451 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24452 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24453
24454 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24455 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24456 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24457
24458 @kindex document
24459 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24460 @item document @var{commandname}
24461 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24462 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24463 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24464 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24465 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24466 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24467
24468 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24469 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24470 does not change the documentation.
24471
24472 @kindex dont-repeat
24473 @cindex don't repeat command
24474 @item dont-repeat
24475 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24476 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24477 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24478
24479 @kindex help user-defined
24480 @item help user-defined
24481 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24482 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24483 included (if any).
24484
24485 @kindex show user
24486 @item show user
24487 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24488 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24489 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24490 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24491 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24492
24493 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24494 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24495 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24496 @item show max-user-call-depth
24497 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24498 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24499 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24500 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24501 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24502 @end table
24503
24504 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24505 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24506
24507 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24508 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24509 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24510
24511 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24512 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24513 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24514 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24515
24516 @node Hooks
24517 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24518 @cindex command hooks
24519 @cindex hooks, for commands
24520 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24521
24522 @kindex hook
24523 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24524 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24525 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24526 before that command.
24527
24528 @cindex hooks, post-command
24529 @kindex hookpost
24530 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24531 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24532 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24533 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24534 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24535
24536 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24537 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24538
24539 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24540 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24541
24542 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24543 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24544 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24545 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24546 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24547
24548 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24549 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24550 you could define:
24551
24552 @smallexample
24553 define hook-stop
24554 handle SIGALRM nopass
24555 end
24556
24557 define hook-run
24558 handle SIGALRM pass
24559 end
24560
24561 define hook-continue
24562 handle SIGALRM pass
24563 end
24564 @end smallexample
24565
24566 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24567 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24568 you could define:
24569
24570 @smallexample
24571 define hook-echo
24572 echo <<<---
24573 end
24574
24575 define hookpost-echo
24576 echo --->>>\n
24577 end
24578
24579 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24580 <<<---Hello World--->>>
24581 (@value{GDBP})
24582
24583 @end smallexample
24584
24585 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24586 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24587 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24588 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24589 @c or not?
24590 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24591 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24592 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24593
24594 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24595 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24596 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24597
24598 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24599 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24600
24601 @node Command Files
24602 @subsection Command Files
24603
24604 @cindex command files
24605 @cindex scripting commands
24606 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24607 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24608 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24609 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24610 terminal.
24611
24612 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24613 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24614 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
24615 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24616 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24617
24618 @table @code
24619 @kindex source
24620 @cindex execute commands from a file
24621 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24622 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24623 @end table
24624
24625 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24626 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24627 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
24628 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
24629 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24630
24631 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24632 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24633 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24634 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24635 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24636 is not relevant to scripts.
24637
24638 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24639 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24640 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24641 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24642 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24643 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24644 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24645 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24646 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24647 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24648 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24649 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
24650 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24651 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24652
24653 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24654 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
24655 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24656
24657 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24658 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24659 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24660 when called from command files.
24661
24662 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24663 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24664 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24665 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24666 the next command.
24667
24668 @smallexample
24669 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24670 @end smallexample
24671
24672 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24673 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24674 would be directed to @file{log}.
24675
24676 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24677 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24678 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24679 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24680 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24681 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24682 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24683 conditionally, etc.
24684
24685 @table @code
24686 @kindex if
24687 @kindex else
24688 @item if
24689 @itemx else
24690 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24691 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24692 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24693 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24694 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24695 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24696 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24697
24698 @kindex while
24699 @item while
24700 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24701 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24702 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24703 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24704 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24705 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24706
24707 @kindex loop_break
24708 @item loop_break
24709 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24710 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24711 line.
24712
24713 @kindex loop_continue
24714 @item loop_continue
24715 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24716 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24717 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24718 the controlling expression.
24719
24720 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24721 @item end
24722 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24723 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24724 @end table
24725
24726
24727 @node Output
24728 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24729
24730 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24731 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24732 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24733 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24734 want.
24735
24736 @table @code
24737 @kindex echo
24738 @item echo @var{text}
24739 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24740 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24741 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24742 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24743 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24744 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24745 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24746 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24747 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24748 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24749 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24750
24751 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24752 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24753
24754 @smallexample
24755 echo This is some text\n\
24756 which is continued\n\
24757 onto several lines.\n
24758 @end smallexample
24759
24760 produces the same output as
24761
24762 @smallexample
24763 echo This is some text\n
24764 echo which is continued\n
24765 echo onto several lines.\n
24766 @end smallexample
24767
24768 @kindex output
24769 @item output @var{expression}
24770 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24771 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24772 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24773 on expressions.
24774
24775 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24776 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24777 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24778 Formats}, for more information.
24779
24780 @kindex printf
24781 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24782 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24783 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24784 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24785 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24786 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24787 executing the code below:
24788
24789 @smallexample
24790 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24791 @end smallexample
24792
24793 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24794 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24795 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24796 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24797 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24798 printed.
24799
24800 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24801
24802 @smallexample
24803 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24804 @end smallexample
24805
24806 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24807 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24808 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24809
24810 @itemize @bullet
24811 @item
24812 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24813
24814 @item
24815 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24816 width.
24817
24818 @item
24819 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24820 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24821
24822 @item
24823 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24824 supported.
24825
24826 @item
24827 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24828
24829 @item
24830 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24831 @end itemize
24832
24833 @noindent
24834 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24835 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24836 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24837 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24838
24839 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24840 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24841 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24842 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24843 supported.
24844
24845 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24846 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24847 together with a floating point specifier.
24848 letters:
24849
24850 @itemize @bullet
24851 @item
24852 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24853
24854 @item
24855 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24856
24857 @item
24858 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24859 @end itemize
24860
24861 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24862 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24863 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24864
24865 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24866 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24867
24868 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24869 @smallexample
24870 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24871 @end smallexample
24872
24873 @anchor{eval}
24874 @kindex eval
24875 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24876 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24877 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24878
24879 @end table
24880
24881 @node Auto-loading sequences
24882 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24883 @cindex native script auto-loading
24884
24885 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24886 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24887 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24888 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24889
24890 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24891 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24892
24893 @table @code
24894 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24895 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24896 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24897 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24898
24899 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24900 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24901 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24902 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24903 disabled.
24904
24905 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24906 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24907 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24908 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24909 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24910 auto-loaded.
24911 @end table
24912
24913 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24914 matching names are printed.
24915
24916 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24917 @include python.texi
24918
24919 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24920 @include guile.texi
24921
24922 @node Auto-loading extensions
24923 @section Auto-loading extensions
24924 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24925
24926 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24927 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24928 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24929 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24930 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24931
24932 @menu
24933 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24934 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24935 * Which flavor to choose?::
24936 @end menu
24937
24938 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24939 debugging commands and features.
24940
24941 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24942 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24943 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24944 for more information.
24945 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24946 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24947
24948 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24949 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24950
24951 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24952 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24953 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24954 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24955 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24956
24957 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24958 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24959 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24960 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24961
24962 @table @code
24963 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24964 GDB's own command language
24965 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24966 Python
24967 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24968 Guile
24969 @end table
24970
24971 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24972 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24973 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24974 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24975 script in the specified extension language.
24976
24977 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24978 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24979
24980 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24981 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24982
24983 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24984 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24985 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24986 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24987 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24988 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24989
24990 @table @code
24991 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24992 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24993 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24994 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24995 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24996 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24997
24998 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24999 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25000
25001 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25002 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25003 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25004 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25005
25006 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25007 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25008 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25009 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25010 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25011 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25012 platform.
25013
25014 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25015 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25016 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25017
25018 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25019 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25020 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25021 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25022
25023 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25024 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25025 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25026 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25027 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25028 @end table
25029
25030 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25031 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25032 @var{objfile} is opened.
25033 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25034 is evaluated more than once.
25035
25036 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25037 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25038 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25039
25040 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25041 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25042 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25043 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25044 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25045 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25046 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25047
25048 The following entries are supported:
25049
25050 @table @code
25051 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25052 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25053 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25054 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25055 @end table
25056
25057 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25058
25059 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25060 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25061 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25062 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25063 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25064
25065 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25066 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25067
25068 @example
25069 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25070 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25071 asm("\
25072 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25073 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25074 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25075 .popsection \n\
25076 ");
25077 @end example
25078
25079 @noindent
25080 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25081 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25082
25083 @example
25084 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25085 @end example
25086
25087 The script name may include directories if desired.
25088
25089 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25090 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25091
25092 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25093 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25094 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25095 will remove duplicates.
25096
25097 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25098
25099 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25100 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25101 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25102 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25103 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25104 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25105 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25106 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25107 on its name.
25108
25109 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25110 testsuite.
25111
25112 @example
25113 #include "symcat.h"
25114 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25115 asm(
25116 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25117 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25118 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25119 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25120 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25121 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25122 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25123 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25124 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25125 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25126 ".byte 0\n"
25127 ".popsection\n"
25128 );
25129 @end example
25130
25131 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25132 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25133 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25134 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25135
25136 @node Which flavor to choose?
25137 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25138
25139 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25140 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25141
25142 @noindent
25143 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25144
25145 @itemize @bullet
25146 @item
25147 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25148
25149 @item
25150 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25151
25152 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25153 in the source search path.
25154 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25155 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25156
25157 @item
25158 Doesn't require source code additions.
25159 @end itemize
25160
25161 @noindent
25162 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25163
25164 @itemize @bullet
25165 @item
25166 Works with static linking.
25167
25168 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25169 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25170 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25171 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25172 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25173
25174 @item
25175 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25176
25177 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25178 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25179
25180 @item
25181 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25182
25183 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25184 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25185 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25186 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25187 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25188 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25189 @end itemize
25190
25191 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25192 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25193
25194 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25195 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25196 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25197
25198 @subsection Python comes first
25199
25200 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25201 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25202 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25203 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25204 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25205 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25206 pretty-printed form of a value).
25207 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25208 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25209 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25210
25211 @node Aliases
25212 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25213 @cindex aliases for commands
25214
25215 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25216 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25217 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25218 that involves less typing.
25219
25220 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25221 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25222 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25223
25224 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25225 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25226 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25227
25228 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25229
25230 @table @code
25231
25232 @kindex alias
25233 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25234
25235 @end table
25236
25237 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25238 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25239 underscores.
25240
25241 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25242 that is being aliased.
25243
25244 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25245 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25246 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25247
25248 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25249 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25250
25251 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25252 of a command so that there is less to type.
25253 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25254 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25255 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25256 The following will accomplish this.
25257
25258 @smallexample
25259 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25260 @end smallexample
25261
25262 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25263 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25264 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25265 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25266
25267 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25268 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25269 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25270 of a command.
25271
25272 @smallexample
25273 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25274 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25275 (gdb) set p elms 20
25276 (gdb) show p elms
25277 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25278 @end smallexample
25279
25280 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25281 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25282 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25283
25284 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25285 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25286
25287 @smallexample
25288 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25289 @end smallexample
25290
25291 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25292 alias for a more complex command.
25293 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25294
25295 @smallexample
25296 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25297 (gdb) spe 20
25298 @end smallexample
25299
25300 @node Interpreters
25301 @chapter Command Interpreters
25302 @cindex command interpreters
25303
25304 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25305 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25306 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25307
25308 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25309 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25310 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25311 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25312
25313 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25314 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25315 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25316 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25317
25318 @table @code
25319 @item console
25320 @cindex console interpreter
25321 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25322 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25323 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25324
25325 @item mi
25326 @cindex mi interpreter
25327 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25328 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25329 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25330 Interface}.
25331
25332 @item mi2
25333 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25334 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25335
25336 @item mi1
25337 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25338 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25339
25340 @end table
25341
25342 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25343
25344 @kindex interpreter-exec
25345 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25346 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25347 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25348
25349 @smallexample
25350 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25351 @end smallexample
25352
25353 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25354 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25355
25356 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25357 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25358 permanently.
25359
25360 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25361
25362 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25363 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25364 device (usually a tty).
25365
25366 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25367 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25368 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25369 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25370 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25371 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25372 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25373 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25374 the separate MI interpreter.
25375
25376 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25377 @code{new-ui} command:
25378
25379 @kindex new-ui
25380 @cindex new user interface
25381 @smallexample
25382 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25383 @end smallexample
25384
25385 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25386 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25387 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25388 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25389 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25390 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25391
25392 @smallexample
25393 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25394 @end smallexample
25395
25396 @noindent
25397 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25398
25399 @node TUI
25400 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25401 @cindex TUI
25402 @cindex Text User Interface
25403
25404 @menu
25405 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25406 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25407 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25408 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25409 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25410 @end menu
25411
25412 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25413 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25414 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25415 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25416 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25417 is available.
25418
25419 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25420 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25421 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25422 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25423 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25424 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25425
25426 @node TUI Overview
25427 @section TUI Overview
25428
25429 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25430
25431 @table @emph
25432 @item command
25433 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25434 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25435 managed using readline.
25436
25437 @item source
25438 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25439 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25440
25441 @item assembly
25442 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25443
25444 @item register
25445 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25446 when their values change.
25447 @end table
25448
25449 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25450 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25451 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25452 indicates the breakpoint type:
25453
25454 @table @code
25455 @item B
25456 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25457
25458 @item b
25459 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25460
25461 @item H
25462 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25463
25464 @item h
25465 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25466 @end table
25467
25468 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25469
25470 @table @code
25471 @item +
25472 Breakpoint is enabled.
25473
25474 @item -
25475 Breakpoint is disabled.
25476 @end table
25477
25478 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25479 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25480 changes.
25481
25482 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25483 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25484 layouts:
25485
25486 @itemize @bullet
25487 @item
25488 source only,
25489
25490 @item
25491 assembly only,
25492
25493 @item
25494 source and assembly,
25495
25496 @item
25497 source and registers, or
25498
25499 @item
25500 assembly and registers.
25501 @end itemize
25502
25503 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25504
25505 @table @emph
25506 @item target
25507 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25508 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25509
25510 @item process
25511 Gives the current process or thread number.
25512 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25513
25514 @item function
25515 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25516 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25517 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25518 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25519
25520 @item line
25521 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25522 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25523
25524 @item pc
25525 Indicates the current program counter address.
25526 @end table
25527
25528 @node TUI Keys
25529 @section TUI Key Bindings
25530 @cindex TUI key bindings
25531
25532 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25533 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25534 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25535 @end ifset
25536 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25537 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25538 @end ifclear
25539 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25540 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25541
25542 @table @kbd
25543 @kindex C-x C-a
25544 @item C-x C-a
25545 @kindex C-x a
25546 @itemx C-x a
25547 @kindex C-x A
25548 @itemx C-x A
25549 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25550 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25551 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25552 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25553 The screen is then refreshed.
25554
25555 @kindex C-x 1
25556 @item C-x 1
25557 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25558 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25559 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25560
25561 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25562
25563 @kindex C-x 2
25564 @item C-x 2
25565 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25566 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25567 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25568 previous layout and the new one.
25569
25570 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25571
25572 @kindex C-x o
25573 @item C-x o
25574 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25575 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
25576 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25577
25578 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25579
25580 @kindex C-x s
25581 @item C-x s
25582 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25583 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25584 @end table
25585
25586 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25587
25588 @table @asis
25589 @kindex PgUp
25590 @item @key{PgUp}
25591 Scroll the active window one page up.
25592
25593 @kindex PgDn
25594 @item @key{PgDn}
25595 Scroll the active window one page down.
25596
25597 @kindex Up
25598 @item @key{Up}
25599 Scroll the active window one line up.
25600
25601 @kindex Down
25602 @item @key{Down}
25603 Scroll the active window one line down.
25604
25605 @kindex Left
25606 @item @key{Left}
25607 Scroll the active window one column left.
25608
25609 @kindex Right
25610 @item @key{Right}
25611 Scroll the active window one column right.
25612
25613 @kindex C-L
25614 @item @kbd{C-L}
25615 Refresh the screen.
25616 @end table
25617
25618 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25619 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25620 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25621 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25622 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25623
25624 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25625 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25626 @cindex TUI single key mode
25627
25628 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25629 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25630 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25631
25632 @table @kbd
25633 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25634 @item c
25635 continue
25636
25637 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25638 @item d
25639 down
25640
25641 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25642 @item f
25643 finish
25644
25645 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25646 @item n
25647 next
25648
25649 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25650 @item o
25651 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
25652
25653 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25654 @item q
25655 exit the SingleKey mode.
25656
25657 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25658 @item r
25659 run
25660
25661 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25662 @item s
25663 step
25664
25665 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25666 @item i
25667 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
25668
25669 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25670 @item u
25671 up
25672
25673 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25674 @item v
25675 info locals
25676
25677 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25678 @item w
25679 where
25680 @end table
25681
25682 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25683 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25684 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25685 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25686 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25687 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25688
25689
25690 @node TUI Commands
25691 @section TUI-specific Commands
25692 @cindex TUI commands
25693
25694 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25695 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25696 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25697 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25698
25699 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25700 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25701 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25702 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25703 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25704
25705 @table @code
25706 @item tui enable
25707 @kindex tui enable
25708 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25709 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25710 otherwise a default layout is used.
25711
25712 @item tui disable
25713 @kindex tui disable
25714 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25715
25716 @item info win
25717 @kindex info win
25718 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25719
25720 @item layout @var{name}
25721 @kindex layout
25722 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25723 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25724 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25725
25726 @table @code
25727 @item next
25728 Display the next layout.
25729
25730 @item prev
25731 Display the previous layout.
25732
25733 @item src
25734 Display the source and command windows.
25735
25736 @item asm
25737 Display the assembly and command windows.
25738
25739 @item split
25740 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25741
25742 @item regs
25743 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25744 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25745 register, assembler, and command windows.
25746 @end table
25747
25748 @item focus @var{name}
25749 @kindex focus
25750 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25751 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25752
25753 @table @code
25754 @item next
25755 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25756
25757 @item prev
25758 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25759
25760 @item src
25761 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25762
25763 @item asm
25764 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25765
25766 @item regs
25767 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25768
25769 @item cmd
25770 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25771 @end table
25772
25773 @item refresh
25774 @kindex refresh
25775 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25776
25777 @item tui reg @var{group}
25778 @kindex tui reg
25779 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25780 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25781 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25782 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25783 following groups are available on most targets:
25784 @table @code
25785 @item next
25786 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25787 through all of the available register groups.
25788
25789 @item prev
25790 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25791 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25792 @var{next}.
25793
25794 @item general
25795 Display the general registers.
25796 @item float
25797 Display the floating point registers.
25798 @item system
25799 Display the system registers.
25800 @item vector
25801 Display the vector registers.
25802 @item all
25803 Display all registers.
25804 @end table
25805
25806 @item update
25807 @kindex update
25808 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25809
25810 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25811 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25812 @kindex winheight
25813 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25814 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25815 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25816 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25817 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25818
25819 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25820 @kindex tabset
25821 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25822 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25823 assembly windows.
25824 @end table
25825
25826 @node TUI Configuration
25827 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25828 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25829
25830 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25831
25832 @table @code
25833 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25834 @kindex set tui border-kind
25835 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25836 The possible values are the following:
25837 @table @code
25838 @item space
25839 Use a space character to draw the border.
25840
25841 @item ascii
25842 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25843
25844 @item acs
25845 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25846 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25847 @end table
25848
25849 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25850 @kindex set tui border-mode
25851 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25852 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25853 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25854 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25855 @table @code
25856 @item normal
25857 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25858
25859 @item standout
25860 Use standout mode.
25861
25862 @item reverse
25863 Use reverse video mode.
25864
25865 @item half
25866 Use half bright mode.
25867
25868 @item half-standout
25869 Use half bright and standout mode.
25870
25871 @item bold
25872 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25873
25874 @item bold-standout
25875 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25876 @end table
25877 @end table
25878
25879 @node Emacs
25880 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25881
25882 @cindex Emacs
25883 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25884 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25885 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25886 @value{GDBN}.
25887
25888 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25889 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25890 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25891 created Emacs buffer.
25892 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25893
25894 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25895 things:
25896
25897 @itemize @bullet
25898 @item
25899 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25900 the GUD buffer.
25901
25902 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25903 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25904
25905 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25906 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25907 in this way.
25908
25909 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25910 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25911 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25912 stop.
25913
25914 @item
25915 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25916
25917 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25918 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25919 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25920 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25921 and the source.
25922
25923 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25924 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25925 @end itemize
25926
25927 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25928 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25929 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25930 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25931
25932 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25933 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25934 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25935 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25936 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25937 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25938 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25939 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25940 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25941
25942 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25943 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25944 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25945 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25946
25947 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25948 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25949 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25950 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25951 one you want.
25952
25953 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25954 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25955
25956 @table @kbd
25957 @item C-h m
25958 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25959
25960 @item C-c C-s
25961 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25962 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25963
25964 @item C-c C-n
25965 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25966 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25967 to show the current file and location.
25968
25969 @item C-c C-i
25970 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25971 display window accordingly.
25972
25973 @item C-c C-f
25974 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25975 @code{finish} command.
25976
25977 @item C-c C-r
25978 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25979 command.
25980
25981 @item C-c <
25982 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25983 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25984 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25985
25986 @item C-c >
25987 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25988 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25989 @end table
25990
25991 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25992 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25993
25994 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25995 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25996 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25997 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25998 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25999 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26000 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26001
26002 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26003 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26004 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26005 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26006 frame.
26007
26008 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26009 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26010 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26011 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26012 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26013 to correspond properly with the code.
26014
26015 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26016 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26017 Emacs Manual}).
26018
26019 @node GDB/MI
26020 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26021
26022 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26023
26024 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26025 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26026 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26027 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26028 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26029 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26030
26031 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26032 in the form of a reference manual.
26033
26034 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26035 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26036 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26037
26038 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26039
26040 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26041 This chapter uses the following notation:
26042
26043 @itemize @bullet
26044 @item
26045 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26046
26047 @item
26048 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26049 it may or may not be given.
26050
26051 @item
26052 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26053 may repeat zero or more times.
26054
26055 @item
26056 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26057 may repeat one or more times.
26058
26059 @item
26060 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26061 @end itemize
26062
26063 @ignore
26064 @heading Dependencies
26065 @end ignore
26066
26067 @menu
26068 * GDB/MI General Design::
26069 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26070 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26071 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26072 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26073 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26074 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26075 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26076 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26077 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26078 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26079 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26080 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26081 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26082 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26083 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26084 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26085 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26086 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26087 @ignore
26088 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26089 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26090 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26091 @end ignore
26092 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26093 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26094 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26095 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26096 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26097 @end menu
26098
26099 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26100 @node GDB/MI General Design
26101 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26102 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26103
26104 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26105 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26106 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26107 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26108 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26109 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26110 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26111 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26112 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26113 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26114
26115 The important examples of notifications are:
26116 @itemize @bullet
26117
26118 @item
26119 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26120 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26121 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26122 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26123 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26124 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26125 command itself was successfully executed.
26126
26127 @item
26128 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26129 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26130 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26131 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26132 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26133 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26134
26135 @item
26136 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26137 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26138 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26139 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26140 orthogonal frontend design.
26141
26142 @end itemize
26143
26144 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26145 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26146 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26147 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26148 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26149 the user interface.
26150
26151
26152 @menu
26153 * Context management::
26154 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26155 * Thread groups::
26156 @end menu
26157
26158 @node Context management
26159 @subsection Context management
26160
26161 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26162
26163 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26164 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26165 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26166 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26167 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26168 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26169 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26170 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26171 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26172
26173 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26174 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26175 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26176 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26177 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26178 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26179 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26180 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26181 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26182 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26183 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26184
26185 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26186 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26187 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26188 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26189 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26190 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26191 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26192 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26193 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26194 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26195
26196 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26197 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26198 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26199 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26200 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26201 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26202 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26203 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26204 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26205 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26206 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26207 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26208 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26209 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26210 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26211 @samp{--frame} options.
26212
26213 @subsubsection Language
26214
26215 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26216 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26217 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26218 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26219 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26220 For instance:
26221
26222 @smallexample
26223 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26224 ^done,value="4"
26225 (gdb)
26226 @end smallexample
26227
26228 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26229 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26230 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26231
26232 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26233 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26234
26235 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26236 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26237 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26238 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26239 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26240 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26241 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26242 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26243 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26244
26245 @table @code
26246 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26247 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26248 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26249
26250 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26251 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26252 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26253
26254 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26255 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26256 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26257 MI commands even while the target is running.
26258
26259 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26260 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26261 @end table
26262
26263 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26264 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26265 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26266 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26267 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26268 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26269
26270 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26271 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26272 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26273 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26274 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26275 are running.
26276
26277 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26278 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26279 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26280 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26281 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26282 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26283 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26284 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26285 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26286 @samp{--thread} option).
26287
26288 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26289 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26290 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26291 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26292
26293 @node Thread groups
26294 @subsection Thread groups
26295 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26296 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26297 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26298 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26299 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26300
26301 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26302 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26303 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26304 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26305 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26306 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26307 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26308 into processes.
26309
26310 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26311 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26312 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26313 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26314 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26315 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26316 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26317 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26318 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26319 the members of specific thread group.
26320
26321 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26322 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26323 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26324 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26325 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26326 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26327 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26328 after attaching to that thread group.
26329
26330 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26331 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26332 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26333 such thread groups.
26334
26335 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26336 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26337 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26338
26339 @menu
26340 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26341 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26342 @end menu
26343
26344 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26345 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26346
26347 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26348 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26349 @table @code
26350 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26351 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26352
26353 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26354 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26355 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26356
26357 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26358 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26359 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26360
26361 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26362 "any sequence of digits"
26363
26364 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26365 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26366
26367 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26368 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26369
26370 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26371 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26372
26373 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26374 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26375 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26376
26377 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26378 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26379
26380 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26381 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26382 @end table
26383
26384 @noindent
26385 Notes:
26386
26387 @itemize @bullet
26388 @item
26389 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26390 output is described below.
26391
26392 @item
26393 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26394 finishes.
26395
26396 @item
26397 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26398 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26399 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26400 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26401 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26402 @end itemize
26403
26404 Pragmatics:
26405
26406 @itemize @bullet
26407 @item
26408 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26409
26410 @item
26411 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26412 @end itemize
26413
26414 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26415 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26416
26417 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26418 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26419 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26420 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26421 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26422 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26423
26424 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26425 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26426 @var{token}.
26427
26428 @table @code
26429 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26430 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26431
26432 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26433 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26434
26435 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26436 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26437
26438 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26439 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26440
26441 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26442 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26443
26444 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26445 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26446
26447 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26448 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26449
26450 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26451 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26452
26453 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26454 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26455
26456 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26457 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26458 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26459
26460 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26461 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26462
26463 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26464 @code{ @var{string} }
26465
26466 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26467 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26468
26469 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26470 @code{@var{c-string}}
26471
26472 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26473 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26474
26475 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26476 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26477 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26478
26479 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26480 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26481
26482 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26483 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26484
26485 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26486 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26487
26488 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26489 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26490
26491 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26492 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26493
26494 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26495 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26496 @end table
26497
26498 @noindent
26499 Notes:
26500
26501 @itemize @bullet
26502 @item
26503 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26504
26505 @item
26506 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26507 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26508 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26509 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26510 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26511 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26512 prior command.
26513
26514 @item
26515 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26516 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26517 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26518 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26519
26520 @item
26521 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26522 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26523 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26524 @samp{*}.
26525
26526 @item
26527 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26528 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26529 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26530 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26531
26532 @item
26533 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26534 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26535 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26536 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26537
26538 @item
26539 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26540 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26541 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26542
26543 @item
26544 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26545 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26546 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26547 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26548
26549 @item
26550 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26551 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26552 @var{values}.
26553
26554
26555 @end itemize
26556
26557 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26558 details about the various output records.
26559
26560 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26561 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26562 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26563
26564 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26565 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26566
26567 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26568 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26569 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26570 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26571 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26572 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26573
26574 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26575 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26576 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26577
26578 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26579 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26580 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26581 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26582
26583 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26584 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26585
26586 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26587 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
26588 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
26589 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26590 might change.
26591
26592 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26593 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
26594 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26595 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26596
26597 @itemize @bullet
26598 @item
26599 New MI commands may be added.
26600
26601 @item
26602 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26603
26604 @item
26605 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26606 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26607
26608 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26609 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
26610
26611 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
26612 @c resolve inconsistencies.
26613 @end itemize
26614
26615 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26616 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
26617 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
26618 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26619 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26620
26621 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26622 @c version?
26623
26624 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26625 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26626 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26627 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26628 @cindex mailing lists
26629
26630 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26631 @node GDB/MI Output Records
26632 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26633
26634 @menu
26635 * GDB/MI Result Records::
26636 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
26637 * GDB/MI Async Records::
26638 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26639 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
26640 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
26641 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26642 @end menu
26643
26644 @node GDB/MI Result Records
26645 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26646
26647 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26648 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26649 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26650 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26651
26652 @table @code
26653 @findex ^done
26654 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26655 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26656 values.
26657
26658 @item "^running"
26659 @findex ^running
26660 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
26661 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26662 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26663 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26664 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26665 which threads are resumed.
26666
26667 @item "^connected"
26668 @findex ^connected
26669 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26670
26671 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26672 @findex ^error
26673 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26674 the corresponding error message.
26675
26676 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26677 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26678 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
26679
26680 @table @samp
26681 @item "undefined-command"
26682 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26683 @end table
26684
26685 @item "^exit"
26686 @findex ^exit
26687 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
26688
26689 @end table
26690
26691 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
26692 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26693
26694 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26695 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26696 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26697 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
26698 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26699
26700 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26701 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26702 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26703 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26704 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26705
26706 @table @code
26707 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26708 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26709 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26710
26711 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26712 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26713 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26714 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26715
26716 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26717 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26718 internals.
26719 @end table
26720
26721 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26722 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26723
26724 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26725 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26726 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26727 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26728 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26729 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26730
26731 The following is the list of possible async records:
26732
26733 @table @code
26734
26735 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26736 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
26737 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26738 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
26739 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26740 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
26741 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
26742 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26743 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26744 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26745 it run freely.
26746
26747 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26748 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26749 following values:
26750
26751 @table @code
26752 @item breakpoint-hit
26753 A breakpoint was reached.
26754 @item watchpoint-trigger
26755 A watchpoint was triggered.
26756 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26757 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26758 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26759 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26760 @item function-finished
26761 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26762 @item location-reached
26763 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26764 @item watchpoint-scope
26765 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26766 @item end-stepping-range
26767 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26768 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26769 @item exited-signalled
26770 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26771 @item exited
26772 The inferior exited.
26773 @item exited-normally
26774 The inferior exited normally.
26775 @item signal-received
26776 A signal was received by the inferior.
26777 @item solib-event
26778 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26779 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26780 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26781 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26782 @item fork
26783 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26784 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26785 @item vfork
26786 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26787 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26788 @item syscall-entry
26789 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26790 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26791 @item syscall-return
26792 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26793 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26794 @item exec
26795 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26796 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26797 @end table
26798
26799 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26800 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26801 Depending on whether all-stop
26802 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26803 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26804 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26805 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26806 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26807 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26808 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26809 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26810 if such information is not available.
26811
26812 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26813 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26814 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26815 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26816 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26817 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26818 cannot be used in any way.
26819
26820 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26821 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26822 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26823 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26824 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26825 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26826
26827 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26828 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26829 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26830 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26831 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26832 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26833
26834 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26835 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26836 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26837 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26838 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26839
26840 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26841 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
26842 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26843 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26844 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26845 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26846 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26847 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
26848 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26849
26850 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26851 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26852
26853 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26854 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26855 that thread.
26856
26857 @item =library-loaded,...
26858 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26859 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26860 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
26861 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26862 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26863 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26864 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26865 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26866 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26867 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26868 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26869 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26870 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
26871 to this library.
26872
26873 @item =library-unloaded,...
26874 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26875 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26876 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26877 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26878 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26879 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26880 thread groups.
26881
26882 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26883 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26884 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26885 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26886 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26887
26888 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26889 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26890 initial value @var{initial}.
26891
26892 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26893 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26894 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26895 trace state variables are deleted.
26896
26897 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26898 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26899 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26900 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26901 value of trace state variable is known.
26902
26903 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26904 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26905 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26906 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26907 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26908 user.
26909
26910 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26911 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26912 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26913
26914 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26915 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26916
26917 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26918 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26919 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26920 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26921 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26922
26923 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
26924 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26925 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
26926 for existing method and format values.
26927
26928 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26929 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26930 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26931 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26932 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26933 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26934
26935 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26936 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26937 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26938 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26939 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26940 executable code.
26941 @end table
26942
26943 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26944 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26945
26946 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26947 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26948 following fields:
26949
26950 @table @code
26951 @item number
26952 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26953 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26954 @samp{1.2}.
26955
26956 @item type
26957 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26958 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26959
26960 @item catch-type
26961 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26962 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26963
26964 @item disp
26965 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26966 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26967 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26968
26969 @item enabled
26970 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26971 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26972 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26973
26974 @item addr
26975 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26976 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26977 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26978 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26979 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26980
26981 @item func
26982 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26983 If not known, this field is not present.
26984
26985 @item filename
26986 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26987 If not known, this field is not present.
26988
26989 @item fullname
26990 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26991 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26992
26993 @item line
26994 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26995 If not known, this field is not present.
26996
26997 @item at
26998 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26999 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27000 by a symbol name.
27001
27002 @item pending
27003 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27004 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27005
27006 @item evaluated-by
27007 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27008 @samp{target}.
27009
27010 @item thread
27011 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27012 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27013
27014 @item task
27015 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27016 field will hold the task identifier.
27017
27018 @item cond
27019 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27020
27021 @item ignore
27022 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27023
27024 @item enable
27025 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27026
27027 @item traceframe-usage
27028 FIXME.
27029
27030 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27031 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27032
27033 @item mask
27034 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27035
27036 @item pass
27037 A tracepoint's pass count.
27038
27039 @item original-location
27040 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27041 This field is optional.
27042
27043 @item times
27044 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27045
27046 @item installed
27047 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27048 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27049 is not.
27050
27051 @item what
27052 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27053
27054 @end table
27055
27056 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27057 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27058
27059 @smallexample
27060 -> -break-insert main
27061 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27062 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27063 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27064 times="0"@}
27065 <- (gdb)
27066 @end smallexample
27067
27068 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27069 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27070
27071 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27072 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27073 fields:
27074
27075 @table @code
27076 @item level
27077 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27078 zero. This field is always present.
27079
27080 @item func
27081 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27082 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27083
27084 @item addr
27085 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27086
27087 @item file
27088 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27089 address. This field may be absent.
27090
27091 @item line
27092 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27093 may be absent.
27094
27095 @item from
27096 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27097 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27098
27099 @end table
27100
27101 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27102 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27103
27104 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27105 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27106 stated otherwise.
27107
27108 @table @code
27109 @item id
27110 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27111
27112 @item target-id
27113 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27114
27115 @item details
27116 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27117 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27118 frontend. This field is optional.
27119
27120 @item name
27121 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27122 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27123 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27124 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27125 field is omitted.
27126
27127 @item state
27128 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27129 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27130
27131 @item frame
27132 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27133 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27134 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27135
27136 @item core
27137 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27138 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27139 @end table
27140
27141 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27142 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27143
27144 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27145 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27146 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27147 the @code{exception-name} field.
27148
27149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27150 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27151 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27152 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27153
27154 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27155 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27156 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27157 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27158
27159 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27160 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27161
27162 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27163
27164 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27165 information of the breakpoint.
27166
27167 @smallexample
27168 -> -break-insert main
27169 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27170 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27171 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27172 times="0"@}
27173 <- (gdb)
27174 @end smallexample
27175
27176 @subheading Program Execution
27177
27178 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27179 reason that execution stopped.
27180
27181 @smallexample
27182 -> -exec-run
27183 <- ^running
27184 <- (gdb)
27185 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27186 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27187 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27188 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27189 <- (gdb)
27190 -> -exec-continue
27191 <- ^running
27192 <- (gdb)
27193 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27194 <- (gdb)
27195 @end smallexample
27196
27197 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27198
27199 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27200
27201 @smallexample
27202 -> (gdb)
27203 <- -gdb-exit
27204 <- ^exit
27205 @end smallexample
27206
27207 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27208 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27209 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27210 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27211 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27212 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27213
27214 @subheading A Bad Command
27215
27216 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27217
27218 @smallexample
27219 -> -rubbish
27220 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27221 <- (gdb)
27222 @end smallexample
27223
27224
27225 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27226 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27227 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27228
27229 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27230 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27231
27232 @subheading Motivation
27233
27234 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27235
27236 @subheading Introduction
27237
27238 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27239
27240 @subheading Commands
27241
27242 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27243
27244 @subsubheading Synopsis
27245
27246 @smallexample
27247 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27248 @end smallexample
27249
27250 @subsubheading Result
27251
27252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27253
27254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27255
27256 @subsubheading Example
27257
27258 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27259 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27260
27261
27262 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27263 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27264 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27265
27266 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27267 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27268 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27269 breakpoints.
27270
27271 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27272 @findex -break-after
27273
27274 @subsubheading Synopsis
27275
27276 @smallexample
27277 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27278 @end smallexample
27279
27280 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27281 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27282 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27283 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27284
27285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27286
27287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27288
27289 @subsubheading Example
27290
27291 @smallexample
27292 (gdb)
27293 -break-insert main
27294 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27295 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27296 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27297 times="0"@}
27298 (gdb)
27299 -break-after 1 3
27300 ~
27301 ^done
27302 (gdb)
27303 -break-list
27304 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27305 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27306 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27307 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27308 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27309 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27310 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27311 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27312 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27313 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27314 (gdb)
27315 @end smallexample
27316
27317 @ignore
27318 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27319 @findex -break-catch
27320 @end ignore
27321
27322 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27323 @findex -break-commands
27324
27325 @subsubheading Synopsis
27326
27327 @smallexample
27328 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27329 @end smallexample
27330
27331 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27332 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27333 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27334 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27335 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27336 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27337
27338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27339
27340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27341
27342 @subsubheading Example
27343
27344 @smallexample
27345 (gdb)
27346 -break-insert main
27347 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27348 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27349 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27350 times="0"@}
27351 (gdb)
27352 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27353 ^done
27354 (gdb)
27355 @end smallexample
27356
27357 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27358 @findex -break-condition
27359
27360 @subsubheading Synopsis
27361
27362 @smallexample
27363 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27364 @end smallexample
27365
27366 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27367 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27368 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27369 command below).
27370
27371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27372
27373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27374
27375 @subsubheading Example
27376
27377 @smallexample
27378 (gdb)
27379 -break-condition 1 1
27380 ^done
27381 (gdb)
27382 -break-list
27383 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27384 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27385 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27386 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27387 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27388 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27389 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27390 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27391 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27392 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27393 (gdb)
27394 @end smallexample
27395
27396 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27397 @findex -break-delete
27398
27399 @subsubheading Synopsis
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27403 @end smallexample
27404
27405 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27406 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27407
27408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27409
27410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27411
27412 @subsubheading Example
27413
27414 @smallexample
27415 (gdb)
27416 -break-delete 1
27417 ^done
27418 (gdb)
27419 -break-list
27420 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27421 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27422 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27423 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27424 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27425 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27426 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27427 body=[]@}
27428 (gdb)
27429 @end smallexample
27430
27431 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27432 @findex -break-disable
27433
27434 @subsubheading Synopsis
27435
27436 @smallexample
27437 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27438 @end smallexample
27439
27440 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27441 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27442
27443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27444
27445 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27446
27447 @subsubheading Example
27448
27449 @smallexample
27450 (gdb)
27451 -break-disable 2
27452 ^done
27453 (gdb)
27454 -break-list
27455 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27456 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27457 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27458 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27459 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27460 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27461 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27462 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27463 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27464 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27465 (gdb)
27466 @end smallexample
27467
27468 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27469 @findex -break-enable
27470
27471 @subsubheading Synopsis
27472
27473 @smallexample
27474 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27475 @end smallexample
27476
27477 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27478
27479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27480
27481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27482
27483 @subsubheading Example
27484
27485 @smallexample
27486 (gdb)
27487 -break-enable 2
27488 ^done
27489 (gdb)
27490 -break-list
27491 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27492 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27493 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27494 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27495 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27496 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27497 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27498 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27499 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27500 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27501 (gdb)
27502 @end smallexample
27503
27504 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27505 @findex -break-info
27506
27507 @subsubheading Synopsis
27508
27509 @smallexample
27510 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27511 @end smallexample
27512
27513 @c REDUNDANT???
27514 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27515
27516 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27517 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27518 table.
27519
27520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27521
27522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27523
27524 @subsubheading Example
27525 N.A.
27526
27527 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27528 @findex -break-insert
27529 @anchor{-break-insert}
27530
27531 @subsubheading Synopsis
27532
27533 @smallexample
27534 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27535 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27536 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27537 @end smallexample
27538
27539 @noindent
27540 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27541
27542 @table @var
27543 @item linespec location
27544 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27545
27546 @item explicit location
27547 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27548 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27549 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27550
27551 @table @samp
27552 @item --source @var{filename}
27553 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27554 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27555
27556 @item --function @var{function}
27557 The name of a function or method.
27558
27559 @item --label @var{label}
27560 The name of a label.
27561
27562 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27563 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27564 @end table
27565
27566 @item address location
27567 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27568 @end table
27569
27570 @noindent
27571 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27572
27573 @table @samp
27574 @item -t
27575 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27576 @item -h
27577 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27578 @item -f
27579 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27580 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27581 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27582 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27583 cannot be parsed.
27584 @item -d
27585 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27586 @item -a
27587 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
27588 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27589 @item -c @var{condition}
27590 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27591 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27592 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27593 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27594 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27595 @var{thread-id}.
27596 @end table
27597
27598 @subsubheading Result
27599
27600 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27601 resulting breakpoint.
27602
27603 Note: this format is open to change.
27604 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27605
27606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27607
27608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27609 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27610
27611 @subsubheading Example
27612
27613 @smallexample
27614 (gdb)
27615 -break-insert main
27616 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27617 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27618 times="0"@}
27619 (gdb)
27620 -break-insert -t foo
27621 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27622 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27623 times="0"@}
27624 (gdb)
27625 -break-list
27626 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27627 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27628 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27629 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27630 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27631 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27632 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27633 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27634 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27635 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27636 times="0"@},
27637 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27638 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27639 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27640 times="0"@}]@}
27641 (gdb)
27642 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
27643 @c ~int foo(int, int);
27644 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27645 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27646 @c times="0"@}
27647 @c (gdb)
27648 @end smallexample
27649
27650 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27651 @findex -dprintf-insert
27652
27653 @subsubheading Synopsis
27654
27655 @smallexample
27656 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27657 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27658 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27659 [ @var{argument} ]
27660 @end smallexample
27661
27662 @noindent
27663 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27664 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
27665
27666 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27667
27668 @table @samp
27669 @item -t
27670 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27671 @item -f
27672 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27673 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27674 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27675 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27676 cannot be parsed.
27677 @item -d
27678 Create a disabled breakpoint.
27679 @item -c @var{condition}
27680 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27681 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
27682 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27683 to @var{ignore-count}.
27684 @item -p @var{thread-id}
27685 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27686 @var{thread-id}.
27687 @end table
27688
27689 @subsubheading Result
27690
27691 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27692 resulting breakpoint.
27693
27694 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27695
27696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27697
27698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27699
27700 @subsubheading Example
27701
27702 @smallexample
27703 (gdb)
27704 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
27705 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27706 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27707 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27708 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27709 original-location="foo"@}
27710 (gdb)
27711 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
27712 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27713 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27714 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27715 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27716 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27717 (gdb)
27718 @end smallexample
27719
27720 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27721 @findex -break-list
27722
27723 @subsubheading Synopsis
27724
27725 @smallexample
27726 -break-list
27727 @end smallexample
27728
27729 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27730
27731 @table @samp
27732 @item Number
27733 number of the breakpoint
27734 @item Type
27735 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27736 @item Disposition
27737 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27738 or @samp{nokeep}
27739 @item Enabled
27740 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27741 @item Address
27742 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27743 @item What
27744 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27745 name, line number
27746 @item Thread-groups
27747 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27748 @item Times
27749 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27750 @end table
27751
27752 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27753 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27754
27755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27756
27757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27758
27759 @subsubheading Example
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 (gdb)
27763 -break-list
27764 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27765 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27766 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27767 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27768 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27769 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27770 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27771 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27772 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27773 times="0"@},
27774 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27775 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27776 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27777 (gdb)
27778 @end smallexample
27779
27780 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27781
27782 @smallexample
27783 (gdb)
27784 -break-list
27785 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27786 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27787 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27788 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27789 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27790 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27791 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27792 body=[]@}
27793 (gdb)
27794 @end smallexample
27795
27796 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27797 @findex -break-passcount
27798
27799 @subsubheading Synopsis
27800
27801 @smallexample
27802 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27803 @end smallexample
27804
27805 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27806 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27807 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27808 command @samp{passcount}.
27809
27810 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27811 @findex -break-watch
27812
27813 @subsubheading Synopsis
27814
27815 @smallexample
27816 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27817 @end smallexample
27818
27819 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27820 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27821 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27822 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27823 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27824 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27825 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27826 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27827
27828 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27829 breakpoints inserted.
27830
27831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27832
27833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27834 @samp{rwatch}.
27835
27836 @subsubheading Example
27837
27838 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27839
27840 @smallexample
27841 (gdb)
27842 -break-watch x
27843 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27844 (gdb)
27845 -exec-continue
27846 ^running
27847 (gdb)
27848 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27849 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27850 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27851 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27852 (gdb)
27853 @end smallexample
27854
27855 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27856 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27857 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27858
27859 @smallexample
27860 (gdb)
27861 -break-watch C
27862 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27863 (gdb)
27864 -exec-continue
27865 ^running
27866 (gdb)
27867 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27868 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27869 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27870 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27871 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27872 (gdb)
27873 -exec-continue
27874 ^running
27875 (gdb)
27876 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27877 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27878 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27879 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27880 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27881 (gdb)
27882 @end smallexample
27883
27884 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27885 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27886 deleted.
27887
27888 @smallexample
27889 (gdb)
27890 -break-watch C
27891 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27892 (gdb)
27893 -break-list
27894 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27895 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27896 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27897 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27898 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27899 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27900 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27901 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27902 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27903 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27904 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27905 times="1"@},
27906 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27907 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27908 (gdb)
27909 -exec-continue
27910 ^running
27911 (gdb)
27912 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27913 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27914 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27915 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27916 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27917 (gdb)
27918 -break-list
27919 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27920 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27921 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27922 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27923 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27924 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27925 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27926 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27927 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27928 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27929 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27930 times="1"@},
27931 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27932 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27933 (gdb)
27934 -exec-continue
27935 ^running
27936 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27937 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27938 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27939 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27940 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27941 (gdb)
27942 -break-list
27943 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27944 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27945 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27946 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27947 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27948 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27949 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27950 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27951 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27952 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27953 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27954 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27955 (gdb)
27956 @end smallexample
27957
27958
27959 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27960 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27961 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27962
27963 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27964 catchpoints.
27965
27966 @menu
27967 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27968 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27969 @end menu
27970
27971 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27972 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27973
27974 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27975 @findex -catch-load
27976
27977 @subsubheading Synopsis
27978
27979 @smallexample
27980 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27981 @end smallexample
27982
27983 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27984 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27985 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27986 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27987 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27988
27989
27990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27991
27992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27993
27994 @subsubheading Example
27995
27996 @smallexample
27997 -catch-load -t foo.so
27998 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27999 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28000 (gdb)
28001 @end smallexample
28002
28003
28004 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28005 @findex -catch-unload
28006
28007 @subsubheading Synopsis
28008
28009 @smallexample
28010 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28011 @end smallexample
28012
28013 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28014 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28015 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28016 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28017 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28018
28019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28020
28021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28022
28023 @subsubheading Example
28024
28025 @smallexample
28026 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28027 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28028 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28029 (gdb)
28030 @end smallexample
28031
28032 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28033 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28034
28035 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28036 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28037
28038 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28039 @findex -catch-assert
28040
28041 @subsubheading Synopsis
28042
28043 @smallexample
28044 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28045 @end smallexample
28046
28047 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28048
28049 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28050
28051 @table @samp
28052 @item -c @var{condition}
28053 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28054 @item -d
28055 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28056 @item -t
28057 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28058 @end table
28059
28060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28061
28062 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28063
28064 @subsubheading Example
28065
28066 @smallexample
28067 -catch-assert
28068 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28069 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28070 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28071 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28072 (gdb)
28073 @end smallexample
28074
28075 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28076 @findex -catch-exception
28077
28078 @subsubheading Synopsis
28079
28080 @smallexample
28081 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28082 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28083 @end smallexample
28084
28085 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28086 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28087 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28088 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28089 catchpoints.
28090
28091 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28092
28093 @table @samp
28094 @item -c @var{condition}
28095 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28096 @item -d
28097 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28098 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28099 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28100 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28101 @item -t
28102 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28103 @item -u
28104 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28105 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28106 @end table
28107
28108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28109
28110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28111 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28112
28113 @subsubheading Example
28114
28115 @smallexample
28116 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28117 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28118 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28119 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28120 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28121 (gdb)
28122 @end smallexample
28123
28124 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28125 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28126 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28127
28128 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28129 @findex -exec-arguments
28130
28131
28132 @subsubheading Synopsis
28133
28134 @smallexample
28135 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28136 @end smallexample
28137
28138 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28139 @samp{-exec-run}.
28140
28141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28142
28143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28144
28145 @subsubheading Example
28146
28147 @smallexample
28148 (gdb)
28149 -exec-arguments -v word
28150 ^done
28151 (gdb)
28152 @end smallexample
28153
28154
28155 @ignore
28156 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28157 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28158
28159 @subsubheading Synopsis
28160
28161 @smallexample
28162 -exec-show-arguments
28163 @end smallexample
28164
28165 Print the arguments of the program.
28166
28167 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28168
28169 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28170
28171 @subsubheading Example
28172 N.A.
28173 @end ignore
28174
28175
28176 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28177 @findex -environment-cd
28178
28179 @subsubheading Synopsis
28180
28181 @smallexample
28182 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28183 @end smallexample
28184
28185 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28186
28187 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28188
28189 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28190
28191 @subsubheading Example
28192
28193 @smallexample
28194 (gdb)
28195 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28196 ^done
28197 (gdb)
28198 @end smallexample
28199
28200
28201 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28202 @findex -environment-directory
28203
28204 @subsubheading Synopsis
28205
28206 @smallexample
28207 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28208 @end smallexample
28209
28210 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28211 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28212 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28213 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28214 occurs as normal.
28215 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28216 multiple directories in a single command
28217 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28218 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28219 If blanks are needed as
28220 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28221 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28222 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28223 character must not be used
28224 in any directory name.
28225 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28226
28227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28228
28229 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28230
28231 @subsubheading Example
28232
28233 @smallexample
28234 (gdb)
28235 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28236 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28237 (gdb)
28238 -environment-directory ""
28239 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28240 (gdb)
28241 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28242 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28243 (gdb)
28244 -environment-directory -r
28245 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28246 (gdb)
28247 @end smallexample
28248
28249
28250 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28251 @findex -environment-path
28252
28253 @subsubheading Synopsis
28254
28255 @smallexample
28256 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28257 @end smallexample
28258
28259 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28260 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28261 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28262 supplied in addition to the
28263 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28264 occurs as normal.
28265 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28266 multiple directories in a single command
28267 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28268 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28269 If blanks are needed as
28270 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28271 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28272 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28273 character must not be used
28274 in any directory name.
28275 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28276
28277
28278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28279
28280 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28281
28282 @subsubheading Example
28283
28284 @smallexample
28285 (gdb)
28286 -environment-path
28287 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28288 (gdb)
28289 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28290 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28291 (gdb)
28292 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28293 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28294 (gdb)
28295 @end smallexample
28296
28297
28298 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28299 @findex -environment-pwd
28300
28301 @subsubheading Synopsis
28302
28303 @smallexample
28304 -environment-pwd
28305 @end smallexample
28306
28307 Show the current working directory.
28308
28309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28310
28311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28312
28313 @subsubheading Example
28314
28315 @smallexample
28316 (gdb)
28317 -environment-pwd
28318 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28319 (gdb)
28320 @end smallexample
28321
28322 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28323 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28324 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28325
28326
28327 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28328 @findex -thread-info
28329
28330 @subsubheading Synopsis
28331
28332 @smallexample
28333 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28334 @end smallexample
28335
28336 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28337 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28338 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28339 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28340 current thread.
28341
28342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28343
28344 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28345 about all threads.
28346
28347 @subsubheading Result
28348
28349 The result contains the following attributes:
28350
28351 @table @samp
28352 @item threads
28353 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28354 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28355
28356 @item current-thread-id
28357 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28358 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28359 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28360 the command.
28361
28362 @end table
28363
28364 @subsubheading Example
28365
28366 @smallexample
28367 -thread-info
28368 ^done,threads=[
28369 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28370 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28371 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28372 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28373 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28374 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28375 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28376 state="running"@}],
28377 current-thread-id="1"
28378 (gdb)
28379 @end smallexample
28380
28381 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28382 @findex -thread-list-ids
28383
28384 @subsubheading Synopsis
28385
28386 @smallexample
28387 -thread-list-ids
28388 @end smallexample
28389
28390 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28391 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28392 threads.
28393
28394 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28395 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28396
28397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28398
28399 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28400
28401 @subsubheading Example
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 (gdb)
28405 -thread-list-ids
28406 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28407 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28408 (gdb)
28409 @end smallexample
28410
28411
28412 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28413 @findex -thread-select
28414
28415 @subsubheading Synopsis
28416
28417 @smallexample
28418 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28419 @end smallexample
28420
28421 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28422 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28423 topmost frame for that thread.
28424
28425 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28426 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28427
28428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28429
28430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28431
28432 @subsubheading Example
28433
28434 @smallexample
28435 (gdb)
28436 -exec-next
28437 ^running
28438 (gdb)
28439 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28440 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28441 (gdb)
28442 -thread-list-ids
28443 ^done,
28444 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28445 number-of-threads="3"
28446 (gdb)
28447 -thread-select 3
28448 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28449 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28450 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28451 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28452 (gdb)
28453 @end smallexample
28454
28455 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28456 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28457 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28458
28459 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28460 @findex -ada-task-info
28461
28462 @subsubheading Synopsis
28463
28464 @smallexample
28465 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28466 @end smallexample
28467
28468 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28469 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28470
28471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28472
28473 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28474 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28475
28476 @subsubheading Result
28477
28478 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28479 defined for each Ada task:
28480
28481 @table @samp
28482 @item current
28483 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28484
28485 @item id
28486 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28487
28488 @item task-id
28489 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28490
28491 @item thread-id
28492 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28493 task.
28494
28495 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28496 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28497 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28498
28499 @item parent-id
28500 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28501 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28502
28503 @item priority
28504 The base priority of the task.
28505
28506 @item state
28507 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28508 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28509
28510 @item name
28511 The name of the task.
28512
28513 @end table
28514
28515 @subsubheading Example
28516
28517 @smallexample
28518 -ada-task-info
28519 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28520 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28521 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28522 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28523 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28524 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28525 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28526 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28527 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28528 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28529 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28530 (gdb)
28531 @end smallexample
28532
28533 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28534 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
28535 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28536
28537 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28538 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28539 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28540 other cases.
28541
28542 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28543 @findex -exec-continue
28544
28545 @subsubheading Synopsis
28546
28547 @smallexample
28548 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28549 @end smallexample
28550
28551 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28552 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
28553 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28554 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
28555 @itemize @bullet
28556 @item
28557 breakpoints or watchpoints
28558 @item
28559 signals or exceptions
28560 @item
28561 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28562 @item
28563 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28564 @end itemize
28565 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28566 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28567 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
28568 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
28569 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28570 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28571
28572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28573
28574 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28575
28576 @subsubheading Example
28577
28578 @smallexample
28579 -exec-continue
28580 ^running
28581 (gdb)
28582 @@Hello world
28583 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28584 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28585 line="13"@}
28586 (gdb)
28587 @end smallexample
28588
28589
28590 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28591 @findex -exec-finish
28592
28593 @subsubheading Synopsis
28594
28595 @smallexample
28596 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28597 @end smallexample
28598
28599 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28600 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
28601 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28602 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28603 function was called.
28604
28605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28606
28607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28608
28609 @subsubheading Example
28610
28611 Function returning @code{void}.
28612
28613 @smallexample
28614 -exec-finish
28615 ^running
28616 (gdb)
28617 @@hello from foo
28618 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28619 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28620 (gdb)
28621 @end smallexample
28622
28623 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
28624 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28625 value itself.
28626
28627 @smallexample
28628 -exec-finish
28629 ^running
28630 (gdb)
28631 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28632 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28633 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28634 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28635 (gdb)
28636 @end smallexample
28637
28638
28639 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28640 @findex -exec-interrupt
28641
28642 @subsubheading Synopsis
28643
28644 @smallexample
28645 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28646 @end smallexample
28647
28648 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
28649 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28650 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
28651 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
28652 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28653
28654 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28655 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
28656 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28657 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28658
28659 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28660 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28661 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
28662 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28663
28664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28665
28666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28667
28668 @subsubheading Example
28669
28670 @smallexample
28671 (gdb)
28672 111-exec-continue
28673 111^running
28674
28675 (gdb)
28676 222-exec-interrupt
28677 222^done
28678 (gdb)
28679 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28680 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28681 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28682 (gdb)
28683
28684 (gdb)
28685 -exec-interrupt
28686 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28687 (gdb)
28688 @end smallexample
28689
28690 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28691 @findex -exec-jump
28692
28693 @subsubheading Synopsis
28694
28695 @smallexample
28696 -exec-jump @var{location}
28697 @end smallexample
28698
28699 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28700 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28701 different forms of @var{location}.
28702
28703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28704
28705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28706
28707 @subsubheading Example
28708
28709 @smallexample
28710 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28711 *running,thread-id="all"
28712 ^running
28713 @end smallexample
28714
28715
28716 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28717 @findex -exec-next
28718
28719 @subsubheading Synopsis
28720
28721 @smallexample
28722 -exec-next [--reverse]
28723 @end smallexample
28724
28725 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28726 of the next source line is reached.
28727
28728 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28729 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28730 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28731 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28732 source line where the function was called.
28733
28734
28735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28736
28737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28738
28739 @subsubheading Example
28740
28741 @smallexample
28742 -exec-next
28743 ^running
28744 (gdb)
28745 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28746 (gdb)
28747 @end smallexample
28748
28749
28750 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28751 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28752
28753 @subsubheading Synopsis
28754
28755 @smallexample
28756 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28757 @end smallexample
28758
28759 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28760 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28761 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28762 printed as well.
28763
28764 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28765 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28766 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28767 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28768 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28769
28770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28771
28772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28773
28774 @subsubheading Example
28775
28776 @smallexample
28777 (gdb)
28778 -exec-next-instruction
28779 ^running
28780
28781 (gdb)
28782 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28783 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28784 (gdb)
28785 @end smallexample
28786
28787
28788 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28789 @findex -exec-return
28790
28791 @subsubheading Synopsis
28792
28793 @smallexample
28794 -exec-return
28795 @end smallexample
28796
28797 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28798 Displays the new current frame.
28799
28800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28801
28802 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28803
28804 @subsubheading Example
28805
28806 @smallexample
28807 (gdb)
28808 200-break-insert callee4
28809 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28810 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28811 (gdb)
28812 000-exec-run
28813 000^running
28814 (gdb)
28815 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28816 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28817 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28818 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28819 (gdb)
28820 205-break-delete
28821 205^done
28822 (gdb)
28823 111-exec-return
28824 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28825 args=[@{name="strarg",
28826 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28827 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28828 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28829 (gdb)
28830 @end smallexample
28831
28832
28833 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28834 @findex -exec-run
28835
28836 @subsubheading Synopsis
28837
28838 @smallexample
28839 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28840 @end smallexample
28841
28842 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28843 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28844 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28845 the program has exited exceptionally.
28846
28847 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28848 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28849 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28850 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28851 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28852
28853 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28854 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28855 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28856 (@pxref{Starting}).
28857
28858 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28859
28860 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28861
28862 @subsubheading Examples
28863
28864 @smallexample
28865 (gdb)
28866 -break-insert main
28867 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28868 (gdb)
28869 -exec-run
28870 ^running
28871 (gdb)
28872 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28873 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28874 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28875 (gdb)
28876 @end smallexample
28877
28878 @noindent
28879 Program exited normally:
28880
28881 @smallexample
28882 (gdb)
28883 -exec-run
28884 ^running
28885 (gdb)
28886 x = 55
28887 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28888 (gdb)
28889 @end smallexample
28890
28891 @noindent
28892 Program exited exceptionally:
28893
28894 @smallexample
28895 (gdb)
28896 -exec-run
28897 ^running
28898 (gdb)
28899 x = 55
28900 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28901 (gdb)
28902 @end smallexample
28903
28904 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28905 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28906
28907 @smallexample
28908 (gdb)
28909 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28910 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28911 @end smallexample
28912
28913
28914 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28915
28916
28917 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28918 @findex -exec-step
28919
28920 @subsubheading Synopsis
28921
28922 @smallexample
28923 -exec-step [--reverse]
28924 @end smallexample
28925
28926 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28927 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28928 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28929 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28930 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28931 previously executed source line.
28932
28933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28934
28935 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28936
28937 @subsubheading Example
28938
28939 Stepping into a function:
28940
28941 @smallexample
28942 -exec-step
28943 ^running
28944 (gdb)
28945 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28946 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28947 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28948 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28949 (gdb)
28950 @end smallexample
28951
28952 Regular stepping:
28953
28954 @smallexample
28955 -exec-step
28956 ^running
28957 (gdb)
28958 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28959 (gdb)
28960 @end smallexample
28961
28962
28963 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28964 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28965
28966 @subsubheading Synopsis
28967
28968 @smallexample
28969 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28970 @end smallexample
28971
28972 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28973 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28974 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28975 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28976 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28977 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28978 as well.
28979
28980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28981
28982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28983
28984 @subsubheading Example
28985
28986 @smallexample
28987 (gdb)
28988 -exec-step-instruction
28989 ^running
28990
28991 (gdb)
28992 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28993 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28994 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28995 (gdb)
28996 -exec-step-instruction
28997 ^running
28998
28999 (gdb)
29000 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29001 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29002 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29003 (gdb)
29004 @end smallexample
29005
29006
29007 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29008 @findex -exec-until
29009
29010 @subsubheading Synopsis
29011
29012 @smallexample
29013 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29014 @end smallexample
29015
29016 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29017 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29018 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29019 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29020
29021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29022
29023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29024
29025 @subsubheading Example
29026
29027 @smallexample
29028 (gdb)
29029 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29030 ^running
29031 (gdb)
29032 x = 55
29033 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29034 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29035 (gdb)
29036 @end smallexample
29037
29038 @ignore
29039 @subheading -file-clear
29040 Is this going away????
29041 @end ignore
29042
29043 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29044 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29045 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29046
29047 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29048 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29049
29050 @smallexample
29051 -enable-frame-filters
29052 @end smallexample
29053
29054 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29055 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29056 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29057 request that this functionality be enabled.
29058
29059 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29060
29061 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29062 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29063
29064 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29065 @findex -stack-info-frame
29066
29067 @subsubheading Synopsis
29068
29069 @smallexample
29070 -stack-info-frame
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073 Get info on the selected frame.
29074
29075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29076
29077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29078 (without arguments).
29079
29080 @subsubheading Example
29081
29082 @smallexample
29083 (gdb)
29084 -stack-info-frame
29085 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29086 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29087 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29088 (gdb)
29089 @end smallexample
29090
29091 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29092 @findex -stack-info-depth
29093
29094 @subsubheading Synopsis
29095
29096 @smallexample
29097 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29098 @end smallexample
29099
29100 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29101 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29102
29103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29104
29105 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29106
29107 @subsubheading Example
29108
29109 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29110
29111 @smallexample
29112 (gdb)
29113 -stack-info-depth
29114 ^done,depth="12"
29115 (gdb)
29116 -stack-info-depth 4
29117 ^done,depth="4"
29118 (gdb)
29119 -stack-info-depth 12
29120 ^done,depth="12"
29121 (gdb)
29122 -stack-info-depth 11
29123 ^done,depth="11"
29124 (gdb)
29125 -stack-info-depth 13
29126 ^done,depth="12"
29127 (gdb)
29128 @end smallexample
29129
29130 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29131 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29132 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29133
29134 @subsubheading Synopsis
29135
29136 @smallexample
29137 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29138 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29139 @end smallexample
29140
29141 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29142 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29143 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29144 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29145 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29146 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29147 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29148 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29149
29150 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29151 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29152 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29153 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29154 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29155 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29156
29157 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29158 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29159 are still displayed, however.
29160
29161 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29162 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29163
29164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29165
29166 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29167 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29168 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29169
29170 @subsubheading Example
29171
29172 @smallexample
29173 (gdb)
29174 -stack-list-frames
29175 ^done,
29176 stack=[
29177 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29178 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29179 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29180 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29181 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29182 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29183 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29184 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29185 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29186 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29187 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29188 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29189 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29190 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29191 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29192 (gdb)
29193 -stack-list-arguments 0
29194 ^done,
29195 stack-args=[
29196 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29197 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29198 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29199 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29200 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29201 (gdb)
29202 -stack-list-arguments 1
29203 ^done,
29204 stack-args=[
29205 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29206 frame=@{level="1",
29207 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29208 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29209 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29210 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29211 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29212 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29213 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29214 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29215 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29216 (gdb)
29217 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29218 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29219 (gdb)
29220 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29221 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29222 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29223 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29224 (gdb)
29225 @end smallexample
29226
29227 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29228
29229
29230 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29231 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29232 @findex -stack-list-frames
29233
29234 @subsubheading Synopsis
29235
29236 @smallexample
29237 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29238 @end smallexample
29239
29240 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29241 following info:
29242
29243 @table @samp
29244 @item @var{level}
29245 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29246 @item @var{addr}
29247 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29248 @item @var{func}
29249 Function name.
29250 @item @var{file}
29251 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29252 @item @var{fullname}
29253 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29254 @item @var{line}
29255 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29256 @item @var{from}
29257 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29258 if the frame's function is not known.
29259 @end table
29260
29261 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29262 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29263 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29264 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29265 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29266 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29267 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29268 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29269 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29270
29271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29272
29273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29274
29275 @subsubheading Example
29276
29277 Full stack backtrace:
29278
29279 @smallexample
29280 (gdb)
29281 -stack-list-frames
29282 ^done,stack=
29283 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29284 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29285 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29286 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29287 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29288 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29289 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29290 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29291 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29292 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29293 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29294 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29295 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29296 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29297 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29298 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29299 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29300 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29301 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29302 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29303 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29304 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29305 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29306 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29307 (gdb)
29308 @end smallexample
29309
29310 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 (gdb)
29314 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29315 ^done,stack=
29316 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29317 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29318 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29319 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29320 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29321 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29322 (gdb)
29323 @end smallexample
29324
29325 Show a single frame:
29326
29327 @smallexample
29328 (gdb)
29329 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29330 ^done,stack=
29331 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29332 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29333 (gdb)
29334 @end smallexample
29335
29336
29337 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29338 @findex -stack-list-locals
29339 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29340
29341 @subsubheading Synopsis
29342
29343 @smallexample
29344 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29345 @end smallexample
29346
29347 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29348 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29349 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29350 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29351 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29352 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29353 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29354 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29355 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29356 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29357
29358 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29359 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29360 variables are still displayed, however.
29361
29362 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29363 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29364
29365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29366
29367 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29368
29369 @subsubheading Example
29370
29371 @smallexample
29372 (gdb)
29373 -stack-list-locals 0
29374 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29375 (gdb)
29376 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29377 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29378 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29379 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29380 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29381 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29382 (gdb)
29383 @end smallexample
29384
29385 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29386 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29387 @findex -stack-list-variables
29388
29389 @subsubheading Synopsis
29390
29391 @smallexample
29392 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29393 @end smallexample
29394
29395 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29396 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29397 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29398 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29399 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29400 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29401 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29402
29403 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29404 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29405 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29406
29407 @subsubheading Example
29408
29409 @smallexample
29410 (gdb)
29411 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29412 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29413 (gdb)
29414 @end smallexample
29415
29416
29417 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29418 @findex -stack-select-frame
29419
29420 @subsubheading Synopsis
29421
29422 @smallexample
29423 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29424 @end smallexample
29425
29426 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29427 the stack.
29428
29429 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29430 option to every command.
29431
29432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29433
29434 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29435 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29436
29437 @subsubheading Example
29438
29439 @smallexample
29440 (gdb)
29441 -stack-select-frame 2
29442 ^done
29443 (gdb)
29444 @end smallexample
29445
29446 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29447 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29448 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29449
29450 @ignore
29451
29452 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29453
29454 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29455 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29456 used by @code{Insight}.
29457
29458 The two main reasons for that are:
29459
29460 @enumerate 1
29461 @item
29462 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29463
29464 @item
29465 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29466 now).
29467 @end enumerate
29468
29469 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29470 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29471 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29472 hints about their use.
29473
29474 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29475 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29476 least, the following operations:
29477
29478 @itemize @bullet
29479 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29480 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29481 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29482 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29483 @end itemize
29484
29485 @end ignore
29486
29487 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29488
29489 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29490
29491 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29492 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29493 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29494 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29495 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29496 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29497 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29498 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29499 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29500 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29501 object, or to change display format.
29502
29503 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29504 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29505 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29506 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29507 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29508 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29509 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29510 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29511 child will be created.
29512
29513 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29514 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29515 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29516 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29517 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29518
29519 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29520 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29521 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29522 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29523 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29524 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29525 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29526 variables that frontend has created.
29527
29528 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29529 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29530 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
29531 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29532 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29533 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
29534 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
29535 implicitly updated.
29536
29537 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
29538 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29539 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29540 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
29541 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29542 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29543 frame. Consider this example:
29544
29545 @smallexample
29546 void do_work(...)
29547 @{
29548 struct work_state state;
29549
29550 if (...)
29551 do_work(...);
29552 @}
29553 @end smallexample
29554
29555 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29556 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29557 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29558 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
29559 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29560
29561 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29562 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29563 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
29564 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29565 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29566 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29567
29568 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29569 access this functionality:
29570
29571 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29572 @item @strong{Operation}
29573 @tab @strong{Description}
29574
29575 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29576 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29577 @item @code{-var-create}
29578 @tab create a variable object
29579 @item @code{-var-delete}
29580 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29581 @item @code{-var-set-format}
29582 @tab set the display format of this variable
29583 @item @code{-var-show-format}
29584 @tab show the display format of this variable
29585 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29586 @tab tells how many children this object has
29587 @item @code{-var-list-children}
29588 @tab return a list of the object's children
29589 @item @code{-var-info-type}
29590 @tab show the type of this variable object
29591 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
29592 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29593 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29594 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29595 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29596 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29597 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29598 @tab get the value of this variable
29599 @item @code{-var-assign}
29600 @tab set the value of this variable
29601 @item @code{-var-update}
29602 @tab update the variable and its children
29603 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29604 @tab set frozeness attribute
29605 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29606 @tab set range of children to display on update
29607 @end multitable
29608
29609 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29610 how it can be used.
29611
29612 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29613
29614 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29615 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
29616
29617 @smallexample
29618 -enable-pretty-printing
29619 @end smallexample
29620
29621 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29622 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
29623 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29624 request that this functionality be enabled.
29625
29626 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29627
29628 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29629 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29630
29631 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29632 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29633
29634 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29635 @findex -var-create
29636
29637 @subsubheading Synopsis
29638
29639 @smallexample
29640 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29641 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29642 @end smallexample
29643
29644 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29645 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29646 register.
29647
29648 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29649 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29650 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
29651 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29652 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29653
29654 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29655 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29656 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29657 object must be created.
29658
29659 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29660 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29661
29662 @itemize @bullet
29663 @item
29664 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29665
29666 @item
29667 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29668
29669 @item
29670 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29671 @end itemize
29672
29673 @cindex dynamic varobj
29674 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
29675 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
29676 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
29677 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29678 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
29679 compatibility for existing clients.
29680
29681 @subsubheading Result
29682
29683 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
29684 are:
29685
29686 @table @samp
29687 @item name
29688 The name of the varobj.
29689
29690 @item numchild
29691 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
29692 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
29693 @samp{has_more} attribute.
29694
29695 @item value
29696 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29697 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29698 will not be interesting.
29699
29700 @item type
29701 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
29702 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
29703 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29704 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29705 @emph{declared} one.
29706
29707 @item thread-id
29708 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29709 thread's global identifier.
29710
29711 @item has_more
29712 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29713 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29714
29715 @item dynamic
29716 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29717 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29718 then this attribute will not be present.
29719
29720 @item displayhint
29721 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29722 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29723 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29724 @end table
29725
29726 Typical output will look like this:
29727
29728 @smallexample
29729 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29730 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29731 @end smallexample
29732
29733
29734 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29735 @findex -var-delete
29736
29737 @subsubheading Synopsis
29738
29739 @smallexample
29740 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29741 @end smallexample
29742
29743 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29744 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29745
29746 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29747
29748
29749 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29750 @findex -var-set-format
29751
29752 @subsubheading Synopsis
29753
29754 @smallexample
29755 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29756 @end smallexample
29757
29758 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29759 @var{format-spec}.
29760
29761 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29762 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29763
29764 @smallexample
29765 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29766 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29767 @end smallexample
29768
29769 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29770 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29771 for pointers, etc.).
29772
29773 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29774 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29775 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29776 zero-hexadecimal format.
29777
29778 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29779 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29780
29781 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29782 @findex -var-show-format
29783
29784 @subsubheading Synopsis
29785
29786 @smallexample
29787 -var-show-format @var{name}
29788 @end smallexample
29789
29790 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 @var{format} @expansion{}
29794 @var{format-spec}
29795 @end smallexample
29796
29797
29798 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29799 @findex -var-info-num-children
29800
29801 @subsubheading Synopsis
29802
29803 @smallexample
29804 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29805 @end smallexample
29806
29807 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29808
29809 @smallexample
29810 numchild=@var{n}
29811 @end smallexample
29812
29813 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29814 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29815 be available.
29816
29817
29818 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29819 @findex -var-list-children
29820
29821 @subsubheading Synopsis
29822
29823 @smallexample
29824 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29825 @end smallexample
29826 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29827
29828 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29829 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29830 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29831 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29832 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29833 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29834 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29835 and unions.
29836
29837 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29838 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29839 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29840 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29841 reported.
29842
29843 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29844 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29845 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29846 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29847 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29848 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29849 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29850 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29851 the visible items.
29852
29853 For each child the following results are returned:
29854
29855 @table @var
29856
29857 @item name
29858 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29859
29860 @item exp
29861 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29862 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29863
29864 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29865 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29866
29867 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29868 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29869 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29870 type and value are not present.
29871
29872 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29873 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29874 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29875
29876 @item numchild
29877 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29878 0.
29879
29880 @item type
29881 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29882 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29883 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29884 @emph{declared} one.
29885
29886 @item value
29887 If values were requested, this is the value.
29888
29889 @item thread-id
29890 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29891 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
29892
29893 @item frozen
29894 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29895
29896 @item displayhint
29897 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29898 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29899 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29900
29901 @item dynamic
29902 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29903 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29904 then this attribute will not be present.
29905
29906 @end table
29907
29908 The result may have its own attributes:
29909
29910 @table @samp
29911 @item displayhint
29912 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29913 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29914 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29915
29916 @item has_more
29917 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29918 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29919 @end table
29920
29921 @subsubheading Example
29922
29923 @smallexample
29924 (gdb)
29925 -var-list-children n
29926 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29927 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29928 (gdb)
29929 -var-list-children --all-values n
29930 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29931 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29932 @end smallexample
29933
29934
29935 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29936 @findex -var-info-type
29937
29938 @subsubheading Synopsis
29939
29940 @smallexample
29941 -var-info-type @var{name}
29942 @end smallexample
29943
29944 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29945 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29946 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 type=@var{typename}
29950 @end smallexample
29951
29952
29953 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29954 @findex -var-info-expression
29955
29956 @subsubheading Synopsis
29957
29958 @smallexample
29959 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29960 @end smallexample
29961
29962 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29963 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29964 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29965
29966 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29967 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29968
29969 @smallexample
29970 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29971 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29972 @end smallexample
29973
29974 @noindent
29975 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29976 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29977
29978 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29979 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29980 is of limited use.
29981
29982 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29983 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29984
29985 @subsubheading Synopsis
29986
29987 @smallexample
29988 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29989 @end smallexample
29990
29991 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29992 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29993 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29994 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29995 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29996 watchpoint from a variable object.
29997
29998 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29999 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30000
30001 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30002 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30003 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30004 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30005 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30006 @smallexample
30007 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30008 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30009 @end smallexample
30010
30011 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30012 @findex -var-show-attributes
30013
30014 @subsubheading Synopsis
30015
30016 @smallexample
30017 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30018 @end smallexample
30019
30020 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30021
30022 @smallexample
30023 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30024 @end smallexample
30025
30026 @noindent
30027 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30028
30029 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30030 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30031
30032 @subsubheading Synopsis
30033
30034 @smallexample
30035 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30039 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30040 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30041 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30042 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30043 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30044 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30045
30046 @smallexample
30047 value=@var{value}
30048 @end smallexample
30049
30050 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30051 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30052
30053 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30054 @findex -var-assign
30055
30056 @subsubheading Synopsis
30057
30058 @smallexample
30059 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30060 @end smallexample
30061
30062 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30063 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30064 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30065 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30066
30067 @subsubheading Example
30068
30069 @smallexample
30070 (gdb)
30071 -var-assign var1 3
30072 ^done,value="3"
30073 (gdb)
30074 -var-update *
30075 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30076 (gdb)
30077 @end smallexample
30078
30079 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30080 @findex -var-update
30081
30082 @subsubheading Synopsis
30083
30084 @smallexample
30085 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30086 @end smallexample
30087
30088 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30089 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30090 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30091 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30092 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30093 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30094 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30095 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30096 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30097 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30098 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30099 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30100 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30101
30102 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30103 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30104 diagnostic.
30105
30106 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30107 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30108
30109 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30110 @samp{changelist}.
30111
30112 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30113
30114 @table @samp
30115 @item name
30116 The name of the varobj.
30117
30118 @item value
30119 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30120 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30121
30122 @item in_scope
30123 @anchor{-var-update}
30124 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30125
30126 @table @code
30127 @item "true"
30128 The variable object's current value is valid.
30129
30130 @item "false"
30131 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30132 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30133 scope.
30134
30135 @item "invalid"
30136 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30137 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30138 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30139 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30140 objects.
30141 @end table
30142
30143 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30144 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30145
30146 @item type_changed
30147 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30148 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30149 be @samp{false}.
30150
30151 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30152 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30153 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30154 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30155 unset.
30156
30157 @item new_type
30158 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30159 hold the new type.
30160
30161 @item new_num_children
30162 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30163 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30164
30165 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30166 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30167 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30168 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30169 children which may be available.
30170
30171 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30172 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30173 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30174 only happen at the end of the update range).
30175
30176 @item displayhint
30177 The display hint, if any.
30178
30179 @item has_more
30180 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30181 available outside the varobj's update range.
30182
30183 @item dynamic
30184 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30185 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30186 then this attribute will not be present.
30187
30188 @item new_children
30189 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30190 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30191 be listed in this attribute.
30192 @end table
30193
30194 @subsubheading Example
30195
30196 @smallexample
30197 (gdb)
30198 -var-assign var1 3
30199 ^done,value="3"
30200 (gdb)
30201 -var-update --all-values var1
30202 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30203 type_changed="false"@}]
30204 (gdb)
30205 @end smallexample
30206
30207 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30208 @findex -var-set-frozen
30209 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30210
30211 @subsubheading Synopsis
30212
30213 @smallexample
30214 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30215 @end smallexample
30216
30217 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30218 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30219 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30220 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30221 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30222 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30223 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30224 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30225 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30226 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30227 @code{-var-update} does.
30228
30229 @subsubheading Example
30230
30231 @smallexample
30232 (gdb)
30233 -var-set-frozen V 1
30234 ^done
30235 (gdb)
30236 @end smallexample
30237
30238 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30239 @findex -var-set-update-range
30240 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30241
30242 @subsubheading Synopsis
30243
30244 @smallexample
30245 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30246 @end smallexample
30247
30248 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30249 @code{-var-update}.
30250
30251 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30252 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30253 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30254 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30255
30256 @subsubheading Example
30257
30258 @smallexample
30259 (gdb)
30260 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30261 ^done
30262 @end smallexample
30263
30264 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30265 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30266 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30267
30268 @subsubheading Synopsis
30269
30270 @smallexample
30271 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30272 @end smallexample
30273
30274 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30275
30276 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30277 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30278
30279 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30280 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30281 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30282 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30283 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30284 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30285 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30286
30287 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30288 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30289 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30290 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30291
30292 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30293 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30294 can be used to check this.
30295
30296 @subsubheading Example
30297
30298 Resetting the visualizer:
30299
30300 @smallexample
30301 (gdb)
30302 -var-set-visualizer V None
30303 ^done
30304 @end smallexample
30305
30306 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30307
30308 @smallexample
30309 (gdb)
30310 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30311 ^done
30312 @end smallexample
30313
30314 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30315 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30316
30317 @smallexample
30318 (gdb)
30319 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30320 ^done
30321 @end smallexample
30322
30323 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30324 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30325 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30326
30327 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30328 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30329 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30330 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30331
30332 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30333 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30334
30335 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30336 @c @subheading -data-assign
30337 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30338 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30339 @c set variable
30340 @c @subsubheading Example
30341 @c N.A.
30342
30343 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30344 @findex -data-disassemble
30345
30346 @subsubheading Synopsis
30347
30348 @smallexample
30349 -data-disassemble
30350 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30351 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30352 -- @var{mode}
30353 @end smallexample
30354
30355 @noindent
30356 Where:
30357
30358 @table @samp
30359 @item @var{start-addr}
30360 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30361 @item @var{end-addr}
30362 is the end address
30363 @item @var{filename}
30364 is the name of the file to disassemble
30365 @item @var{linenum}
30366 is the line number to disassemble around
30367 @item @var{lines}
30368 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30369 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30370 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30371 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30372 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30373 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30374 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30375 are displayed.
30376 @item @var{mode}
30377 is one of:
30378 @itemize @bullet
30379 @item 0 disassembly only
30380 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30381 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30382 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30383 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30384 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30385 @end itemize
30386
30387 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30388 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30389 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30390 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30391 @end table
30392
30393 @subsubheading Result
30394
30395 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30396 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30397 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30398
30399 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30400 following fields:
30401
30402 @table @code
30403 @item address
30404 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30405
30406 @item func-name
30407 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30408
30409 @item offset
30410 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30411
30412 @item inst
30413 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30414
30415 @item opcodes
30416 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30417 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30418
30419 @end table
30420
30421 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30422 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30423
30424 @table @code
30425 @item line
30426 The line number within @samp{file}.
30427
30428 @item file
30429 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30430 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30431 used.
30432
30433 @item fullname
30434 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30435 using the source file search path
30436 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30437 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30438
30439 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30440 present in the debug information.
30441
30442 @item line_asm_insn
30443 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30444 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30445 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30446 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30447 @samp{opcodes}.
30448
30449 @end table
30450
30451 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30452 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30453 adjust its format.
30454
30455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30456
30457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30458
30459 @subsubheading Example
30460
30461 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30462
30463 @smallexample
30464 (gdb)
30465 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30466 ^done,
30467 asm_insns=[
30468 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30469 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30470 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30471 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30472 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30473 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30474 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30475 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30476 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30477 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30478 (gdb)
30479 @end smallexample
30480
30481 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30482 @code{main}.
30483
30484 @smallexample
30485 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30486 ^done,asm_insns=[
30487 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30488 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30489 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30490 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30491 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30492 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30493 [@dots{}]
30494 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30495 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30496 (gdb)
30497 @end smallexample
30498
30499 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30500
30501 @smallexample
30502 (gdb)
30503 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30504 ^done,asm_insns=[
30505 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30506 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30507 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30508 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30509 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30510 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30511 (gdb)
30512 @end smallexample
30513
30514 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30515
30516 @smallexample
30517 (gdb)
30518 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30519 ^done,asm_insns=[
30520 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30521 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30522 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30523 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30524 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30525 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30526 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30527 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30528 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30529 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30530 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30531 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30532 (gdb)
30533 @end smallexample
30534
30535
30536 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30537 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
30538
30539 @subsubheading Synopsis
30540
30541 @smallexample
30542 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30543 @end smallexample
30544
30545 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
30546 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
30547 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30548
30549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30550
30551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30552 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30553 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
30554
30555 @subsubheading Example
30556
30557 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30558 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30559 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30560 output.
30561
30562 @smallexample
30563 211-data-evaluate-expression A
30564 211^done,value="1"
30565 (gdb)
30566 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30567 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30568 (gdb)
30569 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30570 411^done,value="4"
30571 (gdb)
30572 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30573 511^done,value="4"
30574 (gdb)
30575 @end smallexample
30576
30577
30578 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30579 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
30580
30581 @subsubheading Synopsis
30582
30583 @smallexample
30584 -data-list-changed-registers
30585 @end smallexample
30586
30587 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30588
30589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30590
30591 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30592 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30593
30594 @subsubheading Example
30595
30596 On a PPC MBX board:
30597
30598 @smallexample
30599 (gdb)
30600 -exec-continue
30601 ^running
30602
30603 (gdb)
30604 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30605 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30606 line="5"@}
30607 (gdb)
30608 -data-list-changed-registers
30609 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30610 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30611 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30612 (gdb)
30613 @end smallexample
30614
30615
30616 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30617 @findex -data-list-register-names
30618
30619 @subsubheading Synopsis
30620
30621 @smallexample
30622 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
30626 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
30627 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30628 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
30629 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30630 include empty register names.
30631
30632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30633
30634 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30635 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30636 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30637
30638 @subsubheading Example
30639
30640 For the PPC MBX board:
30641 @smallexample
30642 (gdb)
30643 -data-list-register-names
30644 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30645 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30646 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30647 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30648 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30649 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30650 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30651 (gdb)
30652 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30653 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30654 (gdb)
30655 @end smallexample
30656
30657 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30658 @findex -data-list-register-values
30659
30660 @subsubheading Synopsis
30661
30662 @smallexample
30663 -data-list-register-values
30664 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30665 @end smallexample
30666
30667 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
30668 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30669 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
30670 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30671 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30672 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30673
30674 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30675
30676 @table @code
30677 @item x
30678 Hexadecimal
30679 @item o
30680 Octal
30681 @item t
30682 Binary
30683 @item d
30684 Decimal
30685 @item r
30686 Raw
30687 @item N
30688 Natural
30689 @end table
30690
30691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30692
30693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30694 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30695
30696 @subsubheading Example
30697
30698 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30699 don't appear in the actual output):
30700
30701 @smallexample
30702 (gdb)
30703 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30704 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30705 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30706 (gdb)
30707 -data-list-register-values x
30708 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30709 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30710 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30711 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30712 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30713 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30714 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30715 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30716 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30717 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30718 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30719 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30720 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30721 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30722 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30723 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30724 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30725 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30726 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30727 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30728 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30729 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30730 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30731 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30732 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30733 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30734 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30735 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30736 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30737 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30738 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30739 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30740 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30741 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30742 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30743 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30744 (gdb)
30745 @end smallexample
30746
30747
30748 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30749 @findex -data-read-memory
30750
30751 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30752
30753 @subsubheading Synopsis
30754
30755 @smallexample
30756 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30757 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30758 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30759 @end smallexample
30760
30761 @noindent
30762 where:
30763
30764 @table @samp
30765 @item @var{address}
30766 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30767 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30768 quoted using the C convention.
30769
30770 @item @var{word-format}
30771 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30772 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30773 ,Output Formats}).
30774
30775 @item @var{word-size}
30776 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30777
30778 @item @var{nr-rows}
30779 The number of rows in the output table.
30780
30781 @item @var{nr-cols}
30782 The number of columns in the output table.
30783
30784 @item @var{aschar}
30785 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30786 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30787 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30788 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30789
30790 @item @var{byte-offset}
30791 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30792 @end table
30793
30794 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30795 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30796 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30797 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30798 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30799 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30800 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30801 @samp{addr}.
30802
30803 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30804 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30805 @samp{prev-page}.
30806
30807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30808
30809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30810 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30811
30812 @subsubheading Example
30813
30814 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30815 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30816 word. Display each word in hex.
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 (gdb)
30820 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30821 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30822 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30823 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30824 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30825 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30826 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30827 (gdb)
30828 @end smallexample
30829
30830 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30831 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30832
30833 @smallexample
30834 (gdb)
30835 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30836 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30837 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30838 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30839 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30840 (gdb)
30841 @end smallexample
30842
30843 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30844 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30845 used as the non-printable character.
30846
30847 @smallexample
30848 (gdb)
30849 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30850 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30851 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30852 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30853 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30854 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30855 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30856 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30857 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30858 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30859 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30860 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30861 (gdb)
30862 @end smallexample
30863
30864 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30865 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30866
30867 @subsubheading Synopsis
30868
30869 @smallexample
30870 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30871 @var{address} @var{count}
30872 @end smallexample
30873
30874 @noindent
30875 where:
30876
30877 @table @samp
30878 @item @var{address}
30879 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30880 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30881 quoted using the C convention.
30882
30883 @item @var{count}
30884 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30885 literal.
30886
30887 @item @var{offset}
30888 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30889 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30890 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30891 arithmetics itself.
30892
30893 @end table
30894
30895 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30896 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30897 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30898 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30899 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30900 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30901
30902 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30903 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30904 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30905 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30906 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30907 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30908 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30909 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30910
30911 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30912 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30913 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30914 and has the following fields:
30915
30916 @table @code
30917 @item begin
30918 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30919
30920 @item end
30921 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30922
30923 @item offset
30924 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30925 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30926
30927 @item contents
30928 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30929
30930 @end table
30931
30932
30933
30934 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30935
30936 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30937
30938 @subsubheading Example
30939
30940 @smallexample
30941 (gdb)
30942 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30943 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30944 end="0xbffff15e",
30945 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30946 (gdb)
30947 @end smallexample
30948
30949
30950 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30951 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30952
30953 @subsubheading Synopsis
30954
30955 @smallexample
30956 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30957 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30958 @end smallexample
30959
30960 @noindent
30961 where:
30962
30963 @table @samp
30964 @item @var{address}
30965 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30966 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30967 be quoted using the C convention.
30968
30969 @item @var{contents}
30970 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30971 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30972
30973 @item @var{count}
30974 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30975 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30976 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30977 @var{count} memory units.
30978
30979 @end table
30980
30981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30982
30983 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30984
30985 @subsubheading Example
30986
30987 @smallexample
30988 (gdb)
30989 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30990 ^done
30991 (gdb)
30992 @end smallexample
30993
30994 @smallexample
30995 (gdb)
30996 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30997 ^done
30998 (gdb)
30999 @end smallexample
31000
31001 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31002 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31003 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31004
31005 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31006 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31007
31008 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31009 @findex -trace-find
31010
31011 @subsubheading Synopsis
31012
31013 @smallexample
31014 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31015 @end smallexample
31016
31017 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31018 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31019 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31020
31021 @table @samp
31022
31023 @item none
31024 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31025
31026 @item frame-number
31027 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31028 that index.
31029
31030 @item tracepoint-number
31031 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31032 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31033
31034 @item pc
31035 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31036 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31037 address.
31038
31039 @item pc-inside-range
31040 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31041 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31042 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31043
31044 @item pc-outside-range
31045 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31046 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31047 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31048
31049 @item line
31050 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31051 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31052 the specified location.
31053
31054 @end table
31055
31056 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31057 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31058
31059 @table @samp
31060 @item found
31061 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31062 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31063
31064 @item traceframe
31065 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31066 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31067
31068 @item tracepoint
31069 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31070 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31071
31072 @item frame
31073 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31074 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31075 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31076
31077 @end table
31078
31079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31080
31081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31082
31083 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31084 @findex -trace-define-variable
31085
31086 @subsubheading Synopsis
31087
31088 @smallexample
31089 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31090 @end smallexample
31091
31092 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31093 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31094 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31095 with the @samp{$} character.
31096
31097 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31098
31099 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31100
31101 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31102 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31103
31104 @subsubheading Synopsis
31105
31106 @smallexample
31107 -trace-frame-collected
31108 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31109 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31110 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31111 [--memory-contents]
31112 @end smallexample
31113
31114 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31115 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31116 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31117 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31118 See the output description table below for more details.
31119
31120 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31121 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31122 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31123 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31124 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31125
31126 For instance, if the actions were
31127 @smallexample
31128 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31129 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31130 @end smallexample
31131
31132 @noindent
31133 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31134 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31135 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31136 objects would be computed expressions.
31137
31138 An example output would be:
31139
31140 @smallexample
31141 (gdb)
31142 -trace-frame-collected
31143 ^done,
31144 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31145 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31146 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31147 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31148 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31149 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31150 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31151 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31152 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31153 ...
31154 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31155 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31156 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31157 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31158 (gdb)
31159 @end smallexample
31160
31161 Where:
31162
31163 @table @code
31164 @item explicit-variables
31165 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31166 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31167 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31168 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31169 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31170 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31171 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31172 arrays, structures and unions.
31173
31174 @item computed-expressions
31175 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31176 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31177 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31178 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31179
31180 @item registers
31181 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31182 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31183 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31184 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31185 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31186
31187 @item tvars
31188 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31189 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31190 current value are returned.
31191
31192 @item memory
31193 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31194 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31195 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31196
31197 @table @code
31198 @item address
31199 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31200
31201 @item length
31202 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31203
31204 @item contents
31205 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31206 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31207
31208 @end table
31209
31210 @end table
31211
31212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31213
31214 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31215
31216 @subsubheading Example
31217
31218 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31219 @findex -trace-list-variables
31220
31221 @subsubheading Synopsis
31222
31223 @smallexample
31224 -trace-list-variables
31225 @end smallexample
31226
31227 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31228 table has the following fields:
31229
31230 @table @samp
31231 @item name
31232 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31233
31234 @item initial
31235 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31236 field is always present.
31237
31238 @item current
31239 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31240 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31241 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31242 presently running.
31243
31244 @end table
31245
31246 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31247
31248 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31249
31250 @subsubheading Example
31251
31252 @smallexample
31253 (gdb)
31254 -trace-list-variables
31255 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31256 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31257 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31258 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31259 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31260 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31261 (gdb)
31262 @end smallexample
31263
31264 @subheading -trace-save
31265 @findex -trace-save
31266
31267 @subsubheading Synopsis
31268
31269 @smallexample
31270 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31271 @end smallexample
31272
31273 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31274 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31275 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31276 to perform the save.
31277
31278 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31279 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31280 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31281
31282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31283
31284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31285
31286
31287 @subheading -trace-start
31288 @findex -trace-start
31289
31290 @subsubheading Synopsis
31291
31292 @smallexample
31293 -trace-start
31294 @end smallexample
31295
31296 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31297 have any fields.
31298
31299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31300
31301 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31302
31303 @subheading -trace-status
31304 @findex -trace-status
31305
31306 @subsubheading Synopsis
31307
31308 @smallexample
31309 -trace-status
31310 @end smallexample
31311
31312 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31313 the following fields:
31314
31315 @table @samp
31316
31317 @item supported
31318 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31319 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31320 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31321 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31322 started. This field is always present.
31323
31324 @item running
31325 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31326 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31327 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31328
31329 @item stop-reason
31330 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31331 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31332 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31333 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31334 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31335 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31336 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31337 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31338 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31339
31340 @item stopping-tracepoint
31341 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31342 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31343 @samp{passcount}.
31344
31345 @item frames
31346 @itemx frames-created
31347 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31348 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31349 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31350 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31351
31352 @item buffer-size
31353 @itemx buffer-free
31354 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31355 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31356
31357 @item circular
31358 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31359 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31360 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31361 and may fill up.
31362
31363 @item disconnected
31364 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31365 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31366 that the trace run will stop.
31367
31368 @item trace-file
31369 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31370 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31371
31372 @end table
31373
31374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31375
31376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31377
31378 @subheading -trace-stop
31379 @findex -trace-stop
31380
31381 @subsubheading Synopsis
31382
31383 @smallexample
31384 -trace-stop
31385 @end smallexample
31386
31387 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31388 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31389 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31390
31391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31392
31393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31394
31395
31396 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31397 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31398 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31399
31400
31401 @ignore
31402 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31403 @findex -symbol-info-address
31404
31405 @subsubheading Synopsis
31406
31407 @smallexample
31408 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31409 @end smallexample
31410
31411 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31412
31413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31414
31415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31416
31417 @subsubheading Example
31418 N.A.
31419
31420
31421 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31422 @findex -symbol-info-file
31423
31424 @subsubheading Synopsis
31425
31426 @smallexample
31427 -symbol-info-file
31428 @end smallexample
31429
31430 Show the file for the symbol.
31431
31432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31433
31434 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31435 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31436
31437 @subsubheading Example
31438 N.A.
31439
31440
31441 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31442 @findex -symbol-info-function
31443
31444 @subsubheading Synopsis
31445
31446 @smallexample
31447 -symbol-info-function
31448 @end smallexample
31449
31450 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31451
31452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31453
31454 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31455
31456 @subsubheading Example
31457 N.A.
31458
31459
31460 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31461 @findex -symbol-info-line
31462
31463 @subsubheading Synopsis
31464
31465 @smallexample
31466 -symbol-info-line
31467 @end smallexample
31468
31469 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31470
31471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31472
31473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31474 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31475
31476 @subsubheading Example
31477 N.A.
31478
31479
31480 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31481 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31482
31483 @subsubheading Synopsis
31484
31485 @smallexample
31486 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31487 @end smallexample
31488
31489 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31490
31491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31492
31493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31494
31495 @subsubheading Example
31496 N.A.
31497
31498
31499 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31500 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31501
31502 @subsubheading Synopsis
31503
31504 @smallexample
31505 -symbol-list-functions
31506 @end smallexample
31507
31508 List the functions in the executable.
31509
31510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31511
31512 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31513 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31514
31515 @subsubheading Example
31516 N.A.
31517 @end ignore
31518
31519
31520 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31521 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31522
31523 @subsubheading Synopsis
31524
31525 @smallexample
31526 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31527 @end smallexample
31528
31529 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31530 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
31531 ascending PC order.
31532
31533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31534
31535 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31536
31537 @subsubheading Example
31538 @smallexample
31539 (gdb)
31540 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
31541 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31542 (gdb)
31543 @end smallexample
31544
31545
31546 @ignore
31547 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31548 @findex -symbol-list-types
31549
31550 @subsubheading Synopsis
31551
31552 @smallexample
31553 -symbol-list-types
31554 @end smallexample
31555
31556 List all the type names.
31557
31558 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31559
31560 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31561 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31562
31563 @subsubheading Example
31564 N.A.
31565
31566
31567 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31568 @findex -symbol-list-variables
31569
31570 @subsubheading Synopsis
31571
31572 @smallexample
31573 -symbol-list-variables
31574 @end smallexample
31575
31576 List all the global and static variable names.
31577
31578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31579
31580 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31581
31582 @subsubheading Example
31583 N.A.
31584
31585
31586 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31587 @findex -symbol-locate
31588
31589 @subsubheading Synopsis
31590
31591 @smallexample
31592 -symbol-locate
31593 @end smallexample
31594
31595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31596
31597 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31598
31599 @subsubheading Example
31600 N.A.
31601
31602
31603 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31604 @findex -symbol-type
31605
31606 @subsubheading Synopsis
31607
31608 @smallexample
31609 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31610 @end smallexample
31611
31612 Show type of @var{variable}.
31613
31614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31615
31616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31617 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31618
31619 @subsubheading Example
31620 N.A.
31621 @end ignore
31622
31623
31624 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31625 @node GDB/MI File Commands
31626 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31627
31628 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31629 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31630
31631 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31632 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31633
31634 @subsubheading Synopsis
31635
31636 @smallexample
31637 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31638 @end smallexample
31639
31640 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
31641 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
31642 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
31643 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31644 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31645 notification.
31646
31647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31648
31649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31650
31651 @subsubheading Example
31652
31653 @smallexample
31654 (gdb)
31655 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31656 ^done
31657 (gdb)
31658 @end smallexample
31659
31660
31661 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31662 @findex -file-exec-file
31663
31664 @subsubheading Synopsis
31665
31666 @smallexample
31667 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31668 @end smallexample
31669
31670 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
31671 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31672 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31673 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
31674 notification.
31675
31676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31677
31678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31679
31680 @subsubheading Example
31681
31682 @smallexample
31683 (gdb)
31684 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31685 ^done
31686 (gdb)
31687 @end smallexample
31688
31689
31690 @ignore
31691 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31692 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
31693
31694 @subsubheading Synopsis
31695
31696 @smallexample
31697 -file-list-exec-sections
31698 @end smallexample
31699
31700 List the sections of the current executable file.
31701
31702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31703
31704 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31705 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31706 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
31707
31708 @subsubheading Example
31709 N.A.
31710 @end ignore
31711
31712
31713 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31714 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31715
31716 @subsubheading Synopsis
31717
31718 @smallexample
31719 -file-list-exec-source-file
31720 @end smallexample
31721
31722 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31723 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31724 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31725 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31726
31727 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31728
31729 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31730
31731 @subsubheading Example
31732
31733 @smallexample
31734 (gdb)
31735 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31736 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31737 (gdb)
31738 @end smallexample
31739
31740
31741 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31742 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31743
31744 @subsubheading Synopsis
31745
31746 @smallexample
31747 -file-list-exec-source-files
31748 @end smallexample
31749
31750 List the source files for the current executable.
31751
31752 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31753 name) of a source file.
31754
31755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31756
31757 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31758 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31759
31760 @subsubheading Example
31761 @smallexample
31762 (gdb)
31763 -file-list-exec-source-files
31764 ^done,files=[
31765 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31766 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31767 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31768 (gdb)
31769 @end smallexample
31770
31771 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31772 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31773
31774 @subsubheading Synopsis
31775
31776 @smallexample
31777 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
31778 @end smallexample
31779
31780 List the shared libraries in the program.
31781 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
31782 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31783
31784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31785
31786 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
31787 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
31788 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
31789 library. Each range has the following fields:
31790
31791 @table @samp
31792 @item from
31793 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
31794 @item to
31795 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
31796 @end table
31797
31798 @subsubheading Example
31799 @smallexample
31800 (gdb)
31801 -file-list-exec-source-files
31802 ^done,shared-libraries=[
31803 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
31804 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
31805 (gdb)
31806 @end smallexample
31807
31808
31809 @ignore
31810 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31811 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31812
31813 @subsubheading Synopsis
31814
31815 @smallexample
31816 -file-list-symbol-files
31817 @end smallexample
31818
31819 List symbol files.
31820
31821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31822
31823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31824
31825 @subsubheading Example
31826 N.A.
31827 @end ignore
31828
31829
31830 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31831 @findex -file-symbol-file
31832
31833 @subsubheading Synopsis
31834
31835 @smallexample
31836 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31837 @end smallexample
31838
31839 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31840 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31841 produced, except for a completion notification.
31842
31843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31844
31845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31846
31847 @subsubheading Example
31848
31849 @smallexample
31850 (gdb)
31851 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31852 ^done
31853 (gdb)
31854 @end smallexample
31855
31856 @ignore
31857 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31858 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31859 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31860
31861 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31862
31863 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31864
31865 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31866
31867 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31868
31869 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31870
31871 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31872
31873 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31874
31875 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31876
31877 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31878 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31879 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31880
31881 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31882
31883 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31884
31885 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31886
31887 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31888 @end ignore
31889
31890
31891 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31892 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31893 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31894
31895
31896 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31897 @findex -target-attach
31898
31899 @subsubheading Synopsis
31900
31901 @smallexample
31902 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31903 @end smallexample
31904
31905 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31906 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31907 group, the id previously returned by
31908 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31909
31910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31911
31912 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31913
31914 @subsubheading Example
31915 @smallexample
31916 (gdb)
31917 -target-attach 34
31918 =thread-created,id="1"
31919 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31920 ^done
31921 (gdb)
31922 @end smallexample
31923
31924 @ignore
31925 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31926 @findex -target-compare-sections
31927
31928 @subsubheading Synopsis
31929
31930 @smallexample
31931 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31932 @end smallexample
31933
31934 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31935 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31936
31937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31938
31939 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31940
31941 @subsubheading Example
31942 N.A.
31943 @end ignore
31944
31945
31946 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31947 @findex -target-detach
31948
31949 @subsubheading Synopsis
31950
31951 @smallexample
31952 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31953 @end smallexample
31954
31955 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31956 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31957 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31958
31959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31960
31961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31962
31963 @subsubheading Example
31964
31965 @smallexample
31966 (gdb)
31967 -target-detach
31968 ^done
31969 (gdb)
31970 @end smallexample
31971
31972
31973 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31974 @findex -target-disconnect
31975
31976 @subsubheading Synopsis
31977
31978 @smallexample
31979 -target-disconnect
31980 @end smallexample
31981
31982 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31983 generally not resumed.
31984
31985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31986
31987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31988
31989 @subsubheading Example
31990
31991 @smallexample
31992 (gdb)
31993 -target-disconnect
31994 ^done
31995 (gdb)
31996 @end smallexample
31997
31998
31999 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32000 @findex -target-download
32001
32002 @subsubheading Synopsis
32003
32004 @smallexample
32005 -target-download
32006 @end smallexample
32007
32008 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32009 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32010
32011 @table @samp
32012 @item section
32013 The name of the section.
32014 @item section-sent
32015 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32016 @item section-size
32017 The size of the section.
32018 @item total-sent
32019 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32020 @item total-size
32021 The size of the overall executable to download.
32022 @end table
32023
32024 @noindent
32025 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32026 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32027
32028 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32029 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32030
32031 @table @samp
32032 @item section
32033 The name of the section.
32034 @item section-size
32035 The size of the section.
32036 @item total-size
32037 The size of the overall executable to download.
32038 @end table
32039
32040 @noindent
32041 At the end, a summary is printed.
32042
32043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32044
32045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32046
32047 @subsubheading Example
32048
32049 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32050 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32051
32052 @smallexample
32053 (gdb)
32054 -target-download
32055 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32056 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32057 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32058 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32059 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32060 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32061 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32062 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32063 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32064 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32065 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32066 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32067 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32068 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32069 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32070 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32071 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32072 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32073 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32074 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32075 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32076 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32077 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32078 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32079 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32080 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32081 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32082 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32083 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32084 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32085 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32086 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32087 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32088 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32089 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32090 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32091 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32092 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32093 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32094 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32095 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32096 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32097 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32098 write-rate="429"
32099 (gdb)
32100 @end smallexample
32101
32102
32103 @ignore
32104 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32105 @findex -target-exec-status
32106
32107 @subsubheading Synopsis
32108
32109 @smallexample
32110 -target-exec-status
32111 @end smallexample
32112
32113 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32114 not, for instance).
32115
32116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32117
32118 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32119
32120 @subsubheading Example
32121 N.A.
32122
32123
32124 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32125 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32126
32127 @subsubheading Synopsis
32128
32129 @smallexample
32130 -target-list-available-targets
32131 @end smallexample
32132
32133 List the possible targets to connect to.
32134
32135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32136
32137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32138
32139 @subsubheading Example
32140 N.A.
32141
32142
32143 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32144 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32145
32146 @subsubheading Synopsis
32147
32148 @smallexample
32149 -target-list-current-targets
32150 @end smallexample
32151
32152 Describe the current target.
32153
32154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32155
32156 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32157 other things).
32158
32159 @subsubheading Example
32160 N.A.
32161
32162
32163 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32164 @findex -target-list-parameters
32165
32166 @subsubheading Synopsis
32167
32168 @smallexample
32169 -target-list-parameters
32170 @end smallexample
32171
32172 @c ????
32173 @end ignore
32174
32175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32176
32177 No equivalent.
32178
32179 @subsubheading Example
32180 N.A.
32181
32182 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32183 @findex -target-flash-erase
32184
32185 @subsubheading Synopsis
32186
32187 @smallexample
32188 -target-flash-erase
32189 @end smallexample
32190
32191 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32192
32193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32194
32195 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32196 addresses and memory region sizes.
32197
32198 @smallexample
32199 (gdb)
32200 -target-flash-erase
32201 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32202 (gdb)
32203 @end smallexample
32204
32205 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32206 @findex -target-select
32207
32208 @subsubheading Synopsis
32209
32210 @smallexample
32211 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32212 @end smallexample
32213
32214 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32215
32216 @table @samp
32217 @item @var{type}
32218 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32219 @item @var{parameters}
32220 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32221 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32222 @end table
32223
32224 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32225 which the target program is, in the following form:
32226
32227 @smallexample
32228 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32229 args=[@var{arg list}]
32230 @end smallexample
32231
32232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32233
32234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32235
32236 @subsubheading Example
32237
32238 @smallexample
32239 (gdb)
32240 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32241 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32242 (gdb)
32243 @end smallexample
32244
32245 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32246 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32247 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32248
32249
32250 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32251 @findex -target-file-put
32252
32253 @subsubheading Synopsis
32254
32255 @smallexample
32256 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32257 @end smallexample
32258
32259 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32260 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32261
32262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32263
32264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32265
32266 @subsubheading Example
32267
32268 @smallexample
32269 (gdb)
32270 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32271 ^done
32272 (gdb)
32273 @end smallexample
32274
32275
32276 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32277 @findex -target-file-get
32278
32279 @subsubheading Synopsis
32280
32281 @smallexample
32282 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32283 @end smallexample
32284
32285 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32286 on the host system.
32287
32288 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32289
32290 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32291
32292 @subsubheading Example
32293
32294 @smallexample
32295 (gdb)
32296 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32297 ^done
32298 (gdb)
32299 @end smallexample
32300
32301
32302 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32303 @findex -target-file-delete
32304
32305 @subsubheading Synopsis
32306
32307 @smallexample
32308 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32309 @end smallexample
32310
32311 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32312
32313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32314
32315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32316
32317 @subsubheading Example
32318
32319 @smallexample
32320 (gdb)
32321 -target-file-delete remotefile
32322 ^done
32323 (gdb)
32324 @end smallexample
32325
32326
32327 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32328 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32329 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32330
32331 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32332 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32333
32334 @subsubheading Synopsis
32335
32336 @smallexample
32337 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32338 @end smallexample
32339
32340 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32341 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32342 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32343
32344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32345
32346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32347
32348 @subsubheading Result
32349
32350 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32351 defined for each exception:
32352
32353 @table @samp
32354 @item name
32355 The name of the exception.
32356
32357 @item address
32358 The address of the exception.
32359
32360 @end table
32361
32362 @subsubheading Example
32363
32364 @smallexample
32365 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32366 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32367 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32368 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32369 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32370 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32371 @end smallexample
32372
32373 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32374
32375 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32376 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32377 Catchpoint Commands}.
32378
32379
32380 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32381 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32382 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32383
32384 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32385 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32386 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32387 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32388
32389 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32390 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32391 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32392
32393 @subsubheading Synopsis
32394
32395 @smallexample
32396 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32397 @end smallexample
32398
32399 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32400
32401 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32402 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32403 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32404 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32405 dash.
32406
32407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32408
32409 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32410
32411 @subsubheading Result
32412
32413 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32414
32415 @table @samp
32416 @item exists
32417 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32418 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32419
32420 @end table
32421
32422 @subsubheading Example
32423
32424 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32425
32426 @smallexample
32427 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32428 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32429 @end smallexample
32430
32431 @noindent
32432 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32433 to the debugger:
32434
32435 @smallexample
32436 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32437 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32438 @end smallexample
32439
32440 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32441 @findex -list-features
32442 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32443
32444 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32445 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32446 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32447 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32448 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32449 startup.
32450
32451 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32452 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32453 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32454 is given below.
32455
32456 Example output:
32457
32458 @smallexample
32459 (gdb) -list-features
32460 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32461 @end smallexample
32462
32463 The current list of features is:
32464
32465 @ftable @samp
32466 @item frozen-varobjs
32467 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32468 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32469 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32470 @item pending-breakpoints
32471 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32472 command.
32473 @item python
32474 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32475 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32476 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32477 @item thread-info
32478 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32479 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32480 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32481 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32482 @item breakpoint-notifications
32483 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32484 CLI will be announced via async records.
32485 @item ada-task-info
32486 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32487 @item language-option
32488 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32489 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32490 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32491 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32492 @item undefined-command-error-code
32493 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32494 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32495 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32496 @item exec-run-start-option
32497 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32498 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32499 @end ftable
32500
32501 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32502 @findex -list-target-features
32503
32504 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32505 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32506 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32507 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32508 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32509 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32510 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32511 Example output:
32512
32513 @smallexample
32514 (gdb) -list-target-features
32515 ^done,result=["async"]
32516 @end smallexample
32517
32518 The current list of features is:
32519
32520 @table @samp
32521 @item async
32522 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32523 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32524 while the target is running.
32525
32526 @item reverse
32527 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32528 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32529
32530 @end table
32531
32532 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32533 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32534 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32535
32536 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
32537
32538 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32539 @findex -gdb-exit
32540
32541 @subsubheading Synopsis
32542
32543 @smallexample
32544 -gdb-exit
32545 @end smallexample
32546
32547 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32548
32549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32550
32551 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32552
32553 @subsubheading Example
32554
32555 @smallexample
32556 (gdb)
32557 -gdb-exit
32558 ^exit
32559 @end smallexample
32560
32561
32562 @ignore
32563 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32564 @findex -exec-abort
32565
32566 @subsubheading Synopsis
32567
32568 @smallexample
32569 -exec-abort
32570 @end smallexample
32571
32572 Kill the inferior running program.
32573
32574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32575
32576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32577
32578 @subsubheading Example
32579 N.A.
32580 @end ignore
32581
32582
32583 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32584 @findex -gdb-set
32585
32586 @subsubheading Synopsis
32587
32588 @smallexample
32589 -gdb-set
32590 @end smallexample
32591
32592 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32593 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32594
32595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32596
32597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32598
32599 @subsubheading Example
32600
32601 @smallexample
32602 (gdb)
32603 -gdb-set $foo=3
32604 ^done
32605 (gdb)
32606 @end smallexample
32607
32608
32609 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32610 @findex -gdb-show
32611
32612 @subsubheading Synopsis
32613
32614 @smallexample
32615 -gdb-show
32616 @end smallexample
32617
32618 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32619
32620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32621
32622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32623
32624 @subsubheading Example
32625
32626 @smallexample
32627 (gdb)
32628 -gdb-show annotate
32629 ^done,value="0"
32630 (gdb)
32631 @end smallexample
32632
32633 @c @subheading -gdb-source
32634
32635
32636 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32637 @findex -gdb-version
32638
32639 @subsubheading Synopsis
32640
32641 @smallexample
32642 -gdb-version
32643 @end smallexample
32644
32645 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
32646
32647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32648
32649 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
32650 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32651
32652 @subsubheading Example
32653
32654 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32655 @c box in TeX.
32656 @smallexample
32657 (gdb)
32658 -gdb-version
32659 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32660 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32661 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32662 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32663 ~ certain conditions.
32664 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32665 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
32666 ~ details.
32667 ~This GDB was configured as
32668 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32669 ^done
32670 (gdb)
32671 @end smallexample
32672
32673 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32674 @findex -list-thread-groups
32675
32676 @subheading Synopsis
32677
32678 @smallexample
32679 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32680 @end smallexample
32681
32682 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
32683 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32684 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32685 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
32686 top-level thread groups.
32687
32688 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32689 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32690 available on the target.
32691
32692 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32693 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32694 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32695 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32696 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
32697 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32698 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
32699 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32700
32701 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32702 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32703 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32704 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32705 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32706 @samp{threads} field.
32707
32708 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32709 the following caveats:
32710
32711 @itemize @bullet
32712 @item
32713 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32714 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
32715 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32716
32717 @item
32718 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32719 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32720 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32721 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32722 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32723 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32724
32725 @end itemize
32726
32727 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32728 have the following fields:
32729
32730 @table @code
32731 @item id
32732 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
32733 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32734 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32735
32736 @item type
32737 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
32738 valid type.
32739
32740 @item pid
32741 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
32742 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32743
32744 @item exit-code
32745 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32746 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32747 only if the process is not running.
32748
32749 @item num_children
32750 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32751 absent for an available thread group.
32752
32753 @item threads
32754 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32755 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32756 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32757
32758 @item cores
32759 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32760 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32761 such information is not available.
32762
32763 @item executable
32764 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32765 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32766 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32767
32768 @end table
32769
32770 @subheading Example
32771
32772 @smallexample
32773 @value{GDBP}
32774 -list-thread-groups
32775 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32776 -list-thread-groups 17
32777 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32778 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32779 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32780 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32781 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32782 -list-thread-groups --available
32783 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32784 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32785 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32786 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32787 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32788 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32789 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32790 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32791 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32792 @end smallexample
32793
32794 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32795 @findex -info-os
32796
32797 @subsubheading Synopsis
32798
32799 @smallexample
32800 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32801 @end smallexample
32802
32803 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32804 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32805 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32806 of data of that type.
32807
32808 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32809 system.
32810
32811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32812
32813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32814
32815 @subsubheading Example
32816
32817 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32818 like this:
32819
32820 @smallexample
32821 @value{GDBP}
32822 -info-os
32823 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32824 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32825 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32826 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32827 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32828 col2="CPUs"@},
32829 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32830 col2="File descriptors"@},
32831 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32832 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32833 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32834 col2="Message queues"@},
32835 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32836 col2="Processes"@},
32837 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32838 col2="Process groups"@},
32839 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32840 col2="Semaphores"@},
32841 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32842 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32843 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32844 col2="Sockets"@},
32845 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32846 col2="Threads"@}]
32847 @value{GDBP}
32848 -info-os processes
32849 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32850 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32851 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32852 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32853 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32854 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32855 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32856 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32857 ...
32858 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32859 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32860 (gdb)
32861 @end smallexample
32862
32863 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32864 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32865 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32866 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32867 @code{info os} omits it.)
32868
32869 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32870 @findex -add-inferior
32871
32872 @subheading Synopsis
32873
32874 @smallexample
32875 -add-inferior
32876 @end smallexample
32877
32878 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32879 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32880 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32881 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32882 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32883 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32884
32885 @subheading Example
32886
32887 @smallexample
32888 @value{GDBP}
32889 -add-inferior
32890 ^done,inferior="i3"
32891 @end smallexample
32892
32893 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32894 @findex -interpreter-exec
32895
32896 @subheading Synopsis
32897
32898 @smallexample
32899 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32900 @end smallexample
32901 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32902
32903 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32904
32905 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32906
32907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32908
32909 @subheading Example
32910
32911 @smallexample
32912 (gdb)
32913 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32914 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32915 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32916 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32917 ^done
32918 (gdb)
32919 @end smallexample
32920
32921 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32922 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32923
32924 @subheading Synopsis
32925
32926 @smallexample
32927 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32928 @end smallexample
32929
32930 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32931
32932 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32933
32934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32935
32936 @subheading Example
32937
32938 @smallexample
32939 (gdb)
32940 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32941 ^done
32942 (gdb)
32943 @end smallexample
32944
32945 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32946 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32947
32948 @subheading Synopsis
32949
32950 @smallexample
32951 -inferior-tty-show
32952 @end smallexample
32953
32954 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32955
32956 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32957
32958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32959
32960 @subheading Example
32961
32962 @smallexample
32963 (gdb)
32964 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32965 ^done
32966 (gdb)
32967 -inferior-tty-show
32968 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32969 (gdb)
32970 @end smallexample
32971
32972 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32973 @findex -enable-timings
32974
32975 @subheading Synopsis
32976
32977 @smallexample
32978 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32979 @end smallexample
32980
32981 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32982 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32983 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32984 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32985
32986 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32987
32988 No equivalent.
32989
32990 @subheading Example
32991
32992 @smallexample
32993 (gdb)
32994 -enable-timings
32995 ^done
32996 (gdb)
32997 -break-insert main
32998 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32999 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33000 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33001 times="0"@},
33002 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33003 (gdb)
33004 -enable-timings no
33005 ^done
33006 (gdb)
33007 -exec-run
33008 ^running
33009 (gdb)
33010 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33011 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33012 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33013 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33014 (gdb)
33015 @end smallexample
33016
33017 @node Annotations
33018 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33019
33020 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33021 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33022 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33023 relatively high level.
33024
33025 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33026 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33027
33028 @ignore
33029 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33030 @end ignore
33031
33032 @menu
33033 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33034 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33035 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33036 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33037 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33038 * Annotations for Running::
33039 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33040 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33041 @end menu
33042
33043 @node Annotations Overview
33044 @section What is an Annotation?
33045 @cindex annotations
33046
33047 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33048 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33049 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33050 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33051 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33052 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33053 cannot contain newline characters.
33054
33055 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33056 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33057 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33058 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33059 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33060 means those three characters as output.
33061
33062 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33063 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33064 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33065 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33066 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33067 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33068 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33069 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33070 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33071
33072 @table @code
33073 @kindex set annotate
33074 @item set annotate @var{level}
33075 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33076 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33077
33078 @item show annotate
33079 @kindex show annotate
33080 Show the current annotation level.
33081 @end table
33082
33083 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33084
33085 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33086
33087 @smallexample
33088 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33089 GNU gdb 6.0
33090 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33091 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33092 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33093 under certain conditions.
33094 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33095 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33096 for details.
33097 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33098
33099 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33100 (@value{GDBP})
33101 ^Z^Zprompt
33102 @kbd{quit}
33103
33104 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33105 $
33106 @end smallexample
33107
33108 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33109 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33110 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33111 output from @value{GDBN}.
33112
33113 @node Server Prefix
33114 @section The Server Prefix
33115 @cindex server prefix
33116
33117 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33118 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33119 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33120 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33121 a transparent manner.
33122
33123 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33124 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33125 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33126 @code{print} command.
33127
33128 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33129 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33130
33131 @node Prompting
33132 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33133
33134 @cindex annotations for prompts
33135 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33136 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33137 over, etc.
33138
33139 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33140 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33141 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33142 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33143 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33144 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33145 features the following annotations:
33146
33147 @smallexample
33148 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33149 ^Z^Zprompt
33150 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33151 @end smallexample
33152
33153 The input types are
33154
33155 @table @code
33156 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33157 @findex prompt annotation
33158 @findex post-prompt annotation
33159 @item prompt
33160 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33161
33162 @findex pre-commands annotation
33163 @findex commands annotation
33164 @findex post-commands annotation
33165 @item commands
33166 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33167 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33168
33169 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33170 @findex overload-choice annotation
33171 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33172 @item overload-choice
33173 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33174
33175 @findex pre-query annotation
33176 @findex query annotation
33177 @findex post-query annotation
33178 @item query
33179 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33180
33181 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33182 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33183 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33184 @item prompt-for-continue
33185 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33186 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33187 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33188 presence of annotations.
33189 @end table
33190
33191 @node Errors
33192 @section Errors
33193 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33194
33195 @findex quit annotation
33196 @smallexample
33197 ^Z^Zquit
33198 @end smallexample
33199
33200 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33201
33202 @findex error annotation
33203 @smallexample
33204 ^Z^Zerror
33205 @end smallexample
33206
33207 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33208
33209 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33210 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33211 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33212 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33213 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33214 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33215 to the top level.
33216
33217 @findex error-begin annotation
33218 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33219
33220 @smallexample
33221 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33222 @end smallexample
33223
33224 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33225 message.
33226
33227 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33228 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33229 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33230
33231 @node Invalidation
33232 @section Invalidation Notices
33233
33234 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33235 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33236 changed.
33237
33238 @table @code
33239 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33240 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33241
33242 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33243 have changed.
33244
33245 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33246 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33247
33248 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33249 deleted a breakpoint.
33250 @end table
33251
33252 @node Annotations for Running
33253 @section Running the Program
33254 @cindex annotations for running programs
33255
33256 @findex starting annotation
33257 @findex stopping annotation
33258 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33259 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33260
33261 @smallexample
33262 ^Z^Zstarting
33263 @end smallexample
33264
33265 is output. When the program stops,
33266
33267 @smallexample
33268 ^Z^Zstopped
33269 @end smallexample
33270
33271 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33272 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33273
33274 @table @code
33275 @findex exited annotation
33276 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33277 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33278 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33279
33280 @findex signalled annotation
33281 @findex signal-name annotation
33282 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33283 @findex signal-string annotation
33284 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33285 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33286 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33287 annotation continues:
33288
33289 @smallexample
33290 @var{intro-text}
33291 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33292 @var{name}
33293 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33294 @var{middle-text}
33295 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33296 @var{string}
33297 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33298 @var{end-text}
33299 @end smallexample
33300
33301 @noindent
33302 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33303 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33304 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33305 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33306 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33307
33308 @findex signal annotation
33309 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33310 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33311 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33312 terminated with it.
33313
33314 @findex breakpoint annotation
33315 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33316 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33317
33318 @findex watchpoint annotation
33319 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33320 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33321 @end table
33322
33323 @node Source Annotations
33324 @section Displaying Source
33325 @cindex annotations for source display
33326
33327 @findex source annotation
33328 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33329
33330 @smallexample
33331 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33332 @end smallexample
33333
33334 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33335 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33336 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33337 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33338 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33339 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33340 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33341 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33342 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33343 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33344 depend on the language).
33345
33346 @node JIT Interface
33347 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33348 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33349 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33350
33351 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33352 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33353 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33354 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33355
33356 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33357 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33358 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33359 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33360 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33361 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33362
33363 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33364 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33365 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33366 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33367 LLVM JIT.
33368
33369 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33370 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33371 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33372 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33373 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33374 out about additional code.
33375
33376 @menu
33377 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33378 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33379 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33380 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33381 @end menu
33382
33383 @node Declarations
33384 @section JIT Declarations
33385
33386 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33387 implement the interface:
33388
33389 @smallexample
33390 typedef enum
33391 @{
33392 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33393 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33394 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33395 @} jit_actions_t;
33396
33397 struct jit_code_entry
33398 @{
33399 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33400 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33401 const char *symfile_addr;
33402 uint64_t symfile_size;
33403 @};
33404
33405 struct jit_descriptor
33406 @{
33407 uint32_t version;
33408 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33409 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33410 uint32_t action_flag;
33411 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33412 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33413 @};
33414
33415 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33416 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33417
33418 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33419 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33420 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33421 @end smallexample
33422
33423 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33424 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33425 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33426
33427 @node Registering Code
33428 @section Registering Code
33429
33430 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33431
33432 @itemize @bullet
33433 @item
33434 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33435 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33436
33437 @item
33438 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33439 file.
33440
33441 @item
33442 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33443
33444 @item
33445 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33446
33447 @item
33448 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33449 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33450 @end itemize
33451
33452 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33453 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33454 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33455 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33456
33457 @node Unregistering Code
33458 @section Unregistering Code
33459
33460 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33461
33462 @itemize @bullet
33463 @item
33464 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33465
33466 @item
33467 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33468
33469 @item
33470 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33471 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33472 @end itemize
33473
33474 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33475 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33476
33477 @node Custom Debug Info
33478 @section Custom Debug Info
33479 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33480 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33481
33482 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33483 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33484 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33485 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33486 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33487 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33488 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33489 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33490 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33491
33492 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33493 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33494 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33495 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33496 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33497 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33498 compiler.
33499
33500 @menu
33501 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33502 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33503 @end menu
33504
33505 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33506 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33507 @kindex jit-reader-load
33508 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33509
33510 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33511 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33512
33513 @table @code
33514 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33515 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33516 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33517 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33518 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33519 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33520 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33521
33522 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33523 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33524 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33525 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33526 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33527
33528 @item jit-reader-unload
33529 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33530
33531 @end table
33532
33533 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33534 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33535 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33536
33537 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33538 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33539
33540 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33541 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
33542 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33543 the system include directory.
33544
33545 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
33546 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33547 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33548
33549 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33550 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33551
33552 @findex gdb_init_reader
33553 @smallexample
33554 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33555 @end smallexample
33556
33557 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33558
33559 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33560 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
33561 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33562 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33563 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
33564 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
33565
33566 @smallexample
33567 struct gdb_reader_funcs
33568 @{
33569 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
33570 int reader_version;
33571
33572 /* For use by the reader. */
33573 void *priv_data;
33574
33575 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33576 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33577 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33578 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33579 @};
33580 @end smallexample
33581
33582 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33583 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33584
33585 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33586 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33587 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33588 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33589 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33590 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
33591 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33592 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33593 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33594 target's address space.
33595
33596 @node In-Process Agent
33597 @chapter In-Process Agent
33598 @cindex debugging agent
33599 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33600 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
33601 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33602 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33603 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33604 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33605 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
33606 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33607 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33608 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33609 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33610 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33611 behavior without interrupting it.
33612
33613 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33614 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33615 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
33616 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33617 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33618 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33619 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
33620 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33621 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33622
33623 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33624 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
33625 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33626 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33627
33628 @anchor{Control Agent}
33629 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33630 debugging with the following commands:
33631
33632 @table @code
33633 @kindex set agent on
33634 @item set agent on
33635 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33636 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33637 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
33638 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33639 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33640 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33641
33642 @kindex set agent off
33643 @item set agent off
33644 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
33645 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33646
33647 @kindex show agent
33648 @item show agent
33649 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33650 the in-process agent.
33651 @end table
33652
33653 @menu
33654 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
33655 @end menu
33656
33657 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
33658 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
33659 @cindex in-process agent protocol
33660
33661 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33662 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
33663 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33664 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33665 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33666 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33667 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33668 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33669 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33670
33671 @menu
33672 * IPA Protocol Objects::
33673 * IPA Protocol Commands::
33674 @end menu
33675
33676 @node IPA Protocol Objects
33677 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33678 @cindex ipa protocol objects
33679
33680 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33681 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33682
33683 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33684 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33685 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33686 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33687
33688 @enumerate
33689 @item
33690 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33691 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33692 @item
33693 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33694 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33695 the other one.
33696 @end enumerate
33697
33698 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33699
33700 @enumerate
33701 @item
33702 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
33703 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33704 @anchor{agent expression object}
33705 @item
33706 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
33707 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33708 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33709 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
33710 @item
33711 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33712 @anchor{tracepoint object}
33713
33714 @end enumerate
33715
33716 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33717 object:
33718
33719 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33720 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33721 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33722 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33723 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33724 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33725 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33726 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33727 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33728 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33729 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33730 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33731 memory address for collecting.
33732 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33733 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33734 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33735 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33736 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33737 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33738 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33739 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33740 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33741 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33742 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33743 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33744 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33745 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33746 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33747 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33748 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33749 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33750 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33751 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33752 @ref{agent expression object}
33753 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33754 @ref{agent expression object}
33755 @item actions @tab variable
33756 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33757 @end multitable
33758
33759 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33760 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33761 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33762
33763 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33764 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33765
33766 @table @samp
33767
33768 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33769 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33770 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33771 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33772 in IPA finally.
33773
33774 Replies:
33775 @table @samp
33776 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33777 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33778 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33779 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33780 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33781 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33782 @item E @var{NN}
33783 for an error
33784
33785 @end table
33786
33787 @item close
33788 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33789 is about to kill inferiors.
33790
33791 @item qTfSTM
33792 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33793 @item qTsSTM
33794 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33795 @item qTSTMat
33796 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33797 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33798 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33799
33800 Replies:
33801 @table @samp
33802 @item E @var{NN}
33803 for an error
33804 @end table
33805 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33806 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33807 @end table
33808
33809 @node GDB Bugs
33810 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33811 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33812 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33813
33814 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33815
33816 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33817 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33818 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33819 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33820
33821 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33822 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33823
33824 @menu
33825 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33826 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33827 @end menu
33828
33829 @node Bug Criteria
33830 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33831 @cindex bug criteria
33832
33833 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33834
33835 @itemize @bullet
33836 @cindex fatal signal
33837 @cindex debugger crash
33838 @cindex crash of debugger
33839 @item
33840 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33841 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33842
33843 @cindex error on valid input
33844 @item
33845 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33846 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33847 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33848
33849 @cindex invalid input
33850 @item
33851 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33852 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33853 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33854 for traditional practice''.
33855
33856 @item
33857 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33858 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33859 @end itemize
33860
33861 @node Bug Reporting
33862 @section How to Report Bugs
33863 @cindex bug reports
33864 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33865
33866 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33867 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33868 contact that organization first.
33869
33870 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33871 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33872 distribution.
33873 @c should add a web page ref...
33874
33875 @ifset BUGURL
33876 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33877 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33878 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33879 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33880 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33881 be used.
33882
33883 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33884 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33885 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33886 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33887
33888 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33889 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33890 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33891 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33892 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33893 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33894 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33895 bug reports to the mailing list.
33896 @end ifset
33897 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33898 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33899 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33900 @end ifclear
33901 @end ifset
33902
33903 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33904 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33905 fact or leave it out, state it!
33906
33907 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33908 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33909 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33910 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33911 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33912 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33913 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33914 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33915 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33916
33917 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33918 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33919 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33920 self-contained.
33921
33922 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33923 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33924 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33925 bugs properly.
33926
33927 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33928
33929 @itemize @bullet
33930 @item
33931 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33932 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33933 version}.
33934
33935 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33936 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33937
33938 @item
33939 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33940 version number.
33941
33942 @item
33943 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33944 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33945 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33946 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33947
33948 @item
33949 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33950 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33951
33952 @item
33953 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33954 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33955 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33956 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33957 those compilers.
33958
33959 @item
33960 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33961 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33962 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33963 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33964
33965 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33966 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33967
33968 @item
33969 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33970 reproduce the bug.
33971
33972 @item
33973 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33974 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33975
33976 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33977 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33978 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33979 a chance to make a mistake.
33980
33981 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33982 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33983 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33984 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33985 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33986 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33987 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33988 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33989
33990 @pindex script
33991 @cindex recording a session script
33992 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33993 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33994 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33995 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33996
33997 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33998 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33999
34000 @item
34001 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34002 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34003 it by context, not by line number.
34004
34005 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34006 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34007
34008 @end itemize
34009
34010 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34011
34012 @itemize @bullet
34013 @item
34014 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34015
34016 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34017 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34018 changes will not affect it.
34019
34020 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34021 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34022 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34023 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34024
34025 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34026 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34027 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34028 less time, and so on.
34029
34030 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34031 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34032
34033 @item
34034 A patch for the bug.
34035
34036 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34037 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34038 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34039 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34040
34041 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34042 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34043 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34044 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34045
34046 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34047 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34048 help us to understand.
34049
34050 @item
34051 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34052
34053 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34054 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34055 @end itemize
34056
34057 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34058 @c and consists of the two following files:
34059 @c rluser.texi
34060 @c hsuser.texi
34061 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34062 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34063 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34064 @include rluser.texi
34065 @include hsuser.texi
34066 @end ifclear
34067
34068 @node In Memoriam
34069 @appendix In Memoriam
34070
34071 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34072 contributors:
34073
34074 @table @code
34075 @item Fred Fish
34076 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34077 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34078 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34079
34080 @item Michael Snyder
34081 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34082 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34083 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34084 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34085 @end table
34086
34087 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34088 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34089
34090 @node Formatting Documentation
34091 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34092
34093 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34094 @cindex reference card
34095 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34096 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34097 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34098 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34099 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34100 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34101
34102 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34103 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34104
34105 @smallexample
34106 make refcard.dvi
34107 @end smallexample
34108
34109 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34110 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34111 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34112 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34113 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34114
34115 @cindex documentation
34116
34117 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34118 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34119 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34120 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34121 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34122 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34123
34124 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34125 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34126 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34127 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34128 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34129 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34130 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34131 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34132
34133 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34134 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34135 @code{makeinfo}.
34136
34137 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34138 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34139 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34140
34141 @smallexample
34142 cd gdb
34143 make gdb.info
34144 @end smallexample
34145
34146 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34147 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34148 Texinfo definitions file.
34149
34150 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34151 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34152 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34153 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34154 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34155 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34156 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34157
34158 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34159 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34160 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34161 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34162 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34163 directory.
34164
34165 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34166 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34167 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34168 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34169
34170 @smallexample
34171 make gdb.dvi
34172 @end smallexample
34173
34174 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34175
34176 @node Installing GDB
34177 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34178 @cindex installation
34179
34180 @menu
34181 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34182 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34183 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34184 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34185 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34186 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34187 @end menu
34188
34189 @node Requirements
34190 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34191 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34192
34193 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34194 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34195
34196 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34197 @table @asis
34198 @item ISO C90 compiler
34199 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34200 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34201
34202 @end table
34203
34204 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34205 @table @asis
34206 @item Expat
34207 @anchor{Expat}
34208 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34209 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34210 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34211 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34212 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34213 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34214
34215 Expat is used for:
34216
34217 @itemize @bullet
34218 @item
34219 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34220 @item
34221 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34222 @item
34223 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34224 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34225 @item
34226 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34227 @item
34228 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34229 @item
34230 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34231 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34232 @end itemize
34233
34234 @item zlib
34235 @cindex compressed debug sections
34236 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34237 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34238 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34239 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34240 information in such binaries.
34241
34242 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34243 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34244 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34245
34246 @item iconv
34247 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34248 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34249 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34250 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34251
34252 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34253 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34254 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34255 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34256
34257 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34258 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34259 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34260
34261 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34262 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34263 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34264 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34265 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34266 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34267 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34268 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34269 @end table
34270
34271 @node Running Configure
34272 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34273 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34274 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34275 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34276 build the @code{gdb} program.
34277 @iftex
34278 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34279 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34280 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34281 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34282 @end iftex
34283
34284 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34285 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34286 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34287
34288 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34289 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34290
34291 @table @code
34292 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34293 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34294
34295 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34296 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34297
34298 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34299 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34300
34301 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34302 @sc{gnu} include files
34303
34304 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34305 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34306
34307 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34308 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34309
34310 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34311 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34312
34313 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34314 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34315
34316 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34317 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34318 @end table
34319
34320 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34321 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34322 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34323
34324 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34325 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34326 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34327 argument.
34328
34329 For example:
34330
34331 @smallexample
34332 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34333 ./configure @var{host}
34334 make
34335 @end smallexample
34336
34337 @noindent
34338 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34339 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34340 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34341 correct value by examining your system.)
34342
34343 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34344 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34345 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34346 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34347
34348 @need 750
34349 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34350 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34351 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34352
34353 @smallexample
34354 sh configure @var{host}
34355 @end smallexample
34356
34357 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34358 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34359 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34360 @file{configure}
34361 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34362 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34363
34364 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34365 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34366 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34367 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34368 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34369 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34370 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34371 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34372 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34373
34374 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34375 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34376 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34377 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34378 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34379
34380 @node Separate Objdir
34381 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34382
34383 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34384 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34385 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34386 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34387 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34388 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34389 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34390 program specified there.
34391
34392 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34393 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34394 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34395 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34396 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34397 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34398
34399 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34400 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34401
34402 @smallexample
34403 @group
34404 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34405 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34406 cd ../gdb-sun4
34407 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34408 make
34409 @end group
34410 @end smallexample
34411
34412 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34413 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34414 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34415 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34416 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34417 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34418
34419 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34420 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34421 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34422 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34423 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34424
34425 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34426 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34427 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34428 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34429 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34430 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34431
34432 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34433 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34434 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34435
34436 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34437 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34438 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34439 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34440 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34441
34442 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34443 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34444 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34445 with each other.
34446
34447 @node Config Names
34448 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34449
34450 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34451 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34452 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34453 of information in the following pattern:
34454
34455 @smallexample
34456 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34457 @end smallexample
34458
34459 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34460 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34461 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34462
34463 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34464 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34465 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34466 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34467 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34468 abbreviations---for example:
34469
34470 @smallexample
34471 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34472 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34473 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34474 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34475 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34476 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34477 % sh config.sub sun4
34478 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34479 % sh config.sub sun3
34480 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34481 % sh config.sub i986v
34482 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34483 @end smallexample
34484
34485 @noindent
34486 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34487 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34488
34489 @node Configure Options
34490 @section @file{configure} Options
34491
34492 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34493 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34494 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34495 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34496
34497 @smallexample
34498 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34499 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34500 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34501 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34502 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34503 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34504 @var{host}
34505 @end smallexample
34506
34507 @noindent
34508 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34509 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34510 @samp{--}.
34511
34512 @table @code
34513 @item --help
34514 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34515
34516 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
34517 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34518 @file{@var{dir}}.
34519
34520 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34521 Configure the source to install programs under directory
34522 @file{@var{dir}}.
34523
34524 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34525 @need 2000
34526 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34527 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34528 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34529 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34530 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
34531 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34532 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34533 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34534 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
34535 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34536 @var{dirname}.
34537
34538 @item --norecursion
34539 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34540 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34541
34542 @item --target=@var{target}
34543 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34544 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34545 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34546
34547 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34548
34549 @item @var{host} @dots{}
34550 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34551
34552 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34553 @end table
34554
34555 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34556 needed for special purposes only.
34557
34558 @node System-wide configuration
34559 @section System-wide configuration and settings
34560 @cindex system-wide init file
34561
34562 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34563 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34564 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34565
34566 Here is the corresponding configure option:
34567
34568 @table @code
34569 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34570 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34571 @var{file}.
34572 @end table
34573
34574 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34575 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
34576
34577 @itemize @bullet
34578 @item
34579 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34580 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
34581 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34582 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34583 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34584 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34585
34586 @item
34587 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34588 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34589 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34590 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34591 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34592 @end itemize
34593
34594 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34595 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34596 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34597 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34598 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34599 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34600 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34601 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34602 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34603 reread.
34604
34605 @menu
34606 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34607 @end menu
34608
34609 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34610 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34611 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34612
34613 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34614 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34615 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
34616 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34617 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
34618 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34619
34620 The following scripts are currently available:
34621 @itemize @bullet
34622
34623 @item @file{elinos.py}
34624 @pindex elinos.py
34625 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34626 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34627 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34628 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34629 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34630 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34631
34632 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34633 @pindex wrs-linux.py
34634 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34635 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34636 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34637 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34638
34639 @end itemize
34640
34641 @node Maintenance Commands
34642 @appendix Maintenance Commands
34643 @cindex maintenance commands
34644 @cindex internal commands
34645
34646 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34647 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34648 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
34649 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
34650 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34651
34652 @table @code
34653 @kindex maint agent
34654 @kindex maint agent-eval
34655 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34656 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34657 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34658 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34659 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
34660 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34661 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34662 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34663 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34664 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34665 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34666 addition and return the sum.
34667 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34668 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34669
34670 @kindex maint agent-printf
34671 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34672 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34673 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34674 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34675 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34676
34677 @kindex maint info breakpoints
34678 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34679 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34680 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34681 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34682 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34683 is shown:
34684
34685 @table @code
34686 @item breakpoint
34687 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34688
34689 @item watchpoint
34690 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34691
34692 @item longjmp
34693 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34694 @code{longjmp} calls.
34695
34696 @item longjmp resume
34697 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34698
34699 @item until
34700 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34701
34702 @item finish
34703 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34704
34705 @item shlib events
34706 Shared library events.
34707
34708 @end table
34709
34710 @kindex maint info btrace
34711 @item maint info btrace
34712 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34713
34714 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
34715 @item maint btrace packet-history
34716 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34717 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
34718 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34719 recording format.
34720
34721 @table @code
34722 @item bts
34723 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34724 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
34725
34726 @table @asis
34727 @item Block number
34728 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
34729 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
34730 @item Highest @samp{PC}
34731 @end table
34732
34733 @item pt
34734 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34735 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
34736 information is printed:
34737
34738 @table @asis
34739 @item Packet number
34740 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
34741 @item Trace offset
34742 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34743 @item Packet opcode and payload
34744 @end table
34745 @end table
34746
34747 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34748 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34749 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34750 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34751 needed.
34752
34753 @kindex maint btrace clear
34754 @item maint btrace clear
34755 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34756 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34757
34758 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34759 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34760 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34761 buffer.
34762
34763 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34764 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34765 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34766 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34767 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34768 packet history.
34769
34770 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34771 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34772 @cindex displaced stepping support
34773 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34774 @item set displaced-stepping
34775 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34776 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34777 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34778 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34779 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34780 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34781
34782 @table @code
34783 @item set displaced-stepping on
34784 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34785 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34786
34787 @item set displaced-stepping off
34788 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34789 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34790
34791 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34792 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34793 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34794 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34795 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34796 @end table
34797
34798 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34799 @item maint check-psymtabs
34800 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34801 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34802
34803 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34804 @item maint check-symtabs
34805 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34806
34807 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34808 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34809 Expand symbol tables.
34810 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34811 names matching @var{regexp}.
34812
34813 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34814 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34815 @cindex demangler crashes
34816 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34817 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34818 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34819 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34820 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34821 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34822 option to terminate the current session.
34823
34824 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34825 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34826 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34827
34828 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34829 @item maint cplus namespace
34830 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34831
34832 @kindex maint deprecate
34833 @kindex maint undeprecate
34834 @cindex deprecated commands
34835 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34836 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34837 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34838 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34839 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34840 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34841 the replacement as part of the warning.
34842
34843 @kindex maint dump-me
34844 @item maint dump-me
34845 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34846 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34847 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34848 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34849
34850 @kindex maint internal-error
34851 @kindex maint internal-warning
34852 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34853 @cindex demangler crashes
34854 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34855 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34856 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34857
34858 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34859 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34860 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34861 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34862 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34863 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34864 @value{GDBN} session.
34865
34866 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34867 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34868
34869 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34870
34871 @smallexample
34872 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34873 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34874 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34875 debugging may prove unreliable.
34876 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34877 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34878 (@value{GDBP})
34879 @end smallexample
34880
34881 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34882 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34883 @cindex demangler crashes
34884
34885 @kindex maint set internal-error
34886 @kindex maint show internal-error
34887 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34888 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34889 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34890 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34891 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34892 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34893 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34894 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34895 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34896 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34897 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34898 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34899 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34900 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34901 described in the table below.
34902
34903 @table @samp
34904 @item quit
34905 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34906 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34907
34908 @item corefile
34909 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34910 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34911 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34912 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34913 disabled.
34914 @end table
34915
34916 @kindex maint packet
34917 @item maint packet @var{text}
34918 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34919 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34920 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34921 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34922 checksum.
34923
34924 @kindex maint print architecture
34925 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34926 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34927 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34928
34929 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34930 @item maint print c-tdesc
34931 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34932 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
34933 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
34934 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
34935 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
34936 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
34937 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
34938 modify XML target descriptions.
34939
34940 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
34941 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
34942 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
34943 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
34944
34945 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34946 @item maint print dummy-frames
34947 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34948
34949 @smallexample
34950 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34951 @dots{}
34952 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34953 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34954 58 return (a + b);
34955 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34956 @dots{}
34957 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34958 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34959 (@value{GDBP})
34960 @end smallexample
34961
34962 Takes an optional file parameter.
34963
34964 @kindex maint print registers
34965 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34966 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34967 @kindex maint print register-groups
34968 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34969 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34970 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34971 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34972 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34973 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34974 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34975
34976 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34977 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34978 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34979 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34980 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34981 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34982 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34983 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34984
34985 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34986 write the information.
34987
34988 @kindex maint print reggroups
34989 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34990 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34991 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34992 information.
34993
34994 The register groups info looks like this:
34995
34996 @smallexample
34997 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34998 Group Type
34999 general user
35000 float user
35001 all user
35002 vector user
35003 system user
35004 save internal
35005 restore internal
35006 @end smallexample
35007
35008 @kindex flushregs
35009 @item flushregs
35010 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35011
35012 @kindex maint print objfiles
35013 @cindex info for known object files
35014 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35015 Print a dump of all known object files.
35016 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35017 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35018 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35019
35020 @kindex maint print user-registers
35021 @cindex user registers
35022 @item maint print user-registers
35023 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35024 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35025 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35026 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35027 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35028 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35029 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35030
35031 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35032 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35033 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35034 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35035 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35036 matching @var{regexp}.
35037 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35038 and the full path if known.
35039 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35040
35041 @kindex maint print statistics
35042 @cindex bcache statistics
35043 @item maint print statistics
35044 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35045 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35046 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35047 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35048 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35049 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35050 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35051 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35052 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35053 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35054 lengths.
35055
35056 @kindex maint print target-stack
35057 @cindex target stack description
35058 @item maint print target-stack
35059 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35060 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35061 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35062 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35063 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35064 address.
35065
35066 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35067 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35068
35069 @kindex maint print type
35070 @cindex type chain of a data type
35071 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35072 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35073 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35074 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35075 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35076 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35077
35078 @kindex maint selftest
35079 @cindex self tests
35080 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35081 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35082 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35083 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35084 name will by ran.
35085
35086 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35087 @cindex self tests
35088 @item maint info selftests
35089 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35090
35091 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35092 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35093 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35094 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35095 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35096 information.
35097
35098 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35099 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35100 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35101 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35102 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35103 always see the disassembly form.
35104
35105 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35106
35107 @smallexample
35108 (gdb) info addr argc
35109 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35110 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35111 @end smallexample
35112
35113 For more information on these expressions, see
35114 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35115
35116 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35117 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35118 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35119 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35120 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35121
35122 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35123 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35124 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35125 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35126 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35127 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35128 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35129 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35130 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35131
35132 @kindex maint set profile
35133 @kindex maint show profile
35134 @cindex profiling GDB
35135 @item maint set profile
35136 @itemx maint show profile
35137 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35138
35139 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35140 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35141 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35142 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35143 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35144 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35145 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35146
35147 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35148 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35149
35150 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35151 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35152 @cindex hardware debug registers
35153 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35154 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35155 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35156 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35157 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35158 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35159 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35160
35161 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35162 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35163 @item maint set show-all-tib
35164 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35165 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35166 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35167 command.
35168
35169 @kindex maint set target-async
35170 @kindex maint show target-async
35171 @item maint set target-async
35172 @itemx maint show target-async
35173 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35174 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35175 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35176 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35177
35178 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35179 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35180 @item maint set target-non-stop
35181 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35182
35183 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35184 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35185 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35186 if supported by the target.
35187
35188 @table @code
35189 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35190 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35191 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35192
35193 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35194 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35195 does not indicate support.
35196
35197 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35198 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35199 target supports it.
35200 @end table
35201
35202 @kindex maint set per-command
35203 @kindex maint show per-command
35204 @item maint set per-command
35205 @itemx maint show per-command
35206 @cindex resources used by commands
35207
35208 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35209 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35210
35211 @table @code
35212 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35213 @itemx maint show per-command space
35214 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35215 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35216 took, following the command's own output.
35217 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35218 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35219
35220 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35221 @itemx maint show per-command time
35222 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35223 for each command.
35224 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35225 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35226 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35227 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35228 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35229 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35230 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35231 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35232 spent by the program been debugged.
35233 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35234 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35235
35236 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35237 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35238 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35239 for each command.
35240 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35241
35242 @enumerate a
35243 @item
35244 number of symbol tables
35245 @item
35246 number of primary symbol tables
35247 @item
35248 number of blocks in the blockvector
35249 @end enumerate
35250 @end table
35251
35252 @kindex maint space
35253 @cindex memory used by commands
35254 @item maint space @var{value}
35255 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35256 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35257
35258 @kindex maint time
35259 @cindex time of command execution
35260 @item maint time @var{value}
35261 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35262 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35263
35264 @kindex maint translate-address
35265 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35266 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35267 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35268 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35269 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35270 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35271 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35272
35273 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35274 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35275 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35276
35277 @end table
35278
35279 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35280 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35281
35282 @table @code
35283 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35284 @kindex set watchdog
35285 @cindex watchdog timer
35286 @cindex timeout for commands
35287 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35288 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35289 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35290
35291 @item show watchdog
35292 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35293 @end table
35294
35295 @node Remote Protocol
35296 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35297
35298 @menu
35299 * Overview::
35300 * Packets::
35301 * Stop Reply Packets::
35302 * General Query Packets::
35303 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35304 * Tracepoint Packets::
35305 * Host I/O Packets::
35306 * Interrupts::
35307 * Notification Packets::
35308 * Remote Non-Stop::
35309 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35310 * Examples::
35311 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35312 * Library List Format::
35313 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35314 * Memory Map Format::
35315 * Thread List Format::
35316 * Traceframe Info Format::
35317 * Branch Trace Format::
35318 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35319 @end menu
35320
35321 @node Overview
35322 @section Overview
35323
35324 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35325 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35326 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35327 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35328
35329 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35330 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35331
35332 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35333 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35334 @cindex remote serial protocol
35335 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35336 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35337 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35338 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35339 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35340
35341 @smallexample
35342 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35343 @end smallexample
35344 @noindent
35345
35346 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35347 @noindent
35348 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35349 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35350 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35351
35352 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35353 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35354
35355 @smallexample
35356 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35357 @end smallexample
35358
35359 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35360 @noindent
35361 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35362 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35363 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35364
35365 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35366 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35367 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35368 retransmission):
35369
35370 @smallexample
35371 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35372 <- @code{+}
35373 @end smallexample
35374 @noindent
35375
35376 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35377 once a connection is established.
35378 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35379
35380 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35381 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35382 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35383 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35384 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35385 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35386 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35387
35388 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35389 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35390 exceptions).
35391
35392 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35393 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35394 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35395 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35396
35397 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35398 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35399 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35400
35401 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35402 @anchor{Binary Data}
35403 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35404 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35405 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35406 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35407 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35408 binary data.
35409
35410 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35411 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35412 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35413 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35414 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35415 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35416 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35417 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35418 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35419 (described next).
35420
35421 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35422 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35423 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35424 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35425 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35426 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35427 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35428 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35429 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35430 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35431 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35432 3}} more times.
35433
35434 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35435 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35436 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35437 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35438 @samp{0*"00}.
35439
35440 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35441 error number. That number is not well defined.
35442
35443 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35444 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35445 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35446 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35447 on that response.
35448
35449 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35450 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35451 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35452 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35453 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35454 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35455
35456 @node Packets
35457 @section Packets
35458
35459 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35460 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35461 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35462 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35463
35464 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35465 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35466 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35467 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35468 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35469 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35470 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35471 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35472 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35473 @var{baz}.
35474
35475 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35476 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35477 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35478 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35479 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35480 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35481 pick any thread.
35482
35483 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35484 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35485 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35486 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35487 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35488 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35489 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35490 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35491 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35492 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35493 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35494 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35495 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35496
35497 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35498 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35499 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35500 more information.
35501
35502 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35503 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35504
35505 Here are the packet descriptions.
35506
35507 @table @samp
35508
35509 @item !
35510 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35511 @anchor{extended mode}
35512 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35513 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35514 debugged.
35515
35516 Reply:
35517 @table @samp
35518 @item OK
35519 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35520 @end table
35521
35522 @item ?
35523 @cindex @samp{?} packet
35524 @anchor{? packet}
35525 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
35526 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
35527 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35528
35529 Reply:
35530 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35531
35532 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35533 @cindex @samp{A} packet
35534 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35535 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35536 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35537
35538 Reply:
35539 @table @samp
35540 @item OK
35541 The arguments were set.
35542 @item E @var{NN}
35543 An error occurred.
35544 @end table
35545
35546 @item b @var{baud}
35547 @cindex @samp{b} packet
35548 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35549 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35550
35551 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
35552 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
35553 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35554
35555 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35556 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35557 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35558 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35559 of view, nothing actually happened.}
35560
35561 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35562 @cindex @samp{B} packet
35563 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35564 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35565
35566 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35567 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35568
35569 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
35570 @anchor{bc}
35571 @item bc
35572 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
35573 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35574
35575 Reply:
35576 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35577
35578 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
35579 @anchor{bs}
35580 @item bs
35581 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
35582 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35583
35584 Reply:
35585 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35586
35587 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35588 @cindex @samp{c} packet
35589 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
35590 is omitted, resume at current address.
35591
35592 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35593 packet}.
35594
35595 Reply:
35596 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35597
35598 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35599 @cindex @samp{C} packet
35600 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
35601 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35602
35603 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35604 packet}.
35605
35606 Reply:
35607 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35608
35609 @item d
35610 @cindex @samp{d} packet
35611 Toggle debug flag.
35612
35613 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35614 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35615
35616 @item D
35617 @itemx D;@var{pid}
35618 @cindex @samp{D} packet
35619 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35620 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
35621 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35622
35623 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35624 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35625 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
35626 big-endian hex string.
35627
35628 Reply:
35629 @table @samp
35630 @item OK
35631 for success
35632 @item E @var{NN}
35633 for an error
35634 @end table
35635
35636 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35637 @cindex @samp{F} packet
35638 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35639 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
35640 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35641
35642 @item g
35643 @anchor{read registers packet}
35644 @cindex @samp{g} packet
35645 Read general registers.
35646
35647 Reply:
35648 @table @samp
35649 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35650 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
35651 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
35652 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35653 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35654 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
35655
35656 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35657 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35658 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35659 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35660 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
35661 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35662 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35663 have been collected, and both have zero value:
35664
35665 @smallexample
35666 -> @code{g}
35667 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35668 @end smallexample
35669
35670 @item E @var{NN}
35671 for an error.
35672 @end table
35673
35674 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35675 @cindex @samp{G} packet
35676 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35677 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35678
35679 Reply:
35680 @table @samp
35681 @item OK
35682 for success
35683 @item E @var{NN}
35684 for an error
35685 @end table
35686
35687 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35688 @cindex @samp{H} packet
35689 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35690 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35691 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35692 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35693 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
35694 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35695 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35696
35697 Reply:
35698 @table @samp
35699 @item OK
35700 for success
35701 @item E @var{NN}
35702 for an error
35703 @end table
35704
35705 @c FIXME: JTC:
35706 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
35707 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35708 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
35709 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35710 @c described. For example:
35711 @c
35712 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35713 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35714 @c otherwise returns current registers.
35715 @c
35716 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35717 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35718 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35719
35720 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35721 @anchor{cycle step packet}
35722 @cindex @samp{i} packet
35723 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35724 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35725 step starting at that address.
35726
35727 @item I
35728 @cindex @samp{I} packet
35729 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
35730 step packet}.
35731
35732 @item k
35733 @cindex @samp{k} packet
35734 Kill request.
35735
35736 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35737
35738 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35739 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35740
35741 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35742
35743 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35744 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
35745 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35746
35747 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35748 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35749 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35750
35751 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35752 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35753 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35754 (@pxref{? packet}).
35755
35756 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35757 @cindex @samp{m} packet
35758 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35759 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35760 any particular boundary.
35761
35762 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35763 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35764 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35765 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
35766 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35767 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35768 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
35769 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35770
35771 Reply:
35772 @table @samp
35773 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35774 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35775 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35776 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35777 @item E @var{NN}
35778 @var{NN} is errno
35779 @end table
35780
35781 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35782 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35783 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35784 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35785 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35786
35787 Reply:
35788 @table @samp
35789 @item OK
35790 for success
35791 @item E @var{NN}
35792 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35793 written).
35794 @end table
35795
35796 @item p @var{n}
35797 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35798 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35799 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35800 register value is encoded.
35801
35802 Reply:
35803 @table @samp
35804 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35805 the register's value
35806 @item E @var{NN}
35807 for an error
35808 @item @w{}
35809 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35810 @end table
35811
35812 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35813 @anchor{write register packet}
35814 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35815 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35816 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35817 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35818
35819 Reply:
35820 @table @samp
35821 @item OK
35822 for success
35823 @item E @var{NN}
35824 for an error
35825 @end table
35826
35827 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35828 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35829 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35830 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35831 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35832 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35833
35834 @item r
35835 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35836 Reset the entire system.
35837
35838 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35839
35840 @item R @var{XX}
35841 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35842 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35843 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35844
35845 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35846
35847 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35848 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35849 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35850 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35851
35852 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35853 packet}.
35854
35855 Reply:
35856 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35857
35858 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35859 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35860 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35861 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35862 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35863
35864 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35865 packet}.
35866
35867 Reply:
35868 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35869
35870 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35871 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35872 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35873 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35874 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35875
35876 @item T @var{thread-id}
35877 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35878 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35879
35880 Reply:
35881 @table @samp
35882 @item OK
35883 thread is still alive
35884 @item E @var{NN}
35885 thread is dead
35886 @end table
35887
35888 @item v
35889 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35890 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35891
35892 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35893 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35894 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35895 The process ID is a
35896 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35897 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35898 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35899
35900 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35901 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35902 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35903 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35904 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35905 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35906 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35907 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35908
35909 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35910
35911 Reply:
35912 @table @samp
35913 @item E @var{nn}
35914 for an error
35915 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35916 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35917 @item OK
35918 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35919 @end table
35920
35921 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35922 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35923 @anchor{vCont packet}
35924 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35925
35926 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
35927 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
35928 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
35929 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
35930 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
35931 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
35932 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
35933 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
35934 error.
35935
35936 Currently supported actions are:
35937
35938 @table @samp
35939 @item c
35940 Continue.
35941 @item C @var{sig}
35942 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35943 @item s
35944 Step.
35945 @item S @var{sig}
35946 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35947 @item t
35948 Stop.
35949 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35950 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35951 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35952 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35953 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35954 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35955
35956 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35957 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35958 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35959 jumps to @var{start}).
35960
35961 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35962 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35963 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35964
35965 @end table
35966
35967 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35968 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35969 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35970
35971 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35972 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35973 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35974 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35975 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35976 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35977 as an implementation detail.
35978
35979 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
35980 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
35981 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
35982 stopped.
35983
35984 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
35985 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
35986 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
35987
35988 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35989 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
35990
35991 Reply:
35992 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35993
35994 @item vCont?
35995 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35996 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35997
35998 Reply:
35999 @table @samp
36000 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36001 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36002 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36003 @item @w{}
36004 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36005 @end table
36006
36007 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36008 @item vCtrlC
36009 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36010 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36011 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36012 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36013 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36014 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36015 variant.
36016
36017 Reply:
36018 @table @samp
36019 @item E @var{nn}
36020 for an error
36021 @item OK
36022 for success
36023 @end table
36024
36025 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36026 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36027 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36028 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36029
36030 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36031 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36032 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36033 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36034 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36035 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36036 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36037 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36038 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36039 packet is received.
36040
36041 Reply:
36042 @table @samp
36043 @item OK
36044 for success
36045 @item E @var{NN}
36046 for an error
36047 @end table
36048
36049 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36050 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36051 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36052 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36053 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36054 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36055 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36056 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36057 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36058 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36059 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36060 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36061
36062
36063 Reply:
36064 @table @samp
36065 @item OK
36066 for success
36067 @item E.memtype
36068 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36069 @item E @var{NN}
36070 for an error
36071 @end table
36072
36073 @item vFlashDone
36074 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36075 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36076 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36077 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36078 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36079 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36080 request is completed.
36081
36082 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36083 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36084 @anchor{vKill packet}
36085 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36086 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36087 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36088 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36089
36090 Reply:
36091 @table @samp
36092 @item E @var{nn}
36093 for an error
36094 @item OK
36095 for success
36096 @end table
36097
36098 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36099 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36100 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36101 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36102 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36103
36104 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36105 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36106 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36107 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36108 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36109 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36110
36111 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36112 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36113 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36114 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36115 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36116 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36117 state.
36118
36119 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36120
36121 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36122
36123 Reply:
36124 @table @samp
36125 @item E @var{nn}
36126 for an error
36127 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36128 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36129 @end table
36130
36131 @item vStopped
36132 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36133 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36134
36135 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36136 @anchor{X packet}
36137 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36138 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36139 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36140 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36141 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36142
36143 Reply:
36144 @table @samp
36145 @item OK
36146 for success
36147 @item E @var{NN}
36148 for an error
36149 @end table
36150
36151 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36152 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36153 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36154 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36155 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36156 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36157 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36158
36159 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36160 separately.
36161
36162 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36163 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36164 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36165 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36166 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36167 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36168
36169 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36170 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36171 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36172 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36173 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36174 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36175
36176 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36177 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36178 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36179 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36180 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36181 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36182 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36183 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36184 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36185 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36186 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36187 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36188 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36189
36190 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36191 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36192
36193 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36194 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36195
36196 @table @samp
36197
36198 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36199 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36200 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36201
36202 @end table
36203
36204 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36205 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36206 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36207 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36208 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36209 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36210 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36211
36212 @table @samp
36213
36214 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36215 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36216 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36217
36218 @end table
36219
36220 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36221 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36222 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36223 target, is not defined.}
36224
36225 Reply:
36226 @table @samp
36227 @item OK
36228 success
36229 @item @w{}
36230 not supported
36231 @item E @var{NN}
36232 for an error
36233 @end table
36234
36235 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36236 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36237 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36238 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36239 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36240 address @var{addr}.
36241
36242 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36243 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36244 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36245 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36246
36247 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36248 movement.}
36249
36250 Reply:
36251 @table @samp
36252 @item OK
36253 success
36254 @item @w{}
36255 not supported
36256 @item E @var{NN}
36257 for an error
36258 @end table
36259
36260 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36261 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36262 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36263 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36264 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36265 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36266
36267 Reply:
36268 @table @samp
36269 @item OK
36270 success
36271 @item @w{}
36272 not supported
36273 @item E @var{NN}
36274 for an error
36275 @end table
36276
36277 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36278 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36279 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36280 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36281 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36282 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36283
36284 Reply:
36285 @table @samp
36286 @item OK
36287 success
36288 @item @w{}
36289 not supported
36290 @item E @var{NN}
36291 for an error
36292 @end table
36293
36294 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36295 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36296 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36297 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36298 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36299 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36300
36301 Reply:
36302 @table @samp
36303 @item OK
36304 success
36305 @item @w{}
36306 not supported
36307 @item E @var{NN}
36308 for an error
36309 @end table
36310
36311 @end table
36312
36313 @node Stop Reply Packets
36314 @section Stop Reply Packets
36315 @cindex stop reply packets
36316
36317 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36318 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36319 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36320 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36321 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36322 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36323 @value{GDBN} source code.
36324
36325 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36326 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36327 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36328
36329 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36330 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36331 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36332 components.
36333
36334 @table @samp
36335
36336 @item S @var{AA}
36337 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36338 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36339 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36340
36341 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36342 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36343 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36344 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36345 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36346 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36347 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36348 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36349
36350 @itemize @bullet
36351 @item
36352 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36353 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36354 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36355 two-digit hex number.
36356
36357 @item
36358 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36359 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36360
36361 @item
36362 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36363 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36364
36365 @item
36366 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36367 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36368 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36369 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36370
36371 @item
36372 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36373 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36374 future.
36375 @end itemize
36376
36377 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36378
36379 @table @samp
36380 @item watch
36381 @itemx rwatch
36382 @itemx awatch
36383 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36384 hex.
36385
36386 @item syscall_entry
36387 @itemx syscall_return
36388 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36389 syscall number, in hex.
36390
36391 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36392 @item library
36393 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36394 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36395 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36396
36397 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36398 @item replaylog
36399 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36400 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36401 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36402 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36403 for more information.
36404
36405 @item swbreak
36406 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36407 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36408 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36409 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36410 part must be left empty.
36411
36412 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36413 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36414 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36415 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36416 address.
36417
36418 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36419 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36420 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36421 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36422 indicating support.
36423
36424 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36425
36426 @item hwbreak
36427 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36428 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36429
36430 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36431 apply.
36432
36433 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36434 @item fork
36435 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36436 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36437 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36438 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36439 fork events.
36440
36441 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36442 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36443 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36444 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36445 indicating support.
36446
36447 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36448 @item vfork
36449 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36450 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36451 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36452 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36453 vfork events.
36454
36455 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36456 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36457 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36458 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36459 indicating support.
36460
36461 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36462 @item vforkdone
36463 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36464 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36465 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36466 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36467 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36468
36469 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36470 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36471 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36472 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36473 indicating support.
36474
36475 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36476 @item exec
36477 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36478 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36479 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36480
36481 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36482 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36483 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36484 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36485 indicating support.
36486
36487 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36488 @anchor{thread create event}
36489 @item create
36490 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36491 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36492 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36493 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36494 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36495 @var{r} part is ignored.
36496
36497 @end table
36498
36499 @item W @var{AA}
36500 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36501 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36502 applicable to certain targets.
36503
36504 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36505 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36506 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36507 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36508 hex strings.
36509
36510 @item X @var{AA}
36511 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36512 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36513
36514 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36515 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36516 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36517 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36518 hex strings.
36519
36520 @anchor{thread exit event}
36521 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36522 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36523
36524 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
36525 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36526 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36527 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36528
36529 @item N
36530 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
36531 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
36532 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
36533 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36534 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
36535 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36536 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36537 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
36538 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36539 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36540 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
36541 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36542 support.
36543
36544 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36545 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36546 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
36547 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36548 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36549
36550 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36551 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36552 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
36553 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36554 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36555 system calls.
36556
36557 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36558 this very system call.
36559
36560 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36561 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
36562 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36563 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36564 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
36565 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36566
36567 @end table
36568
36569 @node General Query Packets
36570 @section General Query Packets
36571 @cindex remote query requests
36572
36573 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36574 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
36575 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36576 sending information to and from the stub.
36577
36578 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36579 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
36580 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36581 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
36582 conventions:
36583
36584 @itemize @bullet
36585 @item
36586 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36587 @item
36588 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36589 letter.
36590 @item
36591 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36592 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
36593 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36594 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36595 @end itemize
36596
36597 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36598 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36599 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
36600 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36601 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
36602 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36603 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36604 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36605 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36606 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36607 packet.}.
36608
36609 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36610 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36611 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
36612 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
36613 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36614
36615 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36616
36617 @table @samp
36618
36619 @item QAgent:1
36620 @itemx QAgent:0
36621 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36622 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36623
36624 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36625 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36626 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36627 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36628 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36629 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36630 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36631 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36632 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
36633 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36634 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36635
36636 @item qC
36637 @cindex current thread, remote request
36638 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
36639 Return the current thread ID.
36640
36641 Reply:
36642 @table @samp
36643 @item QC @var{thread-id}
36644 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36645 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36646 @item @r{(anything else)}
36647 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36648 @end table
36649
36650 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36651 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36652 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36653 @anchor{qCRC packet}
36654 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36655 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36656 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
36657 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36658
36659 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36660 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36661 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
36662 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36663 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36664 detect trailing zeros.
36665
36666 Reply:
36667 @table @samp
36668 @item E @var{NN}
36669 An error (such as memory fault)
36670 @item C @var{crc32}
36671 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36672 @end table
36673
36674 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36675 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36676 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36677 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36678 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36679 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36680 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36681 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36682 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36683 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36684 randomization.
36685
36686 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36687
36688 Reply:
36689 @table @samp
36690 @item OK
36691 The request succeeded.
36692
36693 @item E @var{nn}
36694 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36695
36696 @item @w{}
36697 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36698 by the stub.
36699 @end table
36700
36701 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36702 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36703 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36704 address space randomization.
36705
36706 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
36707 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
36708 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
36709 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
36710 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
36711 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
36712 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
36713 inferior using a shell or not.
36714
36715 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
36716 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
36717 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
36718 values are considered an error.
36719
36720 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36721 mode}).
36722
36723 Reply:
36724 @table @samp
36725 @item OK
36726 The request succeeded.
36727
36728 @item E @var{nn}
36729 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36730 @end table
36731
36732 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36733 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36734 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36735 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
36736
36737 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
36738 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
36739
36740 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
36741 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36742 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
36743 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
36744 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
36745 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
36746 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
36747 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
36748 environment}).
36749
36750 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36751 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
36752 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
36753 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
36754 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
36755 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
36756 not be present.
36757
36758 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36759 mode}).
36760
36761 Reply:
36762 @table @samp
36763 @item OK
36764 The request succeeded.
36765 @end table
36766
36767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36769 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36770 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36771 inferior.
36772
36773 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
36774 @pxref{set environment}.
36775
36776 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
36777 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
36778 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
36779 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
36780 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
36781 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
36782 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
36783 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
36784
36785 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
36786 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
36787
36788 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36789 mode}).
36790
36791 Reply:
36792 @table @samp
36793 @item OK
36794 The request succeeded.
36795 @end table
36796
36797 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36798 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36799 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36800 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36801 inferior.
36802
36803 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
36804 @pxref{unset environment}.
36805
36806 @item QEnvironmentReset
36807 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
36808 @cindex reset environment, remote request
36809 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
36810 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
36811 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
36812 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
36813 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
36814 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
36815 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
36816 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
36817 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
36818
36819 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
36820 mode}).
36821
36822 Reply:
36823 @table @samp
36824 @item OK
36825 The request succeeded.
36826 @end table
36827
36828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36830 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
36831 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
36832 inferior.
36833
36834 @item qfThreadInfo
36835 @itemx qsThreadInfo
36836 @cindex list active threads, remote request
36837 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36838 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36839 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
36840 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36841 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36842 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
36843 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36844 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36845
36846 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36847
36848 Reply:
36849 @table @samp
36850 @item m @var{thread-id}
36851 A single thread ID
36852 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36853 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36854 @item l
36855 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36856 @end table
36857
36858 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36859 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36860 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36861 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36862 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36863 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36864 fields.
36865
36866 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36867 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36868 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36869 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36870 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36871
36872 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36873 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36874 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36875 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36876 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36877
36878 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36879 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36880
36881 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36882 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
36883 information associated with the variable.)
36884
36885 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36886 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
36887 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36888 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36889 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36890 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36891
36892 Reply:
36893 @table @samp
36894 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36895 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36896 local storage requested.
36897
36898 @item E @var{nn}
36899 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36900
36901 @item @w{}
36902 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36903 @end table
36904
36905 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36906 @cindex get thread information block address
36907 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36908 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36909
36910 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36911
36912 Reply:
36913 @table @samp
36914 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36915 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36916 thread information block.
36917
36918 @item E @var{nn}
36919 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36920 address could not be retrieved.
36921
36922 @item @w{}
36923 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36924 @end table
36925
36926 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36927 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36928 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36929 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36930 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36931 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36932 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36933
36934 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36935
36936 Reply:
36937 @table @samp
36938 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36939 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36940 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36941 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36942 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36943 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36944 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36945 @end table
36946
36947 @item qOffsets
36948 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36949 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36950 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36951 image.
36952
36953 Reply:
36954 @table @samp
36955 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36956 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36957 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36958 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36959 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36960 segments by the supplied offsets.
36961
36962 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36963 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36964 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36965
36966 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36967 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36968 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36969 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36970 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36971 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36972 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36973 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36974 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36975 @end table
36976
36977 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36978 @cindex thread information, remote request
36979 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36980 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36981 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36982 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36983
36984 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36985 (see below).
36986
36987 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36988
36989 @item QNonStop:1
36990 @itemx QNonStop:0
36991 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36992 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36993 @anchor{QNonStop}
36994 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36995 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36996
36997 Reply:
36998 @table @samp
36999 @item OK
37000 The request succeeded.
37001
37002 @item E @var{nn}
37003 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37004
37005 @item @w{}
37006 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37007 the stub.
37008 @end table
37009
37010 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37011 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37012 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37013 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37014
37015 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37016 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37017 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37018 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37019 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37020 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37021 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37022
37023 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37024 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37025 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37026
37027 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37028 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37029 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37030 report the requested syscalls.
37031
37032 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37033 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37034
37035 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37036 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37037 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37038 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37039
37040 Reply:
37041 @table @samp
37042 @item OK
37043 The request succeeded.
37044
37045 @item E @var{nn}
37046 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37047
37048 @item @w{}
37049 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37050 the stub.
37051 @end table
37052
37053 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37054 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37055 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37056 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37057
37058 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37059 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37060 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37061 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37062 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37063 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37064 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37065 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37066 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37067 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37068 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37069 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37070 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37071
37072 Reply:
37073 @table @samp
37074 @item OK
37075 The request succeeded.
37076
37077 @item E @var{nn}
37078 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37079
37080 @item @w{}
37081 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37082 the stub.
37083 @end table
37084
37085 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37086 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37087 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37088 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37089
37090 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37091 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37092 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37093 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37094 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37095 Others should be silently discarded.
37096
37097 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37098 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37099 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37100 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37101 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37102 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37103 signals.
37104
37105 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37106 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37107
37108 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37109 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37110 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37111 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37112 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37113
37114 Reply:
37115 @table @samp
37116 @item OK
37117 The request succeeded.
37118
37119 @item E @var{nn}
37120 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37121
37122 @item @w{}
37123 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37124 by the stub.
37125 @end table
37126
37127 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37128 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37129 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37130 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37131
37132 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37133 @item QThreadEvents:1
37134 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37135 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37136 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37137
37138 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37139 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37140 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37141 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37142 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37143 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37144 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37145 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37146 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37147 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37148
37149 Reply:
37150 @table @samp
37151 @item OK
37152 The request succeeded.
37153
37154 @item E @var{nn}
37155 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37156
37157 @item @w{}
37158 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37159 the stub.
37160 @end table
37161
37162 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37163 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37164
37165 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37166 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37167 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37168 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37169 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37170 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37171 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37172 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37173 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37174
37175 Reply:
37176 @table @samp
37177 @item OK
37178 A command response with no output.
37179 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37180 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37181 @item E @var{NN}
37182 Indicate a badly formed request.
37183 @item @w{}
37184 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37185 @end table
37186
37187 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37188 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37189 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37190 packets.)
37191
37192 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37193 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37194 @ifnotinfo
37195 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37196 @end ifnotinfo
37197 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37198 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37199 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37200 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37201 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37202
37203 Reply:
37204 @table @samp
37205 @item 0
37206 The pattern was not found.
37207 @item 1,address
37208 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37209 @item E @var{NN}
37210 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37211 @item @w{}
37212 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37213 @end table
37214
37215 @item QStartNoAckMode
37216 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37217 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37218 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37219 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37220
37221 Reply:
37222 @table @samp
37223 @item OK
37224 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37225 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37226 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37227 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37228 @item @w{}
37229 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37230 @end table
37231
37232 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37233 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37234 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37235 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37236 @anchor{qSupported}
37237 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37238 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37239 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37240 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37241 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37242 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37243 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37244 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37245 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37246 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37247 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37248 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37249 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37250 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37251
37252 Reply:
37253 @table @samp
37254 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37255 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37256 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37257 possible forms).
37258 @item @w{}
37259 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37260 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37261 @end table
37262
37263 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37264 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37265 are:
37266
37267 @table @samp
37268 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37269 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37270 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37271 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37272 @item @var{name}+
37273 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37274 need an associated value.
37275 @item @var{name}-
37276 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37277 @item @var{name}?
37278 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37279 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37280 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37281 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37282 @end table
37283
37284 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37285 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37286 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37287 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37288 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37289
37290 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37291 are defined:
37292
37293 @table @samp
37294 @item multiprocess
37295 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37296 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37297 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37298 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37299 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37300
37301 @item xmlRegisters
37302 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37303 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37304 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37305 description.
37306
37307 @item qRelocInsn
37308 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37309 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37310 instruction reply packet}).
37311
37312 @item swbreak
37313 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37314 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37315
37316 @item hwbreak
37317 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37318 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37319
37320 @item fork-events
37321 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37322 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37323 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37324 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37325
37326 @item vfork-events
37327 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37328 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37329 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37330 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37331
37332 @item exec-events
37333 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37334 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37335 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37336 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37337
37338 @item vContSupported
37339 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37340 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37341 @end table
37342
37343 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37344 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37345 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37346 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37347 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37348 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37349 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37350 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37351 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37352 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37353 all the features it supports.
37354
37355 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37356 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37357
37358 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37359 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37360 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37361 form response.
37362
37363 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37364 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37365 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37366 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37367
37368 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37369 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37370 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37371 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37372 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37373
37374 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37375
37376 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37377 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37378 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37379 @item Feature Name
37380 @tab Value Required
37381 @tab Default
37382 @tab Probe Allowed
37383
37384 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37385 @tab Yes
37386 @tab @samp{-}
37387 @tab No
37388
37389 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37390 @tab No
37391 @tab @samp{-}
37392 @tab Yes
37393
37394 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37395 @tab No
37396 @tab @samp{-}
37397 @tab Yes
37398
37399 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37400 @tab No
37401 @tab @samp{-}
37402 @tab Yes
37403
37404 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37405 @tab No
37406 @tab @samp{-}
37407 @tab Yes
37408
37409 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37410 @tab No
37411 @tab @samp{-}
37412 @tab Yes
37413
37414 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37415 @tab No
37416 @tab @samp{-}
37417 @tab Yes
37418
37419 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37420 @tab No
37421 @tab @samp{-}
37422 @tab Yes
37423
37424 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37425 @tab No
37426 @tab @samp{-}
37427 @tab No
37428
37429 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37430 @tab No
37431 @tab @samp{-}
37432 @tab Yes
37433
37434 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37435 @tab No
37436 @tab @samp{-}
37437 @tab Yes
37438
37439 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37440 @tab No
37441 @tab @samp{-}
37442 @tab Yes
37443
37444 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37445 @tab No
37446 @tab @samp{-}
37447 @tab Yes
37448
37449 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37450 @tab No
37451 @tab @samp{-}
37452 @tab Yes
37453
37454 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37455 @tab No
37456 @tab @samp{-}
37457 @tab Yes
37458
37459 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37460 @tab No
37461 @tab @samp{-}
37462 @tab Yes
37463
37464 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37465 @tab No
37466 @tab @samp{-}
37467 @tab Yes
37468
37469 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37470 @tab No
37471 @tab @samp{-}
37472 @tab Yes
37473
37474 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37475 @tab No
37476 @tab @samp{-}
37477 @tab Yes
37478
37479 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37480 @tab Yes
37481 @tab @samp{-}
37482 @tab Yes
37483
37484 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37485 @tab Yes
37486 @tab @samp{-}
37487 @tab Yes
37488
37489 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37490 @tab Yes
37491 @tab @samp{-}
37492 @tab Yes
37493
37494 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
37495 @tab Yes
37496 @tab @samp{-}
37497 @tab Yes
37498
37499 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
37500 @tab Yes
37501 @tab @samp{-}
37502 @tab Yes
37503
37504 @item @samp{QNonStop}
37505 @tab No
37506 @tab @samp{-}
37507 @tab Yes
37508
37509 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
37510 @tab No
37511 @tab @samp{-}
37512 @tab Yes
37513
37514 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
37515 @tab No
37516 @tab @samp{-}
37517 @tab Yes
37518
37519 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
37520 @tab No
37521 @tab @samp{-}
37522 @tab Yes
37523
37524 @item @samp{multiprocess}
37525 @tab No
37526 @tab @samp{-}
37527 @tab No
37528
37529 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
37530 @tab No
37531 @tab @samp{-}
37532 @tab No
37533
37534 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
37535 @tab No
37536 @tab @samp{-}
37537 @tab No
37538
37539 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
37540 @tab No
37541 @tab @samp{-}
37542 @tab No
37543
37544 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
37545 @tab No
37546 @tab @samp{-}
37547 @tab No
37548
37549 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
37550 @tab No
37551 @tab @samp{-}
37552 @tab No
37553
37554 @item @samp{QAgent}
37555 @tab No
37556 @tab @samp{-}
37557 @tab No
37558
37559 @item @samp{QAllow}
37560 @tab No
37561 @tab @samp{-}
37562 @tab No
37563
37564 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
37565 @tab No
37566 @tab @samp{-}
37567 @tab No
37568
37569 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
37570 @tab No
37571 @tab @samp{-}
37572 @tab No
37573
37574 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
37575 @tab No
37576 @tab @samp{-}
37577 @tab No
37578
37579 @item @samp{tracenz}
37580 @tab No
37581 @tab @samp{-}
37582 @tab No
37583
37584 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37585 @tab No
37586 @tab @samp{-}
37587 @tab No
37588
37589 @item @samp{swbreak}
37590 @tab No
37591 @tab @samp{-}
37592 @tab No
37593
37594 @item @samp{hwbreak}
37595 @tab No
37596 @tab @samp{-}
37597 @tab No
37598
37599 @item @samp{fork-events}
37600 @tab No
37601 @tab @samp{-}
37602 @tab No
37603
37604 @item @samp{vfork-events}
37605 @tab No
37606 @tab @samp{-}
37607 @tab No
37608
37609 @item @samp{exec-events}
37610 @tab No
37611 @tab @samp{-}
37612 @tab No
37613
37614 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37615 @tab No
37616 @tab @samp{-}
37617 @tab No
37618
37619 @item @samp{no-resumed}
37620 @tab No
37621 @tab @samp{-}
37622 @tab No
37623
37624 @end multitable
37625
37626 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37627
37628 @table @samp
37629 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
37630 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37631 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37632 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37633 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
37634 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37635 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37636 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37637 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
37638 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37639
37640 @item qXfer:auxv:read
37641 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37642 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37643
37644 @item qXfer:btrace:read
37645 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37646 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37647
37648 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37649 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37650 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37651
37652 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
37653 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37654 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37655
37656 @item qXfer:features:read
37657 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37658 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37659
37660 @item qXfer:libraries:read
37661 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37662 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37663
37664 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37665 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37666 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37667
37668 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37669 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37670 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37671 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37672
37673 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
37674 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37675 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37676
37677 @item qXfer:sdata:read
37678 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37679 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37680
37681 @item qXfer:spu:read
37682 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37683 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37684
37685 @item qXfer:spu:write
37686 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37687 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37688
37689 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
37690 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37691 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37692
37693 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
37694 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37695 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37696
37697 @item qXfer:threads:read
37698 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37699 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37700
37701 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37702 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37703 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37704
37705 @item qXfer:uib:read
37706 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37707 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37708
37709 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
37710 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37711 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37712
37713 @item QNonStop
37714 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37715 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
37716
37717 @item QCatchSyscalls
37718 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37719 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37720
37721 @item QPassSignals
37722 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37723 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37724
37725 @item QStartNoAckMode
37726 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37727 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37728
37729 @item multiprocess
37730 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37731 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37732 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37733 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37734 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37735 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37736 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37737 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37738 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
37739 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37740 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37741
37742 @item qXfer:osdata:read
37743 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37744 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37745
37746 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
37747 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37748 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37749 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37750
37751 @item ConditionalTracepoints
37752 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37753 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37754
37755 @item ReverseContinue
37756 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37757 (@pxref{bc}).
37758
37759 @item ReverseStep
37760 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37761 (@pxref{bs}).
37762
37763 @item TracepointSource
37764 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37765 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37766
37767 @item QAgent
37768 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37769
37770 @item QAllow
37771 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37772
37773 @item QDisableRandomization
37774 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37775
37776 @item StaticTracepoint
37777 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37778 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37779
37780 @item InstallInTrace
37781 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37782 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37783
37784 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
37785 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37786 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37787 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37788
37789 @item QTBuffer:size
37790 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37791 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37792
37793 @item tracenz
37794 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37795 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37796 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37797
37798 @item BreakpointCommands
37799 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37800 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37801 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37802
37803 @item Qbtrace:off
37804 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37805
37806 @item Qbtrace:bts
37807 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37808
37809 @item Qbtrace:pt
37810 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37811
37812 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37813 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37814
37815 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37816 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37817
37818 @item swbreak
37819 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37820 breakpoints.
37821
37822 @item hwbreak
37823 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37824 breakpoints.
37825
37826 @item fork-events
37827 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37828
37829 @item vfork-events
37830 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37831 and vforkdone events.
37832
37833 @item exec-events
37834 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37835
37836 @item vContSupported
37837 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37838 @samp{vCont?} packet.
37839
37840 @item QThreadEvents
37841 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37842
37843 @item no-resumed
37844 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37845
37846 @end table
37847
37848 @item qSymbol::
37849 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37850 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37851 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37852 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37853
37854 Reply:
37855 @table @samp
37856 @item OK
37857 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37858 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37859 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37860 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37861 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37862 below.
37863 @end table
37864
37865 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37866 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37867
37868 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37869 target has previously requested.
37870
37871 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
37872 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37873 will be empty.
37874
37875 Reply:
37876 @table @samp
37877 @item OK
37878 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37879 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37880 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37881 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37882 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37883 @end table
37884
37885 @item qTBuffer
37886 @itemx QTBuffer
37887 @itemx QTDisconnected
37888 @itemx QTDP
37889 @itemx QTDPsrc
37890 @itemx QTDV
37891 @itemx qTfP
37892 @itemx qTfV
37893 @itemx QTFrame
37894 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
37895
37896 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37897
37898 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37899 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37900 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37901 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37902 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37903 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
37904 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37905 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
37906 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
37907 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37908 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37909
37910 Reply:
37911 @table @samp
37912 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37913 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37914 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37915 the thread's attributes.
37916 @end table
37917
37918 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37919 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37920 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37921 packets.)
37922
37923 @item QTNotes
37924 @itemx qTP
37925 @itemx QTSave
37926 @itemx qTsP
37927 @itemx qTsV
37928 @itemx QTStart
37929 @itemx QTStop
37930 @itemx QTEnable
37931 @itemx QTDisable
37932 @itemx QTinit
37933 @itemx QTro
37934 @itemx qTStatus
37935 @itemx qTV
37936 @itemx qTfSTM
37937 @itemx qTsSTM
37938 @itemx qTSTMat
37939 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37940
37941 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37942 @cindex read special object, remote request
37943 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37944 @anchor{qXfer read}
37945 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37946 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37947 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37948 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37949 additional details about what data to access.
37950
37951 Reply:
37952 @table @samp
37953 @item m @var{data}
37954 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37955 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37956 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37957 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37958 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37959 request.
37960
37961 @item l @var{data}
37962 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37963 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37964 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37965
37966 @item l
37967 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37968 There is no more data to be read.
37969
37970 @item E00
37971 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37972
37973 @item E @var{nn}
37974 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37975 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37976
37977 @item @w{}
37978 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37979 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37980 @end table
37981
37982 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
37983 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37984 formats, listed above.
37985
37986 @table @samp
37987 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37988 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37989 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37990 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37991
37992 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37993 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37994
37995 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37996 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37997
37998 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37999 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38000 packet may have one of the following values:
38001
38002 @table @code
38003 @item all
38004 Returns all available branch trace.
38005
38006 @item new
38007 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38008 the last read request.
38009
38010 @item delta
38011 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38012 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38013 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38014 used to stitch traces together.
38015
38016 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38017 @end table
38018
38019 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38020 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38021
38022 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38023 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38024
38025 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38026 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38027
38028 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38029 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38030
38031 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38032 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38033 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38034 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38035 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38036 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38037 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38038
38039 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38040 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38041
38042 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38043 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38044 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38045 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38046 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38047
38048 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38049 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38050
38051 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38052 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38053 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38054 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38055 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38056
38057 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38058 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38059 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38060
38061 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38062 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38063
38064 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38065 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38066 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38067 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38068 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38069 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38070 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38071 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38072
38073 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38074 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38075
38076 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38077 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38078
38079 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38080 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38081 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38082 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38083
38084 @table @code
38085 @item start=@var{address}
38086 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38087 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38088 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38089 chosen as the starting point.
38090
38091 @item prev=@var{address}
38092 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38093 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38094 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38095 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38096 exists prior to the starting point.
38097
38098 @end table
38099
38100 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38101 ignored.
38102
38103 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38104 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38105 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38106 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38107 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38108
38109 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38110 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38111
38112 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38113 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38114
38115 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38116 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38117 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38118 Action Lists}.
38119
38120 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38121 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38122 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38123
38124 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38125 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38126 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38127 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38128 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38129
38130 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38131 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38132 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38133
38134 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38135 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38136 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38137 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38138 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38139 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38140 in that context to be accessed.
38141
38142 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38143 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38144 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38145
38146 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38147 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38148 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38149 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38150 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38151
38152 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38153 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38154
38155 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38156 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38157
38158 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38159 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38160 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38161
38162 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38163 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38164
38165 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38166 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38167
38168 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38169 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38170
38171 This packet is not probed by default.
38172
38173 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38174 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38175 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38176 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38177 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38178
38179 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38180 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38181
38182 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38183 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38184 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38185 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38186
38187 @end table
38188
38189 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38190 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38191 @anchor{qXfer write}
38192 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38193 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38194 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38195 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38196 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38197 to access.
38198
38199 Reply:
38200 @table @samp
38201 @item @var{nn}
38202 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38203 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38204
38205 @item E00
38206 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38207
38208 @item E @var{nn}
38209 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38210 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38211
38212 @item @w{}
38213 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38214 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38215 @end table
38216
38217 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38218 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38219 formats, listed above.
38220
38221 @table @samp
38222 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38223 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38224 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38225 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38226 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38227
38228 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38229 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38230 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38231
38232 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38233 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38234 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38235 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38236 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38237 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38238 in that context to be accessed.
38239
38240 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38241 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38242 @end table
38243
38244 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38245 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38246 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38247 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38248 must respond with an empty packet.
38249
38250 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38251 @cindex query attached, remote request
38252 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38253 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38254 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38255 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38256 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38257 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38258 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38259
38260 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38261 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38262 the @code{quit} command.
38263
38264 Reply:
38265 @table @samp
38266 @item 1
38267 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38268 @item 0
38269 The remote server created a new process.
38270 @item E @var{NN}
38271 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38272 @end table
38273
38274 @item Qbtrace:bts
38275 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38276
38277 Reply:
38278 @table @samp
38279 @item OK
38280 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38281 @item E.errtext
38282 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38283 @end table
38284
38285 @item Qbtrace:pt
38286 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38287
38288 Reply:
38289 @table @samp
38290 @item OK
38291 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38292 @item E.errtext
38293 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38294 @end table
38295
38296 @item Qbtrace:off
38297 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38298
38299 Reply:
38300 @table @samp
38301 @item OK
38302 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38303 @item E.errtext
38304 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38305 @end table
38306
38307 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38308 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38309 btrace recording method in bts format.
38310
38311 Reply:
38312 @table @samp
38313 @item OK
38314 The ring buffer size has been set.
38315 @item E.errtext
38316 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38317 @end table
38318
38319 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38320 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38321 btrace recording method in pt format.
38322
38323 Reply:
38324 @table @samp
38325 @item OK
38326 The ring buffer size has been set.
38327 @item E.errtext
38328 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38329 @end table
38330
38331 @end table
38332
38333 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38334 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38335
38336 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38337 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38338 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38339
38340 @menu
38341 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38342 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38343 @end menu
38344
38345 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38346 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38347
38348 @menu
38349 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38350 @end menu
38351
38352 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38353 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38354 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38355
38356 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38357
38358 @table @r
38359
38360 @item 2
38361 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38362
38363 @item 3
38364 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38365
38366 @item 4
38367 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38368
38369 @end table
38370
38371 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38372 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38373
38374 @menu
38375 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38376 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38377 @end menu
38378
38379 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38380 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38381 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38382
38383 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38384 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38385 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38386 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38387 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38388 most-significant -- least-significant.
38389
38390 @table @r
38391
38392 @item MIPS32
38393 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38394 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38395 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38396
38397 @item MIPS64
38398 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38399 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38400 as @code{MIPS32}.
38401
38402 @end table
38403
38404 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38405 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38406 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38407
38408 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38409
38410 @table @r
38411
38412 @item 2
38413 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38414
38415 @item 3
38416 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38417
38418 @item 4
38419 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38420
38421 @item 5
38422 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38423
38424 @end table
38425
38426 @node Tracepoint Packets
38427 @section Tracepoint Packets
38428 @cindex tracepoint packets
38429 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38430
38431 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38432 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38433
38434 @table @samp
38435
38436 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38437 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38438 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38439 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38440 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38441 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38442 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38443 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38444 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38445 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38446 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38447 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38448 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38449 actions.
38450
38451 Replies:
38452 @table @samp
38453 @item OK
38454 The packet was understood and carried out.
38455 @item qRelocInsn
38456 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38457 @item @w{}
38458 The packet was not recognized.
38459 @end table
38460
38461 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38462 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38463 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38464 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38465 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38466 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38467 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38468
38469 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38470 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38471 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38472 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38473 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38474 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38475 tracepoint actions.
38476
38477 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38478 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38479 following forms:
38480
38481 @table @samp
38482
38483 @item R @var{mask}
38484 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38485 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38486 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38487 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38488 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38489
38490 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38491 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38492 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
38493 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
38494 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
38495 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
38496 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
38497
38498 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38499 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
38500 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
38501 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
38502 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
38503 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
38504 packet).
38505
38506 @end table
38507
38508 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
38509 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
38510 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
38511 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
38512 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
38513 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
38514 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
38515 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
38516
38517 Replies:
38518 @table @samp
38519 @item OK
38520 The packet was understood and carried out.
38521 @item qRelocInsn
38522 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38523 @item @w{}
38524 The packet was not recognized.
38525 @end table
38526
38527 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
38528 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
38529 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
38530 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
38531 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
38532 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
38533 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
38534 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
38535
38536 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
38537 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
38538 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
38539 fit in a single packet.
38540 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
38541 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
38542
38543 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
38544 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
38545 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
38546 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
38547
38548 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
38549 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
38550 query packets.
38551
38552 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
38553 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
38554 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
38555 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
38556 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
38557 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
38558 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
38559 be found.
38560
38561 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
38562 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
38563 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
38564 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
38565 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
38566 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
38567 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
38568 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
38569 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
38570 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
38571 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
38572 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
38573 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
38574 variable.
38575
38576 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
38577 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
38578 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
38579 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38580 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38581
38582 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38583 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38584 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
38585 one of the following forms:
38586
38587 @table @samp
38588 @item F @var{f}
38589 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38590 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38591 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38592
38593 @item T @var{t}
38594 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38595 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38596
38597 @end table
38598
38599 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38600 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38601 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38602 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38603
38604 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38605 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38606 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38607 is a hexadecimal number.
38608
38609 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38610 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38611 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38612 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38613 numbers.
38614
38615 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38616 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38617 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38618
38619 @item qTMinFTPILen
38620 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38621 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38622 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
38623 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38624 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38625 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38626 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38627 arrange for that.
38628
38629 Replies:
38630
38631 @table @samp
38632 @item 0
38633 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38634 @item @var{length}
38635 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38636 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
38637 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38638 regardless of size.
38639 @item E
38640 An error has occurred.
38641 @item @w{}
38642 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38643 @end table
38644
38645 @item QTStart
38646 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38647 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
38648 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
38649 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38650 instruction reply packet}).
38651
38652 @item QTStop
38653 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38654 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
38655
38656 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38657 @anchor{QTEnable}
38658 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38659 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38660 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38661 of data from it will resume.
38662
38663 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38664 @anchor{QTDisable}
38665 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38666 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38667 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38668 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38669
38670 @item QTinit
38671 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38672 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38673
38674 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38675 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38676 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
38677 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38678 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38679
38680 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38681 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
38682 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38683 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38684
38685 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38686 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38687 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38688 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38689 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38690 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38691
38692 @item qTStatus
38693 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38694 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38695
38696 The reply has the form:
38697
38698 @table @samp
38699
38700 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38701 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38702 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
38703 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38704
38705 @end table
38706
38707 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38708 explanations as one of the optional fields:
38709
38710 @table @samp
38711
38712 @item tnotrun:0
38713 No trace has been run yet.
38714
38715 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38716 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
38717 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38718 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38719 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
38720
38721 @item tfull:0
38722 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38723
38724 @item tdisconnected:0
38725 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38726
38727 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38728 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38729
38730 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38731 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
38732 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38733 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38734 is hex encoded.
38735
38736 @item tunknown:0
38737 The trace stopped for some other reason.
38738
38739 @end table
38740
38741 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38742 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38743 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
38744 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38745 trace.
38746
38747 @table @samp
38748
38749 @item tframes:@var{n}
38750 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38751
38752 @item tcreated:@var{n}
38753 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38754 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38755
38756 @item tsize:@var{n}
38757 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38758
38759 @item tfree:@var{n}
38760 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38761
38762 @item circular:@var{n}
38763 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
38764 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38765 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38766 and may fill up.
38767
38768 @item disconn:@var{n}
38769 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
38770 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38771 that the trace run will stop.
38772
38773 @end table
38774
38775 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38776 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38777 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38778 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38779 address @var{addr}.
38780
38781 Replies:
38782 @table @samp
38783 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38784 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38785 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
38786 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38787 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38788
38789 @end table
38790
38791 @item qTV:@var{var}
38792 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38793 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38794 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38795
38796 Replies:
38797 @table @samp
38798 @item V@var{value}
38799 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
38800 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38801 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38802 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
38803 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38804 program is running.
38805
38806 @item U
38807 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
38808 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38809 was not collected.
38810 @end table
38811
38812 @item qTfP
38813 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38814 @itemx qTsP
38815 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38816 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38817 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38818 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
38819 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38820 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38821
38822 @item qTfV
38823 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38824 @itemx qTsV
38825 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38826 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38827 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38828 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
38829 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38830 trace state variables.
38831
38832 @item qTfSTM
38833 @itemx qTsSTM
38834 @anchor{qTfSTM}
38835 @anchor{qTsSTM}
38836 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38837 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38838 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38839 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38840 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38841 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
38842
38843 Reply:
38844 @table @samp
38845 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38846 A single marker
38847 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38848 a comma-separated list of markers
38849 @item l
38850 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38851 @item E @var{nn}
38852 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38853 @item @w{}
38854 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38855 stub.
38856 @end table
38857
38858 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38859 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38860
38861 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38862 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38863 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38864 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38865 @dfn{last}).
38866
38867 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38868 @anchor{qTSTMat}
38869 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38870 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38871 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
38872 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38873 tracepoint markers.
38874
38875 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
38876 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38877 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38878 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
38879 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38880 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38881
38882 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38883 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38884 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38885 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38886 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38887 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38888 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38889 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38890 available.
38891
38892 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38893 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38894 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38895
38896 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38897 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38898 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38899 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38900 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38901 use whatever size it prefers.
38902
38903 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38904 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38905 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
38906 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38907 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38908
38909 @end table
38910
38911 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38912 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38913 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38914 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
38915 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38916 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38917 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38918 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38919 it had executed in the original location.
38920
38921 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38922 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38923 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38924 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38925 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
38926 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
38927 format of the request is:
38928
38929 @table @samp
38930 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38931
38932 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38933 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38934 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38935 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38936 memory starting at @var{to}.
38937 @end table
38938
38939 Replies:
38940 @table @samp
38941 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38942 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38943 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38944 @item E @var{NN}
38945 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38946 relocating the instruction.
38947 @end table
38948
38949 @node Host I/O Packets
38950 @section Host I/O Packets
38951 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38952 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38953
38954 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38955 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38956 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38957 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38958 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38959 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38960 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38961 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38962 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38963 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38964
38965 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38966 its arguments. They have this format:
38967
38968 @table @samp
38969
38970 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38971 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38972 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38973 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38974 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38975 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38976 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38977 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38978 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38979
38980 @end table
38981
38982 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38983
38984 @table @samp
38985
38986 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38987 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38988 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38989 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38990 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38991 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38992 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38993 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38994 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38995 @var{attachment}.
38996
38997 @item @w{}
38998 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38999
39000 @end table
39001
39002 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39003
39004 @table @samp
39005 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39006 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39007 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39008 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39009 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39010 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39011 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39012
39013 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39014 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39015 -1 if an error occurs.
39016
39017 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39018 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39019 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39020 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39021 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39022 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39023 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39024 @var{count} was zero.
39025
39026 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39027 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39028 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39029 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39030 some characters were escaped.
39031
39032 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39033 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39034 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39035 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39036 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39037 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39038 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39039 error occurred.
39040
39041 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39042 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39043 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39044 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39045 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39046 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39047
39048 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39049 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39050 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39051
39052 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39053 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39054 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39055
39056 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39057 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39058 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39059 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39060 some characters were escaped.
39061
39062 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39063 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39064 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39065 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39066 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39067 inferior(s).
39068
39069 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39070 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39071 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39072 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39073 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39074 operation.
39075
39076 @end table
39077
39078 @node Interrupts
39079 @section Interrupts
39080 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39081 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39082
39083 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39084 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39085 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39086 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39087
39088 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39089 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39090 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39091 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39092 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39093
39094 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39095 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39096 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39097 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39098 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39099 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39100 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39101 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39102
39103 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39104 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39105 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39106
39107 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39108 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39109 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39110 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39111 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39112 @code{0x03}.
39113
39114 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39115 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39116 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39117 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39118 currently-executing threads and processes.
39119 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39120 running program, it should send one of the stop
39121 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39122 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39123 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39124 Interrupts received while the
39125 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39126 it is resumed next time.
39127
39128 @node Notification Packets
39129 @section Notification Packets
39130 @cindex notification packets
39131 @cindex packets, notification
39132
39133 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39134 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39135 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39136 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39137 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39138 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39139 is not a problem.
39140
39141 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39142 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39143 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39144 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39145 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39146 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39147 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39148
39149 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39150 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39151
39152 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39153 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39154 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39155 not they understand it.
39156
39157 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39158 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39159 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39160 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39161 recipients.
39162
39163 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39164 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39165 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39166 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39167 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39168
39169 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39170 @table @samp
39171 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39172 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39173 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39174 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39175 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39176 @item @var{ack}
39177 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39178 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39179 @end table
39180
39181 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39182 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39183
39184 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39185 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39186 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39187 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39188 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39189 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39190 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39191 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39192 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39193 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39194
39195 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39196 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39197 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39198 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39199 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39200 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39201
39202 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39203 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39204 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39205 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39206 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39207
39208 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39209 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39210 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39211 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39212 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39213 normally.
39214
39215 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39216 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39217 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39218 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39219 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39220 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39221 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39222 the process shall be repeated.
39223
39224 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39225 following example:
39226 @smallexample
39227 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39228 @code{...}
39229 -> @code{vStopped}
39230 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39231 -> @code{vStopped}
39232 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39233 -> @code{vStopped}
39234 <- @code{OK}
39235 @end smallexample
39236
39237 The following notifications are defined:
39238 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39239
39240 @item Notification
39241 @tab Ack
39242 @tab Event
39243 @tab Description
39244
39245 @item Stop
39246 @tab vStopped
39247 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39248 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39249 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39250 @value{GDBN}.
39251 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39252
39253 @end multitable
39254
39255 @node Remote Non-Stop
39256 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39257
39258 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39259 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39260 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39261 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39262
39263 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39264 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39265 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39266 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39267 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39268 probe the target state after a mode change.
39269
39270 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39271 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39272 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39273 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39274 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39275 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39276 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39277 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39278 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39279 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39280 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39281
39282 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39283 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39284 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39285 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39286 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39287 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39288 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39289 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39290 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39291 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39292 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39293 @samp{OK}.
39294
39295 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39296 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39297 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39298 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39299 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39300 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39301 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39302 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39303 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39304 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39305 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39306 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39307 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39308
39309 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39310 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39311
39312 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39313 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39314 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39315 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39316 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39317 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39318 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39319
39320 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39321 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39322 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39323 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39324 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39325
39326 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39327 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39328 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39329 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39330
39331 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39332 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39333 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39334 @pxref{qSupported}.
39335 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39336 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39337 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39338 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39339 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39340 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39341 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39342
39343 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39344 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39345 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39346 connection.
39347 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39348 new connection is established,
39349 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39350 for the current connection, once disabled.
39351
39352 @node Examples
39353 @section Examples
39354
39355 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39356 does not get any direct output:
39357
39358 @smallexample
39359 -> @code{R00}
39360 <- @code{+}
39361 @emph{target restarts}
39362 -> @code{?}
39363 <- @code{+}
39364 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39365 -> @code{+}
39366 @end smallexample
39367
39368 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39369
39370 @smallexample
39371 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39372 <- @code{+}
39373 -> @code{s}
39374 <- @code{+}
39375 @emph{time passes}
39376 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39377 -> @code{+}
39378 -> @code{g}
39379 <- @code{+}
39380 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39381 -> @code{+}
39382 @end smallexample
39383
39384 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39385 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39386 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39387
39388 @menu
39389 * File-I/O Overview::
39390 * Protocol Basics::
39391 * The F Request Packet::
39392 * The F Reply Packet::
39393 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39394 * Console I/O::
39395 * List of Supported Calls::
39396 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39397 * Constants::
39398 * File-I/O Examples::
39399 @end menu
39400
39401 @node File-I/O Overview
39402 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39403 @cindex file-i/o overview
39404
39405 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39406 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39407 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39408 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39409 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39410 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39411
39412 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39413 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39414 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39415 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39416 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39417
39418 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39419 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39420 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39421 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39422 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39423 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39424 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39425
39426 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39427 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39428 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39429 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39430 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39431
39432 @smallexample
39433 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39434 <- target requests 'system call X'
39435 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39436 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39437 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39438 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39439 @end smallexample
39440
39441 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39442 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39443 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39444 system are not supported by this protocol.
39445
39446 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39447
39448 @node Protocol Basics
39449 @subsection Protocol Basics
39450 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39451
39452 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39453 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39454 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39455 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39456 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39457 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39458 to call the appropriate host system call:
39459
39460 @itemize @bullet
39461 @item
39462 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39463
39464 @item
39465 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39466 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39467 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39468 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39469
39470 @end itemize
39471
39472 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39473
39474 @itemize @bullet
39475 @item
39476 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39477 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39478 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39479 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39480 packet.
39481
39482 @item
39483 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39484 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39485
39486 @item
39487 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39488
39489 @item
39490 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39491
39492 @item
39493 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
39494 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
39495 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
39496 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
39497 packet.
39498
39499 @end itemize
39500
39501 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
39502 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
39503
39504 @itemize @bullet
39505 @item
39506 Return value.
39507
39508 @item
39509 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
39510
39511 @item
39512 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
39513
39514 @end itemize
39515
39516 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
39517 the latest continue or step action.
39518
39519 @node The F Request Packet
39520 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
39521 @cindex file-i/o request packet
39522 @cindex @code{F} request packet
39523
39524 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
39525
39526 @table @samp
39527 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
39528
39529 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
39530 This is just the name of the function.
39531
39532 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
39533 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
39534 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
39535 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
39536 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
39537 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
39538 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
39539
39540 @end table
39541
39542
39543
39544 @node The F Reply Packet
39545 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
39546 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
39547 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
39548
39549 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
39550
39551 @table @samp
39552
39553 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
39554
39555 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
39556
39557 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
39558 representation.
39559 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
39560
39561 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
39562 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
39563 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
39564
39565 @smallexample
39566 F0,0,C
39567 @end smallexample
39568
39569 @noindent
39570 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
39571
39572 @smallexample
39573 F-1,4,C
39574 @end smallexample
39575
39576 @noindent
39577 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
39578
39579 @end table
39580
39581
39582 @node The Ctrl-C Message
39583 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39584 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39585
39586 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39587 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39588 the target should behave as if it had
39589 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
39590 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39591 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39592 packet.
39593
39594 It's important for the target to know in which
39595 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
39596
39597 @itemize @bullet
39598 @item
39599 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39600
39601 @item
39602 The system call on the host has been finished.
39603
39604 @end itemize
39605
39606 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39607 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39608 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39609 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
39610 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39611 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39612
39613 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
39614 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39615 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
39616 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39617 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39618 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39619 or the full action has been completed.
39620
39621 @node Console I/O
39622 @subsection Console I/O
39623 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39624
39625 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39626 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
39627 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39628 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
39629 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
39630 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39631 conditions is met:
39632
39633 @itemize @bullet
39634 @item
39635 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39636 @code{read}
39637 system call is treated as finished.
39638
39639 @item
39640 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39641 newline.
39642
39643 @item
39644 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
39645 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39646
39647 @end itemize
39648
39649 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39650 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39651 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39652 is stopped at the user's request.
39653
39654
39655 @node List of Supported Calls
39656 @subsection List of Supported Calls
39657 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39658
39659 @menu
39660 * open::
39661 * close::
39662 * read::
39663 * write::
39664 * lseek::
39665 * rename::
39666 * unlink::
39667 * stat/fstat::
39668 * gettimeofday::
39669 * isatty::
39670 * system::
39671 @end menu
39672
39673 @node open
39674 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
39675 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
39676
39677 @table @asis
39678 @item Synopsis:
39679 @smallexample
39680 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39681 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39682 @end smallexample
39683
39684 @item Request:
39685 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39686
39687 @noindent
39688 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39689
39690 @table @code
39691 @item O_CREAT
39692 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
39693 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39694 are concerned.
39695
39696 @item O_EXCL
39697 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39698 an error and open() fails.
39699
39700 @item O_TRUNC
39701 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39702 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39703 truncated to zero length.
39704
39705 @item O_APPEND
39706 The file is opened in append mode.
39707
39708 @item O_RDONLY
39709 The file is opened for reading only.
39710
39711 @item O_WRONLY
39712 The file is opened for writing only.
39713
39714 @item O_RDWR
39715 The file is opened for reading and writing.
39716 @end table
39717
39718 @noindent
39719 Other bits are silently ignored.
39720
39721
39722 @noindent
39723 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39724
39725 @table @code
39726 @item S_IRUSR
39727 User has read permission.
39728
39729 @item S_IWUSR
39730 User has write permission.
39731
39732 @item S_IRGRP
39733 Group has read permission.
39734
39735 @item S_IWGRP
39736 Group has write permission.
39737
39738 @item S_IROTH
39739 Others have read permission.
39740
39741 @item S_IWOTH
39742 Others have write permission.
39743 @end table
39744
39745 @noindent
39746 Other bits are silently ignored.
39747
39748
39749 @item Return value:
39750 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39751 occurred.
39752
39753 @item Errors:
39754
39755 @table @code
39756 @item EEXIST
39757 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39758
39759 @item EISDIR
39760 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39761
39762 @item EACCES
39763 The requested access is not allowed.
39764
39765 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39766 @var{pathname} was too long.
39767
39768 @item ENOENT
39769 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39770
39771 @item ENODEV
39772 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39773
39774 @item EROFS
39775 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39776 write access was requested.
39777
39778 @item EFAULT
39779 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39780
39781 @item ENOSPC
39782 No space on device to create the file.
39783
39784 @item EMFILE
39785 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39786
39787 @item ENFILE
39788 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39789 has been reached.
39790
39791 @item EINTR
39792 The call was interrupted by the user.
39793 @end table
39794
39795 @end table
39796
39797 @node close
39798 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
39799 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
39800
39801 @table @asis
39802 @item Synopsis:
39803 @smallexample
39804 int close(int fd);
39805 @end smallexample
39806
39807 @item Request:
39808 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39809
39810 @item Return value:
39811 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39812
39813 @item Errors:
39814
39815 @table @code
39816 @item EBADF
39817 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39818
39819 @item EINTR
39820 The call was interrupted by the user.
39821 @end table
39822
39823 @end table
39824
39825 @node read
39826 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
39827 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
39828
39829 @table @asis
39830 @item Synopsis:
39831 @smallexample
39832 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39833 @end smallexample
39834
39835 @item Request:
39836 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39837
39838 @item Return value:
39839 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39840 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
39841 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
39842
39843 @item Errors:
39844
39845 @table @code
39846 @item EBADF
39847 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39848 reading.
39849
39850 @item EFAULT
39851 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39852
39853 @item EINTR
39854 The call was interrupted by the user.
39855 @end table
39856
39857 @end table
39858
39859 @node write
39860 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
39861 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
39862
39863 @table @asis
39864 @item Synopsis:
39865 @smallexample
39866 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39867 @end smallexample
39868
39869 @item Request:
39870 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39871
39872 @item Return value:
39873 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39874 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
39875 is returned.
39876
39877 @item Errors:
39878
39879 @table @code
39880 @item EBADF
39881 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39882 writing.
39883
39884 @item EFAULT
39885 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39886
39887 @item EFBIG
39888 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39889 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39890
39891 @item ENOSPC
39892 No space on device to write the data.
39893
39894 @item EINTR
39895 The call was interrupted by the user.
39896 @end table
39897
39898 @end table
39899
39900 @node lseek
39901 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39902 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39903
39904 @table @asis
39905 @item Synopsis:
39906 @smallexample
39907 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39908 @end smallexample
39909
39910 @item Request:
39911 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39912
39913 @var{flag} is one of:
39914
39915 @table @code
39916 @item SEEK_SET
39917 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39918
39919 @item SEEK_CUR
39920 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39921 bytes.
39922
39923 @item SEEK_END
39924 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39925 bytes.
39926 @end table
39927
39928 @item Return value:
39929 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39930 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39931 value of -1 is returned.
39932
39933 @item Errors:
39934
39935 @table @code
39936 @item EBADF
39937 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39938
39939 @item ESPIPE
39940 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39941
39942 @item EINVAL
39943 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39944
39945 @item EINTR
39946 The call was interrupted by the user.
39947 @end table
39948
39949 @end table
39950
39951 @node rename
39952 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39953 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39954
39955 @table @asis
39956 @item Synopsis:
39957 @smallexample
39958 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39959 @end smallexample
39960
39961 @item Request:
39962 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39963
39964 @item Return value:
39965 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39966
39967 @item Errors:
39968
39969 @table @code
39970 @item EISDIR
39971 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39972 directory.
39973
39974 @item EEXIST
39975 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39976
39977 @item EBUSY
39978 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39979 process.
39980
39981 @item EINVAL
39982 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39983 of itself.
39984
39985 @item ENOTDIR
39986 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39987 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39988 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39989
39990 @item EFAULT
39991 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39992
39993 @item EACCES
39994 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39995
39996 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39997
39998 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39999
40000 @item ENOENT
40001 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40002
40003 @item EROFS
40004 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40005
40006 @item ENOSPC
40007 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40008 directory entry.
40009
40010 @item EINTR
40011 The call was interrupted by the user.
40012 @end table
40013
40014 @end table
40015
40016 @node unlink
40017 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40018 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40019
40020 @table @asis
40021 @item Synopsis:
40022 @smallexample
40023 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40024 @end smallexample
40025
40026 @item Request:
40027 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40028
40029 @item Return value:
40030 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40031
40032 @item Errors:
40033
40034 @table @code
40035 @item EACCES
40036 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40037
40038 @item EPERM
40039 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40040
40041 @item EBUSY
40042 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40043 being used by another process.
40044
40045 @item EFAULT
40046 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40047
40048 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40049 @var{pathname} was too long.
40050
40051 @item ENOENT
40052 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40053
40054 @item ENOTDIR
40055 A component of the path is not a directory.
40056
40057 @item EROFS
40058 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40059
40060 @item EINTR
40061 The call was interrupted by the user.
40062 @end table
40063
40064 @end table
40065
40066 @node stat/fstat
40067 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40068 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40069 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40070
40071 @table @asis
40072 @item Synopsis:
40073 @smallexample
40074 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40075 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40076 @end smallexample
40077
40078 @item Request:
40079 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40080 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40081
40082 @item Return value:
40083 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40084
40085 @item Errors:
40086
40087 @table @code
40088 @item EBADF
40089 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40090
40091 @item ENOENT
40092 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40093 path is an empty string.
40094
40095 @item ENOTDIR
40096 A component of the path is not a directory.
40097
40098 @item EFAULT
40099 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40100
40101 @item EACCES
40102 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40103
40104 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40105 @var{pathname} was too long.
40106
40107 @item EINTR
40108 The call was interrupted by the user.
40109 @end table
40110
40111 @end table
40112
40113 @node gettimeofday
40114 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40115 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40116
40117 @table @asis
40118 @item Synopsis:
40119 @smallexample
40120 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40121 @end smallexample
40122
40123 @item Request:
40124 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40125
40126 @item Return value:
40127 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40128
40129 @item Errors:
40130
40131 @table @code
40132 @item EINVAL
40133 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40134
40135 @item EFAULT
40136 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40137 @end table
40138
40139 @end table
40140
40141 @node isatty
40142 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40143 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40144
40145 @table @asis
40146 @item Synopsis:
40147 @smallexample
40148 int isatty(int fd);
40149 @end smallexample
40150
40151 @item Request:
40152 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40153
40154 @item Return value:
40155 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40156
40157 @item Errors:
40158
40159 @table @code
40160 @item EINTR
40161 The call was interrupted by the user.
40162 @end table
40163
40164 @end table
40165
40166 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40167 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40168 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40169 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40170 needed.
40171
40172
40173 @node system
40174 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40175 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40176
40177 @table @asis
40178 @item Synopsis:
40179 @smallexample
40180 int system(const char *command);
40181 @end smallexample
40182
40183 @item Request:
40184 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40185
40186 @item Return value:
40187 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40188 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40189 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40190 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40191 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40192 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40193 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40194
40195 @item Errors:
40196
40197 @table @code
40198 @item EINTR
40199 The call was interrupted by the user.
40200 @end table
40201
40202 @end table
40203
40204 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40205 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40206 the host is simplified before it's returned
40207 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40208 is discarded, and the return value consists
40209 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40210
40211 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40212 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40213 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40214
40215 @table @code
40216 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40217 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40218 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40219 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40220
40221 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40222 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40223 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40224 protocol.
40225 @end table
40226
40227 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40228 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40229 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40230
40231 @menu
40232 * Integral Datatypes::
40233 * Pointer Values::
40234 * Memory Transfer::
40235 * struct stat::
40236 * struct timeval::
40237 @end menu
40238
40239 @node Integral Datatypes
40240 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40241 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40242
40243 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40244 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40245 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40246
40247 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40248 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40249
40250 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40251
40252 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40253 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40254
40255 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40256
40257 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40258 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40259 byte order.
40260
40261 @node Pointer Values
40262 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40263 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40264
40265 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40266 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40267 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40268 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40269
40270 @smallexample
40271 @code{1aaf/12}
40272 @end smallexample
40273
40274 @noindent
40275 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40276 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40277 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40278 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40279
40280 @smallexample
40281 @code{123456/d}
40282 @end smallexample
40283
40284 @node Memory Transfer
40285 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40286 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40287
40288 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40289 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40290 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40291 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40292 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40293 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40294 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40295
40296
40297 @node struct stat
40298 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40299 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40300
40301 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40302 is defined as follows:
40303
40304 @smallexample
40305 struct stat @{
40306 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40307 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40308 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40309 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40310 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40311 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40312 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40313 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40314 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40315 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40316 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40317 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40318 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40319 @};
40320 @end smallexample
40321
40322 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40323 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40324 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40325
40326 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40327 range of values.
40328
40329 @table @code
40330
40331 @item st_dev
40332 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40333
40334 @item st_ino
40335 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40336
40337 @item st_mode
40338 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40339 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40340
40341 @item st_uid
40342 @itemx st_gid
40343 @itemx st_rdev
40344 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40345
40346 @item st_atime
40347 @itemx st_mtime
40348 @itemx st_ctime
40349 These values have a host and file system dependent
40350 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40351 support exact timing values.
40352 @end table
40353
40354 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40355 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40356 continuing.
40357
40358 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40359 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40360 get truncated on the target.
40361
40362 @node struct timeval
40363 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40364 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40365
40366 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40367 is defined as follows:
40368
40369 @smallexample
40370 struct timeval @{
40371 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40372 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40373 @};
40374 @end smallexample
40375
40376 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40377 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40378 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40379
40380 @node Constants
40381 @subsection Constants
40382 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40383
40384 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40385 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40386 values before and after the call as needed.
40387
40388 @menu
40389 * Open Flags::
40390 * mode_t Values::
40391 * Errno Values::
40392 * Lseek Flags::
40393 * Limits::
40394 @end menu
40395
40396 @node Open Flags
40397 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40398 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40399
40400 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40401
40402 @smallexample
40403 O_RDONLY 0x0
40404 O_WRONLY 0x1
40405 O_RDWR 0x2
40406 O_APPEND 0x8
40407 O_CREAT 0x200
40408 O_TRUNC 0x400
40409 O_EXCL 0x800
40410 @end smallexample
40411
40412 @node mode_t Values
40413 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40414 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40415
40416 All values are given in octal representation.
40417
40418 @smallexample
40419 S_IFREG 0100000
40420 S_IFDIR 040000
40421 S_IRUSR 0400
40422 S_IWUSR 0200
40423 S_IXUSR 0100
40424 S_IRGRP 040
40425 S_IWGRP 020
40426 S_IXGRP 010
40427 S_IROTH 04
40428 S_IWOTH 02
40429 S_IXOTH 01
40430 @end smallexample
40431
40432 @node Errno Values
40433 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40434 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40435
40436 All values are given in decimal representation.
40437
40438 @smallexample
40439 EPERM 1
40440 ENOENT 2
40441 EINTR 4
40442 EBADF 9
40443 EACCES 13
40444 EFAULT 14
40445 EBUSY 16
40446 EEXIST 17
40447 ENODEV 19
40448 ENOTDIR 20
40449 EISDIR 21
40450 EINVAL 22
40451 ENFILE 23
40452 EMFILE 24
40453 EFBIG 27
40454 ENOSPC 28
40455 ESPIPE 29
40456 EROFS 30
40457 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40458 EUNKNOWN 9999
40459 @end smallexample
40460
40461 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40462 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40463
40464 @node Lseek Flags
40465 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40466 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40467
40468 @smallexample
40469 SEEK_SET 0
40470 SEEK_CUR 1
40471 SEEK_END 2
40472 @end smallexample
40473
40474 @node Limits
40475 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40476 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40477
40478 All values are given in decimal representation.
40479
40480 @smallexample
40481 INT_MIN -2147483648
40482 INT_MAX 2147483647
40483 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40484 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40485 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40486 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40487 @end smallexample
40488
40489 @node File-I/O Examples
40490 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40491 @cindex file-i/o examples
40492
40493 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40494 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
40495
40496 @smallexample
40497 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
40498 @emph{request memory read from target}
40499 -> @code{m1234,6}
40500 <- XXXXXX
40501 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
40502 -> @code{F6}
40503 @end smallexample
40504
40505 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
40506 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
40507
40508 @smallexample
40509 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40510 @emph{request memory write to target}
40511 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40512 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
40513 -> @code{F6}
40514 @end smallexample
40515
40516 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
40517 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
40518
40519 @smallexample
40520 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40521 -> @code{F-1,9}
40522 @end smallexample
40523
40524 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
40525 host is called:
40526
40527 @smallexample
40528 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40529 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
40530 <- @code{T02}
40531 @end smallexample
40532
40533 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
40534 host is called:
40535
40536 @smallexample
40537 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
40538 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
40539 <- @code{T02}
40540 @end smallexample
40541
40542 @node Library List Format
40543 @section Library List Format
40544 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40545
40546 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
40547 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
40548 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
40549 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
40550 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
40551 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
40552 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40553 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
40554 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
40555 are loaded.
40556
40557 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
40558 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
40559 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
40560 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
40561
40562 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
40563 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
40564 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
40565 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
40566 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
40567 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
40568
40569 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40570 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40571
40572 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
40573 offset, looks like this:
40574
40575 @smallexample
40576 <library-list>
40577 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
40578 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
40579 </library>
40580 </library-list>
40581 @end smallexample
40582
40583 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40584 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40585
40586 @smallexample
40587 <library-list>
40588 <library name="sharedlib.o">
40589 <section address="0x10000000"/>
40590 <section address="0x20000000"/>
40591 <section address="0x30000000"/>
40592 </library>
40593 </library-list>
40594 @end smallexample
40595
40596 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40597
40598 @smallexample
40599 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40600 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
40601 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40602 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
40603 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40604 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
40605 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40606 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
40607 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
40608 @end smallexample
40609
40610 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40611 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40612 section for each library.
40613
40614 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40615 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40616 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
40617
40618 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40619 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40620 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40621 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40622
40623 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40624 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
40625 target, the following parameters are reported:
40626
40627 @itemize @minus
40628 @item
40629 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40630 @code{struct link_map}.
40631 @item
40632 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40633 (Thread Local Storage) access.
40634 @item
40635 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40636 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40637 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40638 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40639 @item
40640 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40641 @end itemize
40642
40643 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40644 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
40645 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40646
40647 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40648 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
40649
40650 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40651 looks like this:
40652
40653 @smallexample
40654 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40655 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40656 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40657 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40658 l_ld="0x152350"/>
40659 </library-list-svr>
40660 @end smallexample
40661
40662 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40663
40664 @smallexample
40665 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40666 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
40667 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40668 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
40669 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
40670 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40671 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
40672 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
40673 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
40674 @end smallexample
40675
40676 @node Memory Map Format
40677 @section Memory Map Format
40678 @cindex memory map format
40679
40680 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40681 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
40682 memory map.
40683
40684 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40685 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40686 lists memory regions.
40687
40688 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40689 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
40690
40691 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40692
40693 @smallexample
40694 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40695 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
40696 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40697 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40698 <memory-map>
40699 region...
40700 </memory-map>
40701 @end smallexample
40702
40703 Each region can be either:
40704
40705 @itemize
40706
40707 @item
40708 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40709 bytes from there:
40710
40711 @smallexample
40712 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40713 @end smallexample
40714
40715
40716 @item
40717 A region of read-only memory:
40718
40719 @smallexample
40720 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40721 @end smallexample
40722
40723
40724 @item
40725 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40726 bytes in length:
40727
40728 @smallexample
40729 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40730 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40731 </memory>
40732 @end smallexample
40733
40734 @end itemize
40735
40736 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40737 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40738 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40739
40740 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40741
40742 @smallexample
40743 <!-- ................................................... -->
40744 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40745 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40746 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
40747 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40748 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40749 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40750 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
40751 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40752 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40753 and its type, or device. -->
40754 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
40755 start CDATA #REQUIRED
40756 length CDATA #REQUIRED
40757 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
40758 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40759 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40760 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
40761 @end smallexample
40762
40763 @node Thread List Format
40764 @section Thread List Format
40765 @cindex thread list format
40766
40767 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40768 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40769 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40770 the following structure:
40771
40772 @smallexample
40773 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40774 <threads>
40775 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40776 ... description ...
40777 </thread>
40778 </threads>
40779 @end smallexample
40780
40781 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40782 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
40783 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40784 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
40785 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
40786 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40787 auxiliary information.
40788
40789 @node Traceframe Info Format
40790 @section Traceframe Info Format
40791 @cindex traceframe info format
40792
40793 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40794 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40795 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40796 collected in a traceframe.
40797
40798 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40799 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40800
40801 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40802 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40803
40804 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40805
40806 @smallexample
40807 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40808 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40809 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40810 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40811 <traceframe-info>
40812 block...
40813 </traceframe-info>
40814 @end smallexample
40815
40816 Each traceframe block can be either:
40817
40818 @itemize
40819
40820 @item
40821 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40822 @var{length} bytes from there:
40823
40824 @smallexample
40825 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40826 @end smallexample
40827
40828 @item
40829 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40830 collected:
40831
40832 @smallexample
40833 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40834 @end smallexample
40835
40836 @end itemize
40837
40838 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40839
40840 @smallexample
40841 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
40842 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40843
40844 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
40845 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
40846 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
40847 <!ELEMENT tvar>
40848 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
40849 @end smallexample
40850
40851 @node Branch Trace Format
40852 @section Branch Trace Format
40853 @cindex branch trace format
40854
40855 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40856 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
40857 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40858 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40859
40860 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40861 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40862
40863 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40864 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40865
40866 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40867
40868 @smallexample
40869 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40870 <!DOCTYPE btrace
40871 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40872 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40873 <btrace>
40874 block...
40875 </btrace>
40876 @end smallexample
40877
40878 @itemize
40879
40880 @item
40881 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40882 and ending at @var{end}:
40883
40884 @smallexample
40885 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40886 @end smallexample
40887
40888 @end itemize
40889
40890 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40891
40892 @smallexample
40893 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
40894 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40895
40896 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
40897 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
40898 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
40899
40900 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40901
40902 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40903
40904 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40905 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
40906 family CDATA #REQUIRED
40907 model CDATA #REQUIRED
40908 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40909
40910 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40911 @end smallexample
40912
40913 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40914 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40915 @cindex branch trace configuration format
40916
40917 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40918 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40919 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40920
40921 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40922 settings for that format. The following information is described:
40923
40924 @table @code
40925 @item bts
40926 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40927 @table @code
40928 @item size
40929 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40930 @end table
40931 @item pt
40932 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40933 PT}) format.
40934 @table @code
40935 @item size
40936 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40937 @end table
40938 @end table
40939
40940 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40941 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40942
40943 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40944
40945 @smallexample
40946 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40947 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40948
40949 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40950 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40951
40952 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40953 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40954 @end smallexample
40955
40956 @include agentexpr.texi
40957
40958 @node Target Descriptions
40959 @appendix Target Descriptions
40960 @cindex target descriptions
40961
40962 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40963 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40964 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40965 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40966 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40967 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40968 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40969
40970 @itemize @bullet
40971 @item
40972 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40973 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40974 @item
40975 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40976 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40977 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40978 @item
40979 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40980 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40981 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40982 @end itemize
40983
40984 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40985 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40986 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40987 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40988 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40989
40990 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40991 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40992
40993 @menu
40994 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40995 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40996 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40997 descriptions.
40998 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
40999 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41000 @end menu
41001
41002 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41003 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41004
41005 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41006 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41007 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41008 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41009 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41010 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41011 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41012 Format}.
41013
41014 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41015 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41016 specify a file are:
41017
41018 @table @code
41019 @cindex set tdesc filename
41020 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41021 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41022
41023 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41024 @item unset tdesc filename
41025 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41026 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41027
41028 @cindex show tdesc filename
41029 @item show tdesc filename
41030 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41031 @end table
41032
41033
41034 @node Target Description Format
41035 @section Target Description Format
41036 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41037
41038 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41039 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41040 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41041 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41042 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41043 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41044 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41045
41046 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41047 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41048 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41049 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41050 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41051
41052 Here is a simple target description:
41053
41054 @smallexample
41055 <target version="1.0">
41056 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41057 </target>
41058 @end smallexample
41059
41060 @noindent
41061 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41062 the x86-64 architecture.
41063
41064 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41065 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41066 are explained further below.
41067
41068 @smallexample
41069 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41070 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41071 <target version="1.0">
41072 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41073 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41074 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41075 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41076 </target>
41077 @end smallexample
41078
41079 @noindent
41080 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41081 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41082 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41083 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41084 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41085 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41086 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41087 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41088 the version mismatch.
41089
41090 @subsection Inclusion
41091 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41092 @cindex XInclude
41093 @ifnotinfo
41094 @cindex <xi:include>
41095 @end ifnotinfo
41096
41097 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41098 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41099 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41100 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41101 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41102
41103 @smallexample
41104 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41105 @end smallexample
41106
41107 @noindent
41108 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41109 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41110 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41111 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41112 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41113 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41114 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41115 original description.
41116
41117 @subsection Architecture
41118 @cindex <architecture>
41119
41120 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41121
41122 @smallexample
41123 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41124 @end smallexample
41125
41126 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41127 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41128
41129 @subsection OS ABI
41130 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41131
41132 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41133 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41134
41135 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41136
41137 @smallexample
41138 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41139 @end smallexample
41140
41141 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41142 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41143
41144 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41145 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41146
41147 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41148 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41149
41150 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41151
41152 @smallexample
41153 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41154 @end smallexample
41155
41156 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41157 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41158
41159 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41160 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41161 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41162 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41163 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41164 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41165 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41166
41167 @smallexample
41168 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41169 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41170 @end smallexample
41171
41172 @subsection Features
41173 @cindex <feature>
41174
41175 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41176 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41177 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41178 has this form:
41179
41180 @smallexample
41181 <feature name="@var{name}">
41182 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41183 @var{reg}@dots{}
41184 </feature>
41185 @end smallexample
41186
41187 @noindent
41188 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41189 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41190 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41191 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41192
41193 @subsection Types
41194
41195 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41196 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41197 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41198 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41199 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41200 and enum types.
41201
41202 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41203 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41204 Types must be defined before they are used.
41205
41206 @cindex <vector>
41207 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41208 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41209 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41210 @var{count}:
41211
41212 @smallexample
41213 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41214 @end smallexample
41215
41216 @cindex <union>
41217 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41218 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41219 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41220 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41221
41222 @smallexample
41223 <union id="@var{id}">
41224 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41225 @dots{}
41226 </union>
41227 @end smallexample
41228
41229 @cindex <struct>
41230 @cindex <flags>
41231 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41232 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41233 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41234 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41235 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41236 specified.
41237
41238 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41239
41240 @smallexample
41241 <struct id="@var{id}">
41242 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41243 @dots{}
41244 </struct>
41245 @end smallexample
41246
41247 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41248 No implicit padding is added.
41249
41250 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41251
41252 @smallexample
41253 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41254 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41255 @dots{}
41256 </struct>
41257 @end smallexample
41258
41259 @smallexample
41260 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41261 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41262 @dots{}
41263 </flags>
41264 @end smallexample
41265
41266 The @var{name} value is required.
41267 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41268 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41269 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41270
41271 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41272 is optional.
41273 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41274 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41275
41276 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41277 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41278
41279 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41280
41281 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41282 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41283
41284 @itemize @bullet
41285 @item
41286 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41287 @item
41288 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41289 @end itemize
41290
41291 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41292 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41293
41294 @itemize @bullet
41295 @item
41296 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41297
41298 @smallexample
41299 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41300 $1 = 42
41301 @end smallexample
41302
41303 @end itemize
41304
41305 @subsection Registers
41306 @cindex <reg>
41307
41308 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41309
41310 @smallexample
41311 <reg name="@var{name}"
41312 bitsize="@var{size}"
41313 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41314 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41315 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41316 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41317 @end smallexample
41318
41319 @noindent
41320 The components are as follows:
41321
41322 @table @var
41323
41324 @item name
41325 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41326
41327 @item bitsize
41328 The register's size, in bits.
41329
41330 @item regnum
41331 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41332 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41333 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41334 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41335 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41336 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41337 in order of increasing register number.
41338
41339 @item save-restore
41340 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41341 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41342 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41343 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41344 ABI.
41345
41346 @item type
41347 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41348 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41349 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41350 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41351 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41352 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41353
41354 @item group
41355 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
41356 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
41357 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
41358 in @code{info registers}.
41359
41360 @end table
41361
41362 @node Predefined Target Types
41363 @section Predefined Target Types
41364 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41365
41366 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41367 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41368 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41369 types. The currently supported types are:
41370
41371 @table @code
41372
41373 @item bool
41374 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41375
41376 @item int8
41377 @itemx int16
41378 @itemx int32
41379 @itemx int64
41380 @itemx int128
41381 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41382
41383 @item uint8
41384 @itemx uint16
41385 @itemx uint32
41386 @itemx uint64
41387 @itemx uint128
41388 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41389
41390 @item code_ptr
41391 @itemx data_ptr
41392 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41393 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41394 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41395 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41396 may be marked as data pointers.
41397
41398 @item ieee_single
41399 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41400
41401 @item ieee_double
41402 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41403
41404 @item arm_fpa_ext
41405 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41406
41407 @item i387_ext
41408 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41409
41410 @item i386_eflags
41411 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41412
41413 @item i386_mxcsr
41414 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41415
41416 @end table
41417
41418 @node Enum Target Types
41419 @section Enum Target Types
41420 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41421
41422 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41423 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41424
41425 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41426
41427 @smallexample
41428 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41429 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41430 @dots{}
41431 </enum>
41432 @end smallexample
41433
41434 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41435
41436 @smallexample
41437 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41438 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41439 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41440 </enum>
41441 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41442 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41443 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41444 </flags>
41445 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41446 @end smallexample
41447
41448 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41449 would be printed as:
41450
41451 @smallexample
41452 (gdb) info register flags
41453 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41454 @end smallexample
41455
41456 @node Standard Target Features
41457 @section Standard Target Features
41458 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41459
41460 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41461 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41462 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41463 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41464 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41465 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41466 can recognize them.
41467
41468 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41469 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41470 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41471 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41472 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41473 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41474 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41475 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41476
41477 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41478 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41479 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41480
41481 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41482 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41483 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41484 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41485
41486 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41487 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41488 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
41489
41490 @menu
41491 * AArch64 Features::
41492 * ARC Features::
41493 * ARM Features::
41494 * i386 Features::
41495 * MicroBlaze Features::
41496 * MIPS Features::
41497 * M68K Features::
41498 * NDS32 Features::
41499 * Nios II Features::
41500 * PowerPC Features::
41501 * S/390 and System z Features::
41502 * Sparc Features::
41503 * TIC6x Features::
41504 @end menu
41505
41506
41507 @node AArch64 Features
41508 @subsection AArch64 Features
41509 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
41510
41511 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
41512 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
41513 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41514
41515 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41516 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
41517 and @samp{fpcr}.
41518
41519 @node ARC Features
41520 @subsection ARC Features
41521 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
41522
41523 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
41524 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
41525 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
41526 that one of the core registers features is present.
41527 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
41528
41529 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
41530 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41531 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41532 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
41533 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41534 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
41535 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
41536
41537 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
41538 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
41539 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
41540 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
41541 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
41542 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
41543
41544 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
41545 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
41546 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
41547 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
41548 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
41549 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
41550 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
41551 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
41552 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
41553 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
41554
41555 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
41556 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
41557
41558 @node ARM Features
41559 @subsection ARM Features
41560 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
41561
41562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
41563 ARM targets.
41564 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
41565 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
41566
41567 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
41568 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
41569 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
41570 and @samp{xpsr}.
41571
41572 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
41573 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
41574
41575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
41576 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
41577 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
41578 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
41579
41580 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
41581 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
41582 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
41583 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
41584 halves of the double-precision registers.
41585
41586 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
41587 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
41588 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
41589 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
41590 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
41591 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
41592
41593 @node i386 Features
41594 @subsection i386 Features
41595 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
41596
41597 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
41598 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41599
41600 @itemize @minus
41601 @item
41602 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
41603 @item
41604 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
41605 @item
41606 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
41607 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
41608 @item
41609 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
41610 @item
41611 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
41612 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
41613 @end itemize
41614
41615 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
41616
41617 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
41618 describe registers:
41619
41620 @itemize @minus
41621 @item
41622 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41623 @item
41624 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41625 @item
41626 @samp{mxcsr}
41627 @end itemize
41628
41629 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41630 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
41631 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41632
41633 @itemize @minus
41634 @item
41635 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41636 @item
41637 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41638 @end itemize
41639
41640 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41641 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
41642
41643 @itemize @minus
41644 @item
41645 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41646 @item
41647 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41648 @end itemize
41649
41650 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
41651 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41652
41653 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
41654 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
41655
41656 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41657 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
41658 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41659
41660 @itemize @minus
41661 @item
41662 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41663 @end itemize
41664
41665 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41666
41667 @itemize @minus
41668 @item
41669 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41670 @end itemize
41671
41672 It should
41673 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41674
41675 @itemize @minus
41676 @item
41677 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41678 @item
41679 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41680 @end itemize
41681
41682 It should
41683 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41684
41685 @itemize @minus
41686 @item
41687 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41688 @end itemize
41689
41690 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
41691 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
41692 valid for i386 and amd64.
41693
41694 @node MicroBlaze Features
41695 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
41696 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41697
41698 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41699 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41700 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41701 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41702 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41703
41704 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41705 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41706
41707 @node MIPS Features
41708 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41709 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41710
41711 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41712 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41713 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41714 on the target.
41715
41716 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
41717 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41718 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41719
41720 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41721 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
41722 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41723 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41724
41725 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
41726 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41727 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
41728 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41729
41730 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
41731 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41732 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41733
41734 @node M68K Features
41735 @subsection M68K Features
41736 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41737
41738 @table @code
41739 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41740 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41741 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41742 One of those features must be always present.
41743 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41744 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
41745 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41746 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41747
41748 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41749 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
41750 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41751 @samp{fpiaddr}.
41752 @end table
41753
41754 @node NDS32 Features
41755 @subsection NDS32 Features
41756 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41757
41758 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41759 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41760 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41761 and @samp{pc}.
41762
41763 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
41764 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41765 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41766 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41767
41768 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41769 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41770 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41771 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41772 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
41773 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41774 support to it could be totally removed some day.
41775
41776 @node Nios II Features
41777 @subsection Nios II Features
41778 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41779
41780 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41781 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41782 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41783 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41784 @samp{mpuacc}).
41785
41786 @node PowerPC Features
41787 @subsection PowerPC Features
41788 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41789
41790 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41791 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41792 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41793 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41794
41795 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
41796 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41797
41798 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
41799 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41800 and @samp{vrsave}.
41801
41802 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
41803 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
41804 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41805 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41806 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41807 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41808
41809 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
41810 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41811 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41812 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41813 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
41814 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41815 user.
41816
41817 @node S/390 and System z Features
41818 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
41819 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41820 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
41821
41822 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41823 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41824 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41825 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41826 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41827 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
41828 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41829 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41830 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41831
41832 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
41833 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41834 @samp{fpc}.
41835
41836 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
41837 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41838
41839 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
41840 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41841 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
41842 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41843 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
41844 32-bit wide.
41845
41846 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
41847 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41848 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41849
41850 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
41851 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41852 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41853 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41854 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
41855 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41856 @samp{v31}.
41857
41858 @node Sparc Features
41859 @subsection Sparc Features
41860 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
41861 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
41862 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41863 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41864
41865 @itemize @minus
41866 @item
41867 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
41868 @item
41869 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
41870 @item
41871 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
41872 @item
41873 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
41874 @end itemize
41875
41876 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41877
41878 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41879 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41880
41881 @itemize @minus
41882 @item
41883 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
41884 @item
41885 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
41886 @end itemize
41887
41888 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
41889 targets. It should describe the following registers:
41890
41891 @itemize @minus
41892 @item
41893 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
41894 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
41895 @item
41896 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
41897 for sparc64
41898 @end itemize
41899
41900 @node TIC6x Features
41901 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
41902 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41903 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41904 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41905 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41906 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41907
41908 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
41909 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41910 through @samp{B31}.
41911
41912 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
41913 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41914
41915 @node Operating System Information
41916 @appendix Operating System Information
41917 @cindex operating system information
41918
41919 @menu
41920 * Process list::
41921 @end menu
41922
41923 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41924 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41925 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
41926 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
41927 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41928 on a different aspect of target.
41929
41930 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41931 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41932 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41933 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41934
41935 @node Process list
41936 @appendixsection Process list
41937 @cindex operating system information, process list
41938
41939 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41940 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
41941 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41942 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41943
41944 An example document is:
41945
41946 @smallexample
41947 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41948 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41949 <osdata type="processes">
41950 <item>
41951 <column name="pid">1</column>
41952 <column name="user">root</column>
41953 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41954 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41955 </item>
41956 </osdata>
41957 @end smallexample
41958
41959 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
41960 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
41961 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41962 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41963 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41964 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
41965 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41966
41967 @node Trace File Format
41968 @appendix Trace File Format
41969 @cindex trace file format
41970
41971 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41972 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41973
41974 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
41975 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41976 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41977 in the future.
41978
41979 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41980 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
41981 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41982 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
41983 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
41984 of this section.
41985
41986 @table @code
41987 @item R @var{size}
41988 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
41989 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
41990 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
41991 a single trace file.
41992
41993 @item status @var{status}
41994 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41995 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
41996 file.
41997
41998 @item tp @var{payload}
41999 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42000 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42001 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42002 reply packets.
42003
42004 @item tsv @var{payload}
42005 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42006 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42007 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42008 reply packets.
42009
42010 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42011 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42012 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42013 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42014 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42015 file. Includes are not allowed.
42016
42017 @end table
42018
42019 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42020 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42021 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42022 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42023 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42024 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42025 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42026 endianness.
42027
42028 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42029
42030 @table @code
42031 @item R @var{bytes}
42032 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42033 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42034 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42035
42036 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42037 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42038 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42039 @var{length} bytes.
42040
42041 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42042 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42043 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42044
42045 @end table
42046
42047 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42048 of blocks.
42049
42050 @node Index Section Format
42051 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42052 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42053 @cindex index section format
42054
42055 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42056 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42057 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42058 description.
42059
42060 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42061 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42062 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42063 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42064 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42065 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42066
42067 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42068
42069 @enumerate
42070 @item
42071 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42072 unless otherwise noted:
42073
42074 @enumerate
42075 @item
42076 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42077 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42078 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42079 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42080 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42081 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42082 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42083
42084 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42085 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42086 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42087 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42088
42089 @item
42090 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42091
42092 @item
42093 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42094 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42095 to the next offset.
42096
42097 @item
42098 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42099
42100 @item
42101 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42102
42103 @item
42104 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42105 @end enumerate
42106
42107 @item
42108 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42109 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42110 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42111 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42112 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42113 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42114 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42115 CU indices.
42116
42117 @item
42118 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42119 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42120 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42121 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42122
42123 @item
42124 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42125 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42126
42127 @enumerate
42128 @item
42129 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42130
42131 @item
42132 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42133 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42134
42135 @item
42136 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42137 @end enumerate
42138
42139 @item
42140 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42141 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42142
42143 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42144 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42145 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42146 constant pool.
42147
42148 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42149 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42150 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42151
42152 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42153 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42154 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42155 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42156 index version:
42157
42158 @table @asis
42159 @item Version 4
42160 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42161
42162 @item Versions 5 to 7
42163 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42164 @end table
42165
42166 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42167
42168 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42169 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42170 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42171 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42172 collision.
42173
42174 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42175 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42176 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42177 the code.
42178
42179 @item
42180 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42181 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42182 strings.
42183
42184 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42185 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42186 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42187 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42188 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42189 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42190
42191 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42192 @end enumerate
42193
42194 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42195 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42196 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42197
42198 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42199 (bit 0 = LSB):
42200
42201 @table @asis
42202
42203 @item Bits 0-23
42204 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42205 @item Bits 24-27
42206 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42207 @item Bits 28-30
42208 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42209
42210 @table @asis
42211 @item 0
42212 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42213 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42214 with previous versions of the index.
42215 @item 1
42216 The symbol is a type.
42217 @item 2
42218 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42219 @item 3
42220 The symbol is a function.
42221 @item 4
42222 Any other kind of symbol.
42223 @item 5,6,7
42224 These values are reserved.
42225 @end table
42226
42227 @item Bit 31
42228 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42229
42230 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42231 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42232 @value{GDBN} sources.
42233
42234 @end table
42235
42236 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42237 global/static attributes in the index.
42238
42239 @smallexample
42240 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42241 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42242 switch (die->tag)
42243 @{
42244 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42245 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42246 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42247 kind = TYPE;
42248 is_static = 1;
42249 break;
42250 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42251 kind = VARIABLE;
42252 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42253 break;
42254 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42255 kind = FUNCTION;
42256 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42257 break;
42258 case DW_TAG_constant:
42259 kind = VARIABLE;
42260 is_static = ! is_external;
42261 break;
42262 case DW_TAG_variable:
42263 kind = VARIABLE;
42264 is_static = ! is_external;
42265 break;
42266 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42267 kind = TYPE;
42268 is_static = 0;
42269 break;
42270 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42271 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42272 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42273 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42274 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42275 kind = TYPE;
42276 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42277 break;
42278 default:
42279 assert (0);
42280 @}
42281 @end smallexample
42282
42283 @node Man Pages
42284 @appendix Manual pages
42285 @cindex Man pages
42286
42287 @menu
42288 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42289 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42290 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42291 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42292 @end menu
42293
42294 @node gdb man
42295 @heading gdb man
42296
42297 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42298
42299 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42300 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42301 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42302 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42303 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42304 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42305 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42306 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42307 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42308 @c man end
42309
42310 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42311 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42312 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42313 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42314
42315 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42316 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42317
42318 @itemize @bullet
42319 @item
42320 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42321
42322 @item
42323 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42324
42325 @item
42326 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42327
42328 @item
42329 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42330 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42331 @end itemize
42332
42333 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42334 Modula-2.
42335
42336 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42337 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42338 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42339 by using the command @code{help}.
42340
42341 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42342 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42343 executable program as the argument:
42344
42345 @smallexample
42346 gdb program
42347 @end smallexample
42348
42349 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42350
42351 @smallexample
42352 gdb program core
42353 @end smallexample
42354
42355 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42356 to debug a running process:
42357
42358 @smallexample
42359 gdb program 1234
42360 gdb -p 1234
42361 @end smallexample
42362
42363 @noindent
42364 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42365 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42366 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42367
42368 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42369
42370 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42371 @table @env
42372 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42373 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42374
42375 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42376 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42377
42378 @item bt
42379 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42380
42381 @item print @var{expr}
42382 Display the value of an expression.
42383
42384 @item c
42385 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42386
42387 @item next
42388 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42389 function calls in the line.
42390
42391 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42392 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42393
42394 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42395 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42396
42397 @item step
42398 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42399 function calls in the line.
42400
42401 @item help [@var{name}]
42402 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42403 about using @value{GDBN}.
42404
42405 @item quit
42406 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42407 @end table
42408
42409 @ifset man
42410 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42411 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42412 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42413 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42414 @end ifset
42415 @c man end
42416
42417 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42418 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42419 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42420 encountered with no
42421 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42422 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42423 Many options have
42424 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42425 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42426 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42427 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42428 more usual convention.)
42429
42430 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42431 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42432 option is used.
42433
42434 @table @env
42435 @item -help
42436 @itemx -h
42437 List all options, with brief explanations.
42438
42439 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42440 @itemx -s @var{file}
42441 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42442
42443 @item -write
42444 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42445
42446 @item -exec=@var{file}
42447 @itemx -e @var{file}
42448 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42449 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42450 dump.
42451
42452 @item -se=@var{file}
42453 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42454 file.
42455
42456 @item -core=@var{file}
42457 @itemx -c @var{file}
42458 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42459
42460 @item -command=@var{file}
42461 @itemx -x @var{file}
42462 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42463
42464 @item -ex @var{command}
42465 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42466
42467 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42468 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42469 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42470
42471 @item -nh
42472 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
42473
42474 @item -nx
42475 @itemx -n
42476 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
42477
42478 @item -quiet
42479 @itemx -q
42480 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
42481 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
42482
42483 @item -batch
42484 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
42485 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
42486 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
42487 commands in the command files.
42488
42489 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
42490 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
42491 more useful, the message
42492
42493 @smallexample
42494 Program exited normally.
42495 @end smallexample
42496
42497 @noindent
42498 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
42499 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
42500
42501 @item -cd=@var{directory}
42502 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
42503 instead of the current directory.
42504
42505 @item -fullname
42506 @itemx -f
42507 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
42508 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
42509 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
42510 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
42511 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
42512 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
42513 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
42514 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
42515
42516 @item -b @var{bps}
42517 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
42518 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
42519
42520 @item -tty=@var{device}
42521 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
42522 @end table
42523 @c man end
42524
42525 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
42526 @ifset man
42527 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42528 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42529 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42530
42531 @smallexample
42532 info gdb
42533 @end smallexample
42534
42535 @noindent
42536 should give you access to the complete manual.
42537
42538 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42539 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42540 @end ifset
42541 @c man end
42542
42543 @node gdbserver man
42544 @heading gdbserver man
42545
42546 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
42547 @format
42548 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
42549 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42550
42551 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42552
42553 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42554 @c man end
42555 @end format
42556
42557 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
42558 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
42559 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
42560
42561 @ifclear man
42562 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
42563 @end ifclear
42564 @ifset man
42565 Usage (server (target) side):
42566 @end ifset
42567
42568 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
42569 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
42570 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
42571 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
42572
42573 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
42574 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
42575 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
42576
42577 @smallexample
42578 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
42579 @end smallexample
42580
42581 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
42582
42583 @smallexample
42584 @ifset man
42585 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
42586 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
42587 @end ifset
42588 @ifclear man
42589 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
42590 @end ifclear
42591 @end smallexample
42592
42593 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
42594 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
42595 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
42596
42597 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
42598
42599 @smallexample
42600 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
42601 @end smallexample
42602
42603 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
42604 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
42605 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
42606 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
42607 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
42608 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
42609 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
42610 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
42611 print an error message and exit.
42612
42613 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
42614 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
42615
42616 @smallexample
42617 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42618 @end smallexample
42619
42620 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42621 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42622
42623 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42624 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
42625 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
42626 the program you want to debug.
42627
42628 @smallexample
42629 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42630 @end smallexample
42631
42632 @ifclear man
42633 @subheading Usage (host side)
42634 @end ifclear
42635 @ifset man
42636 Usage (host side):
42637 @end ifset
42638
42639 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
42640 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
42641 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
42642 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
42643 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
42644 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
42645 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
42646 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
42647 descriptor. For example:
42648
42649 @smallexample
42650 @ifset man
42651 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
42652 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
42653 @end ifset
42654 @ifclear man
42655 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
42656 @end ifclear
42657 @end smallexample
42658
42659 @noindent
42660 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
42661
42662 @smallexample
42663 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
42664 @end smallexample
42665
42666 @noindent
42667 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
42668 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
42669 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42670 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42671 `Connection refused'.
42672
42673 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42674 described in
42675 @ifset man
42676 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42677 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42678 @end ifset
42679 @ifclear man
42680 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42681 @end ifclear
42682 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42683
42684 @smallexample
42685 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42686 @end smallexample
42687
42688 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42689 case.
42690 @c man end
42691
42692 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42693 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42694
42695 @itemize @bullet
42696
42697 @item
42698 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42699
42700 @smallexample
42701 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42702 @end smallexample
42703
42704 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42705 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42706 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42707 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
42708 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42709 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42710 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42711
42712 @item
42713 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42714 program:
42715
42716 @smallexample
42717 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42718 @end smallexample
42719
42720 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
42721 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42722 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42723 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42724
42725 @item
42726 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42727
42728 @smallexample
42729 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42730 @end smallexample
42731
42732 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42733 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42734 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42735 debug several processes in the same session.
42736 @end itemize
42737
42738 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42739
42740 @table @env
42741
42742 @item --help
42743 List all options, with brief explanations.
42744
42745 @item --version
42746 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42747
42748 @item --attach
42749 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
42750
42751 @smallexample
42752 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42753 @end smallexample
42754
42755 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
42756 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42757
42758 @item --multi
42759 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42760 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42761 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42762 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
42763
42764 @smallexample
42765 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42766 @end smallexample
42767
42768 @item --debug
42769 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42770 process.
42771 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42772 the developers.
42773
42774 @item --remote-debug
42775 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42776 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42777 the developers.
42778
42779 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42780 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42781 of debugging output.
42782 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42783
42784 @item --wrapper
42785 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42786 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
42787 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42788 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42789
42790 @item --once
42791 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42792 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42793 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42794 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42795
42796 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42797
42798 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42799 @c QDisableRandomization.
42800
42801 @end table
42802 @c man end
42803
42804 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42805 @ifset man
42806 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42807 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42808 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42809
42810 @smallexample
42811 info gdb
42812 @end smallexample
42813
42814 should give you access to the complete manual.
42815
42816 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42817 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42818 @end ifset
42819 @c man end
42820
42821 @node gcore man
42822 @heading gcore
42823
42824 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42825
42826 @format
42827 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42828 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42829 @c man end
42830 @end format
42831
42832 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42833 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42834 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42835 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42836 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42837 running without any change.
42838 @c man end
42839
42840 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42841 @table @env
42842 @item -o @var{filename}
42843 The optional argument
42844 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42845 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42846 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42847 @end table
42848 @c man end
42849
42850 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42851 @ifset man
42852 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42853 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42854 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42855
42856 @smallexample
42857 info gdb
42858 @end smallexample
42859
42860 @noindent
42861 should give you access to the complete manual.
42862
42863 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42864 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42865 @end ifset
42866 @c man end
42867
42868 @node gdbinit man
42869 @heading gdbinit
42870
42871 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42872
42873 @format
42874 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42875 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42876 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42877 @end ifset
42878
42879 ~/.gdbinit
42880
42881 ./.gdbinit
42882 @c man end
42883 @end format
42884
42885 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42886 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42887 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42888 described in
42889 @ifset man
42890 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42891 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42892 @end ifset
42893 @ifclear man
42894 @ref{Sequences}.
42895 @end ifclear
42896
42897 Please read more in
42898 @ifset man
42899 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42900 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42901 @end ifset
42902 @ifclear man
42903 @ref{Startup}.
42904 @end ifclear
42905
42906 @table @env
42907 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42908 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42909 @end ifset
42910 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42911 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42912 @end ifclear
42913 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42914 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42915 See more in
42916 @ifset man
42917 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42918 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42919 @end ifset
42920 @ifclear man
42921 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
42922 @end ifclear
42923
42924 @item ~/.gdbinit
42925 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
42926 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42927
42928 @item ./.gdbinit
42929 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
42930 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42931 See more in
42932 @ifset man
42933 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42934 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42935 @end ifset
42936 @ifclear man
42937 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42938 @end ifclear
42939 @end table
42940 @c man end
42941
42942 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42943 @ifset man
42944 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42945
42946 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42947 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42948 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42949
42950 @smallexample
42951 info gdb
42952 @end smallexample
42953
42954 should give you access to the complete manual.
42955
42956 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42957 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42958 @end ifset
42959 @c man end
42960
42961 @include gpl.texi
42962
42963 @node GNU Free Documentation License
42964 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42965 @include fdl.texi
42966
42967 @node Concept Index
42968 @unnumbered Concept Index
42969
42970 @printindex cp
42971
42972 @node Command and Variable Index
42973 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42974
42975 @printindex fn
42976
42977 @tex
42978 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
42979 % meantime:
42980 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42981 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42982 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42983 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42984 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42985 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42986 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42987 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42988 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42989 \page\colophon
42990 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42991 @end tex
42992
42993 @bye
This page took 1.322811 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.